PC Programming Manual Pure IP-PBX Model No. KX-NCP500 KX-NCP1000 Thank you for purchasing a Panasonic Pure IP-PBX. Please read this manual carefully before using this product and save this manual for future use. KX-NCP500/KX-NCP1000: PBMPR Software File Version 2.0000 or later Introduction Introduction About this Programming Manual The PC Programming Manual is designed to serve as a system programming reference for the Panasonic Pure IP-PBX. It explains how to programme this PBX using the Maintenance Console software. The PC Programming Manual is divided into the following sections: Section 1, Overview Provides an overview of programming the PBX. Section 2, Introduction of Maintenance Console Explains the layout and menus of the Maintenance Console. Sections 3 – 13, Maintenance Console Operating Instructions Serves as reference operating instructions when using the Maintenance Console software to programme the PBX. Section 14, Appendix Provides a list of changes from the previous version of each model. Feature Programming References Provides a list of all related PC programming items for each feature. References Found in the PC Programming Manual Programming Manual References Related sections of the PC Programming Manual are listed for your reference. Feature Guide References The Feature Guide explains what the PBX can do, as well as how to obtain the most of its many features and facilities. Sections from the Feature Guide are listed throughout this manual for your reference. Installation Manual References The Installation Manual provides instructions detailing the installation and maintenance of the PBX. Sections from the Installation Manual are listed throughout this manual for your reference. Links to Other Pages and Manuals If you are viewing this manual with a PC, certain items are linked to different sections of this and other PBX manuals. Click on a link to jump to that section. Linked items include: • Installation Manual References • PC Programming Manual References • Feature Guide References Safety Notices Please observe the safety notices in this manual in order to avoid danger to users or other people, and prevent damage to property. The notices are classified as follows, according to the severity of injury or damage: 2 PC Programming Manual Introduction WARNING This notice means that misuse could result in death or serious injury. CAUTION This notice means that misuse could result in injury or damage to property. WARNING Unplug the PBX from the AC outlet if it emits smoke, an abnormal smell or makes unusual noise. These conditions can cause fire or electric shock. Confirm that smoke has stopped and contact an authorised Panasonic Factory Service Centre. CAUTION Do not remove the SD Memory Card while power is supplied to the PBX. Doing so may cause the PBX to fail to start when you try to restart the system. Notice 1. During a long programming session, it is highly recommended that you periodically save the system data to the SD Memory Card. If the PBX undergoes a sudden power failure or if the system is reset for some reason, all the system data in RAM will be lost. However, if system data has been saved to the SD Memory Card, it can be easily restored. To save the system data to the SD Memory Card, (1) click the "SD Memory Backup" icon before resetting the PBX or turning off the power, or (2) exit the Maintenance Console so that the PBX automatically saves the system data. 2. Maintenance Console cannot be used to program the PBX when the PBX is being powered by the backup batteries (for example, during a power cut). This is to prevent damage to the SD Memory Card that may occur if the backup battery power runs out while data is being written to the card. 3. The PC will not perform any shutdown operation, or enter the power-saving system standby mode while the Maintenance Console is connected to the PBX. To perform either of the operations above, first close the connection to the PBX. Trademarks • • • Microsoft, Windows and Windows Vista are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and/or other countries. All other trademarks identified herein are the property of their respective owners. Microsoft product screen shot(s) reprinted with permission from Microsoft Corporation. NOTES • • • • The contents of this manual apply to PBXs with a certain software version, as indicated on the cover of this manual. To confirm the software version of your PBX, see How do I confirm the software version of the PBX or installed cards? in Maintenance Console Software in 2.7.1 Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ). Some optional service cards, PTs, and features are not available in some areas. Additionally, some optional service cards and features are not available for some PBX models. Please consult your certified Panasonic dealer for more information. The PBX supports the Virtual 16-Channel SIP Trunk Card, and configuration of the card is done using the Maintenance Console. However, all of the related programming information is explained in the Programming Manual for Virtual SIP Trunk Card, and is therefore omitted from this manual. Product specifications, including text displayed by the software, are subject to change without notice. PC Programming Manual 3 Introduction • In some cases, additional information, including updates to this and other manuals, is included in the Maintenance Console’s Information before programming. Install the latest version of Maintenance Console to view this information. In this manual, the suffix of each model number (e.g., KX-NCP500NE) is omitted unless necessary. The KX-NCP500UK/KX-NCP1000UK, KX-NCP500NE/KX-NCP1000NE, and KX-NCP500GR/KX-NCP1000GR are designed to interwork with the: • Analogue Public Switched Telephone Network (PSTN) of European countries • Pan-European Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) using ISDN basic rate access • Pan-European Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) using ISDN primary rate access • ONP 2048 kbit/s digital structured leased lines (D2048S) Panasonic Communications Co., Ltd./Panasonic Communications Company (U.K.) Ltd. declares that this equipment is in compliance with the essential requirements and other relevant provisions of Radio & Telecommunications Terminal Equipment (R&TTE) Directive 1999/5/EC. Declarations of Conformity for the relevant Panasonic products described in this manual are available for download by visiting: http://www.doc.panasonic.de Contact to Authorised Representative: Panasonic Testing Centre Panasonic Marketing Europe GmbH Winsbergring 15, 22525 Hamburg, Germany 4 PC Programming Manual Table of Contents Table of Contents 1 Overview .................................................................................................11 1.1 1.1.1 1.1.2 1.2 1.2.1 1.2.2 Introduction .....................................................................................................................12 Introduction .....................................................................................................................12 Entering Characters .......................................................................................................13 PC Programming .............................................................................................................17 Installing and Starting the Maintenance Console ...........................................................17 Password Security ..........................................................................................................22 2 Introduction of Maintenance Console ..................................................23 2.1 2.1.1 2.1.2 2.1.3 2.1.4 2.1.5 2.1.6 2.2 2.2.1 2.2.2 2.2.3 2.2.4 2.2.5 2.2.6 2.2.7 2.2.8 2.3 2.3.1 2.3.2 2.3.3 2.3.4 2.4 2.4.1 2.5 2.5.1 2.5.2 2.5.3 2.5.4 2.5.5 2.5.6 2.5.7 2.5.8 2.5.9 2.5.10 2.5.11 2.6 2.6.1 2.6.2 2.6.3 2.6.4 2.6.5 2.6.6 2.6.7 Introduction .....................................................................................................................24 Starting Maintenance Console and Software Modes .....................................................24 Access Levels ................................................................................................................27 Software Interface ..........................................................................................................31 Card Status ....................................................................................................................34 Display Options ..............................................................................................................35 Extension Number Setting ..............................................................................................36 Programme launcher ......................................................................................................37 Programme launcher—New ...........................................................................................37 Programme launcher—Open .........................................................................................38 Programme launcher—Connect—RS-232C ..................................................................39 Programme launcher—Connect—USB ..........................................................................40 Programme launcher—Connect—LAN ..........................................................................41 Programme launcher—Connect—Modem .....................................................................42 Programme launcher—Connect—ISDN Remote ...........................................................43 Programme launcher—Connect—Profile Setup .............................................................44 File ....................................................................................................................................45 File—Close .....................................................................................................................45 File—Save ......................................................................................................................46 File—Save As .................................................................................................................47 File—Exit ........................................................................................................................48 Disconnect .......................................................................................................................49 Disconnect—Disconnect ................................................................................................49 Tool ...................................................................................................................................50 Tool—SD memory backup .............................................................................................50 Tool—BRI Automatic Configuration ...............................................................................51 Tool—NDSS Link Data Clear .........................................................................................52 Tool—DXDP All OUS .....................................................................................................53 Tool—Simplified Voice Message—Delete All Recording ...............................................54 Tool—Simplified Voice Message—Check Current Usage .............................................55 Tool—Call Pickup for My Group .....................................................................................56 Tool—Extension List View ..............................................................................................57 Tool—Import ...................................................................................................................58 Tool—Export ..................................................................................................................62 Tool—Screen Customize—User Level/Administrator Level ...........................................63 Utility ................................................................................................................................64 Utility—Diagnosis ...........................................................................................................64 Utility—File Transfer PC to PBX (SD Card) ...................................................................66 Utility—File Transfer PBX (SD Card) to PC ...................................................................69 Utility—SD Card File View and Load ..............................................................................70 Utility—SD Card File Delete ...........................................................................................71 Utility—Message File Transfer PC to PBX .....................................................................72 Utility—Message File Transfer PBX to PC .....................................................................73 PC Programming Manual 5 Table of Contents 2.6.8 2.6.9 2.6.10 2.6.11 2.6.12 2.6.13 2.6.14 2.6.15 2.6.16 2.6.17 2.6.18 2.6.19 2.6.20 2.6.21 2.7 2.7.1 Utility—Error Log ............................................................................................................74 Utility—T1/E1 Signalling Bit Monitor ...............................................................................76 Utility—T1/E1 Line Trace ...............................................................................................77 Utility—ISDN/QSIG Protocol Trace ................................................................................78 Utility—V-IPGW16 Protocol Trace .................................................................................79 Utility—Digital Trunk Error Report ..................................................................................80 Utility—IP Extension Statistical Information ...................................................................81 Utility—CS Information ...................................................................................................82 Utility—PS Information ...................................................................................................83 Utility—CS Status Monitor ..............................................................................................84 Utility—Ping ....................................................................................................................85 Utility—File Transfer FTP to IP Equipment—IP-CS/NT400 ...........................................86 Utility—Card Software Timed Update ............................................................................87 Utility—System Reset—Reset by the Command ...........................................................88 Help ..................................................................................................................................89 Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ) ...............................................................................89 3 [1] Configuration ....................................................................................99 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 3.6 3.7 3.8 3.9 3.10 3.11 3.12 3.13 3.14 3.15 3.16 3.17 3.18 3.19 3.20 3.21 3.22 3.23 3.24 3.25 3.26 3.27 3.28 3.29 3.30 3.31 3.32 3.33 3.34 3.35 3.36 6 [1-1] Slot .........................................................................................................................100 [1-1] Slot—Summary .....................................................................................................103 [1-1] Slot—Activation Key ............................................................................................107 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR ............................................................................110 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property ..................................................................................130 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property—Card Command ....................................................134 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Gateway Port ...................................................135 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Gateway Port—Connection Command .........137 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway ..........................................................138 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GK Settings ..................................162 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GW Settings .................................163 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—DN2IP ............................................170 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—Hunt Pattern .................................172 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IP Extension ........................................................173 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension .........................................................180 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension—Connection Command ...............189 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual SIP Extension ......................................................190 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port ...............................................194 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port—Connection Command .......................................................................................................................199 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IPCS .....................................................................200 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS ......................................................................207 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS—Connection Command ............................216 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Extension Type ...............................................................217 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port ..................................................................222 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port—Connection Command ........................230 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port—Port Type View ....................................231 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type ..........................................................................232 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port ...........................................................................245 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port—Connection Command .................................251 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type ............................................................252 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port .............................................................................267 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—Connection Command ...................................290 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port .............................................................................291 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—Connection Command ...................................311 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type .............................................................................312 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port ...............................................................................323 PC Programming Manual Table of Contents 3.37 3.38 3.39 3.40 3.41 3.42 3.43 3.44 3.45 3.46 3.47 3.48 3.49 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port—Connection Command .....................................332 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type .............................................................................333 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting .........................................342 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 1 ............................................350 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 ............................................356 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port ..............................................................................364 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port—Connection Command ....................................373 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property ..................................................................................374 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property—Card Command ....................................................379 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Option Card Setup ...........................................................................381 [1-2] Portable Station ....................................................................................................383 [1-3] Option ....................................................................................................................387 [1-4] Clock Priority ........................................................................................................389 4 [2] System .............................................................................................391 4.1 4.2 4.3 4.4 4.5 4.6 4.7 4.8 4.9 4.10 4.11 4.12 4.13 4.14 4.15 4.16 4.17 4.18 4.19 4.20 4.21 [2-1-1] Date & Time—Date & Time Setting ..................................................................392 [2-1-2] Date & Time—SNTP / Daylight Saving ............................................................393 [2-1-2] Date & Time—SNTP / Daylight Saving—Daylight Saving ..............................395 [2-2] Operator & BGM ...................................................................................................397 [2-3] Timers & Counters ...............................................................................................400 [2-4] Week Table ............................................................................................................421 [2-4] Week Table—Time Setting ...................................................................................422 [2-5] Holiday Table ........................................................................................................425 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main .....................................................................................427 [2-6-2] Numbering Plan—Quick Dial ............................................................................457 [2-6-3] Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature ......................................................459 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings ......................................................................463 [2-7-2] Class of Service—External Call Block ............................................................478 [2-7-3] Class of Service—Internal Call Block ..............................................................479 [2-8-1] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from CO ..................................................................480 [2-8-2] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from Doorphone ....................................................481 [2-8-3] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from Others ............................................................482 [2-9] System Options ....................................................................................................485 [2-10] Extension CID Settings ......................................................................................512 [2-11-1] Audio Gain—Paging/MOH ..............................................................................516 [2-11-2] Audio Gain—Card ...........................................................................................518 5 [3] Group ...............................................................................................519 5.1 5.2 5.3 5.4 5.5 5.6 5.7 5.8 5.9 5.10 5.11 5.12 5.13 5.14 5.15 5.16 5.17 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings ............................................................................520 [3-1-2] Trunk Group—Local Access Priority ..............................................................528 [3-1-3] Caller ID Modification ........................................................................................529 [3-1-4] Dialling Plan .......................................................................................................534 [3-1-4] Dialling Plan—Auto Assign ..............................................................................536 [3-1-5] Trunk Group—Charge Rate ..............................................................................537 [3-2] User Group ............................................................................................................538 [3-3] Call Pickup Group ................................................................................................539 [3-3] Call Pickup Group—All Setting ...........................................................................540 [3-4] Paging Group ........................................................................................................541 [3-4] Paging Group—All Setting ..................................................................................542 [3-4] Paging Group—External Pager ...........................................................................543 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings ......................................545 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Member List .............561 [3-5-2] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Queuing Time Table ..............................563 [3-5-3] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Miscellaneous ........................................564 [3-6] Extension Hunting Group ....................................................................................566 PC Programming Manual 7 Table of Contents 5.18 5.19 5.20 5.21 5.22 5.23 5.24 5.25 5.26 5.27 5.28 5.29 [3-6] Extension Hunting Group—Member List ...........................................................568 [3-7-1] VM(DPT) Group—System Settings ..................................................................569 [3-7-2] VM(DPT) Group—Unit Settings ........................................................................571 [3-7-2] VM(DPT) Group—Unit Settings—Member List ...............................................572 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings ...............................................................575 [3-8-2] VM(DTMF) Group—Group Settings .................................................................584 [3-8-2] VM(DTMF) Group—Group Settings—Member List ........................................586 [3-9] PS Ring Group ......................................................................................................587 [3-9] PS Ring Group—Member List .............................................................................589 [3-10] Broadcasting Group ...........................................................................................590 [3-10] Broadcasting Group—Member List ..................................................................591 [3-11] Air Synchronisation Group ................................................................................592 6 [4] Extension .........................................................................................593 6.1 6.2 6.3 6.4 6.5 6.6 6.7 6.8 6.9 6.10 6.11 6.12 6.13 6.14 6.15 6.16 6.17 6.18 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings ............................................................594 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—CLIP Generate ................................646 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND ............................................................................649 [4-1-3] Wired Extension—Speed Dial ..........................................................................654 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button ...................................................................655 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button—Flexible button data copy ....................667 [4-1-5] Wired Extension—PF Button ...........................................................................668 [4-1-6] Wired Extension—NDSS Link Data - Send .....................................................669 [4-1-7] Wired Extension—Simplified Voice Message .................................................670 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings .............................................................673 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—CLIP Generate ................................704 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND ............................................................................707 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button ...................................................................712 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button—Flexible button data copy ....................723 [4-2-4] Portable Station—NDSS Link Data - Send ......................................................724 [4-2-5] Portable Station—Simplified Voice Message .................................................725 [4-3] DSS Console .........................................................................................................727 [4-3] DSS Console—DSS key data copy .....................................................................739 7 [5] Optional Device ...............................................................................741 7.1 7.2 7.3 7.4 7.5 7.6 7.7 [5-1] Doorphone ............................................................................................................742 [5-2] External Pager ......................................................................................................745 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System .........................................................................746 [5-3-2] Voice Message—DISA Message ......................................................................754 [5-3-3] Voice Message—SVM .......................................................................................757 [5-4] External Relay .......................................................................................................762 [5-5] External Sensor ....................................................................................................765 8 [6] Feature .............................................................................................769 8.1 8.2 8.3 8.4 8.5 8.6 [6-1] System Speed Dial ...............................................................................................770 [6-2] Hotel & Charge ......................................................................................................772 [6-3] Verification Code ..................................................................................................782 [6-4] Second Dial Tone .................................................................................................785 [6-5] Absent Message ...................................................................................................786 [6-6] Tenant ....................................................................................................................787 9 [7] TRS ...................................................................................................789 9.1 9.2 9.3 9.4 8 [7-1] Denied Code ..........................................................................................................790 [7-2] Exception Code ....................................................................................................791 [7-3] Special Carrier ......................................................................................................792 [7-4] Emergency Dial .....................................................................................................793 PC Programming Manual Table of Contents 9.5 [7-5] Miscellaneous .......................................................................................................794 10 [8] ARS ..................................................................................................797 10.1 10.2 10.3 10.4 10.5 10.6 10.7 10.8 [8-1] System Setting ......................................................................................................798 [8-2] Leading Number ...................................................................................................799 [8-3] Routing Plan Time ................................................................................................801 [8-3] Routing Plan Time—Time Setting .......................................................................802 [8-4] Routing Plan Priority ............................................................................................803 [8-5] Carrier ....................................................................................................................804 [8-6] Leading Number Exception .................................................................................807 [8-7] Authorisation Code for TRG ................................................................................808 11 [9] Private Network ...............................................................................809 11.1 11.2 11.3 11.4 [9-1] TIE Table ................................................................................................................810 [9-2] Network Data Transmission ................................................................................813 [9-3] Network Operator (VoIP) ......................................................................................817 [9-4] NDSS Key Table ....................................................................................................818 12 [10] CO & Incoming Call ......................................................................821 12.1 12.2 12.3 12.4 12.5 12.6 12.7 [10-1] CO Line Settings .................................................................................................822 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings ..................................................................................825 [10-3] DDI / DID Table ....................................................................................................835 [10-3] DDI/DID Table—Automatic Registration ...........................................................838 [10-3] DDI/DID Table—Name Generate ........................................................................840 [10-4] MSN Table ...........................................................................................................842 [10-5] Miscellaneous .....................................................................................................847 13 [11] Maintenance ..................................................................................849 13.1 13.2 13.3 13.4 13.5 13.6 [11-1] Main .....................................................................................................................850 [11-2] PT Programming Access ...................................................................................872 [11-3] Power Failure Transfer .......................................................................................873 [11-4-1] SNMP—System Setting ..................................................................................874 [11-4-2] SNMP—Manager ..............................................................................................876 [11-5] Air Synchronisation ...........................................................................................879 14 Appendix ...............................................................................................887 14.1 14.1.1 Revision History ............................................................................................................888 KX-NCP500/KX-NCP1000 PBMPR Software File Version 2.0xxx ...............................888 Feature Programming References ...........................................................891 PC Programming Manual 9 Table of Contents 10 PC Programming Manual Section 1 Overview This section provides an overview of programming the PBX. PC Programming Manual 11 1.1.1 Introduction 1.1 Introduction 1.1.1 Introduction These programming instructions are designed to serve as an overall system programming reference for the PBX. Each feature in the PBX has default settings that can be changed to customise the PBX to your requirements. These settings control the functions of the PBX, and changing them is referred to as "system programming". Only one person can perform system programming at a time. Any other users trying to enter programming mode will be denied access. Ways to Programme There are two programming methods: • PC (Personal Computer) Programming All features and settings of the PBX can be programmed through PC programming with Maintenance Console. Installing and starting the Maintenance Console is described in Section 1.2 PC Programming. Individual PC programming items are described in Section 2 Introduction of Maintenance Console. • PT (Proprietary Telephone) Programming A subset of the features and settings of the PBX can be programmed using a PT. PT programming is described in the PT Programming Manual. 12 PC Programming Manual 1.1.2 Entering Characters 1.1.2 Entering Characters The characters on a white background below can be used when storing a name, message, password or other text entry data using a PC. The available characters vary according to the model of PBX. Table 1 (Standard) PC Programming Manual 13 1.1.2 Entering Characters Table 2 (For CE model) 14 PC Programming Manual 1.1.2 Entering Characters Table 3 (For RU model) PC Programming Manual 15 1.1.2 Entering Characters Table 4 (For GR model) 16 PC Programming Manual 1.2.1 Installing and Starting the Maintenance Console 1.2 PC Programming 1.2.1 Installing and Starting the Maintenance Console System programming, diagnosis and administration can be performed with a PC using the Maintenance Console. This section describes how to install and start the Maintenance Console. System Requirements Required Operating System • Microsoft® Windows® XP or Windows Vista® Business operating system Minimum Hardware Requirements • HDD: 100 MB of available hard disk space Recommended Display Settings • Screen resolution: XGA (1024 ´ 768) • DPI setting: Normal size (96 DPI) PC Programming Manual 17 1.2.1 Installing and Starting the Maintenance Console Installing the Maintenance Console Note • • • Make sure to install and use the latest version of the Maintenance Console. To install or uninstall the software on a PC running Windows XP Professional, you must be logged in as a user in either the "Administrators" or "Power Users" group. To install or uninstall the software on a PC running Windows Vista Business, you must be logged in as a user in the "Administrators" group. 1. Copy the setup file of the Maintenance Console to your PC. 2. Double-click the setup file to run the installer. 3. Follow the on-screen instructions provided by the installation wizard. Starting the Maintenance Console and Assigning the Basic Items (Quick Setup) When you start the Maintenance Console with the Installer Level Programmer Code and connect to the PBX for the first time after initialisation (with the factory default setting), Quick Setup will launch automatically. During Quick Setup, you will set up the following basic items. For details about the basic items, refer to "2.3.4 Quick Setup" in the Feature Guide. 1. Connect the PC to the PBX with an Ethernet straight cable or RS-232C cross cable. 2. Start the Maintenance Console from the Start menu. 3. "Information before programming" appears. a. Carefully read this important additional information, which includes updates to this and other manuals. b. Click OK to close this window. 4. a. Enter the Installer Level Programmer Code (default: INSTALLER). Note There are 2 other Programmer Codes with limited authorisation: Administrator Level (default: ADMIN), and User Level (default: USER). (® 1.2.2 Password Security) b. Click OK. 5. Click Connect. 6. a. Select KX-NCP500/1000 from PBX Model. b. Select the LAN or RS-232C tab, depending on the type of PC connection with the PBX. c. Specify the settings as required. (See 2.1.1 Starting Maintenance Console and Software Modes) Note When connecting to the PBX for the first time selecting LAN, the IP Address and Port Number must be set to 192.168.0.101 and 35300 respectively. d. Enter the system password for installer (default: 1234). e. Click Connect. 18 PC Programming Manual 1.2.1 Installing and Starting the Maintenance Console When country/area data do not match: a. Click OK to replace the country/area data of the PBX. Replacement may take several minutes to 7. complete. b. Follow the procedure described in Section 3.13.1 Starting the PBX in the Installation Manual and restart the PBX. c. Repeat step 5 to reconnect the Maintenance Console to the PBX. 8. Follow the instructions of the Quick Setup wizard for the basic items in Quick Setup. 9. On the IP addressing information screen, the information for the IPCMPR card can be assigned automatically through a DHCP server or entered manually. Note If you change any information on this screen and click Apply, the PBX will need to be reset. When using a DHCP server: a. Select Enable for the DHCP Client setting. b. Click Apply. Note The boxes will turn grey and the IP addresses will be assigned automatically after the PBX is reset. When not using a DHCP server: a. Select Disable for the DHCP Client setting. b. In the IP Address for IPCMPR Card box, type the IP address of the IPCMPR card.*1 c. In the IP Address for VoIP-DSP box, type the IP address of the DSP card.*2 d. In the Subnet Mask box, type the subnet mask address of the network.*3 e. In the Default Gateway box, type the IP address of the default gateway.*4 f. Click Apply. After Quick Setup is completed, if the IP addressing information was not changed, the IP-PT registration screen is displayed. For information on registering IP-PTs to the PBX, see 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension. You may now begin programming the PBX. Notice • • • Do not change the IP addresses of the IPCMPR and DSP cards once IP telephones are registered to the PBX using these IP addresses. The IP telephones will not operate properly if these IP addresses are changed. A DHCP server must be able to use a "client identifier" option specified by RFC 2131. The PBX will not start properly if the IP addresses cannot be assigned automatically by the DHCP server when DHCP Client is set to Enable. In this case, you need to consult your network administrator because the DHCP server on your network may not be running or a network failure may have occurred. If the DHCP server is not available, change the DHCP Client setting to Disable and set fixed IP addresses, then restart the PBX. To change the DHCP Client setting, connect the PC with an RS-232C cross cable or Ethernet straight cable. When connecting the PC with an Ethernet straight cable, make sure the PBX is disconnected PC Programming Manual 19 1.2.1 Installing and Starting the Maintenance Console from the LAN and then connect the PC with an Ethernet straight cable using 192.168.0.101 for the IP address of the IPCMPR card. Valid IP address range: "1.0.0.0" to "223.255.255.255" Valid IP address range: "1.0.0.0" to "223.255.255.255" Valid subnet mask address range: "0–255.0–255.0–255.0–255" (except 0.0.0.0 and 255.255.255.255) Valid IP address range: "0.0.0.0" to "223.255.255.255" *1 *2 *3 *4 PBX Web Manager It is possible to use a PC with the Maintenance Console (PBX Unified PC Maintenance Console) installed, as a web server. This allows users to configure the PBX via a web browser on a local client, or a remote PC through the Internet. Client PBX Server IP Network Remote PC If Maintenance Console is installed on the client PC, a web server is not necessary. PBX Server/Client Accessing PBX Web Manager PBX Web Manager can be enabled during the installation of the Maintenance Console. It can also be enabled in Options. Note • When starting the Maintenance Console, if there is less than 80 MB of available memory, this feature is automatically disabled. • Only one user can access Maintenance Console or PBX Web Manager at any given time. To start PBX Web Manager: 1. If the PC is not the web server: Launch a web browsing application and enter the following URL: "http://xxx:8181/INDEX.ASPX" ’xxx’ should be replaced with the server’s IP address. If the PC is the web server: Double-click the PBX Web Manager icon in the system tray( ). 20 PC Programming Manual 1.2.1 Installing and Starting the Maintenance Console 2. At the login screen input the PBX’s IP address, port, and password. Any profiles using LAN connection that have been saved when accessing the Maintenance Console directly will be automatically displayed, for easy access to your PBX. 3. Click Connect. PBX Web Manager Main Menu After successful login the main menu will appear where settings can be changed. Note While logged in, if there is no activity over a 5-minute period, PBX Web Manager will automatically disconnect. PC Programming Manual 21 1.2.2 Password Security 1.2.2 Password Security To maintain system security, system passwords are required to access certain programming functions of the PBX. By giving different users access to different passwords, it is possible to control the amount of programming that each user is able to perform. The following types of system passwords are available: Password Description System Password for User Used with the user-level programmer code to access user-level PC programming. The installer can specify which system programming settings are available. System Password for Administrator Used with the administrator-level programmer code to access administrator-level PC programming. The installer can specify which system programming settings are available. System Password for Installer Used with the installer-level programmer code to access installer-level PC programming. All system programming settings are available. Format 4 – 10 characters The three programmer codes used for PC programming can be set through Maintenance Console. For more information about programmer codes, see 2.1.2 Access Levels. CAUTION To the Administrator or Installer regarding the system password 1. Please provide all system passwords to the customer. 2. To avoid unauthorised access and possible abuse of the PBX, keep the passwords secret, and inform the customer of the importance of the passwords, and the possible dangers if they become known to others. 3. The PBX has default passwords preset. For security, change these passwords the first time that you programme the PBX. 4. Change the passwords periodically. 5. It is strongly recommended that passwords of 10 numbers or characters be used for maximum protection against unauthorised access. For a list of numbers and characters that can be used in system passwords, see 1.1.2 Entering Characters. 22 PC Programming Manual Section 2 Introduction of Maintenance Console This section serves as reference operating instructions when using the Maintenance Console software to programme the PBX. PC Programming Manual 23 2.1.1 Starting Maintenance Console and Software Modes 2.1 Introduction 2.1.1 Starting Maintenance Console and Software Modes Every time Maintenance Console is started, a dialogue box will appear. From here, you can enter any of the 2 available software modes. • Batch mode Batch mode allows you to create new system data files, and make modifications to system data files stored on your PC, without being connected to the PBX. When you connect to the PBX, the modified data will be uploaded at one time. • Interactive mode Interactive mode allows you to directly modify the system data and settings stored in the PBX’s memory from a PC that is connected to the PBX. This mode displays the system data that is currently being used by the PBX, rather than the system data stored on the SD memory card. Data can be modified and results displayed in real time. To start Maintenance Console in Batch mode 1. Enter the relevant programmer code. 2. Click OK. The programme launcher will appear. 3. Select an option. • Select New to create a new system data file. • Select Open to open an existing system data file. To start Maintenance Console in Interactive mode 1. Enter the relevant programmer code. 2. Click OK. The programme launcher will appear. 3. Click Connect. Connection options will be displayed. • Select a Profile Name if you want to use a pre-saved profile. This option is only available when one or more profiles have been previously stored. a. Select the profile to use from the drop-down list. b. If the system password for the PBX has not been stored with the profile, enter it. If the system password has been stored with the selected profile, it does not need to be entered. • To enter the parameters manually, select the PBX Model and select the method of connecting to the PBX. a. Specify the settings as required. For more details, see the tables below. b. Enter the system password for the PBX. 4. Click Connect. Maintenance Console will start, and automatically connect to the PBX. If this is the first time that Maintenance Console has connected to the PBX, and the date and time of the PBX have not yet been set, the Quick Setup wizard will run. For more details, see Starting the Maintenance Console and Assigning the Basic Items (Quick Setup). 24 PC Programming Manual 2.1.1 Starting Maintenance Console and Software Modes Connection Settings for RS-232C Setting Values Explanation Port COMx Specify the number of the COM port assigned to the PC’s RS-232C interface. Only available COM ports are displayed. Baud Rate (bps) 2400, 4800, 9600, 19200, 38400, 57600, 115200 Specify the speed of data transmission. Connection Settings for Modem Setting Values Explanation Dial Number 1-9, 0, *, #, -, "," [comma], T, P, W Enter the telephone number to be dialled to access the PBX. T: Converts the Dial Type from Pulse to Tone. "," [comma], P, W: Inserts a pause. Dial Type Auto(Tone), Auto(Pulse), Manual Specify the outgoing dialling method. If Manual is chosen, dialling must be done with a connected telephone. Comment Max. 40 characters Enter a comment to identify the set of values. Port COMx Specify the number of the COM port assigned to the PC’s modem interface. Only available COM ports will be displayed. Baud Rate (bps) 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 19200, 38400 Specify the speed of data transmission. Modem Initialise – Enter the modem initialise command, and click Initialise to send the command to the modem. For more details, refer to your modem’s instruction manual. Connection Settings for LAN Setting Values Explanation IP Address 1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255 Specify the IP address of the PBX on the LAN. Enter the same IP address that was input in IP Address of 3.4 [1-1] Slot— Card Property - IPCMPR. PC Programming Manual 25 2.1.1 Starting Maintenance Console and Software Modes Setting Values Explanation Port Number 1–65535 Specify the port number used to access the PBX via LAN. Enter the same port number that was input in Maintenance Port Number of 3.4 [1-1] Slot— Card Property - IPCMPR. Connection Setting for ISDN Remote 26 Setting Values Explanation Dial Number 30 digits (consisting of 1-9, 0, *, #, -, and "," [comma]) Enter the telephone number to be dialled to access the PBX. PC Programming Manual 2.1.2 Access Levels 2.1.2 Access Levels There are three main levels of access to the Maintenance Console: User, Administrator and Installer. Each level has its own Programmer Code, which must be entered to run the Maintenance Console. The allowed format for each programmer code is as follows: Item Length User Level Programmer Code 0 – 16 characters Administrator Level Programmer Code 4 – 16 characters Installer Level Programmer Code 4 – 16 characters Access to menu options within the Maintenance Console is restricted depending on the Programmer Code, and the current software mode (see 2.1.1 Starting Maintenance Console and Software Modes). When a menu option is limited to certain access levels, this is noted in this manual in the initial description of that menu option, for example: "This option is only available at Installer level." If a sentence like this does not appear under the heading, the menu option is available at all levels. The target users for each access level are as follows: Access Level User User For end users Administrator For system administrators Installer For dealers and system installers The options available in each mode and access level are shown below. The access levels are abbreviated as follows: U: User; A: Administrator; I: Installer A check mark indicates that the menu option is available for that access level. Programme launcher Menu Option Batch U A New Interactive I U A ü I ü Open ü ü ü ü ü ü Connect—RS-232C ü ü ü ü ü ü Connect—USB ü ü ü ü ü ü Connect—LAN ü ü ü ü ü ü Connect—Modem ü ü ü ü ü ü Connect—ISDN Remote ü ü ü ü ü ü Connect—Profile Setup ü ü ü ü ü ü PC Programming Manual 27 2.1.2 Access Levels File Menu Option Batch Interactive U A I Close ü ü ü Save ü ü ü Save As ü ü ü Exit ü ü ü U A I ü ü ü Disconnect Menu Option Batch U A Interactive I Disconnect U A I ü ü ü Tool Menu Option Batch U A Interactive I SD memory backup A I ü ü ü BRI Automatic Configuration ü NDSS Link Data Clear ü DXDP All OUS ü Simplified Voice Message®Delete All Recording ü Simplified Voice Message®Check Current Usage ü Call Pickup for My Group 28 U ü ü Extension List View ü ü ü ü ü ü Import®Feature - Speed Dial and Caller ID ü ü ü ü ü ü Import®Incoming Call - DDI/DID Table ü ü Import®ARS - Leading Digit ü ü Import®ARS - Except Code ü ü Import®ARS - Routing Plan ü ü Import®Wired Extension ü ü Import®PS Extension ü ü Import®Quick Dial (Basic) ü ü Import®Quick Dial (Expansion) ü ü Import®SIP Extension ü ü PC Programming Manual 2.1.2 Access Levels Menu Option Batch U A Interactive I U A I Import®V-IPGW16 GW Settings ü ü Import®V-IPGW16 DN2IP ü ü Export®Feature - Speed Dial and Caller ID ü ü ü ü ü ü Export®Incoming Call - DDI/DID Table ü ü Export®ARS - Leading Digit ü ü Export®ARS - Except Code ü ü Export®ARS - Routing Plan ü ü Export®Wired Extension ü ü Export®PS Extension ü ü Export®Quick Dial (Basic) ü ü Export®Quick Dial (Expansion) ü ü Export®SIP Extension ü ü Export®V-IPGW16 GW Settings ü ü Export®V-IPGW16 DN2IP ü ü Screen Customize®User Level ü ü Screen Customize®Administrator Level ü ü Utility Menu Option Batch U Diagnosis A Interactive I U A I ü ü ü File Transfer PC to PBX (SD Card) ü File Transfer PBX (SD Card) to PC ü SD Card File View and Load ü SD Card File Delete ü Message File Transfer PC to PBX ü Message File Transfer PBX to PC ü Error Log ü ü ü T1/E1 Signalling Bit Monitor ü T1/E1 Line Trace ü ISDN/QSIG Protocol Trace ü V-IPGW16 Protocol Trace ü PC Programming Manual 29 2.1.2 Access Levels Menu Option Batch U A Interactive I U A I Digital Trunk Error Report ü IP Extension Statistical Information ü CS Information ü PS Information ü CS Status Monitor ü Ping ü File Transfer FTP to IP Equipment®IP-CS ü File Transfer FTP to IP Equipment®NT400 ü Card Software Timed Update ü System Reset®Reset by the Command ü View Menu Option Batch Interactive U A I U A I Toolbar ü ü ü ü ü ü Statusbar ü ü ü ü ü ü System Menu ü ü ü ü ü ü Window Menu Option Batch Interactive U A I U A I Cascade ü ü ü ü ü ü Tile(Horz) ü ü ü ü ü ü Tile(Vert) ü ü ü ü ü ü Help Menu Option 30 Batch Interactive U A I U A I Help ü ü ü ü ü ü Additional Information ü ü ü ü ü ü About ü ü ü ü ü ü PC Programming Manual 2.1.3 Software Interface 2.1.3 Software Interface This section explains the functions of the various elements of the software interface. Main Window The window of the Maintenance Console software is divided into several areas, as shown below: 1 23 4 5 6 1. Menu Bar Provides access to file management and connection options, as well as tools and utilities used in programming the PBX. For details, see Sections 2.3 File to 2.7 Help. 2. Tool Bar Provides easy access to commonly used software functions. Two tool bars are provided, as follows: PC Programming Manual 31 2.1.3 Software Interface • File • Tools Contains the icon for saving files. For details, see Section 2.3.2 File—Save. Contains icons for backing up PBX data to the SD Memory Card, viewing extension information, and accessing Online Help. For details, see Sections 2.5.1 Tool—SD memory backup and 2.5.8 Tool —Extension List View. These menus can be positioned freely. Click and drag the title bar of a menu to move it to another position. It will automatically snap in to position above, below, to the left, or to the right of the main window if released there. Otherwise, it will float separately from the main window. Whether the tool bar is displayed or not can be chosen by selecting Toolbar from the View menu. 3. Tab Bar The name of each screen currently open is displayed in a tab in this tab bar. When multiple screens are open at the same time, click on the tab of a screen to display the options associated with that screen. 4. System Menu Provides access to the settings used for programming the PBX, grouped into 11 topics. For details, see Sections Section 3 [1] Configuration to Section 13 [11] Maintenance. To display the individual screens within a topic, click the topic heading. It will expand to show the sub-topics. • If a sub-topic contains more than one screen, clicking the name of the sub-topic will display the names of individual screens. Clicking an expanded sub-topic will hide the names of individual screens. Double-click on a screen name to open that screen in 6. Main Screen below. This menu can be positioned freely. Click and drag the title bar of the menu to move it to another position. It will automatically snap in to either the left side or right side of the main window if released there. Otherwise, it will float separately from the main window. Whether the system menu is displayed or not can be chosen by selecting System Menu from the View menu. 5. Status Bar The status bar displays information on the current state of the Maintenance Console. Whether the status bar is displayed or not can be chosen by selecting Statusbar from the View menu. The information displayed is as follows, in order from left to right: Area Values Description Programme Mode and Connection Type Programme Mode: Batch Mode xxx Interactive Mode yyy Displays the current programme mode and connection type. See 2.1.1 Starting Maintenance Console and Software Modes above. "xxx" is replaced by the name of the current system data file. "yyy" is replaced by the name of the profile if used. Connection Type: RS-232C USB LAN Modem ISDN Remote 32 PBX Type Type: NCP500/ NCP1000 Displays the type of PBX being programmed. Access Level Level : User Administrator Installer Displays the current access level, determined by the Programmer Code entered when starting Maintenance Console. See 2.1.2 Access Levels for more information. PC Programming Manual 2.1.3 Software Interface Area Values Description PBX System Data Version Versionxxx-xxx Displays the version number of the system software installed to the PBX. The first 3 digits are the version number, and the last 3 digits are the revision number. PBX Region Code Regionxxx-xxx Displays the region code assigned to the PBX and Maintenance Console. The first 3 digits represent the region code assigned to the PBX, and the last 3 digits represent the region code assigned to the Maintenance Console. 6. Main Screen Displays the screens selected from 4. System Menu above. For details, see Sections Section 3 [1] Configuration to Section 13 [11] Maintenance. Standard Buttons and Elements There are several standard buttons that are displayed on many screens within the Maintenance Console. The standard buttons are as follows: Button Function OK Implements changes and closes the current screen. Cancel Abandons changes and returns to the previous screen. Close Keeps any changes implemented, and closes the current screen. Apply Implements changes and remains on the same screen. Refresh Implements changes, updates displayed data, and remains on the current screen. Help Displays the relevant help topic for the current screen. In addition, many screens within the software display a small open folder icon ( ) beside lists of setting items. Clicking this icon will collapse part of the list, allowing other items to be displayed. The icon will change to a closed folder ( ). Clicking the closed folder icon will expand the list again. PC Programming Manual 33 2.1.4 Card Status 2.1.4 Card Status Certain tools, utilities and settings require that the target card be set to out-of-service (OUS) or in-service (INS) status before the operation is carried out. Where required, this is noted in the description of each item. Card status changes can only be performed when the software is in Interactive mode (see 2.1.1 Starting Maintenance Console and Software Modes). • "In service" means that the card is installed correctly in the PBX, and is capable of being used normally. • "Out of service" means that the card is installed correctly in the PBX, but has been temporarily removed from use. This allows settings to be modified or software to be upgraded. • "Fault" means that the card is not installed in the PBX correctly, or is not functioning correctly. For more information, see the Installation Manual. For details about how to change the status of a card, see To change the status (INS/OUS) of a card (Interactive mode only) on screen 3.1 [1-1] Slot. 34 PC Programming Manual 2.1.5 Display Options 2.1.5 Display Options The View and Window menus provide options to control the display of items within the Maintenance Console. View – Toolbar: Displays or hides the tool bar of commonly used buttons. – Statusbar: Displays or hides the bar at the bottom of the Maintenance Console window. – System Menu: Displays or hides the menu of PBX setting screens. • Window – Cascade: When multiple data screens are open, displays all open screens overlapped, with the title bars visible. – Tile(Horz): When multiple data screens are open, displays all open screens side by side. – Tile(Vert): When multiple data screens are open, displays all open screens vertically. • PC Programming Manual 35 2.1.6 Extension Number Setting 2.1.6 Extension Number Setting Many screens within the Maintenance Console software allow you to select extensions as part of programming various features (for example, as members of a group). These screens use a standard window to make selecting multiple extensions easy, accessed by clicking a button. This section explains how to use this Extension Number Setting window. To select multiple extension numbers, select the type of extension to display, highlight the extensions you wish to add, then click the Add button. When finished, click OK. Data for the selected extensions will be added to the first free spaces on the original screen. Extension Type Selects the types of extension numbers to display in Extension Numbers & Names List. Multiple items can be selected. Items that are not available are shown with a grey checkbox. Value Range Wired Extension, Portable Station, VM Group(DPT), VM Group(DTMF), ICD Group, PS Ring Group, OGM(DISA), External Pager, Analogue MODEM, ISDN Remote Extension Numbers & Names List Displays all available extensions of the types selected in Extension Type, and names. Click entries to select them, and click the Add button when finished, to add the selected extensions. To deselect an entry, click it again. Value Range Matching extensions Available Column Specifies which fields in the original form to add extension data to. For example, if both extension numbers and names can be entered in the original form, it is possible to specify that extension name data not be transferred, by deselecting that field here. To select or deselect a field, click its name. Value Range Available fields Selected Extension List Displays the extensions that have been selected to be added to member data. To remove an extension from this list, click it to select it and click Delete. Value Range Selected extensions 36 PC Programming Manual 2.2.1 Programme launcher—New 2.2 Programme launcher 2.2.1 Programme launcher—New Creates a new system data file, used to programme the PBX in Batch mode. All settings are in their initial or default state. This option is only available at Installer level. To upload the file created here to the SD memory card installed in the PBX, see 2.6.2 Utility—File Transfer PC to PBX (SD Card). Note Since selecting this option creates a blank system data file, uploading this file to the PBX will overwrite all previous settings. Use only when necessary. To create a new system data file 1. From the programme launcher, select New. 2. Click the appropriate model number. 3. Click OK. PC Programming Manual 37 2.2.2 Programme launcher—Open 2.2.2 Programme launcher—Open Opens a system data file previously saved on the PC, and enters Batch mode. When opening a file created with an older version of the Maintenance Console, you will be asked whether you want to convert the data for use with the current version or not. Using the data without converting may result in some data being loaded to an incorrect destination, and is not recommended. If the file is not supported by the PBX (e.g. a system data file from an incompatible PBX), it will not be opened. The only files that can be opened are files that were created by the Maintenance Console for a supported PBX. To upload a file opened here to the SD memory card installed in the PBX, see 2.6.2 Utility—File Transfer PC to PBX (SD Card). To open a system data file 1. From the programme launcher, select Open. The Open dialogue box will be displayed. 2. Navigate to the folder containing the system data file you want to open. 3. Select the file. 4. Click Open. If the file was created with an older version of the Maintenance Console, you will be asked if you want to convert the data. • Click Yes to convert the data for use with the current version of the Maintenance Console. Enter a name for the new converted system file. • Click No to open the file as it is. 38 PC Programming Manual 2.2.3 Programme launcher—Connect—RS-232C 2.2.3 Programme launcher—Connect—RS-232C Connects to the PBX in Interactive mode through the serial RS-232C interface of the PBX. This option allows direct entry of connection parameters, for cases where the PC is used to connect to one or just a few PBXs, and an individual profile for each PBX is not necessary. If you connect to multiple PBXs and would prefer to choose from among pre-saved profiles instead, see 2.2.8 Programme launcher—Connect —Profile Setup for more details about creating profiles. To connect to the PBX by RS-232C 1. From the programme launcher, select Connect. The Login window will be displayed. 2. Select a connection option. • Select a Profile Name if you want to use a pre-saved profile. This option is only available when one or more profiles have been previously stored. a. Select the profile to use from the drop-down list. b. If the system password for the PBX has not been stored with the profile, enter it. If the system password has been stored with the selected profile, it does not need to be entered. • To enter the parameters manually, select the PBX Model and confirm that the RS-232C radio button is selected. a. Specify the settings as required. For more details, see the table below. b. Enter the system password for the PBX. 3. Click Connect. Connection Settings for RS-232C Setting Values Explanation Port COMx Specify the number of the COM port assigned to the PC’s RS-232C interface. Only available COM ports are displayed. Baud Rate (bps) 2400, 4800, 9600, 19200, 38400, 57600, 115200 Specify the speed of data transmission. PC Programming Manual 39 2.2.4 Programme launcher—Connect—USB 2.2.4 Programme launcher—Connect—USB Connects to the PBX in Interactive mode through a USB port (USB Module) attached to the KX-DT300 series or KX-T7600 series DPT. To connect to the PBX by USB 1. From the programme launcher, select Connect. The Login window will be displayed. 2. Select a connection option. • Select a Profile Name if you want to use a pre-saved profile. a. Select the profile to use from the drop-down list. b. If the system password for the PBX has not been stored with the profile, enter it. If the system password has been stored with the selected profile, it does not need to be entered. • To enter the parameters manually, select the PBX Model and confirm that the USB radio button is selected. a. Enter the system password for the PBX. 3. Click Connect. 40 PC Programming Manual 2.2.5 Programme launcher—Connect—LAN 2.2.5 Programme launcher—Connect—LAN Connects to the PBX in Interactive mode through the Local Area Network interface of the PBX. This option allows direct entry of connection parameters, for cases where the PC is used to connect to one or just a few PBXs, and an individual profile for each PBX is not necessary. If you connect to multiple PBXs and would prefer to choose from among pre-saved profiles instead, see 2.2.8 Programme launcher—Connect —Profile Setup for more details about creating profiles. To connect to the PBX by LAN 1. From the programme launcher, select Connect. The Login window will be displayed. 2. Select a connection option. • Select a Profile Name if you want to use a pre-saved profile. a. Select the profile to use from the drop-down list. b. If the system password for the PBX has not been stored with the profile, enter it. If the system password has been stored with the selected profile, it does not need to be entered. • To enter the parameters manually, select the PBX Model and confirm that the LAN radio button is selected. a. Specify the settings as required. For more details, see the table below. b. Enter the system password for the PBX. 3. Click Connect. Connection Settings for LAN Setting Values Explanation IP Address 1.0.0.0– 223.255.255.255 Specify the IP address of the PBX on the LAN. Enter the same IP address that was input in IP Address for IPCMPR Card of 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR. Port Number 1–65535 Specify the port number used to access the PBX via LAN. Enter the same port number that was input in Maintenance Port Number of 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR. PC Programming Manual 41 2.2.6 Programme launcher—Connect—Modem 2.2.6 Programme launcher—Connect—Modem Connects to the PBX in Interactive mode through the modem. To access the PBX remotely using this feature, an RMT card must be installed and the Remote—Analogue Remote (Modem) Floating Extension Number assigned in 13.1 [11-1] Main. This option allows direct entry of connection parameters, for cases where the PC is used to connect to one or just a few PBXs, and an individual profile for each PBX is not necessary. If you connect to multiple PBXs and would prefer to choose from among pre-saved profiles instead, see 2.2.8 Programme launcher—Connect —Profile Setup for more details about creating profiles. To connect to the PBX by Modem 1. From the programme launcher, select Connect. The Login window will be displayed. 2. Select a connection option. • Select a Profile Name if you want to use a pre-saved profile. a. Select the profile to use from the drop-down list. b. If the system password for the PBX has not been stored with the profile, enter it. If the system password has been stored with the selected profile, it does not need to be entered. • To enter the parameters manually, select the PBX Model and confirm that the Modem radio button is selected. a. Specify the settings as required. For more details, see the table below. b. Enter the system password for the PBX. 3. Click Connect. Connection Settings for Modem 42 Setting Values Description Dial Number 1-9, 0, *, #, -, "," [comma], T, P, W Enter the telephone number to be dialled to access the PBX. T: Converts the Dial Type from Pulse to Tone. "," [comma], P, W: Inserts a pause. Dial Type Auto(Tone), Auto(Pulse), Manual Specify the outgoing dialling method. If Manual is chosen, dialling must be done with a connected telephone. Comment Max. 40 characters Enter a comment to identify the set of values. Port COMx Specify the number of the COM port assigned to the PC’s modem interface. Only available COM ports will be displayed. Baud Rate (bps) 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 19200, 38400 Specify the speed of data transmission. Modem Initialise – Enter the modem initialise command, and click Initialise to send the command to the modem. For more details, refer to your modem’s instruction manual. PC Programming Manual 2.2.7 Programme launcher—Connect—ISDN Remote 2.2.7 Programme launcher—Connect—ISDN Remote Connects to the PBX in Interactive mode using the ISDN TA interface of the PBX. This method is only available when a user-supplied ISDN TA that supports CAPI 2.0 is used, and Remote —ISDN Remote Floating Extension Number of the 13.1 [11-1] Main screen is set. This option allows direct entry of connection parameters, for cases where the PC is used to connect to one or just a few PBXs, and an individual profile for each PBX is not necessary. If you connect to multiple PBXs and would prefer to choose from among pre-saved profiles instead, see 2.2.8 Programme launcher—Connect —Profile Setup for more details about creating profiles. To connect to the PBX by ISDN Remote 1. From the programme launcher, select Connect. The Login window will be displayed. 2. Select a connection option. • Select a Profile Name if you want to use a pre-saved profile. a. Select the profile to use from the drop-down list. b. If the system password for the PBX has not been stored with the profile, enter it. If the system password has been stored with the selected profile, it does not need to be entered. • To enter the parameters manually, select the PBX Model and confirm that the ISDN Remote radio button is selected. a. Specify the settings as required. For more details, see the table below. b. Enter the system password for the PBX. 3. Click Connect. Connection Setting for ISDN Remote Setting Values Explanation Dial Number 30 digits (consisting of 1-9, 0, *, #, -, and "," [comma]) Enter the telephone number to be dialled to access the PBX. PC Programming Manual 43 2.2.8 Programme launcher—Connect—Profile Setup 2.2.8 Programme launcher—Connect—Profile Setup Profiles are useful when one PC is used to connect to multiple PBXs. Rather than manually adjusting the connection settings each time a different PBX is accessed, it is possible to store the connection settings for several PBXs. Then, when you wish to connect to a specific PBX, you can simply choose that PBX’s profile from the list. Note When reinstalling or upgrading the Maintenance Console, it is possible to create a backup of all profiles. This allows you to use the original connection settings with the new Maintenance Console. The functions of the buttons on this screen are as follows: 44 Button Function Profile File Opens or saves profiles as separate files. Save current profile Overwrites the previous settings with the current settings when a profile already exists. A confirmation message will be displayed. Save as new profile Saves the current settings as a new profile. A Profile Name is required. Delete profile When an existing profile is selected, deletes that profile. A confirmation message will be displayed. PC Programming Manual 2.3.1 File—Close 2.3 File 2.3.1 File—Close Closes the system data file that is currently being modified, and returns to the programme launcher. To close a system data file • From the File menu, select Close. If the system data file has not been saved, a warning message will be displayed, giving you the option to save the file. • Click Yes to save the file. • Click No to abandon the changes. PC Programming Manual 45 2.3.2 File—Save 2.3.2 File—Save Overwrites the previously saved system data file with the system data currently being modified in Batch mode. To upload a file saved here to the SD memory card installed in the PBX, see 2.6.2 Utility—File Transfer PC to PBX (SD Card). To save a system data file • From the File menu, select Save. If the data has never been saved, the Save dialogue box will be displayed. For more details, see 2.3.3 File —Save As. 46 PC Programming Manual 2.3.3 File—Save As 2.3.3 File—Save As Saves the system data file being modified in Batch mode with the name chosen by the user. To upload a file saved here to the SD memory card installed in the PBX, see 2.6.2 Utility—File Transfer PC to PBX (SD Card). To save a system data file with a new name 1. From the File menu, select Save As. 2. Navigate to the folder in which you want to save the file. 3. Enter a file name, or select a file to overwrite. 4. Click Save. If choosing to overwrite another file, a warning message will be displayed. • Click Yes to overwrite. • Click No to return to the previous screen. PC Programming Manual 47 2.3.4 File—Exit 2.3.4 File—Exit Closes the Maintenance Console. To exit the Maintenance Console • From the File menu, select Exit If the system data file being modified has not been saved, a warning message will be displayed, giving you the option to save the file. • Click Yes to save the file. • Click No to abandon the changes. 48 PC Programming Manual 2.4.1 Disconnect—Disconnect 2.4 Disconnect 2.4.1 Disconnect—Disconnect Closes the connection between the Maintenance Console and the PBX. When this option is chosen, system data is automatically backed up from the PBX to the SD memory card (see 2.5.1 Tool—SD memory backup). To disconnect 1. From the Disconnect menu, select Disconnect. A confirmation message will be displayed. 2. Click Yes. PC Programming Manual 49 2.5.1 Tool—SD memory backup 2.5 Tool 2.5.1 Tool—SD memory backup Saves system data from the PBX to the SD memory card. Backup begins as soon as this option is chosen. To back up system data • From the Tool menu, select SD memory backup. 50 PC Programming Manual 2.5.2 Tool—BRI Automatic Configuration 2.5.2 Tool—BRI Automatic Configuration Automatically configures the network settings of the BRI card. This option is only available at Installer level. This tool automatically inputs values into the fields L1 Mode, L2 Mode, Access Mode, and Mode, on the Network tab of the 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port screen. TEI Note • • • Only one card can be configured at a time. To use this tool, the card to be configured must be pre-set to OUS status. For more details, see 2.1.4 Card Status. When configuration is complete, the card is automatically returned to INS status. At any time on this screen, you can click Close to return to the previous screen without saving. To configure the BRI card 1. From the Tool menu, select BRI Automatic Configuration. 2. Select the BRI card to configure by clicking the Check cell and setting it to ON. 3. Click OK. 4. 5. 6. 7. The ports associated with the selected BRI card will be displayed on a new screen. Enter suitable Subscriber Numbers for the ports you want to configure. Only ports whose Subscriber Numbers have been entered will be configured. Click Execute. The results of configuration will be displayed. Click the Check Box cell for the ports that have been configured. Click Data Apply to save these results to the BRI card. PC Programming Manual 51 2.5.3 Tool—NDSS Link Data Clear 2.5.3 Tool—NDSS Link Data Clear Clears NDSS Link Data stored in the connected PBX. While this tool clears both monitor extension and monitored extension data, it only clears it at the connected PBX. To clear this data at other PBXs in the network, it is necessary to run this tool at those PBXs. To clear the NDSS Link Data • From the Tool menu, select NDSS Link Data Clear. A confirmation screen will be displayed. • Click OK to clear the data. • Click Cancel to keep the data, and close the screen. 52 PC Programming Manual 2.5.4 Tool—DXDP All OUS 2.5.4 Tool—DXDP All OUS Sets the status of all DXDP/XDP extension ports to "OUS" simultaneously. To set all DXDP/XDP ports to OUS. 1. From the Tool menu, select DXDP All OUS. 2. Click OK. PC Programming Manual 53 2.5.5 Tool—Simplified Voice Message—Delete All Recording 2.5.5 Tool—Simplified Voice Message—Delete All Recording Deletes all voice messages recorded by the SVM feature. To delete voice messages 1. From the Tool menu, point to Simplified Voice Message and select Delete All Recording. 2. Select the card from which to delete messages. 3. Click OK. 54 PC Programming Manual 2.5.6 Tool—Simplified Voice Message—Check Current Usage 2.5.6 Tool—Simplified Voice Message—Check Current Usage Displays information on the voice messages stored by the SVM feature. For each message, the type of message and the associated extension are displayed. To view SVM message status • From the Tool menu, point to Simplified Voice Message and select Check Current Usage. PC Programming Manual 55 2.5.7 Tool—Call Pickup for My Group 2.5.7 Tool—Call Pickup for My Group Allows you to automatically configure settings in 4.10 [2-6-2] Numbering Plan—Quick Dial and 6.4 [4-1-3] Wired Extension—Speed Dial so that users can answer calls to their Call Pickup Group by pressing " 0". To activate this tool • From the Tool menu, select Call Pickup for My Group. The Group Call Pickup feature number (default: is assigned to first personal speed dial. 40) + the extension user group number of the extension Note This tool can only be activated if all of the following conditions are met: – The first Quick Dial setting is empty or is already set to " 0". – " 0" is not used for another feature number. – The Group Call Pickup feature number has been assigned. – The Personal Speed Dialling feature number has been assigned. 56 PC Programming Manual 2.5.8 Tool—Extension List View 2.5.8 Tool—Extension List View Displays a list of all programmed extension numbers and types. It is possible to sort the information according to Extension Number, Type, Extension Name, Shelf, Slot, or Port. There is also a key-word searching feature. The types that can be displayed are as follows: Type Detail Intercom Wired Extension VM Voice Mail Portable Station Wireless Extension (Portable Station) ICDG Incoming Call Distribution Group WG PS Ring Group VM (DPT) VM (DPT) Group VM (DTMF) VM (DTMF) Group Pager External Pager MODEM Analogue Modem ISDN Remote ISDN Modem OGM (DISA) DISA DSS DSS Console DPT-I/F CS PT-interface CS SVM SVM Feature SIP/IP-PT IP Telephone To view extension information • From the Tool menu, select Extension List View. PC Programming Manual 57 2.5.9 Tool—Import 2.5.9 Tool—Import Allows several types of system data files or tables to be imported. Except for Speed Dial and Caller ID, this option is only available at Installer level. The files from which data can be imported are files that were previously saved at this or another PBX using the Export tool (see 2.5.10 Tool—Export), or comma-separated value (CSV) files. Unsupported file types cannot be opened. For all tables except ARS - Routing Plan, it is possible to edit the CSV file directly using an appropriate editor, before importing. The types of data that can be imported using this tool, and the matching destination fields, are as follows: Feature - Speed Dial and Caller ID Data Type Import Destination System Speed Dialling Number Location Name Name CO Line Access Number + Telephone Number Dial CLI Destination CLI Destination Related programming: 8.1 [6-1] System Speed Dial Incoming Call - DDI/DID Table Data Type Import Destination Location Location DDI/DID Number Dial In Number DDI/DID Name Dial In Name DDI/DID Destination-Day Destination-Day DDI/DID Destination-Lunch Destination-Lunch DDI/DID Destination-Break Destination-Break DDI/DID Destination-Night Destination-Night Tenant Number Tenant Number VM Trunk Group No. Group Number for VPS answer CLI Ring for DDI/DID-Day CLI Ring - Day CLI Ring for DDI/DID-Lunch CLI Ring - Lunch CLI Ring for DDI/DID-Break CLI Ring - Break CLI Ring for DDI/DID-Night CLI Ring - Night Related programming: 12.3 [10-3] DDI / DID Table 58 PC Programming Manual 2.5.9 Tool—Import ARS - Leading Digit Data Type Import Destination No. Location Leading Number Leading Digit Additional Number of Digits Additional Dial Digits Routing Plan Number Route Plan Number Related programming: 10.2 [8-2] Leading Number ARS - Except Code Data Type Import Destination No. Location Leading Number Exception Exception Code Related programming: 10.7 [8-6] Leading Number Exception ARS - Routing Plan Data Type Import Destination (no fields to select) (no fields to select) Related programming: 10.3 [8-3] Routing Plan Time Wired Extension Data Type Import Destination No. Location (selected automatically) Extension Number Extension Number (selected automatically) Extension Name Extension Name (selected automatically) Related programming: 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings PS Extension *1 Data Type Import Destination No. Location (selected automatically) Extension Number*1 Extension Number (selected automatically) Extension Name Extension Name (selected automatically) This data can only be exported, and cannot be imported. PC Programming Manual 59 2.5.9 Tool—Import Related programming: 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Quick Dial (Basic) Data Type Import Destination No. Location Dial Dial Phone Number Phone Number Related programming: 4.10 [2-6-2] Numbering Plan—Quick Dial Quick Dial (Expansion) Data Type Import Destination No. Location Dial Dial Phone Number Phone Number Related programming: 4.10 [2-6-2] Numbering Plan—Quick Dial SIP Extension Data Type Import Destination No. Location Extension Number Extension Number Password Password Related programming: 3.18 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port V-IPGW16 GW Settings 60 Data Type Import Destination No. Location GW Name GW Name GW IP Address GW IP Address GW Group GW Group No. Connection for IP-GW16 Connection for IP-GW16 Protocol Protocol Progress Tone Send Mode Progress Tone Send Mode IP Codec Priority 1st IP Codec Priority 1st IP Codec Priority 2nd IP Codec Priority 2nd IP Codec Priority 3rd IP Codec Priority 3rd Packet Sampling Time (G. 711A) Packet Sampling Time (G. 711A) PC Programming Manual 2.5.9 Tool—Import Data Type Import Destination Packet Sampling Time (G. 711Mu) Packet Sampling Time (G. 711Mu) Packet Sampling Time (G. 729A) Packet Sampling Time (G. 729A) Voice Activity Detection for G. 711 Voice Activity Detection for G. 711 FAX Detection Ability FAX Detection Ability DTMF DTMF Payload Type Payload Type Related programming: 3.11 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GW Settings V-IPGW16 DN2IP Data Type Import Destination No. Location Leading Number Leading Number Remaining Number of Digits Remaining Number of Digits GW No./GW Group Selection GW No./GW Group Selection GW Group GW Group GW No. GW No. Related programming: 3.12 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—DN2IP To import system data 1. From the Tool menu, point to Import, and then click the type of data to import. 2. Navigate to the folder containing the system data file you want to open. 3. Select the file. 4. Click Open to open the file. If applicable, a list of field names found in the imported file will be displayed. 5. For the Feature - Speed Dial and Caller ID table, select the Speed Dial table to which to import the data (system or tenant) from the drop-down list. 6. If required, select import fields. When import fields can be selected, the selection screen is displayed automatically. Matching origin and destination fields are entered by default. • To change the destination for an import field, select the preferred field from the drop-down list. • To not import a field, select the blank option from the drop-down list. 7. Click OK to perform the import operation. Depending on the type of data imported, the relevant programming screen may be displayed. • Click OK or Apply to complete the import operation. If data in a field being imported does not match the required format for the import destination, an error message will be displayed when the import operation is attempted, and the operation will be cancelled. This can occur when, for example, the destination field can only accept numeric data, but the data being imported contains alphabet characters, as the correct fields were not linked together. PC Programming Manual 61 2.5.10 Tool—Export 2.5.10 Tool—Export Allows several types of system data to be exported to files. These files can be used with the Import tool (see 2.5.9 Tool—Import) to update another PBX. Except for ARS - Routing Plan, tables are exported as comma-separated value (CSV) files. Except for Speed Dial and Caller ID, this option is only available at Installer level. Note The separator used in CSV files created using the Export tool is decided by the unit specified in List Separator, in the Windows Regional Options Control Panel. To export system data 1. From the Tool menu, point to Export, and then click the type of data to export. 2. Navigate to the folder in which you want to save the file. 3. Enter a file name. 4. Click Save. • When export fields are automatically selected, the file will be saved. • When export fields can be selected, the selection screen will be displayed automatically. 5. For the Feature - Speed Dial and Caller ID table, select the Speed Dial table from which to export the data (system or tenant) from the drop-down list. A list of field names that can be exported will be displayed. 6. Click the check box beside the name of each field that you want to export. 7. Click OK. 62 PC Programming Manual 2.5.11 Tool—Screen Customize—User Level/Administrator Level 2.5.11 Tool—Screen Customize—User Level/Administrator Level Allows you to specify which menu screens, tools and utilities can be accessed in User and Administrator levels. This option is only available at Installer level. Selected check boxes will be displayed on the main screen of the Maintenance Console and in the menu bar to users with the level of access being edited. To modify displayed screens 1. From the Tool menu, point to Screen Customize, and then click the access level to modify. 2. Select the items that you want to have displayed. • Clear the check box beside the names of items you do not want to have displayed. • Select the check box beside the names of items you want to have displayed. 3. Click OK. PC Programming Manual 63 2.6.1 Utility—Diagnosis 2.6 Utility 2.6.1 Utility—Diagnosis Performs diagnostic tests on cards installed in the PBX, to identify the source of problems. If any of the tests listed here returns the result "NG" ("No Good"), contact your dealer. Test results can be saved as a TXT-format (text) file. When testing is complete, any cards that were set to OUS status must be returned to INS status if they are to be used again. Card Test Tests the relevant functions of a card to ensure that it is operating correctly. The tests carried out vary according to the type of card being tested. The tests that are performed on each card are as follows: Test Type Available Cards Local loop back diagnosis DHLC, DLC, SLC, LCOT, T1, E1, PRI, OPB Card CT Bus diagnosis DHLC, DLC, SLC, LCOT, T1, E1, BRI, PRI, OPB DTMF Receive test port DHLC, SLC PT loop back diagnosis DHLC, DLC DSP DTMF generator/receiver diagnosis T1, E1 DSP DTMF receiver diagnosis T1, E1 Framer IC alarm signal detection diagnosis T1, E1, PRI Framer IC error detection diagnosis T1, E1, PRI Caller ID card loop back diagnosis LCOT Extension mode setting test BRI To perform a card test 1. From the Utility menu, select Diagnosis. 2. Click on the Status cell of the card to be tested, and set it to "OUS". 3. Click on the cell showing the card type. A new window will be displayed. 4. Select the Card Test option. A new window will be displayed. 5. Click Test to perform the test(s). The error report will be displayed. When all tests are completed, the words "Test End!" will be shown on the last line of the output. 6. Select an option: • Click Capture if you want to save the displayed information. 1. Enter a file name, or select a file to overwrite. 2. Click Save. 64 PC Programming Manual 2.6.1 Utility—Diagnosis • Click Cancel to return to the Diagnosis screen. Network Loopback Test Performs a remote loopback test on the PRI23 card. Note • • To perform this test, it is necessary to set Loopback Test started by Network in 3.33 [1-1] Slot —Port Property - PRI Port to "Enable". The version of the PRI23 card must be 2.000 or later. To perform a network loopback test 1. From the Utility menu, select Diagnosis. 2. Click on the Status cell of the PRI23 card, and set it to "OUS". 3. Click on the cell showing the card type. A new window will be displayed. 4. Select the Loopback Type option. 5. 6. 7. 8. A new window will be displayed. Select Point1 or Point2 depending on the type of loopback test you want to perform The available selections may vary depending on the hardware version of the card. Click Apply. Preparation for the test is complete. The test will start automatically. After the test is complete, select Release and click Apply. Click Close to return to the Diagnosis screen. PC Programming Manual 65 2.6.2 Utility—File Transfer PC to PBX (SD Card) 2.6.2 Utility—File Transfer PC to PBX (SD Card) Copies PBX system files (programme files, data files and activation key files) from the connected PC to the SD memory card installed in the PBX. Pre-existing files on the SD memory card are overwritten. This option is only available at Installer level. The following types of files can be copied using this tool: • Programme files: These contain the programmes used to operate cards within the PBX and CSs, acting as on-board drivers. • Data files: These contain the initial configuration data for individual cards and settings. • Activation Key files: These contain the activation keys used to enable the use of IP trunks and IP telephones through Virtual VoIP cards and upgrade the software. Not all files that are copied using this tool are automatically made active. To install new programme files, main system data, or activation key for software upgrade to the PBX, use the System Reset—Reset by the Command utility (see 2.6.21 Utility—System Reset—Reset by the Command) for PBMPR, DBSYS, and LIC files. Use the Activation Key button (see 3.3 [1-1] Slot—Activation Key) for other LIC files, and the SD Card File View and Load utility (see 2.6.4 Utility—SD Card File View and Load) for all other files. The PBX examines the header information of a file to determine 2 things: whether the file contains supported data, and which system component the file applies to. Only files whose header information matches that of a system file supported by the PBX can be transferred. Attempting to transfer any other type of file results in an error message. The names of all files that can be stored on the SD memory card are as follows: Main Programme *1 Name on SD Memory Card Corresponding Card PBMPR IPCMPR PBMPR_S IPCMPR*1 PBMPR-file-format data that is transferred to the PBX from the PC is saved as "PBMPR_S". LPR Programme 66 Name on SD Memory Card Corresponding Card PDHLC DHLC4, DLC8, DLC16 PSLC SLC8/SLC16 PT1 T1 PE1 E1 PBRI BRI PPRI23 PRI23 PPRI30 PRI30 POPB3 OPB PC Programming Manual 2.6.2 Utility—File Transfer PC to PBX (SD Card) CS Programme Name on SD Memory Card Corresponding Unit PDCSDECT CS using a DHLC/DLC card for DECT Portable Station PHCSDECT High-density CS for DECT Portable Station PDCS24G CS using a DHLC/DLC card for 2.4 GHz Portable Station System Data *1 Name on SD Memory Card Corresponding Card DBSYS IPCMPR DBSYS_S IPCMPR*1 DBSYS-file-format data that is transferred to the PBX is saved as "DBSYS_S". Language Data Name on SD Memory Card Corresponding Unit DLNG0–DLNG5 PT DVMLNG1–DVMLNG5 VPS (Display Guidance data) Activation Key Name on SD Memory Card Corresponding Card LIC00–LIC99 V-IPEXT32, V-SIPEXT32, V-IPGW16, V-SIPGW16 Default Value Data Name on SD Memory Card Corresponding Card DBINI IPCMPR DBIDHLC DHLC4 DBISLC SLC8 DBIDLC DLC8/DLC16 DBIBRI BRI DBILCOT LCOT4 DBIT1 T1 DBIE1 E1 DBIOPB3 OPB3 PC Programming Manual 67 2.6.2 Utility—File Transfer PC to PBX (SD Card) Name on SD Memory Card Corresponding Card DBIEIO EIO DBIPRI23 PRI23 DBIPRI30 PRI30 DBISLCLC SLC16 DBIVIPGW V-IPGW16 DBIVSPGW V-SIPGW16 DBIVIPEX V-IPEXT32 DBIVSPEX V-SIPEXT32 To transfer files to the SD memory card 1. From the Utility menu, select File Transfer PC to PBX (SD Card). The dialogue box will be displayed. 2. Select the file to upload. A window showing the upload progress will be displayed. While transferring files to the SD memory card, the PBX automatically renames them according to the header information. A message will be displayed when the transfer is complete. 3. Click OK. 68 PC Programming Manual 2.6.3 Utility—File Transfer PBX (SD Card) to PC 2.6.3 Utility—File Transfer PBX (SD Card) to PC Copies system data files from the SD memory card installed in the PBX to the connected PC. This option is only available at Installer level. The files that can be downloaded from the SD memory card are as follows: File Name File Type DBSYS System Data $SYSERR Error Data $SYSERR1–$SYSERR9 LIC00–LIC99 Activation Key Downloading the DBSYS system data file allows you to make a backup of the configuration of the PBX. The error data files are snapshots of the configuration of the PBX taken automatically when a major error causes a system reset. They can be analysed by your dealer to identify the source of a problem. If there is only one error data file, its name will be $SYSERR. If there is more than one file, the files will be numbered in chronological order, up to a maximum of 9 files. To transfer files to the PC 1. From the Utility menu, select File Transfer PBX (SD Card) to PC. 2. Select the file to download from the list of files on the SD memory card. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. Only the files listed in the table above can be downloaded. Selecting any other file will cause an error message to be displayed. Click Transfer. The Save dialogue box will be displayed Navigate to the folder in which you want to save the file. Enter a file name. Click Save. A window showing the download progress will be displayed. A message will be displayed when the transfer is complete. Click OK. PC Programming Manual 69 2.6.4 Utility—SD Card File View and Load 2.6.4 Utility—SD Card File View and Load Displays a list of files on the SD memory card, and allows you to update the programmes stored in LPR cards (cards with local processors) and Cell Stations (CSs). This option is only available at Installer level. To update the programme stored in an LPR card, the card must first be set to out of service (OUS). To update the programme stored in a CS, the port of the card (DHLC/DLC) that the CS is attached to must be set to OUS, but the card itself must be set to in service (INS). Only cards that are in the correct status will be displayed. The name, date and time of creation, and size of files are displayed. This utility can also display information on activation key files stored in the SD memory card. The effective date, IPCMPR-ID, activation key type, number of activation keys, and expiration data of activation keys are displayed on the Detail screen. The expiration data of preinstalled activation keys is displayed as "Unlimited duration". To view and load files on the SD memory card 1. From the Utility menu, select SD Card File View and Load. 2. Click on the name of the desired file. Only files containing programme data (whose filenames start with "P") can be selected. 3. Click Detail. 4. 5. 6. 7. The Detail screen will be displayed. Header information from the chosen SD memory card file is displayed on the left. From the Card drop-down list on the right, select the card(s) whose software you want to update. • To update a specific card or port: • LPR cards: select the slot number and card name. • CSs: select the slot number and card name, and then select the related CS port from the drop-down list directly below. • To update all matching cards simultaneously: • Select "ALL". Click View to update the displayed header information of the selected files. The file with the higher File Version and File Revision numbers is newer. Click Load to update the file stored on the PBX. When the update is finished, a message will be displayed. Click OK. The display will return to the Detail screen. To view information on activation key files stored in the SD memory card (Interactive mode only) 1. From the Utility menu, select SD Card File View and Load. 2. Click on the name of the desired activation key file. 3. Click Detail. The Detail screen will be displayed. 70 PC Programming Manual 2.6.5 Utility—SD Card File Delete 2.6.5 Utility—SD Card File Delete Allows you to delete files from the SD memory card. This option is only available at Installer level. The following essential system files cannot be deleted by this utility: PBMPR, DBSYS To delete files from the SD memory card 1. From the Utility menu, select SD Card File Delete. 2. Click on the file to be deleted. 3. Click Delete. A confirmation screen will be displayed. 4. Click OK. The display will return to the SD Card File Delete screen. PC Programming Manual 71 2.6.6 Utility—Message File Transfer PC to PBX 2.6.6 Utility—Message File Transfer PC to PBX Transfers Outgoing Message (OGM) files from the PC to the selected MSG/ESVM card/block mounted on an OPB/IPCMPR card. This option is only available at Installer level. Note • When transferring to or from an MSG/ESVM card mounted on an OPB card, the OPB card must be set to OUS status. • When transferring to or from the built-in ESVM block on the IPCMPR card, the ESVM block must be set to OUS status. Files are stored on the MSG/ESVM card/block in the location specified by the file’s header information. Uploaded files are automatically renamed as necessary. If this location already contains an OGM, it will be overwritten by the newly uploaded message. To transfer OGMs to an MSG/ESVM card/block 1. From the Utility menu, select Message File Transfer PC to PBX. 2. Select the target MSG/ESVM card/block, or "ALL", from the drop-down list, and click OK. The Open dialogue box will be displayed. 3. Select the message files to upload. It is possible to select multiple files. 4. Click OK. The files will be uploaded. Files that do not contain message data will be ignored. When complete, the display will return to the main screen. 72 PC Programming Manual 2.6.7 Utility—Message File Transfer PBX to PC 2.6.7 Utility—Message File Transfer PBX to PC Transfers Outgoing Message (OGM) files from the MSG/ESVM card/block mounted on an OPB/IPCMPR card to the PC. This option is only available at Installer level. Note • • When transferring to or from an MSG/ESVM card mounted on an OPB card, the OPB card must be set to OUS status. When transferring to or from the built-in ESVM block on the IPCMPR card, the ESVM block must be set to OUS status. To transfer OGMs to the PC 1. From the Utility menu, select Message File Transfer PBX to PC. 2. From the upper drop-down list, select the target MSG/ESVM card/block. 3. From the lower drop-down list, select the messages to transfer. • To transfer a certain message, select the number of that message. • To transfer all messages at once, select "ALL". The Save dialogue box will be displayed. 4. Enter a file name. 5. Click Save. 6. Click OK. When you choose to transfer all messages, each message is saved as an individual file, with a number appended to the file name corresponding to that message’s location on the MSG/ESVM card/block. When complete, the display will return to the main screen. PC Programming Manual 73 2.6.8 Utility—Error Log 2.6.8 Utility—Error Log Collects and displays system error information. Whenever there is a system failure, the PBX stores the error code generated. The connected PC collects all of these codes, along with other information, and displays an explanatory error message. The functions of the buttons on this screen are as follows: Button Function Cancel Closes the Error Log screen without saving. Capture Saves the currently displayed Error Log information as a text file. Minor Displays minor errors, which affect only a certain part of system operation. Major Displays major errors, which affect operation of the whole system, or result in system failure. Clear Erases the stored error log information from both the screen and the PBX. Log Information Displays probable causes of the errors and their solutions. The items displayed on screen are as follows: 74 Item Description Index The ordinal number assigned to an error record in the current log. Date The date of the error detection. Time The time of the error detection. Error Code The 3-digit error code assigned by the PBX. PC Programming Manual 2.6.8 Utility—Error Log Item Description Sub Code The 6-digit sub code of the relevant hardware (X1YYZZ). • X: Slot type – Physical slot: " " (blank) – Virtual slot: "*" (asterisk) • 1: Cabinet number • YY: Slot number – KX-NCP500 (Physical slot): 00 to 05 (00: IPCMPR Card Slot; 01 to 05: Free Slots) – KX-NCP1000 (Physical slot): 00 to 07 (00: IPCMPR Card Slot; 01 to 07: Free Slots) – KX-NCP500/KX-NCP1000 (Virtual slot): 01 to 08 (01 to 04: Virtual Trunk Slots; 05 to 08: Virtual Extension Slots) • ZZ: Port number – For optional service cards except OPB3 card: Port number (01 to 16) will be displayed. – For OPB3 card: Sub slot number (1 to 3) + port number (1 to 4) will be displayed as follows: • Sub slot 1 of OPB3: 11 to 14 • Sub slot 2 of OPB3: 21 to 24 • Sub slot 3 of OPB3: 31 to 34 Note When there is no parameter for slot and port number, YY and ZZ will be displayed as "00". Example: Sub code for IPCMPR card = " 10000" Error Message A description of the error. To view the error log • From the Utility menu, select Error Log. PC Programming Manual 75 2.6.9 Utility—T1/E1 Signalling Bit Monitor 2.6.9 Utility—T1/E1 Signalling Bit Monitor Displays reference signalling bit information for all channels of the T1 or E1 card, by monitoring sent and received A, B, C and D bits. This utility is intended for use by dealers. This option is only available at Installer level, and requires that the target card be set to INS status. While monitoring is being performed, any displayed bits whose value changes from 0 to 1 or vice versa will be highlighted in red until the next screen refresh is performed. To view signalling bit information 1. From the Utility menu, select T1/E1 Signalling Bit Monitor. 2. From the Slot No drop-down list, select the target slot. 3. From the Interval Timer drop-down list, select the number of seconds between each automatic screen refresh. 4. Click Start. Monitoring will be performed and the screen will refresh according to the interval specified. 5. Click Stop to end monitoring. To refresh the screen at any time while monitoring is stopped, click Refresh. 76 PC Programming Manual 2.6.10 Utility—T1/E1 Line Trace 2.6.10 Utility—T1/E1 Line Trace Traces the sent and received signalling bits and dial numbers on the specified channel of the T1 or E1 line. This utility is intended for use by dealers. This option is only available at Installer level, and requires that the target card be set to INS status. To view trace data 1. From the Utility menu, select T1/E1 Line Trace. 2. From the Slot No drop-down list, select the target slot. 3. From the CH No drop-down list, select the target channel. 4. Click Start. Trace information will be displayed. The information is automatically updated whenever the data being monitored changes. 5. Click Stop to end the trace. 6. Select an option: • Click Capture to save the displayed trace information. Information is saved as a text-format file. • Click Clear to erase the information. PC Programming Manual 77 2.6.11 Utility—ISDN/QSIG Protocol Trace 2.6.11 Utility—ISDN/QSIG Protocol Trace This utility collects protocol trace data from BRI or PRI cards, and displays it on the PC. This option is only available at Installer level, and requires that the target BRI or PRI card be set to INS status. Protocol trace data is continually accumulated on these cards, and 3 types of data can be downloaded: • Real Time Trace: Pseudo-real-time data is collected through data polling at one-second intervals. The displayed information is updated beginning when the Start button is clicked. • Accumulation Trace: Previously accumulated data is retrieved and displayed. • Error Accumulation Trace: Previously accumulated error data is retrieved and displayed. This trace shows the data snapshot that is taken just before a card resets. To view trace data 1. From the Utility menu, select ISDN/QSIG Protocol Trace. 2. From the Slot No drop-down list, select the target slot. 3. From the Trace Data Type drop-down list, select the type of data to view. 4. Click Start. Trace information will be displayed. 5. Select an option: • Click Capture to save the displayed trace information. • Click Clear to clear the screen display. 6. Click Cancel to return to the main screen. 78 PC Programming Manual 2.6.12 Utility—V-IPGW16 Protocol Trace 2.6.12 Utility—V-IPGW16 Protocol Trace This utility collects trace data of protocol activity from V-IPGW16 card. This option is only available at Installer level, and requires that the target V-IPGW16 card be set to INS status. To save trace data to the SD Memory Card 1. From the Utility menu, select V-IPGW16 Protocol Trace. When the progress bar disappears, the protocol trace is complete. The trace data has been saved to the SD Memory Card (file name: "PRTH323"). To transfer trace data to the PC 1. From the Utility menu, select File Transfer PBX (SD Card) to PC. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. The trace data will be displayed. Select the desired trace data file. Click Transfer. Navigate to the folder in which you want to save the file. Enter a file name. Click Save. Click OK. PC Programming Manual 79 2.6.13 Utility—Digital Trunk Error Report 2.6.13 Utility—Digital Trunk Error Report Displays accumulated information on various types of errors occurring on digital trunks. This option is only available at Installer level. The value displayed for each error item is the number of times that each error occurred during the time period selected. Average values for these items vary depending upon many factors, such as the equipment being used, and the distance from the telephone company. The displayed items are as follows: Item Description Time Time of error Slot Relevant slot and card type Counter of Digital Trunk Error Logs logged in "Minor Error" Log Counter of minor communication error Out of SYNC (#300) Digital trunk out of sync (Loss of Signal) RAI (#301) Digital trunk RAI signal reception AIS (#302) Digital trunk Alarm Indication Signal reception Frame Failure (#300) Digital trunk frame failure (Loss of Frame) CRC Cyclic Redundancy Check error SF Severely errored frame (or Severe Framing Error) FE Frame synchronisation bit-error LV Line Code Violation SL Controlled slip To view digital trunk information 1. From the Utility menu, select Digital Trunk Error Report. 2. From the Slot No drop-down list, select the target slot. • To generate a report on a specific card, select the slot number and card name. • To generate a report on all matching cards simultaneously, select "ALL". 3. From the Display form drop-down list, select the time period to view. 4. Click Execute. The error report will be displayed. 80 PC Programming Manual 2.6.14 Utility—IP Extension Statistical Information 2.6.14 Utility—IP Extension Statistical Information Displays accumulated statistical information on IP extensions, V-IPEXT32 cards, V-IPCS4 cards, and the DSP card. The displayed items are as follows: Item Description Collection Started Time Date and time the port was last reset. Port No. Number of the port. RTP Receive Packet Counter Total number of packets received. RTP Receive Lost Packet Counter Total number of packets lost. RTP Receive Abandoned Packet Counter Total number of packets abandoned. RTP Arrive Packet Interval (MAX.) [ms] Maximum time taken for a packet to arrive. RTP Arrive Packet Interval (MIN.) [ms] Minimum time taken for a packet to arrive. To view IP extension information 1. From the Utility menu, select IP Extension Statistical Information. 2. From the Card Selection drop-down list, select the slot number for the card. "IPCMPR (VoIP-DSP)" can be selected for the DSP card when DSP Card Status is enabled. See 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property IPCMPR. 3. Click Execute. The statistical information will be displayed. 4. Select an option: • Click Capture if you want to save the displayed information. 1. Enter a file name, or select a file to overwrite. 2. Click Save. • Click Clear to erase the information and reset the Collection Started Time. 5. Click Cancel to return to the main screen. PC Programming Manual 81 2.6.15 Utility—CS Information 2.6.15 Utility—CS Information Displays information stored by the PBX regarding each Cell Station (CS). This option is only available at Installer level, and requires that the target DHLC, DLC, or V-IPCS4 card be set to INS status. The displayed items are as follows: Item Description Slot Number of the slot Port Number of the port CS Name Name of the attached CS Status Service status of the attached CS: INS, OUS, or FAULT. If the status is FAULT, subsequent data items for that port will be left blank. Version Version number of the programme file stored in the CS Revision Revision number of the programme file stored in the CS CSID 12-digit ID number of the CS Path Number of the wireless extension currently using each path. In the case of a group, several extensions may be using the same floating extension number. When an extension number is not registered, the display shows "OFF". Both 2.4 GHz PSs and DECT PSs can use up to 2 paths. When using high-density CSs or IP-CSs, DECT PSs can use up to 8 paths. Group Call Number of PSs registered to the attached CS that are members of a PS Ring Group. To view CS information 1. From the Utility menu, select CS Information. 2. From the Target CSI/F Slot No drop-down list, select the target slot. • To display information on a single card, select the slot number and name of that card. • To display information on all matching cards, select "All". 3. From the Interval Timer drop-down list, select the number of seconds between each automatic screen refresh. 4. Click Start to begin monitoring. Monitoring will be performed and the screen will refresh according to the interval specified. To refresh the screen manually at any time, click Refresh. 5. Click Stop to end monitoring. 6. Select an option: • Click Capture if you want to save the displayed information. 1. Enter a file name, or select a file to overwrite. 2. Click Start. • Click Close to return to the main screen. 82 PC Programming Manual 2.6.16 Utility—PS Information 2.6.16 Utility—PS Information Displays Portable Station (PS) registration information, including the associated Cell Station (CS). This option is only available at Installer level. The displayed items are as follows: Item Description PS No. PS location number. Only registered PSs will be displayed. Extension Number Extension number of the PS. Location—Slot Slot number of the CS that the PS is registered with. Location—Port Port number of the CS that the PS is registered with. To view PS information 1. From the Utility menu, select PS Information. 2. Click Refresh. PC Programming Manual 83 2.6.17 Utility—CS Status Monitor 2.6.17 Utility—CS Status Monitor This utility monitors the status of CSs within Air Synchronisation Groups. CSs receive data from other CSs that they are currently synchronised with, within the Air Synchronisation Group. Current Sync CS information is displayed for IP-CSs that are in INS status. This option is only available at Installer level. The displayed items for the Current Sync CS of each CS are as follows: Item Description CS Type Type of CS that each CS is currently synchronised with. Slot Type Slot type of the CS that each CS is currently synchronised with. Slot Slot number of the CS that each CS is currently synchronised with. Port Port number of the CS that each CS is currently synchronised with. CS / Repeater Indicates whether the CS that each CS is currently synchronised with, is a CS or Repeater. CS Name Name of the CS that each CS is currently synchronised with. CS ID 12-digit ID number of the CS that each CS is currently synchronised with. Monitored Value Monitored value (dBm) of the CS that each CS is currently synchronised with. Monitored Level Monitored level (signal strength level) of the CS that each CS is currently synchronised with. To monitor the status of CSs 1. From the Utility menu, select CS Status Monitor. 2. From the Air Sync Group No drop-down list, select an Air Synchronisation Group. • For PBMPR Software File Version 2.0000, only Air Synchronisation Group 1 can be selected. 3. From the Interval Timer drop-down list, select the number of seconds between each automatic screen refresh. 4. Click Start to begin monitoring. Monitoring will be performed and the screen will refresh according to the interval specified. To refresh the screen manually at any time, click Refresh. 5. Click Stop to end monitoring. 6. Select an option: • Click Capture if you want to save the displayed information. 1. Enter a file name, or select a file to overwrite. 2. Click Start. • Click Close to return to the main screen. 84 PC Programming Manual 2.6.18 Utility—Ping 2.6.18 Utility—Ping Performs a connection test on network devices. This function sends echo requests to a particular IP address across an IP network, and displays the result of responses and round-trip time. This option is only available when the Maintenance Console is in Interactive mode. To perform a Ping test 1. Enter a specific IP address in the IP Address box. 2. Click Test to perform the test. The result will be displayed. 3. Select an option: • Click Capture if you want to save the displayed information. 1. Enter a file name, or select a file to overwrite. 2. Click Save. • Click Close to return to the Ping screen. PC Programming Manual 85 2.6.19 Utility—File Transfer FTP to IP Equipment—IP-CS/NT400 2.6.19 Utility—File Transfer FTP to IP Equipment—IP-CS/NT400 Displays a list of files on the FTP server, and allows you to update the programmes stored in IP-CSs and KX-NT400 IP-PTs. This option is only available at Installer level. It is possible to perform the update in 2 ways: • Manual update • Timed (automatic) update To update manually: 1. From the Utility menu, select File Transfer FTP to IP Equipment, and then either IP-CS or NT400. 2. Input the FTP Server Address and File Name. 3. Put a check in the Select check boxes of the items to be updated. 4. Click Execute. To set timed update: 1. From the Utility menu, select File Transfer FTP to IP Equipment, and then either IP-CS or NT400. 2. Input the FTP Server Address and File Name. 3. Put a check in the Select check boxes of the items to be updated. 4. Click Timed Update. The Timed Update screen appears. For information on setting this screen, see 2.6.20 Utility—Card Software Timed Update. Note • • • • 86 Cards are automatically set to OUS status during an update, and returned to INS status when the update is complete. To display the file version of the file stored on the FTP server, click Load. To refresh the status of all ports, click Refresh. Timed updates can only be set for either LPR cards, IP-CSs, or KX-NT400 IP-PTs. They cannot be set for more than one type of device. PC Programming Manual 2.6.20 Utility—Card Software Timed Update 2.6.20 Utility—Card Software Timed Update Updates programmes in the LPR cards (optional service cards with local processors) by comparing them with files found on the SD memory card on a preset schedule, and downloading newer files to the cards. This option is only available at Installer level. Note • Timed updates can only be set for either LPR cards, IP-CSs, or KX-NT400 IP-PTs. They cannot be set for more than one type of device. • Cards are automatically set to OUS status during an update, and returned to INS status when the update is complete. • It is recommended to set the timed update to take place during the least active time period, for example late at night. This utility does not apply to CS programmes. These must be updated manually using the SD Card File View and Load utility (see 2.6.4 Utility—SD Card File View and Load). When this utility has been set, all commands that would affect the status of cards are prevented from operating. The list of these commands is as follows: • Card status change (INS/OUS) • Diagnosis commands • Card installation • Card deletion • Remote reset • LPR programme download requests • ISDN automatic setup requests (BRI card) • Signalling Bit Monitor requests (T1/E1) • Line trace start requests (T1/E1) • ISDN/QSIG Protocol Data Trace start requests • Time setting • CS programme download requests • File deletion When a function other than those listed above, that cannot be performed while timed update has been set, is selected, an error message will be displayed. To turn this utility on: 1. From the Utility menu, select Card Software Timed Update. 2. Select the Set option. The time setting box will become available. 3. Enter the desired time using the number keys. Click in the hour or minute field and use the up and down arrows to adjust the displayed time in increments of one unit. 4. Click Apply. A message box will be displayed. 5. Click Yes. To turn this utility off: 1. From the Utility menu, select Card Software Timed Update. 2. Select the Off (Cancel) option. 3. Click Apply. A message box will be displayed. 4. Click Yes. PC Programming Manual 87 2.6.21 Utility—System Reset—Reset by the Command 2.6.21 Utility—System Reset—Reset by the Command Updates the main system programme and data files stored within the PBX using files taken from the SD memory card, and resets the connected PBX. This option is only available at Installer level. Two copies of each of the main system files can be stored on the SD memory card. The names of these files are as follows: File Name Description DBSYS Main system data file. Contains all of the current configuration data for the PBX. DBSYS_S Backup main system data file PBMPR PBX programme file. Contains the software to run the IPCMPR board of the PBX. PBMPR_S Backup PBX programme file When new DBSYS and PBMPR files are transferred from a connected PC to the SD memory card using the File Transfer PC to PBX (SD Card) utility (see 2.6.2 Utility—File Transfer PC to PBX (SD Card)), they are stored as the backup files. To use these files on the PBX, it is necessary to first swap them with the currently active files on the SD memory card. To update system files and reset the PBX 1. From the Utility menu, point to System Reset and then click Reset by the Command. 2. Choose whether to back up current system data or not. • Click SD Backup to back up the current system data to the SD memory card before proceeding. Select this if you intend to use the current system data unchanged after reset. Click Skip to continue without backing up. Select this if you intend to replace the current system data with data that was uploaded from the PC. The second screen will be displayed. A list of matching files found on the SD memory card, with dates and times, is shown at the top. Select whether to replace the DBSYS and PBMPR files or not. When no backup file is found, the corresponding options are not available. Click OK. A confirmation screen will be displayed. Select an option: • Click OK to reset the PBX. If OK is clicked, a final confirmation screen will be displayed. • Click Cancel to return to the main screen without copying files. Click OK to reset the PBX, or Cancel to return to the main screen without copying files. If the reset command was not carried out correctly, an error message will be displayed, and you will be returned to the main screen. • 3. 4. 5. 6. After resetting the PBX with this command, it is necessary to reconnect to the PBX to continue programming. 88 PC Programming Manual 2.7.1 Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ) 2.7 Help 2.7.1 Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ) This section provides answers to some common questions about using the Maintenance Console software to programme the PBX. The information is divided into the following topics: Title Description Connection Connecting to the PBX using Maintenance Console. Maintenance Console Software Using the Maintenance Console software. Card Status Changing the status (INS/OUS) of cards. Portable Stations Setting up portable stations, including registration and deregistration. Numbering Changing the numbering plan for the PBX, or numbers of individual extensions or features. Saving Modified Data Safely saving PBX data edited with Maintenance Console. Setting Features Setting up individual features. Connection Q The Maintenance Console cannot connect to the PBX via RS-232C cable. A • • • • • Is the cable firmly connected to both the PC and the PBX? Is the serial port that the PC uses correctly specified? Is the baud rate correct? The default setting, and a safe rate, is 19 200 bps. Is the password correct? Is the Maintenance Console not connected to the PBX by another connection method? Q The Maintenance Console cannot connect to the PBX via USB. A • • • • Is the USB cable firmly connected to both the PC and the KX-DT300 series/ KX-T7600 series DPT with a USB Module? Is the USB driver on the PC running? To confirm, open the Windows Device Manager, and look for "Panasonic KX-TDA USB Main Unit driver" in the USB Controllers section. If it is not present, re-install the USB driver Is the password correct? Is the Maintenance Console not connected to the PBX by another connection method? Q The Maintenance Console cannot connect to the PBX via LAN. A • • • • Is the PC connected to the LAN? Have the IP address and port number of the PBX been set correctly? For more details, see 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR. Is the password correct? Is the Maintenance Console not connected to the PBX by another connection method? PC Programming Manual 89 2.7.1 Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ) Q The Maintenance Console cannot connect to the PBX via modem. A • • • • • Is the dial number of the modem correct? For more details, see 13.1 [11-1] Main. Has a modem been installed to the PBX? Are the modem settings of the PBX and Maintenance Console correct? For more details, see 13.1 [11-1] Main. Is the password correct? Is the Maintenance Console not connected to the PBX by another connection method? Q The Maintenance Console cannot connect to the PBX via ISDN Remote. A • • • • Are the ISDN Remote settings of the PC correct? For more details, see 13.1 [11-1] Main. Is the ISDN Remote dial number correct? Is the password correct? Is the Maintenance Console not connected to the PBX by another connection method? Q Can I perform initial setup of the PBX without being connected to the PBX? A • Yes. This is possible in Batch mode. Create a new system data file using 2.2.1 Programme launcher—New, edit settings as required, and then upload this file to the PBX later (see 2.6.2 Utility—File Transfer PC to PBX (SD Card)). Maintenance Console Software Q How do I confirm the software version of the PBX or installed cards? A • Q Not all of the characters of a setting can be displayed because the column is too narrow. A • From 3.1 [1-1] Slot, click Summary. Summary information, including software versions, is displayed for all cards installed in the PBX. Move the mouse to the line between the names of 2 setting items, at the top of the table. The pointer will change to a double arrow. Click and drag the line to the right until all characters are displayed. Card Status Q The status of a new card will not change to "INS". A • • • • Q 90 With the new card installed, does the total number of extensions or trunks exceed the maximum supported by the PBX? Is the type of card installed in the slot different from the card type set as "Pre-install" for that slot? Confirm that the correct card is installed in the slot. Is the card firmly and fully installed in the slot? Confirm that the card is installed correctly in the slot. Confirm that the card is not damaged. I cannot change an LCO port to INS status. PC Programming Manual 2.7.1 Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ) A • • • • • Is the card installed in the appropriate slot? Is the card installed in the correct slot, but not functioning correctly? Check the condition of the card. Is the card itself in INS status? Set it to INS status. Is a trunk line connected to the appropriate port? Is the port in FAULT status, even though a trunk is connected? Run diagnosis on the relevant slot. Q How do I prevent newly installed cards automatically being changed to "INS"? A • Change New Card Installation—Card Status for any Card in 3.48 [1-3] Option from "In Service (INS)" to "Out of Service (OUS)". Portable Stations Q I cannot register Portable Stations using the method described in Portable Station [1-2]. A • • • • • Is the status of the DHLC or DLC card set to "INS"? Is a CS connected to the DHLC or DLC card? If not, connect one. Do the PINs (Personal Identification Numbers) of the PBX and the Portable Station match? Confirm that they are the same. Is the Portable Station within transmission range of the CS? Has the Portable Station previously been registered at another location? It is not possible to register a Portable Station at 2 locations, so use the Forced De-registration option to delete the previous registration. Q I cannot delete the extension number of a Portable Station. A • Q I cannot de-register a Portable Station. A • • Q The Portable Station I want to de-register is broken, and will not turn on, or is not available, or the registration information was deleted first from the Portable Station, so it cannot be de-registered. A • Q I changed the extension number of a Portable Station, but the display of the Portable Station still shows the old extension number. A • Q I changed the FCO of a Portable Station, but the display of the Portable Station still shows the old FCO. A • First, de-register the Portable Station itself, and then delete the extension number. Is the Portable Station turned on? If not, turn it on. Is the Portable Station within transmission range of the CS? If not, move it closer to the CS and try the de-registration operation again. The Portable Station can be forcibly de-registered by following the procedure shown in Forced De-registration of 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station. Turn the Portable Station off and back on again, to force it to re-register its location. Turn the Portable Station off and back on again, to force it to re-register its location. PC Programming Manual 91 2.7.1 Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ) Q If I delete the extension number of a Portable Station, and then turn the Portable Station off and back on again, it does not function correctly. A • Do not delete the extension number of the Portable Station, as this information is necessary for it to operate. Numbering 92 Q How do I change the extension number of a wired extension? A • Q I changed the extension number of a wired extension while the extension was engaged in a call, but the display still shows the previous extension number. A • Q How do I change the extension numbering plan from 3-digit numbers to 4-digit numbers? A • Q How do I set a 3-digit numbering plan? A • Q What is the procedure to modify the Numbering Plan? Change the extension number of the target port to the new number, and click Apply. Next, set the port to OUS status, and then back to INS status. The extension number will not change while the extension is in use. When the conversation is finished, set the port to OUS status, and then back to INS status. Perform the following steps: 1. Open the 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main screen. 2. Enter a 2-digit number in Leading Number, or change No. of Additional Digits from "x" to "xx". For more details, see What is the procedure to modify the Numbering Plan? in Numbering. There are 2 methods of creating a 3-digit numbering plan, using 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main: 1. Set the leading number to be 2 digits, with one additional digit. This method allows a maximum of 10 extensions. Example: Leading Number = 10; No. of Additional Digits = x In this example, extension numbers 100 to 109 can be used. 2. Set the leading number to be one digit, with 2 additional digits. This method allows a maximum of 100 extensions. Example: Leading Number = 1; No. of Additional Digits = xx In this example, extension numbers 100 to 199 can be used. For more details, see What is the procedure to modify the Numbering Plan? in Numbering. PC Programming Manual 2.7.1 Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ) A • Q When modifying the Numbering Plan, I cannot change the Leading Number. A • Q When modifying the Numbering Plan, how do I set a 1-digit extension number? A • Q How do I change a feature number? A • Perform the following steps: 1. Confirm that the Numbering Plan you will change is not currently being used by any extensions (see 2.5.8 Tool—Extension List View). If it is being used by extensions, temporarily change the extension numbers of those extensions to that of another numbering plan, or delete the extension number (see 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings and 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings). 2. Clear the Leading Number cell. 3. Click Apply. 4. Modify the No. of Additional Digits cell as required. 5. Click Apply. 6. Enter the desired value in the Leading Number cell. 7. Click Apply. 8. Set all extension ports to OUS status. 9. On the relevant screens, set the extension numbers of extensions to the desired values. 10. Set all extension ports back to INS status. It is not possible to use the same Leading Number for 2 extension blocks, or to use a number that could possibly overlap with another Leading Number. So, for example, if "2" is already set as a Leading Number it is not possible to set "21" as another Leading Number because of the possible overlap of extension numbers. The number you are trying to store cannot be used if it is already being used by: • A feature number • Another extension block • A Dial setting (see 11.1 [9-1] TIE Table) • Quick Dialling (see 4.10 [2-6-2] Numbering Plan—Quick Dial) In any of these cases, choose another number. Perform the following steps: 1. Clear the Leading Number cell. 2. Click Apply. 3. Set No. of Additional Digits to "None". 4. Click Apply. 5. Enter the desired value in the Leading Number cell. 6. Click Apply. 7. Set all extension ports to OUS status. 8. On the relevant screens, set the extension numbers of extensions to the desired values. 9. Set all extension ports back to INS status. Perform the following steps: 1. Open the 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main screen. 2. Change the value in the Dial cell of the desired feature. 3. Click Apply. PC Programming Manual 93 2.7.1 Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ) Q I cannot change a feature number. A • Q How do I change the code used to access another PBX? A • Q I cannot change an Other PBX Extension code. A • Q I cannot change a feature number on the B/NA DND Call Feature screen. A • Q How do I prevent extension numbers being automatically assigned to a newly installed card? A • It is not possible to use the same number for 2 items. The number you are trying to store cannot be used if it is already being used by: • A feature number • An extension • A Dial setting (see 11.1 [9-1] TIE Table) • Quick Dialling (see 4.10 [2-6-2] Numbering Plan—Quick Dial) In any of these cases, choose another number. Perform the following steps: 1. Open the 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main screen. 2. Select the Other PBX Extension tab. 3. Change the value in the Dial cell of the desired feature. 4. Click Apply. It is not possible to use the same number for 2 items. The number you are trying to store cannot be used if it is already being used by: • A feature number • An extension • A Dial setting (see 11.1 [9-1] TIE Table) • Quick Dialling (see 4.10 [2-6-2] Numbering Plan—Quick Dial) In any of these cases, choose another number. The number you are trying to store is already being used by another call feature. Please choose a different number. Change New Card Installation—Automatic Extension Number Set for Extension Card in the 3.48 [1-3] Option screen from "Automatic" to "Manual". Saving Modified Data 94 Q Modified settings have not been updated in the PBX. A • Q Modified settings are not saved even when I press the Apply button. A • Q If I reset the PBX directly after modifying settings, the modified settings are not updated in the PBX. Click Apply or OK in the sub-menu screen. To save the system data files, choose Save from the File menu. PC Programming Manual 2.7.1 Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ) A • When you click Apply, the settings are updated in the PBX, but are not yet saved to the SD memory card. If system data is not saved to the SD memory card, the PBX will restore the data that was last saved to the card in the event that the PBX is reset, or power is turned off and back on again. Therefore, before resetting the PBX, click the SD memory backup icon to save the system data to the SD memory card. Alternatively, exit the Maintenance Console. This automatically saves system data to the SD memory card. Note Do not remove the SD memory card while power is supplied to the PBX. Doing so may cause the PBX to fail to start when you try to restart the system. Q After reinitialising the PBX, I restored system data from a previous backup. However, some of the settings have not been restored to their previous values. A • The following setting data is not saved to the SD memory card, so will be deleted when the PBX is initialised. This data is stored in the PBX’s battery backup memory. • Incoming Call Log • Outgoing Call Log (including Last Number Redial) • Message Waiting • SMDR • Advice of Charge (AOC)/Pay Tone • Hospitality guest billing data • ICD Group monitor log for supervisor • PBX date and time • Timed Reminder • LPR Timed Update time • PT handset/headset volume • PT SP-PHONE volume • PT ring volume • PT display contrast • ICD Group login status (All extensions are set to Login by default.) • ICD Group Ready/Not Ready status (All extensions are set to Ready by default.) • Live Call Screening (LCS) On/Off • Hands-free Answerback status • Absent Message status of extensions (Absent Message data itself is not cleared.) • FWD/DND status (FWD destinations are not cleared.) • Extension Dial Lock/Remote Extension Dial Lock • Extension PIN Lock/Extension PIN Lock counter • Verification Code PIN Lock/Verification Code PIN Lock counter • Password Lock counter for Remote System Programming • PBX Error Log • Digital Trunk Error Report data In addition, the following data cannot be restored: • SVM Log and messages (both greeting messages and voice messages left by callers) recorded by the SVM feature. PC Programming Manual 95 2.7.1 Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ) Setting Features 96 Q How do I change the dialling mode of an analogue trunk? A • Q How do I set disconnect detection (CPC Detection) for an analogue trunk? A • Q What settings do I change to enable use of an extension ISDN telephone? A • Q When using a TE with an extension ISDN, how do I enable power output? A • Q How do I connect to another PBX using QSIG? A • Q How do I change the type of an extension port? A • Q I have set the type of an extension port to "DSS Console", but I cannot apply this setting. (Error E000402) A • Q I have set the type of an extension port to "VM (DPT)", but I cannot apply this setting. (Error E000403) A • Q I have set the type of an extension port to "PC Console", but I cannot apply this setting. (Error E000402) A • From the 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port screen, change the Mode setting of the target port to "DTMF" or "Pulse", as required. Dialling From the 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port screen, modify the CPC Signal Detection Time—Outgoing, Incoming setting of the target port. The required value varies by carrier. Transmission and reception can be set separately. From the 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port screen, set the the port you want to use to "Extension". From the 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port screen, set on the ISDN Extension tab to "Enable". Port Type of ISDN TE Power From the 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port or 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port screen, set the Port Type of the port you want to use to either "QSIG-Slave" or "QSIG-Master". Set the port to OUS status. Then, change DPT Type—Type in the 3.24 [1-1] Slot —Port Property - Extension Port window The number entered in DPT Type—Location No. on the 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port screen is the same as that entered for another DSS Console. Change this so that the numbers do not overlap. The DPT Type—VM Unit No. and DPT Type—VM Port No. settings entered on the 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port screen are the same as those entered for another VM (DPT). Change this so that the numbers do not overlap. The number entered in DPT Type—Location No. on the 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port screen is the same as that entered for another PC Console. Change this so that the numbers do not overlap. PC Programming Manual 2.7.1 Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ) Q What programming do I have to perform to use a headset with an extension? A • Q What programming do I have to perform to use XDP with an extension port? A • Q How do I edit a Class of Service, or create a new Class of Service? A • Q How do I restrict calls between 2 extensions? A • Q How do I restrict trunk calls made by extensions? A • Q How do I modify the hold operation for SLTs? A • Q How do I set up an Incoming Call Distribution (ICD) group to receive trunk calls directly? A • Set Headset OFF/ON on the 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port screen to "Headset ON". Set XDP Mode on the 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port screen to "On". Class of Service feature restrictions can be set from the 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service —COS Settings screen. Calls between extensions can be restricted from the 4.14 [2-7-3] Class of Service— Internal Call Block screen. Click in the relevant cells to select the COS levels whose extensions are blocked from calling each other. Trunk calls made by extensions can be restricted from the 4.13 [2-7-2] Class of Service—External Call Block screen. Click in the relevant cells to select the trunk groups that cannot be used by extensions associated with a particular COS in each time mode. To prevent extensions associated with a COS from making trunk calls, set all trunk groups for that COS to "Block" (blue). It is possible to choose how to hold a line and transfer a call with an SLT using the SLT—SLT Hold Mode option on the 4.18 [2-9] System Options screen. For more details, see "1.13.1 Call Hold" of the Feature Guide. Perform the following steps: 1. On the 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings screen, enter the floating extension number you chose for the ICD group in the Floating Extension Number cell. 2. Click Apply. 3. On the 5.14 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings— Member List screen, select the ICD group you created from the Incoming Call Distribution drop-down list. 4. Enter the extension numbers of member extensions in the Extension Number column. 5. Click Apply. 6. On the DIL tab of the 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings screen, enter the floating extension number of the ICD group as the DIL Destination—Day, Lunch, Break, Night of each time mode. 7. Modify other settings as required from the Group—Incoming Call Distribution Group submenu. PC Programming Manual 97 2.7.1 Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ) Q How do I set the queuing operation for an Incoming Call Distribution group? A • Q How do I add an extension as a member of an Incoming Call Distribution (ICD) group? A • Perform the following steps: 1. On the 5.14 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings— Member List screen, from the Incoming Call Distribution drop-down list, select the group you want to modify. The ICD group must have an extension number set. 2. Enter the extension number of the extension you want to add in a blank cell of the Extension Number column. 3. Set Delayed Ring as necessary. 4. Click Apply. Note that it is necessary to set the extension number of the ICD group in advance. Q I cannot set system speed dialling numbers from PC Console. A • • 98 Perform the following steps: 1. On the 5.15 [3-5-2] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Queuing Time Table screen, set the actions as required for each queuing table. 2. On the 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings screen, from the Queuing Time Table tab, select the number of the Queuing Time Table to use in each time mode. Set the COS of the extension to which PC Console is connected to Manager class, by setting Manager on the Extension Feature tab of the 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings screen to "Enable". System speed dialling numbers can only be edited by one PC Console at a time. Q I have set FWD through system programming, but calls are still not being forwarded. A • Perform the following steps: 1. Check that the Call from CO—Present Button Status or Call from Extension—Present Button Status of the target extension on the 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND or 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND screen is set to "FWD". 2. Create a FWD button on the target extension if one does not already exist. 3. Press the FWD button so that it changes to FWD status. PC Programming Manual Section 3 [1] Configuration PC Programming Manual 99 3.1 [1-1] Slot 3.1 [1-1] Slot The operating characteristics associated with each service card can be programmed. Move the mouse pointer over an installed card to display the menu of options for that card. To view a summary of status and MPR versions for all cards installed in the PBX, click the Summary button (see 3.2 [1-1] Slot —Summary). To install a new card to the PBX 1. Click on the name of the card to install in the list on the right. An image of the card will be displayed to the left of the list, and information about the card will be shown below. 2. Click and drag the image of the card to the free slot it is to be installed in, and release it. The card will move into the slot space. 3. Click Yes to confirm. To switch between physical and virtual shelves of the PBX 1. Move the mouse pointer over the PBX image at the top of the screen you wish to select. Select Shelf will be shown under the mouse pointer. 2. Click Select Shelf. To access card properties 1. Move the mouse pointer over a card. A menu will be shown under the mouse pointer. 2. Select Card Property. The property screen for that card will be displayed. To access port properties 1. Move the mouse pointer over a card. A menu will be shown under the mouse pointer. 2. Select Port Property. The property screen for that card’s port or ports will be displayed. To remove a card from the PBX 1. Move the mouse pointer over the card to remove. A menu will be shown under the mouse pointer. 2. Select Delete. 3. Click Yes to confirm. The card will be removed. To change the status (INS/OUS) of a card (Interactive mode only) 1. Move the mouse pointer over the card. A menu will be shown under the mouse pointer. 2. Select the desired status: • Click INS to set the card to in-service status. • Click OUS to set the card to out-of-service status. 100 PC Programming Manual 3.1 [1-1] Slot To install an option card on an OPB3 card 1. Move the mouse pointer over the card. A menu will be shown under the mouse pointer. 2. Select Option Card. The OPB3 Option Card Setup screen will be displayed. See 3.46 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Option Card Setup. To access IP-PT port properties 1. Click the IP Phone Registration button. Supported Card Types Card IPCMPR: IP Convergence Main Processing Card DHLC4: 4-Port Digital Hybrid Extension Card Maximum Quantity Card Programming 1 (fixed) 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property IPCMPR KX-NCP500: 1 KX-NCP1000: 1 DLC8: 8-Port Digital Extension Card DLC16: 16-Port Digital Extension Card SLC8: 8-Port Single Line Telephone Extension Card KX-NCP500: 1 KX-NCP1000: 2 3.23 [1-1] Slot—Card Property Extension Type SLC16: 16-Port Single Line Telephone Extension Card LCOT4: 4-Port Analogue Trunk Card KX-NCP500: 3 KX-NCP1000: 4 BRI2: 2-Port BRI Card KX-NCP500: 3 KX-NCP1000: 4 PRI23: PRI Card (23B channels) 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property LCO type 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type PRI30: PRI Card (30B channels) T1: T-1 Trunk Card KX-NCP500: 2 KX-NCP1000: 2 E1: E-1 Trunk Card 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type OPB3: Optional 3-Slot Base Card KX-NCP500: 2 KX-NCP1000: 3 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property V-IPEXT32: Virtual 32-Channel VoIP Extension Card KX-NCP500: 2 KX-NCP1000: 2 3.14 [1-1] Slot—Card Property Virtual IP Extension V-SIPEXT32: Virtual 32-Channel SIP Extension Card KX-NCP500: 1 KX-NCP1000: 2 3.17 [1-1] Slot—Card Property Virtual SIP Extension V-IPGW16: Virtual 16-Channel VoIP Gateway Card KX-NCP500: 1 KX-NCP1000: 2 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property Virtual IP Gateway PC Programming Manual 101 3.1 [1-1] Slot Card V-IPCS4: Virtual 4-Channel Cell Station Interface Card Maximum Quantity Card Programming KX-NCP500: 2 KX-NCP1000: 2 3.20 [1-1] Slot—Card Property Virtual IPCS For more information on the IPCMPR card, virtual cards and other optional cards, see the following sections in the Installation Manual: → 1.3.1 Optional Equipment → 3.3.1 IPCMPR Card → 3.4.1 Virtual Cards 102 PC Programming Manual 3.2 [1-1] Slot—Summary 3.2 [1-1] Slot—Summary Summary information is displayed for all cards installed in the PBX. Physical Shelf No. Indicates the slot number (reference only). Value Range Available slot numbers. Maintenance Console Location 3.2 [1-1] Slot—Summary Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot Feature Guide References None Card Type Indicates the type of service card installed in each slot of the physical shelf (reference only). Note that for IPCMPR cards, the PBX model code is displayed in parentheses after the name. Value Range DHLC4: 4-Port Digital Hybrid Extension Card DLC8: 8-Port Digital Extension Card DLC16: 16-Port Digital Extension Card SLC8: 8-Port Single Line Telephone Extension Card SLC16: 16-Port Single Line Telephone Extension Card LCOT4: 4-Port Analogue Trunk Card BRI2: 2-Port BRI Card PRI23: PRI Card PRI30: PRI Card T1: T-1 Trunk Card E1: E-1 Trunk Card OPB3: Optional 3-Slot Base Card IPCMPR: IPCMPR Card Maintenance Console Location 3.2 [1-1] Slot—Summary Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot PC Programming Manual 103 3.2 [1-1] Slot—Summary 3.23 3.27 3.30 3.35 3.38 3.44 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Extension Type [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Feature Guide References None Status Indicates the card status (reference only) Note that IPCMPR card status is always displayed as "-". Value Range INS: The port is in service. OUS: The port is out of service. Fault: The port is not communicating with the network. Pre-Install: A card has been added to the slot. Idle: No card is installed in the slot. Maintenance Console Location 3.2 [1-1] Slot—Summary Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot Feature Guide References None Version Indicates the LPR version of the installed card (reference only). Value Range Version number Maintenance Console Location 3.2 [1-1] Slot—Summary Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot 104 PC Programming Manual 3.2 [1-1] Slot—Summary Feature Guide References None IPCMPR Virtual Shelf No. Indicates the slot number (reference only). Value Range 1–8 Maintenance Console Location 3.2 [1-1] Slot—Summary Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot Feature Guide References None Slot Type Indicates the slot type (reference only). Value Range Trunk, Extension Maintenance Console Location 3.2 [1-1] Slot—Summary Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot Feature Guide References None Card Type Indicates the type of virtual VoIP card installed in each slot of the virtual shelf (reference only). Value Range V-IPEXT32: Virtual 32-Channel VoIP Extension Card V-SIPEXT32: Virtual 32-Channel SIP Extension Card V-IPGW16: Virtual 16-Channel VoIP Gateway Card V-SIPGW16: Virtual 16-Channel SIP Trunk Card PC Programming Manual 105 3.2 [1-1] Slot—Summary V-IPCS4: Virtual 4-Channel Cell Station Interface Card Maintenance Console Location 3.2 [1-1] Slot—Summary Programming Manual References 3.14 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IP Extension 3.17 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual SIP Extension 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway 3.20 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IPCS Feature Guide References None Status Indicates the card status (reference only). Value Range INS: The port is in service. OUS: The port is out of service. Fault: The port is not communicating with the network. Pre-Install: A card has been added to the slot. Idle: No card is installed in the slot. Maintenance Console Location 3.2 [1-1] Slot—Summary Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot Feature Guide References None 106 PC Programming Manual 3.3 [1-1] Slot—Activation Key 3.3 [1-1] Slot—Activation Key Refreshes and displays information on activation keys provided by activation key files on the SD memory card and pre-installed activation keys of the DSP card. It is possible to programme the number of provided IP Trunk channels to be used for H.323 and SIP trunks. In the The number of activated IP-GW box, type the number of IP Trunk channels to be used for H.323 trunks. The remaining number of IP Trunk channels will be used for SIP trunks. Similarly, you can programme how many IP softphones can be used through the IP Softphone/IP Proprietary Telephone Activation Key. In the The number of activated IP Softphone box, type the number of IP softphones to be used through the IP Softphone/IP Proprietary Telephone Activation Key. The remainder is the number of IP-PTs that can be used through the IP Softphone/IP Proprietary Telephone Activation Key. At default, only IP softphones can be used. IPCMPR-ID Indicates the ID number of the IPCMPR card (reference only). Value Range ID number of the IPCMPR card Maintenance Console Location 3.3 [1-1] Slot—Activation Key Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Activated Feature Indicates the type of activation keys (reference only). Note that the types of activation keys are subject to change without notice. Value Range IP Trunk (ch): IP Trunk Activation Key IP Proprietary Telephone (ch): IP Proprietary Telephone Activation Key IP Proprietary Telephone/IP Softphone (ch): IP Softphone/IP Proprietary Telephone Activation Key SIP Extension (ch): SIP Extension Activation Key Enhanced Features: Activation Key for Software Upgrade to Enhanced Version CA Basic (user): Activation Key for CA Basic CA Pro (user): Activation Key for CA PRO CA Supervisor (user): Activation Key for CA ACD Monitor Maintenance Console Location 3.3 [1-1] Slot—Activation Key PC Programming Manual 107 3.3 [1-1] Slot—Activation Key Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None The number of activated feature by—VoIP-DSP Card Indicates the number of channels provided by the DSP card (reference only). Value Range For DSP4/DSP16 card: IP Trunk (ch): 4 IP Proprietary Telephone (ch): 8 For DSP64 card: IP Trunk (ch): 16 IP Proprietary Telephone (ch): 32 Maintenance Console Location 3.3 [1-1] Slot—Activation Key Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None The number of activated feature by—Activation Key File in SD Card Indicates the number of channels (or CA users) provided by activation key files on the SD memory card (reference only). Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.3 [1-1] Slot—Activation Key Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None 108 PC Programming Manual 3.3 [1-1] Slot—Activation Key The number of activated feature by—Total Indicates the total number of channels (or CA users) provided by the DSP card and activation key files on the SD memory card (reference only). Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.3 [1-1] Slot—Activation Key Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 109 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR The properties of the IPCMPR card can be specified. LAN Setting DHCP Client Enables the DHCP Client function to assign IP address information automatically to the IPCMPR card. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.4.5 Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) Assignment MAC Address for IPCMPR Card Indicates the MAC address of the IPCMPR card (reference only). Value Range 00:00:00:00:00:00–FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None IP Address for IPCMPR Card Specifies the IP address of the IPCMPR card. This parameter is only available for entering values when DHCP Client is disabled. Value Range 1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255 110 PC Programming Manual 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None MAC Address for VoIP-DSP Indicates the MAC address of the DSP card (reference only). Value Range 00:00:00:00:00:00–FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None IP Address for VoIP-DSP Specifies the IP address of the DSP card. This parameter is only available for entering values when DHCP Client is disabled. Value Range 1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255 Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 111 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Subnet Mask Specifies the subnet mask address of the IPCMPR card. This parameter is only available for entering values when DHCP Client is disabled. Value Range 0–255.0–255.0–255.0–255 (except 0.0.0.0 and 255.255.255.255) Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Default Gateway Specifies the IP address of the default gateway for the network. This parameter is only available for entering values when DHCP Client is disabled. Value Range 0.0.0.0–223.255.255.255 Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Speed/Duplex for Main Port Specifies the connection mode of the main port. The connection is made in 100Mbps/half duplex when Auto Negotiation fails. Value Range Auto Negotiation 100Mbps/full duplex 100Mbps/half duplex 10Mbps/full duplex 10Mbps/half duplex 112 PC Programming Manual 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Speed/Duplex for Maintenance Port Specifies the connection mode of the maintenance port. The connection is made in 100Mbps/half duplex when Auto Negotiation fails. Value Range Auto Negotiation 100Mbps/full duplex 100Mbps/half duplex 10Mbps/full duplex 10Mbps/half duplex Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None LAN Disconnect Decision Time Specifies the length of time that the PBX waits before disconnecting LAN connection when no communication via the LAN is detected. Value Range 1–10 s Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 113 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Feature Guide References None DHCP Port Number Specifies the port number used by a DHCP server. Value Range 1–65535 Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.4.5 Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) Assignment DHCP Time Out Specifies the length of time that the PBX waits to receive IP addressing information from a DHCP server. Value Range 1–30 s Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.4.5 Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) Assignment VoIP-DSP Option DSP Card Type Indicates the type of the installed DSP card (reference only). Value Range None, DSP4, DSP16, DSP64 114 PC Programming Manual 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None DSP Card Status Indicates whether the DSP card is enabled for use (reference only). Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None IPCMPR-SVM TS Circuit Availability Specifies whether the built-in ESVM card of the PBX is enabled or disabled. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.7 Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM) PC Programming Manual 115 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR IP Extension Count of BGM Specifies how many IP-PTs connected to the IPCMPR card can send out BGM. Value Range When using the built-in ESVM card: 0–49 When not using the built-in ESVM card: 0–53 Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References 3.6 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property—Card Command Feature Guide References 1.17.4 Background Music (BGM) Version Indicates the programme software file version of the installed DSP card (reference only). Value Range Version number Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Jitter Compensation Operation for G.711 Enables the use of a jitter buffer feature for voice communications using the G.711 codec. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR 116 PC Programming Manual 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Jitter Compensation Operation for G.711 FAX Enables the use of a jitter buffer feature for fax communications using the G.711 codec. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Jitter Compensation Operation for G.729A Enables the use of a jitter buffer feature for communications using the G.729A codec. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Jitter Buffer Delay Min. for Voice Specifies the minimum size of the jitter buffer for voice communications. Value Range 0–200 ms PC Programming Manual 117 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Jitter Buffer Delay Max. for Voice Specifies the maximum size of the jitter buffer for voice communications. Value Range 0–200 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Jitter Buffer Delay Init. for Voice Specifies the initial size of the jitter buffer for voice communications. Value Range 0–200 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None 118 PC Programming Manual 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Jitter Buffer Adaptation Period for Voice Specifies the length of time that the jitter buffer is applied for voice communications. Value Range 1000–65530 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Jitter Buffer Delay Min. for FAX Specifies the minimum size of the jitter buffer for fax communications. Value Range 0–200 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Jitter Buffer Delay Max. for FAX Specifies the maximum size of the jitter buffer for fax communications. Value Range 0–200 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 119 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Feature Guide References None Jitter Buffer Delay Init. for FAX Specifies the initial size of the jitter buffer for fax communications. Value Range 0–200 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Jitter Buffer Adaptation Period for FAX Specifies the length of time that the jitter buffer is applied for fax communications. Value Range 1000–65530 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None DTMF Detection Level for G.711A Specifies the level of DTMF detection for the G.711A codec. Value Range -45– -12 dB Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR 120 PC Programming Manual 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None DTMF Detection Level for G.711µ Specifies the level of DTMF detection for the G.711µ codec. Value Range -39– -6 dB Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None CNG Signal Effective Detection Width 1 (ON) Specifies the length of time that the PBX detects the CNG signal. Value Range 20–5000 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None CNG Signal Effective Detection Width 2 (OFF) Specifies the length of time that the PBX waits until another CNG signal is detected. Value Range 20–5000 ms PC Programming Manual 121 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None CNG Signal Fixation Detection Counter Specifies the number of times the CNG signal must be detected before the PBX proceeds the fax operation. Value Range 1–3 Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None CED Signal Fixation Detection Time Specifies the minimum length of time required for the CED (called station identification) signal to be detected by the PBX. Value Range 50 ´ n (n=1–100) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None 122 PC Programming Manual 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR T.38 FAX Transmit Level (Network to PBX) A-Law Specifies the transmission level of G3 fax signals after being converted from T.38 protocol packets, when the codec used is G.711A. Value Range -13–2 dB Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None T.38 FAX Transmit Level (Network to PBX) µ-Law Specifies the transmission level of G3 fax signals after being converted from T.38 protocol packets, when the codec used is G.711µ. Value Range -7–8 dB Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None DSP CODEC G.711 only (SIP extension) Specifies whether or not to only use the G.711 codec for SIP extension calls. Value Range Enable, Disable Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR PC Programming Manual 123 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References 3.18 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port Feature Guide References None DSP CODEC G.711 only (IP-GW) Specifies whether or not to only use the G.711 codec for IP trunk calls. Value Range Enable, Disable Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References 3.11 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GW Settings Feature Guide References None DSP CODEC Priority-1 value only (others) Specifies whether or not to only use the priority 1 codec set for the following types of calls: • IP extension calls • SIP trunk calls Value Range Enable, Disable Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS Feature Guide References None 124 PC Programming Manual 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Port Number Maintenance Port Number Specifies the port number used to operate Maintenance Console via the LAN. Value Range 1–65535 Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None LOGIN Port Number Specifies the port number used to login to the PBX via the LAN. Value Range 1–65535 Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None CTI Port Number Specifies the port number used to operate CTI via the LAN. Selecting "0" disables the 3rd Party CTI feature. Value Range 0–65535 Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR PC Programming Manual 125 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.32 Computer Telephony Integration (CTI) Features Built-in Communication Assistant Server Specifies the port number for the Communication Assistant (CA) application. Value Range 1024–65535 Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 9— Built-in Communication Assistant 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 9— Built-in Communication Assistant Feature Guide References 1.32.3 CA (Communication Assistant) LAN Status LINK for Main Port Indicates the current connection status of the main port (reference only). Value Range Disconnect, Connect Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None LINK for Maintenance Port Indicates the current connection status of the maintenance port (reference only). 126 PC Programming Manual 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Value Range Disconnect, Connect Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None DHCP DHCP Client Indicates the DHCP client function status of the IPCMPR card (reference only). Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.4.5 Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) Assignment IP Address for IPCMPR Card Indicates the IP address of the IPCMPR card (reference only). Value Range 1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255 Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 127 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Feature Guide References None IP Address for VoIP-DSP Indicates the IP address of the DSP card (reference only). Value Range 1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255 Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Subnet Mask Indicates the subnet mask address of the IPCMPR card (reference only). Value Range 0–255.0–255.0–255.0–255 (except 0.0.0.0 and 255.255.255.255) Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Default Gateway Indicates the IP address of the default gateway for the network (reference only). Value Range 0.0.0.0–223.255.255.255 Maintenance Console Location 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR 128 PC Programming Manual 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 129 3.5 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property 3.5 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property The properties of the built-in 2-channel SVM (Simplified Voice Message) and OGM (Outgoing Message) features can be specified. To change the status of the built-in ESVM card, click Command. Only the following parameters can be set. Other parameters on this screen are only applicable for the Optional Base card. See 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property for details. Note To reach this screen, move the mouse pointer over the IPCMPR card and click SVM Property. Slot Indicates the slot type (reference only). Value Range IPCMPR Maintenance Console Location 3.5 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Sub-Slot Indicates the sub-slot number (reference only). Value Range Sub-slot number Maintenance Console Location 3.5 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Feature Card Type Indicates the feature type of each sub-slot (reference only). 130 PC Programming Manual 3.5 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Value Range In sub-slot 1–2: Reserve: No feature is installed. In sub-slot 3: ESVM2: Built-in ESVM card is installed. Maintenance Console Location 3.5 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Status Indicates the status of the feature type of each slot (reference only). The sub-slot 3 column offers two ways to open the screen to select the card command: • Click the desired cell in the column. • Select the desired cell in the column, and then click Command. Value Range For sub-slot 1–2: Not applicable. For sub-slot 3: INS: Built-in ESVM card is activated. OUS: Built-in ESVM card is not activated. Maintenance Console Location 3.5 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Programming Manual References 3.6 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property—Card Command Feature Guide References None Port Number Indicates the port number of the built-in ESVM card (reference only). PC Programming Manual 131 3.5 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 3.5 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Status Indicates the port status of the built-in ESVM card (reference only). Value Range For sub-slot 1–2: Not applicable. For sub-slot 3: INS: The card is activated. OUS: The card is not activated. Maintenance Console Location 3.5 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None SVM Feature Specifies whether or not to use the ESVM card for the SVM feature. It is possible to use the ESVM card for the SVM feature, as an MSG card (OGM feature), or both. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.5 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property 132 PC Programming Manual 3.5 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Programming Manual References 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property— SVM Feature Feature Guide References 1.17.5 Outgoing Message (OGM) 1.17.7 Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM) MSG Feature Specifies whether or not to use the ESVM card as an MSG card (OGM feature). It is possible to use the ESVM card for the SVM feature, as an MSG card (OGM feature), or both. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.5 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Programming Manual References 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property— MSG Feature Feature Guide References 1.17.5 Outgoing Message (OGM) 1.17.7 Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM) PC Programming Manual 133 3.6 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property—Card Command 3.6 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property—Card Command Commands for the built-in ESVM card can be programmed. INS Puts the feature in service. Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.6 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property—Card Command Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None OUS Takes the feature out of service. Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.6 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property—Card Command Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None 134 PC Programming Manual 3.7 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Gateway Port 3.7 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Gateway Port Various settings can be programmed for each virtual IP Gateway port. To change the status of virtual IP Gateway ports, click Command. Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 3.7 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Gateway Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 3.7 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Gateway Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Connection Indicates the port status (reference only). This column offers two ways to open the screen to select the port command: • Click the desired cell in the column. • Select the desired cell in the column, and then click Command. PC Programming Manual 135 3.7 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Gateway Port Value Range INS: The port is in service. OUS: The port is out of service. Fault: The port is not communicating with the network. Maintenance Console Location 3.7 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Gateway Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Call Distribution Port Group Specifies a call distribution port group to which incoming trunk calls are directed through the virtual VoIP gateway port. Value Range 1–16 Maintenance Console Location 3.7 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Gateway Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.2.3 Call Distribution Port Group 136 PC Programming Manual 3.8 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Gateway Port—Connection Command 3.8 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Gateway Port —Connection Command Commands for the virtual IP gateway ports can be programmed. INS Puts the port in service. Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.8 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Gateway Port—Connection Command Programming Manual References 3.7 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Gateway Port Feature Guide References None OUS Takes the port out of service. Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.8 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Gateway Port—Connection Command Programming Manual References 3.7 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Gateway Port Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 137 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Common settings for all of the V-IPGW cards installed in the IPCMPR Virtual Shelf can be programmed. Main Gatekeeper Available Specifies whether to use a gatekeeper. This setting can only be changed when all V-IPGW cards are set to OUS. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Call Signalling Model Specifies whether to carry out a call control (H.225) process directly between the cards or through a gatekeeper. Value Range Direct, GateKeeper Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Gatekeeper Connection Checking Interval (min) Specifies the time between periodic checks of connection to the gatekeeper. Value Range 0 (disabled), 1–1440 min 138 PC Programming Manual 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Primary Gatekeeper IP Address Specifies the IP address of the primary gatekeeper. Value Range 1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255 Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Primary Gatekeeper Port Number Specifies the port number of the primary gatekeeper. Value Range 1–65535 Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 139 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Secondary Gatekeeper IP Address Specifies the IP address of the secondary gatekeeper. Value Range 1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255 Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Secondary Gatekeeper Port Number Specifies the port number of the secondary gatekeeper. Value Range 1–65535 Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None H.225 Port Number Specifies the port number for the H.225 protocol (call control) in an H.323 protocol suite. Value Range 1–65535 Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None 140 PC Programming Manual 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Feature Guide References None RAS Port Number Specifies the port number for the H.225 protocol (RAS) in an H.323 protocol suite. Value Range 1–65535 Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None QSIG Connectionless Tunneling TCP Port Number Specifies the TCP port number for connectionless tunnelling between gateway devices at different locations in a QSIG network. Value Range 1–65535 Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None QSIG Connectionless Tunneling UDP Port Number Specifies the UDP port number for connectionless tunnelling between gateway devices at different locations in a QSIG network. Value Range 1–65535 PC Programming Manual 141 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None H.323 Dynamic Port Number Specifies the starting port number from which 448 contiguous ports are used as dynamic ports. Value Range 1–65000 Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None RTCP Packet Sending Ability Specifies whether to enable the PBX to send RTCP packets. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None 142 PC Programming Manual 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway RTCP Packet Interval Specifies the length of time until the PBX retries to send RTCP packets when no reply is received. Value Range 5–60 s Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None RTP QoS Available Specifies the type of value to be stored in the ToS field of the packet. Value Range ToS, DSCP, HEX Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None RTP QoS-ToS Priority Specifies the priority level in the ToS field. Value Range 0–7 Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 143 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Feature Guide References None RTP QoS-ToS Type Specifies the ToS type in the ToS field. Value Range Normal, Monetary Cost, Reliability, Throughput, Delay Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None RTP QoS-DSCP Specifies the value in the ToS field by a DSCP for DiffServ. Value Range 0–63 Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None RTP QoS-HEX Specifies the value in the ToS field by a hexadecimal number. Value Range 00–FF Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway 144 PC Programming Manual 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Echo Canceller Ability Specifies the echo canceller ability time. Value Range OFF, 48 ms, 128 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) DSP Digital Gain (Down) Specifies the DSP Digital Gain for the down voice path. Value Range -14–6 dB Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) DSP Digital Gain (Up) Specifies the DSP Digital Gain for the up voice path. Value Range -14–6 dB PC Programming Manual 145 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) EC Gain Specifies the Echo Canceller Gain. Value Range -14–6 dB Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) NLP Setting Specifies the NLP (Non-Linear Processor) setting to control echo sound quality. Value Range Disable, Weak, Normal, Strong Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) 146 PC Programming Manual 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway QSIG-CT Enables a call to be transferred to a destination extension at another PBX in a QSIG network. Value Range No, Yes Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.30.4.4 Call Transfer (CT)—by QSIG QSIG-CF Enables a call to be forwarded to a destination extension at another PBX in a QSIG network. When using the Centralised VM feature, set this to "No". Value Range No, Yes Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.30.4.3 Call Forwarding (CF)—by QSIG Trunk Property Indicates the networking type of each trunk. Value Range Public, Private, VPN Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway PC Programming Manual 147 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Outgoing Call En-bloc Dialling setting Selects the call dialling mode. Value Range En-bloc: The PBX sends all of the dialled digits at once after the extension user completes dialling. The PBX recognises the end of dialling when (1) # is dialled, if programmed, (2) a preprogrammed telephone number is dialled, or (3) the inter-digit timer expires. Overlap: The PBX sends dialled digits one at a time. Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.30.2 Voice over Internet Protocol (VoIP) Network Overlap—First-digit Timer (T302-1) Specifies the length of time within which the first digit of a dial number must be dialled after seizing a virtual IP trunk. Value Range 5–30 s Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None 148 PC Programming Manual 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Overlap—Inter-digit Timer (T302-2) Specifies the length of time within which subsequent digits of a dial number must be dialled. Value Range 1–10 s Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Overlap—Dial End Code Specifies the delimiter code to be used to signal the end of a dialled number. Value Range 0–9, #, * Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Incoming Call Voice Activity Detection for G.711 Enables the use of the Voice Activity Detection feature for the G.711 codec. This feature conserves bandwidth by detecting silent periods during a call and suppressing the packets of silence from being sent to the network. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway PC Programming Manual 149 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Voice Codec Priority 1st Specifies the highest priority codec type. For fax communications, it is necessary to specify G.711A or G. 711µ for this parameter. Value Range G.711A, G.711µ, G.729A Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Voice Codec Priority 2nd Specifies the second highest priority codec type. Value Range None, G.711A, G.711µ, G.729A Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Voice Codec Priority 3rd Specifies the third highest priority codec type. 150 PC Programming Manual 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Value Range None, G.711A, G.711µ, G.729A Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Packet Sampling Time for G.711A Specifies the time interval between measurements (samples) of sound data during a conversation. The smaller this number, the higher the quality of the transmitted sound. Value Range 10 ms, 20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 50 ms, 60 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Packet Sampling Time for G.711µ Specifies the time interval between measurements (samples) of sound data during a conversation. The smaller this number, the higher the quality of the transmitted sound. Value Range 10 ms, 20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 50 ms, 60 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 151 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Feature Guide References None Packet Sampling Time for G.729A Specifies the time interval between measurements (samples) of sound data during a conversation. The smaller this number, the higher the quality of the transmitted sound. Value Range 10 ms, 20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 50 ms, 60 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None FAX Detection Ability Enables the use of the FAX Detection Ability feature. Since fax signals using a codec other than G.711 cannot be received accurately at the destination, this feature automatically switches the codec to G.711 to enable end-to-end fax signal relay over the network. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—Incoming Call— Feature Guide References None DTMF Specifies the type of DTMF tone to be sent out. Value Range Inband, Outband (RFC2833), Outband (H.245) 152 PC Programming Manual Voice Codec Priority 1st 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Payload Type Specifies the payload type for DTMF tones using RFC2833. Programming this parameter is only necessary if DTMF is set to Outband (RFC2833). Value Range 96–127 Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None T.38 FAX Max Datagram Specifies the maximum datagram size when using the T.38 protocol. Value Range 272–512 Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 153 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway T.38 FAX UDPTL Error Correction – Redundancy Specifies whether to enable the redundancy feature when using the T.38 protocol. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None T.38 FAX UDPTL Redundancy count for T.30 messages Specifies the redundancy count for T.30 messages when using the T.38 protocol. Value Range 0–7 Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None T.38 FAX UDPTL Redundancy count for data Specifies the redundancy count for data when using the T.38 protocol. Value Range 0–3 Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None 154 PC Programming Manual 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Feature Guide References None T.38 FAX Rate Management Method Specifies the rate management method when using the T.38 protocol. Value Range Transferred TCF, Local TCF Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Timer T301 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after making a call. Value Range 0–18000 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None T302 Specifies the maximum time allowed between each digit on an incoming call. Applies to overlap receiving. Value Range 0–600 ´ 100 ms PC Programming Manual 155 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None T303 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the SETUP (call setting) message. Value Range 0–600 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None T304 Specifies the maximum time allowed between each digit on an outgoing call. Applies to overlap sending. Value Range 0–3000 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None 156 PC Programming Manual 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway T305 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the DISC (disconnection) message. Value Range 0–3000 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None T308 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after receiving the Release message. Value Range 0–600 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None T309 Specifies the length of time after which the PBX tries to disconnect the data link, before disconnecting the call. Value Range 0–3000 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 157 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Feature Guide References None T310 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a continuance message after receiving the Incoming Call Proceeding message. Value Range 0–3000 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None T313 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the Connect message. Value Range 0–600 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None T316 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the Restart message. Value Range 0–3000 ´ 100 ms 158 PC Programming Manual 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None T318 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the Resume message. Value Range 0–600 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None T319 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the Suspend message. Value Range 0–600 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 159 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway T322 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the Status enquiry message. Value Range 0–600 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None T3D3 Specifies the length of time after which the PBX tries to establish L2 in "Permanent" mode. Value Range 0–3000 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None T3D9 Specifies the length of time after which the PBX tries to disconnect L2 in "Call by Call" mode. Value Range 0–3000 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Programming Manual References None 160 PC Programming Manual 3.9 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 161 3.10 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GK Settings 3.10 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway— GK Settings Gatekeeper registration information can be programmed. Destination Number Specifies a telephone number to register with a gatekeeper. Value Range Max. 30 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 3.10 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GK Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Device Name Specifies the name of the device for programming reference. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 3.10 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GK Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None 162 PC Programming Manual 3.11 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GW Settings 3.11 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway— GW Settings The settings related to destination gateway devices can be programmed. The following parameters can be specified for a maximum of 512 destination gateway devices. Main GW Name Specifies the name of the destination gateway device for programming reference. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 3.11 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GW Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None GW IP Address Specifies the IP address of the destination gateway device. Value Range 1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255 Maintenance Console Location 3.11 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GW Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None GW Group Specifies the number of the gateway group to which the gateway entry belongs. A maximum of 256 gateway groups can be created. PC Programming Manual 163 3.11 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GW Settings Value Range 1–256, None Maintenance Console Location 3.11 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GW Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Connection for IP-GW16 Enables the use of the Voice Activity Detection feature between the V-IPGW and KX-TDE/KX-TDA IP-GW16 cards. Value Range Disable (TDE), Enable (TDA) Maintenance Console Location 3.11 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GW Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Protocol Specifies the type of protocol for connectionless tunnelling between gateway devices at different locations in a QSIG network. Value Range TCP, UDP Maintenance Console Location 3.11 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GW Settings Programming Manual References None 164 PC Programming Manual 3.11 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GW Settings Feature Guide References None Progress Tone Send Mode Specifies whether to send call progress tones to the destination. When selecting External, call progress tones are audible at the destination. Value Range External, Internal Maintenance Console Location 3.11 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GW Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Option 1 GW Name Specifies the name of the destination gateway device for programming reference. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 3.11 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GW Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None IP Codec Priority—1st, 2nd, 3rd Specifies the priority of the codecs to be used. For fax communications, it is necessary to specify G.711A or G.711Mu for 1st priority. PC Programming Manual 165 3.11 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GW Settings Value Range For 1st: G.711A, G.711Mu, G.729A For 2nd and 3rd: None, G.711A, G.711Mu, G.729A Maintenance Console Location 3.11 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GW Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Packet Sampling Time (G.711A) Specifies the time interval between measurements (samples) of sound data during a conversation. The smaller this number, the higher the quality of the transmitted sound. Value Range 10 ms, 20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 50 ms, 60 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.11 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GW Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Packet Sampling Time (G.711Mu) Specifies the time interval between measurements (samples) of sound data during a conversation. The smaller this number, the higher the quality of the transmitted sound. Value Range 10 ms, 20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 50 ms, 60 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.11 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GW Settings 166 PC Programming Manual 3.11 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GW Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Packet Sampling Time (G.729A) Specifies the time interval between measurements (samples) of sound data during a conversation. The smaller this number, the higher the quality of the transmitted sound. Value Range 10 ms, 20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 50 ms, 60 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.11 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GW Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Option 2 GW Name Specifies the name of the destination gateway device for programming reference. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 3.11 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GW Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Voice Activity Detection for G.711 Enables the use of the Voice Activity Detection feature for the G.711 codec. This feature conserves bandwidth by detecting silent periods during a call and suppressing the packets of silence from being sent to the network. PC Programming Manual 167 3.11 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GW Settings Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.11 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GW Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None FAX Detection Ability Enables the use of the FAX Detection Ability feature. Since fax signals using a codec other than G.711 cannot be received accurately at the destination, this feature automatically switches the codec to G.711 to enable end-to-end fax signal relay over the network. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.11 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GW Settings Programming Manual References 3.11 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GW Settings—Option 1— 3rd Feature Guide References None DTMF Specifies the method to transport DTMF tones. Value Range Inband, Outband (RFC2833), Outband (H.245) Maintenance Console Location 3.11 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GW Settings Programming Manual References None 168 PC Programming Manual IP Codec Priority—1st, 2nd, 3.11 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GW Settings Feature Guide References None Payload Type Specifies the payload type for DTMF tones using RFC2833. Programming this parameter is only necessary if DTMF is set to Outband (RFC2833). Value Range 96–127 Maintenance Console Location 3.11 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—GW Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 169 3.12 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—DN2IP 3.12 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway— DN2IP The related settings of the address translation of telephone numbers and IP addresses can be programmed. Leading Number Specifies the leading digits in dialled numbers by which to associate calls with the appropriate destination. Value Range Max. 30 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 3.12 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—DN2IP Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Remaining Number of Digits Specifies the number of digits to be dialled following the leading number to access the destination. Value Range 0–29 Maintenance Console Location 3.12 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—DN2IP Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None GW No./GW Group Selection Specifies the type of destination when making calls: a gateway device or a gateway group. Value Range GW Group, GW No. 170 PC Programming Manual 3.12 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—DN2IP Maintenance Console Location 3.12 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—DN2IP Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None GW Group Specifies the number of the destination gateway group. Value Range 1–256 Maintenance Console Location 3.12 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—DN2IP Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None GW No. Specifies the number of the destination gateway device. Value Range 1–512 Maintenance Console Location 3.12 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—DN2IP Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 171 3.13 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—Hunt Pattern 3.13 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway— Hunt Pattern The related settings of hunt patterns can be programmed. The hunt pattern determines how to route incoming calls through virtual IP trunks to the PBX. A maximum of 32 hunt patterns can be programmed. Hunt Pattern 1–16 Leading Number Specifies the leading digits of dialled numbers by which to determine the call distribution port group to direct incoming calls. Value Range Max. 30 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 3.13 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—Hunt Pattern Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Call Distribution Port Group—1st–16th Specifies the number of the call distribution port group to which incoming calls are directed in priority. Value Range For 1st: CDPG1–CDPG16 For 2nd–16th: None, CDPG1–CDPG16 Maintenance Console Location 3.13 [1-1] Slot—Shelf Property - Virtual IP Gateway—Hunt Pattern Programming Manual References 3.7 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Gateway Port— Feature Guide References 1.2.3 Call Distribution Port Group 172 PC Programming Manual Call Distribution Port Group 3.14 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IP Extension 3.14 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IP Extension The properties of the V-IPEXT card can be specified. Signalling (PTAP) UDP Port No. (Server) Specifies the UDP port used by the V-IPEXT card to transmit and receive PTAP (Panasonic Telephony Administration Protocol) data. This must be changed if another network application is using the same port. To change the value displayed here, click Common Settings and set the desired value. Value Range 1–65535 Maintenance Console Location 3.14 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) Signalling (MGCP) UDP Port No. (Server) Specifies the UDP port used by the V-IPEXT card to transmit and receive MGCP (Media Gateway Control Protocol) data. This must be changed if another network application is using the same port. To change the value displayed here, click Common Settings and set the desired value. Value Range 1–65535 Maintenance Console Location 3.14 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) Signalling (MGCP) UDP Port No. (IP-PT) Specifies the UDP port used to transmit and receive MGCP (Media Gateway Control Protocol) data on the IP-PT side. This must be changed if another network application is using the same port. To change the value displayed here, click Common Settings and set the desired value. PC Programming Manual 173 3.14 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IP Extension Value Range 1–65535 Maintenance Console Location 3.14 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) Voice (RTP) UDP Port No. (Server) Specifies the UDP port used by the V-IPEXT card to transmit and receive RTP (Realtime Transfer Protocol) data. This must be changed if another network application is using the same port. For voice communications, the V-IPEXT card uses 64 contiguous UDP ports, starting from the port number specified here. To change the value displayed here, click Common Settings and set the desired value. Value Range 1–65024 Maintenance Console Location 3.14 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) Voice (RTP) UDP Port No. (IP-PT) Specifies the UDP port used to transmit and receive RTP (Realtime Transfer Protocol) data on the IP-PT side. This must be changed if another network application is using the same port. For voice communications, an IP-PT uses 64 contiguous UDP ports, starting from the port number specified here. To change the value displayed here, click Common Settings and set the desired value. Value Range 1–65024 174 PC Programming Manual 3.14 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IP Extension Maintenance Console Location 3.14 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) Keep Alive Time-Out Specifies the length of time that the PBX will continue to consider an IP-PT to be active even if it receives no transmissions from that IP-PT. The PBX constantly confirms the status of IP-PTs. If no communications are received from an IP-PT for the duration specified here, the PBX considers the IP-PT to be unreachable, and sets the port status to Fault. During operation, set between 10 s and 60 s. Settings over 60 s, and Disable, are used for debugging purposes, and IP-PTs cannot be guaranteed to function normally in these circumstances. Do not use debugging settings unless instructed to do so. To change the value displayed here, click Common Settings and set the desired value. Value Range Disable, 10–120 s Maintenance Console Location 3.14 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) First Resending Time (PTAP) Specifies the length of time that the PBX waits before starting to resend PTAP (Panasonic Telephony Administration Protocol). To change the value displayed here, click Common Settings and set the desired value. Value Range 500 ´ n (n=1–16) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.14 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IP Extension PC Programming Manual 175 3.14 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) Resending Time Out (PTAP) Specifies the length of time after which the PBX terminates resending PTAP (Panasonic Telephony Administration Protocol). To change the value displayed here, click Common Settings and set the desired value. Value Range 150–240 s Maintenance Console Location 3.14 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) First Resending Time (MGCP) Specifies the length of time that the PBX waits before starting to resend MGCP (Media Gateway Control Protocol). To change the value displayed here, click Common Settings and set the desired value. Value Range 500 ´ n (n=1–8) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.14 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) 176 PC Programming Manual 3.14 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IP Extension Resending Time Out (MGCP) Specifies the length of time after which the PBX terminates resending MGCP (Media Gateway Control Protocol). To change the value displayed here, click Common Settings and set the desired value. Value Range 75–120 s Maintenance Console Location 3.14 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) Echo Canceller Ability Specifies the echo canceller ability time. Value Range OFF, 48 ms, 128 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.14 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) DSP Digital Gain (Down) Specifies the DSP Digital Gain for the down voice path. Value Range -14–6 dB Maintenance Console Location 3.14 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IP Extension PC Programming Manual 177 3.14 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) DSP Digital Gain (Up) Specifies the DSP Digital Gain for the up voice path. Value Range -14–6 dB Maintenance Console Location 3.14 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) EC Gain Specifies the Echo Canceller Gain. Value Range -14–6 dB Maintenance Console Location 3.14 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) NLP Setting Specifies the NLP (Non-Linear Processor) setting to control echo sound quality. Value Range Disable, Weak, Normal, Strong 178 PC Programming Manual 3.14 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IP Extension Maintenance Console Location 3.14 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) PC Programming Manual 179 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension Various settings can be programmed for each virtual IP extension port. To change the status of virtual IP extension ports, click Command. IP-PT Registration and De-registration An IP-PT must be registered to the PBX by programming the PBX and IP-PT before it can be used. Programming instructions for the PBX are given below. It is possible to de-register the IP-PT later. Preparation Open 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR, and confirm that the IP addresses of the IPCMPR and DSP cards, subnet mask address, and default gateway address are set. Registration Follow the steps below to register the IP-PT. 1. Connect the IP-PT to be registered to the network and, if necessary, the power supply. 2. Click Registration. A dialogue box will appear. Non-registered (available) extension numbers and names are displayed on the left. 3. Highlight numbers and names and click the right arrow to select them for registration. Click Next. 4. If the registration is still in progress, the dialogue box will show "Registration Executing". If the registration is successful, the dialogue box will show "Registration Completed". Click Close. Once the IP-PT is successfully registered, the status of the IP-PT will update to show "Registered". De-registration Follow the steps below to de-register the IP-PT. 1. Click De-registration. A dialogue box will appear. Registered extension numbers and names are displayed on the left. 2. Highlight numbers and names and click the right arrow to select them for de-registration. Click Next. A dialogue box will appear. 3. Click Confirm. • If the de-registration is successful, the dialogue box will show "De-registration Succeed". • If the de-registration is unsuccessful, the dialogue box will show "De-registration Error". De-registration will be terminated. 4. Click Close. If the IP-PT is successfully de-registered, the status of the IP-PT will update to show "None". Forced De-registration Follow the steps below to forcibly de-register the IP-PT when normal de-registration has been unsuccessful or IP address settings have been changed or deleted only on the IP-PT. 1. Click Forced De-registration. A dialogue box will appear. Registered extension numbers and names are displayed on the left. 2. Highlight numbers and names and click the right arrow to select them for forced de-registration. Click Next. A dialogue box will appear. 180 PC Programming Manual 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension 3. Click OK. A dialogue box will appear. 4. Click Confirm. • If the de-registration is successful, the dialogue box will show "Forced De-registration Succeed". 5. Click Close. Once the IP-PT is successfully de-registered, the status of the IP-PT will update to show "None". Main Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) Extension Number Specifies the extension number of the port. PC Programming Manual 181 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) Extension Name Specifies the extension name of the port. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) Connection Indicates the port status (reference only). This column offers two ways to open the screen to select the port command: • Click the desired cell in the column. • Select the desired cell in the column, and then click Command. This cell is only active when Status on this screen shows Registered. Value Range INS: The port is in service. OUS: The port is out of service. Fault: The port is not communicating with the network. Maintenance Console Location 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension 182 PC Programming Manual 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) Status Indicates whether a certain IP-PT is registered (reference only). Value Range None, Registered Maintenance Console Location 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) IP Phone Registration ID (MAC Address) Specifies the MAC address of the IP-PT. This parameter can only be modified when Connection on this screen is set to OUS. Value Range 00:00:00:00:00:00–FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF Maintenance Console Location 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) Current IP Address Indicates the current IP address of the IP-PT (reference only). PC Programming Manual 183 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension Value Range 1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255 Maintenance Console Location 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) Program Ver. Indicates the programme software file version of the IP-PT (reference only). Value Range Version number Maintenance Console Location 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) Option Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None 184 PC Programming Manual 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) Extension Number Specifies the extension number of the port. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) Extension Name Specifies the extension name of the port. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension PC Programming Manual 185 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) Connection Indicates the port status (reference only). This column offers two ways to open the screen to select the port command: • Click the desired cell in the column. • Select the desired cell in the column, and then click Command. This cell is only active when Status on this screen shows Registered. Value Range INS: The port is in service. OUS: The port is out of service. Fault: The port is not communicating with the network. Maintenance Console Location 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) Headset OFF/ON Turns on or off the use of a headset with the IP-PT. Value Range Headset OFF, Headset ON Maintenance Console Location 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) 186 PC Programming Manual 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension Ringing Tone Selects the dual-tone switching pattern of the ring tone for incoming calls. Value Range A: 64 ms (697 Hz), 64 ms (852 Hz) B: 32 ms (697 Hz), 32 ms (852 Hz) C: 128 ms (697 Hz), 128 ms (852 Hz) D: 32 ms (697 Hz), 96 ms (852 Hz) Maintenance Console Location 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) IP Codec Priority Specifies the codec used for compression and decompression of transmitted data. Some codecs may become unavailable depending on the value set here, as follows: – When G.722 is selected, the priority is G.722 ® G.711 ® G.729A. – When G.711 is selected, the priority is G.711 ® G.729A (G.722 is unavailable). – When G.729A is selected, both G.711 and G.722 are unavailable. Value Range G.711, G.729A, G.722 Maintenance Console Location 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) Packet Sampling Time (G.711/G.722) Specifies the time interval between measurements (samples) of sound data during a conversation. The smaller this number, the higher the quality of the transmitted sound. Value Range 20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 60 ms PC Programming Manual 187 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension Maintenance Console Location 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) Packet Sampling Time (G.729A) Specifies the time interval between measurements (samples) of sound data during a conversation. The smaller this number, the higher the quality of the transmitted sound. Value Range 20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 60 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) 188 PC Programming Manual 3.16 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension—Connection Command 3.16 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension —Connection Command Commands for the virtual IP extension ports can be programmed. INS Puts the port in service. Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.16 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension—Connection Command Programming Manual References 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension Feature Guide References None OUS Takes the port out of service. Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.16 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension—Connection Command Programming Manual References 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 189 3.17 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual SIP Extension 3.17 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual SIP Extension The properties of the virtual SIP Extension card can be specified. UDP Port No. for SIP Extension Server Specifies the UDP port number used for the SIP Extension server. To change the value displayed here, click Common Settings and set the desired value. Value Range 1–65535 Maintenance Console Location 3.17 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual SIP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.2 SIP (Session Initiation Protocol) Extension SIP Location Hold Time Max. Specifies the maximum length of time that the PBX holds information on the location of SIP Extensions. To change the value displayed here, click Common Settings and set the desired value. Value Range 10–3600 s Maintenance Console Location 3.17 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual SIP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.2 SIP (Session Initiation Protocol) Extension SIP Location Hold Time Min. Specifies the minimum length of time that the PBX holds information on the location of SIP Extensions. To change the value displayed here, click Common Settings and set the desired value. Value Range 10–3600 s 190 PC Programming Manual 3.17 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual SIP Extension Maintenance Console Location 3.17 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual SIP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.2 SIP (Session Initiation Protocol) Extension SIP Location Hold Time Interval Specifies the interval time that the PBX waits before starting to hold information on location of SIP Extensions. To change the value displayed here, click Common Settings and set the desired value. Value Range 1–10 s Maintenance Console Location 3.17 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual SIP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.2 SIP (Session Initiation Protocol) Extension SIP Session Timer Min. Specifies the minimum length of time that the PBX waits before disconnecting SIP sessions when no communication is detected. To change the value displayed here, click Common Settings and set the desired value. Value Range 90–3600 s Maintenance Console Location 3.17 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual SIP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.2 SIP (Session Initiation Protocol) Extension PC Programming Manual 191 3.17 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual SIP Extension Echo Canceller Ability Specifies the echo canceller ability time. Value Range OFF, 48 ms, 128 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.17 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual SIP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.2 SIP (Session Initiation Protocol) Extension DSP Digital Gain (Down) Specifies the DSP Digital Gain for the down voice path. Value Range -14–6 dB Maintenance Console Location 3.17 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual SIP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.2 SIP (Session Initiation Protocol) Extension DSP Digital Gain (Up) Specifies the DSP Digital Gain for the up voice path. Value Range -14–6 dB Maintenance Console Location 3.17 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual SIP Extension Programming Manual References None 192 PC Programming Manual 3.17 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual SIP Extension Feature Guide References 1.31.2 SIP (Session Initiation Protocol) Extension EC Gain Specifies the Echo Canceller Gain. Value Range -14–6 dB Maintenance Console Location 3.17 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual SIP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.2 SIP (Session Initiation Protocol) Extension NLP Setting Specifies the NLP (Non-Linear Processor) setting to control echo sound quality. Value Range Disable, Weak, Normal, Strong Maintenance Console Location 3.17 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual SIP Extension Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.2 SIP (Session Initiation Protocol) Extension PC Programming Manual 193 3.18 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port 3.18 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port Various settings can be programmed for each virtual SIP extension port. To change the status of virtual SIP extension ports, click Command. Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 3.18 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.2 SIP (Session Initiation Protocol) Extension Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 3.18 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.2 SIP (Session Initiation Protocol) Extension Extension Number Specifies the extension number of the port. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) 194 PC Programming Manual 3.18 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port Maintenance Console Location 3.18 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.2 SIP (Session Initiation Protocol) Extension Password Specifies the password used for registering a SIP Extension to the PBX. While it is possible to enter a password manually for each SIP Extension, you can copy Extension Number to Password clicking Copy to button. This parameter can only be modified when the virtual SIP extension port is set to OUS. Value Range 3–16 characters (consisting of 0–9, a–z, A–Z) Maintenance Console Location 3.18 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.2 SIP (Session Initiation Protocol) Extension Connection Indicates the port status (reference only). This column offers two ways to open the screen to select the port command: • Click the desired cell in the column. • Select the desired cell in the column, and then click Command. This cell is only active when Status on this screen shows Registered. Value Range INS: The port is in service. OUS: The port is out of service. Fault: The port is not communicating with the network. Maintenance Console Location 3.18 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 195 3.18 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port Feature Guide References 1.31.2 SIP (Session Initiation Protocol) Extension Current IP Address Indicates the current IP address of the SIP Extension (reference only). Value Range 1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255 Maintenance Console Location 3.18 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.2 SIP (Session Initiation Protocol) Extension Bearer Selects the bearer mode. When Automatic is selected, the bearer mode is set to Speech automatically. Value Range Automatic, Speech, Audio Maintenance Console Location 3.18 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.2 SIP (Session Initiation Protocol) Extension Packet Sampling Time (G.711/G.722) Specifies the time interval between measurements (samples) of sound data during a conversation. The smaller this number, the higher the quality of the transmitted sound. Value Range 10 ms, 20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 50 ms, 60 ms 196 PC Programming Manual 3.18 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port Maintenance Console Location 3.18 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.2 SIP (Session Initiation Protocol) Extension Packet Sampling Time (G.729A) Specifies the time interval between measurements (samples) of sound data during a conversation. The smaller this number, the higher the quality of the transmitted sound. Value Range 10 ms, 20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 50 ms, 60 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.18 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.2 SIP (Session Initiation Protocol) Extension Voice Activity Detection for G.711 Enables the use of the Voice Activity Detection feature for the G.711 codec. This feature conserves bandwidth by detecting silent periods during a call and suppressing the packets of silence from being sent to the network. Value Range OFF, ON Maintenance Console Location 3.18 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.2 SIP (Session Initiation Protocol) Extension PC Programming Manual 197 3.18 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port Voice Activity Detection for G.729A Enables the use of the Voice Activity Detection feature for the G.729A codec. This feature conserves bandwidth by detecting silent periods during a call and suppressing the packets of silence from being sent to the network. Value Range OFF, ON Maintenance Console Location 3.18 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.2 SIP (Session Initiation Protocol) Extension 198 PC Programming Manual 3.19 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port—Connection Command 3.19 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port—Connection Command Commands for the virtual SIP extension ports can be programmed. INS Puts the port in service. Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.19 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port—Connection Command Programming Manual References 3.18 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port Feature Guide References 1.31.2 SIP (Session Initiation Protocol) Extension OUS Takes the port out of service. Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.19 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port—Connection Command Programming Manual References 3.18 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port Feature Guide References 1.31.2 SIP (Session Initiation Protocol) Extension PC Programming Manual 199 3.20 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IPCS 3.20 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IPCS The properties of the V-IPCS card can be specified. Signalling (PTAP) UDP Port No. (Server) Specifies the UDP port used by the V-IPCS card to transmit and receive PTAP (Panasonic Telephony Administration Protocol) data. This must be changed if another network application is using the same port. To change the value displayed here, click Common Settings and set the desired value. Value Range 1–65535 Maintenance Console Location 3.20 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Signalling (MGCP) UDP Port No. (Server) Specifies the UDP port used by the V-IPCS card to transmit and receive MGCP (Media Gateway Control Protocol) data. This must be changed if another network application is using the same port. To change the value displayed here, click Common Settings and set the desired value. Value Range 1–65535 Maintenance Console Location 3.20 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Signalling (MGCP) UDP Port No. (IP-CS) Specifies the UDP port used to transmit and receive MGCP (Media Gateway Control Protocol) data on the IP-CS side. This must be changed if another network application is using the same port. To change the value displayed here, click Common Settings and set the desired value. 200 PC Programming Manual 3.20 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IPCS Value Range 1–65535 Maintenance Console Location 3.20 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Voice (RTP) UDP Port No. (Server) Specifies the UDP port used by the V-IPCS card to transmit and receive RTP (Realtime Transfer Protocol) data. This must be changed if another network application is using the same port. For voice communications, the V-IPCS card uses 64 contiguous UDP ports, starting from the port number specified here. To change the value displayed here, click Common Settings and set the desired value. Value Range 1–65024 Maintenance Console Location 3.20 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Voice (RTP) UDP Port No. (IP-CS) Specifies the UDP port used to transmit and receive RTP (Realtime Transfer Protocol) data on the IP-CS side. This must be changed if another network application is using the same port. For voice communications, an IP-CS uses 64 contiguous UDP ports, starting from the port number specified here. To change the value displayed here, click Common Settings and set the desired value. Value Range 1–65024 PC Programming Manual 201 3.20 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IPCS Maintenance Console Location 3.20 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Keep Alive Time-Out Specifies the length of time that the PBX will continue to consider an IP-CS to be active even if it receives no transmissions from that IP-CS. The PBX constantly confirms the status of IP-CSs. If no communications are received from an IP-CS for the duration specified here, the PBX considers the IP-CS to be unreachable, and sets the port status to Fault. During operation, set between 10 s and 60 s. Settings over 60 s, and Disable, are used for debugging purposes, and IP-CSs cannot be guaranteed to function normally in these circumstances. Do not use debugging settings unless instructed to do so. To change the value displayed here, click Common Settings and set the desired value. Value Range Disable, 10–120 s Maintenance Console Location 3.20 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None First Resending Time (PTAP) Specifies the length of time that the PBX waits before starting to resend PTAP (Panasonic Telephony Administration Protocol). To change the value displayed here, click Common Settings and set the desired value. Value Range 500 ´ n (n=1–16) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.20 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IPCS 202 PC Programming Manual 3.20 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Resending Time Out (PTAP) Specifies the length of time after which the PBX terminates resending PTAP (Panasonic Telephony Administration Protocol). To change the value displayed here, click Common Settings and set the desired value. Value Range 150–240 s Maintenance Console Location 3.20 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None First Resending Time (MGCP) Specifies the length of time that the PBX waits before starting to resend MGCP (Media Gateway Control Protocol). To change the value displayed here, click Common Settings and set the desired value. Value Range 500 ´ n (n=1–8) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.20 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 203 3.20 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IPCS Resending Time Out (MGCP) Specifies the length of time after which the PBX terminates resending MGCP (Media Gateway Control Protocol). To change the value displayed here, click Common Settings and set the desired value. Value Range 75–120 s Maintenance Console Location 3.20 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Echo Canceller Ability Specifies the echo canceller ability time. Value Range OFF, 48 ms, 128 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.20 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None DSP Digital Gain (Down) Specifies the DSP Digital Gain for the down voice path. Value Range -14–6 dB Maintenance Console Location 3.20 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IPCS 204 PC Programming Manual 3.20 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None DSP Digital Gain (Up) Specifies the DSP Digital Gain for the up voice path. Value Range -14–6 dB Maintenance Console Location 3.20 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None EC Gain Specifies the Echo Canceller Gain. Value Range -14–6 dB Maintenance Console Location 3.20 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None NLP Setting Specifies the NLP (Non-Linear Processor) setting to control echo sound quality. Value Range Disable, Weak, Normal, Strong PC Programming Manual 205 3.20 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IPCS Maintenance Console Location 3.20 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None 206 PC Programming Manual 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS Various settings can be programmed for each virtual IP-CS port. To change the status of virtual IP-CS ports, click Command. IP-CS Registration and De-registration An IP-CS must be registered to the PBX by programming the PBX and IP-CS before it can be used. Programming instructions for the PBX are given below. It is possible to de-register the IP-CS later. Preparation Open 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR, and confirm that the IP addresses of the IPCMPR and DSP cards, subnet mask address, and default gateway address are set. Registration Follow the steps below to register the IP-CS. 1. Connect the IP-CS to be registered to the network and, if necessary, the power supply. 2. Click Registration. A dialogue box will appear. Non-registered (available) IP-CSs are displayed on the left. 3. Highlight IP-CSs and click the right arrow to select them for registration. Click Next. 4. If the registration is still in progress, the dialogue box will show "Registration Executing". If the registration is successful, the dialogue box will show "Registration Completed". Click Close. Once the IP-CS is successfully registered, the status of the IP-CS will update to show "Registered". De-registration Follow the steps below to de-register the IP-CS. 1. Click De-registration. A dialogue box will appear. Registered IP-CSs are displayed on the left. 2. Highlight IP-CSs and click the right arrow to select them for de-registration. Click Next. A dialogue box will appear. 3. Click Confirm. • If the de-registration is successful, the dialogue box will show "De-registration Succeed". • If the de-registration is unsuccessful, the dialogue box will show "De-registration Error". De-registration will be terminated. 4. Click Close. If the IP-CS is successfully de-registered, the status of the IP-CS will update to show "None". Forced De-registration Follow the steps below to forcibly de-register the IP-CS when normal de-registration has been unsuccessful or IP address settings have been changed or deleted only on the IP-CS. 1. Click Forced De-registration. A dialogue box will appear. Registered IP-CSs are displayed on the left. 2. Highlight IP-CSs and click the right arrow to select them for forced de-registration. Click Next. A dialogue box will appear. 3. Click OK. A dialogue box will appear. PC Programming Manual 207 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS 4. Click Confirm. • If the de-registration is successful, the dialogue box will show "Forced De-registration Succeed". 5. Click Close. Once the IP-CS is successfully de-registered, the status of the IP-CS will update to show "None". Main Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None CS Name Specifies the CS name of the port. Value Range Max. 20 characters 208 PC Programming Manual 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS Maintenance Console Location 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Connection Indicates the port status (reference only). This column offers two ways to open the screen to select the port command: • Click the desired cell in the column. • Select the desired cell in the column, and then click Command. This cell is only active when Status on this screen shows Registered. Value Range INS: The port is in service. OUS: The port is out of service. Fault: The port is not communicating with the network. Maintenance Console Location 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Status Indicates whether a certain IP-CS is registered (reference only). Value Range None, Registered Maintenance Console Location 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 209 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS Feature Guide References None MAC Address Indicates the MAC address of the IP-CS (reference only). Value Range 00:00:00:00:00:00–FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF Maintenance Console Location 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Current IP Address Indicates the current IP address of the IP-CS (reference only). Value Range 1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255 Maintenance Console Location 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Program Ver. Indicates the programme software file version of the IP-CS (reference only). Value Range Version number Maintenance Console Location 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS 210 PC Programming Manual 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Air Sync Group No Assigns an Air Synchronisation Group number to the IP-CS. Value Range None, 1 Maintenance Console Location 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References 5.29 [3-11] Air Synchronisation Group 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Feature Guide References None Air Sync Group Name Indicates the name of the Air Synchronisation Group of the IP-CS (reference only). Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References 5.29 [3-11] Air Synchronisation Group 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Feature Guide References None Option Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). PC Programming Manual 211 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None CS Name Specifies the CS name of the port. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None 212 PC Programming Manual 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS Feature Guide References None Connection Indicates the port status (reference only). This column offers two ways to open the screen to select the port command: • Click the desired cell in the column. • Select the desired cell in the column, and then click Command. This cell is only active when Status on this screen shows Registered. Value Range INS: The port is in service. OUS: The port is out of service. Fault: The port is not communicating with the network. Maintenance Console Location 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None IP Codec Priority Specifies the codec used for compression and decompression of transmitted data. Value Range G.711, G.729A Maintenance Console Location 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Packet Sampling Time (G.711) Specifies the time interval between measurements (samples) of sound data during a conversation. The smaller this number, the higher the quality of the transmitted sound. PC Programming Manual 213 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS Value Range 10 ms, 20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 50 ms, 60 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Packet Sampling Time (G.729A) Specifies the time interval between measurements (samples) of sound data during a conversation. The smaller this number, the higher the quality of the transmitted sound. Value Range 10 ms, 20 ms, 30 ms, 40 ms, 50 ms, 60 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Voice Activity Detection for G.711 Enables the use of the Voice Activity Detection feature for the G.711 codec. This feature conserves bandwidth by detecting silent periods during a call and suppressing the packets of silence from being sent to the network. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS Programming Manual References None 214 PC Programming Manual 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 215 3.22 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS—Connection Command 3.22 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS— Connection Command Commands for the virtual IP-CS ports can be programmed. INS Puts the port in service. Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.22 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS—Connection Command Programming Manual References 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS Feature Guide References None OUS Takes the port out of service. Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.22 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS—Connection Command Programming Manual References 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS Feature Guide References None 216 PC Programming Manual 3.23 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Extension Type 3.23 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Extension Type The property for the extension cards can be specified. KX-T7250 Transfer/Hold Key Mode Selects whether the control signals sent by the Transfer and Hold buttons on KX-T7250 PTs are reversed or not. Value Range Mode 1: Does not switch the control signals Mode 2: Switches the control signals Maintenance Console Location 3.23 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Extension Type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None SLT Pulse Dial Mode Selects the type of pulse dial transmission appropriate to your area. Value Range Normal, Sweden, New Zealand Maintenance Console Location 3.23 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Extension Type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None SLT Off Hook Time Specifies the minimum length that a pulse dial sent from an SLT must be for the PBX to recognise it as an off-hook signal. Value Range 8 ´ n (n=3–255) ms PC Programming Manual 217 3.23 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Extension Type Maintenance Console Location 3.23 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Extension Type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None SLT Off Hook Guard Time Specifies the length of guard time used for off-hook signals from SLTs, to prevent the PBX mistaking them for pulse dials. Value Range 8 ´ n (n=12–63) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.23 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Extension Type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None SLT Pulse Maximum Break Width Specifies the maximum length of the break signal in a pulse dial. Value Range 8 ´ n (n=9–20) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.23 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Extension Type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None 218 PC Programming Manual 3.23 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Extension Type SLT Pulse Minimum Make Width Specifies the minimum length of the make signal in a pulse dial. Value Range 8 ´ n (n=1–5) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.23 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Extension Type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None SLT Flash Detection Enables the PBX to detect the flash signal sent when an SLT user presses the hookswitch or the Flash/Recall button. Value Range Disable: The PBX disconnects the line to prevent placing the call on hold. Enable: The PBX places the call on consultation hold. Maintenance Console Location 3.23 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Extension Type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.13.3 Call Splitting Flash Timing - Min. Specifies the minimum length that a signal sent from an SLT must be for the PBX to recognise it as a hookswitch flash signal. Value Range 8 ´ n (n=3–63) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.23 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Extension Type PC Programming Manual 219 3.23 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Extension Type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Flash Timing - Range Specifies the maximum length that a signal sent from an SLT can be for the PBX to recognise it as a hookswitch flash signal. Value Range 8 ´ n (n=3–191) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.23 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Extension Type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None DTMF-R STD Detection Time Specifies the minimum length that a DTMF tone must be for the PBX to recognise it as a DTMF tone. Value Range 2 ´ n (n=1–31) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.23 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Extension Type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None APT/SLT Parallel Ring Enables an SLT connected in parallel to an APT to ring with the APT for calls. 220 PC Programming Manual 3.23 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Extension Type Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.23 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Extension Type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.11.9 Parallelled Telephone PC Programming Manual 221 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Various settings can be programmed for each extension port. To change the status of extension ports, click Command. To view total numbers of each type of extension connected, click Port Type View. Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port or channel number (reference only). Value Range Port or channel number Maintenance Console Location 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.1.1 Extension Port Configuration Port Type Indicates the port type (reference only). Value Range DPT: DPT port (DLC) SLT: SLT port (SLC) S-Hybrid: Super Hybrid port (DHLC) 222 PC Programming Manual 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port S-Hybrid(SLT): XDP port of Super Hybrid port (DHLC) S-Hybrid(S-DPT): Digital XDP port of Super Hybrid port (DHLC) DPT(S-DPT): Digital XDP port of DPT port (DLC) IP-EXT: Virtual IP-Extension port (V-IPEXT) SIP: Virtual SIP Extension port (V-SIPEXT) Maintenance Console Location 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.1.1 Extension Port Configuration Telephone Type Indicates the connected telephone type (reference only). The number of all connected telephones and Cell Stations can be viewed by clicking Port Type View. Value Range DPT (40V): DPT is connected. APT (15V): APT is connected. DSS: DSS Console is connected. VM: VPS is connected. SLT: SLT is connected (or no telephone is connected to the Super Hybrid or SLT port). CS: CS is connected. CS-M: High-density CS is connected with its master port. CS-S1–3: High-density CS is connected with its slave port. Maintenance Console Location 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Programming Manual References 3.26 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port—Port Type View Feature Guide References 2.1.1 Extension Port Configuration Connection Indicates the port status (reference only). This column offers two ways to open the screen to select the port command as follows: • Click the desired cell in the column. • Select the desired cell in the column, and then click Command. PC Programming Manual 223 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Value Range INS: The port is in service. OUS: The port is out of service. Fault: The port is not communicating with the PBX. Maintenance Console Location 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Programming Manual References 3.25 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port—Connection Command Feature Guide References None Extension Number Specifies the extension number of the port. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Programming Manual References 3.25 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port—Connection Command Feature Guide References None Extension Name Specifies the extension name of the port. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Programming Manual References None 224 PC Programming Manual 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Feature Guide References None XDP Mode Turns XDP mode on or off for the port. This setting is only available when Port Type on this screen is set to S-Hybrid. Value Range On: XDP enabled (The main telephone and sub telephone have different extension numbers. This is called XDP Mode.) Off: XDP disabled (The main telephone and sub telephone both have the main telephone’s extension number. This is called Parallel Mode.) Maintenance Console Location 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.11.9 Parallelled Telephone 2.1.1 Extension Port Configuration Parallel Telephone Ringing Specifies whether the sub telephone (SLT) rings at the same time as the main telephone (DPT) for an incoming call. This setting is only available when Port Type on this screen is set to S-Hybrid. Value Range Yes, No Maintenance Console Location 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.11.9 Parallelled Telephone DPT Type—Type Selects the port type. To change the port type of an extension port, follow the steps below: PC Programming Manual 225 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port 1. Set the status of the extension port to "OUS". 2. Change the port type of the extension port, then click Apply. 3. Set the status of the extension port to "INS". When changing the port type of an extension port for which Wireless XDP has been set on the 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings screen, the Wireless XDP setting must be deleted first. When changing the type of a port for which one or more SDN buttons are set (except when changing between PC Console and Telephone), all SDN buttons customised for that device will be deleted. When you attempt to apply the new settings, a warning message is displayed showing the slot and port number for which SDN buttons will be deleted. If you do not wish to delete SDN buttons for this port, click Cancel. Value Range Normal: For connecting a DPT or CS DSS: For connecting a DSS Console (A maximum of 8 DSS Consoles can be connected to the PBX.) VM (DPT): For connecting a Panasonic VPS through DPT Integration PC Console: For connecting a PC Console (A maximum of 8 PC Consoles can be connected to the PBX.) Maintenance Console Location 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Programming Manual References 3.25 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port—Connection Command Feature Guide References 1.24.1 Voice Mail (VM) Group 1.32.1 Computer Telephony Integration (CTI) DPT Type—Location No. Specifies the location number of the connected DSS Console or PC Console. This setting is only available when DPT Type—Type on this screen is set to DSS or PC Console. Note that, depending on system traffic, there may be a limit to the number of PC Consoles that can be supported by a single DLC/DHLC card. When changing the location number of a DSS Console for which one or more SDN buttons are set, all SDN buttons customised for that device will be deleted. When you attempt to apply the new settings, a warning message is displayed showing the slot and port number for which SDN buttons will be deleted. If you do not wish to delete SDN buttons for this port, click Cancel. Value Range 1–8 Maintenance Console Location 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Programming Manual References None 226 PC Programming Manual 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Feature Guide References 1.32.1 Computer Telephony Integration (CTI) DPT Type—VM Unit No. Selects the unit number of the connected VPS. This setting is only available when DPT Type—Type on this screen is set to VM (DPT). Value Range 1, 2 Maintenance Console Location 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.24.1 Voice Mail (VM) Group DPT Type—VM Port No. Specifies the VM port number for the port. This setting is only available when DPT Type—Type on this screen is set to VM (DPT). Value Range 1–12 Maintenance Console Location 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.24.1 Voice Mail (VM) Group DPT Type—Air Sync Group No Assigns an Air Synchronisation Group number to the CS. This setting is only available when DPT Type— Type on this screen is set to Normal. Value Range None, 1 PC Programming Manual 227 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Maintenance Console Location 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Programming Manual References 5.29 [3-11] Air Synchronisation Group 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Feature Guide References None DPT Type—Air Sync Group Name Indicates the name of the Air Synchronisation Group of the CS (reference only). Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Programming Manual References 5.29 [3-11] Air Synchronisation Group 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Feature Guide References None Headset OFF/ON Turns on or off the use of a headset with a DPT. This setting is only available when Port Type on this screen is set to DPT, DPT(S-DPT), S-Hybrid, or S-Hybrid(S-DPT). Value Range Headset OFF, Headset ON Maintenance Console Location 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.11.4 Headset Operation 228 PC Programming Manual 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Ringing Tone Selects the dual-tone switching pattern of the ring tone for incoming calls when Port Type on this screen is set to DPT, DPT(S-DPT), S-Hybrid, S-Hybrid(SLT), or S-Hybrid(S-DPT). This setting is not available for the KX-T7200, the KX-T7451, APTs, or SLTs. Value Range A: 64 ms (697 Hz), 64 ms (852 Hz) B: 32 ms (697 Hz), 32 ms (852 Hz) C: 128 ms (697 Hz), 128 ms (852 Hz) D: 32 ms (697 Hz), 96 ms (852 Hz) Maintenance Console Location 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 229 3.25 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port—Connection Command 3.25 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port— Connection Command Commands for the extension ports can be programmed. INS Puts the port in service. Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.25 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port—Connection Command Programming Manual References 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Feature Guide References None OUS Takes the port out of service. This enables a temporary non-use of the port, for example, for the purpose of repair. Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.25 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port—Connection Command Programming Manual References 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Feature Guide References None 230 PC Programming Manual 3.26 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port—Port Type View 3.26 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port—Port Type View Displays the number of connected telephones and Cell Stations (CSs). This screen can only be accessed in Interactive mode. Type Indicates the types of telephone (reference only). Value Range New-DPT (KX-DT300 series/KX-T7600 series DPTs), Old-DPT (DPTs other than KX-DT300 series/ KX-T7600 series), APT, SLT, DSS Console, VM, Other, CS, High-density CS, IP-EXT, IP-PT, SIP Maintenance Console Location 3.26 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port—Port Type View Programming Manual References 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Feature Guide References None Total Count Indicates the total number of each type of telephone and CS connected to the PBX (reference only). CSs are counted on the basis of the number of ports in service plus the number of extension ports to which CSs are connected. Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.26 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port—Port Type View Programming Manual References 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 231 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type The properties of the analogue trunk cards can be specified. Outgoing Guard Time Specifies the length of time after a trunk is disconnected, during which the PBX cannot seize the line. Value Range 3–6 s Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None First Dial Timer (CO) Specifies the minimum time that the PBX waits after seizing a trunk, before sending the dialled digits to the telephone company. This allows the telephone company to have enough time to accept the dialled digits correctly. Value Range 0.5 ´ n (n=1–16) s Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None CO Feed Back Tone Specifies whether the pulse feedback tone is turned on or not. For outgoing trunk calls, audible tones can be heard as the dialled number is sent out, which informs the extension user that the number has been dialled. Value Range No, Yes 232 PC Programming Manual 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Bell Detection—Bell Start Detection Timer Specifies the minimum length of a bell signal that can be recognised by the PBX as the bell signal sent from the telephone company, before the PBX detects an arriving call. Value Range 24 ´ n (n=1–50) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Bell Detection—Bell Off Detection Timer Specifies the duration of the bell off detection timer. If the PBX receives no bell signal from the telephone company for the length of time specified here, the PBX treats the call as lost. Value Range 1.0 s–15.0 s Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 233 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Pulse / DTMF Dial—DTMF Inter-digit Pause Specifies the length of the DTMF inter-digit pause. This allows the telephone company to have enough time to accept the dialled digits correctly. Value Range 64 + 16 ´ n (n=0–11) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Pulse / DTMF Dial—Pulse Inter-digit Pause Specifies the length of the pulse inter-digit pause. This allows the telephone company to have enough time to accept the dialled digits correctly. Value Range 630 ms, 830 ms, 1030 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Low Speed Pulse Dial—Pulse % Break Specifies the % break for a low speed pulse dial. This is the ratio between the break (on-hook) signal and make (off-hook) signal in a pulse dial. Value Range Other, 60 %, 67 % Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type 234 PC Programming Manual 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port Feature Guide References None Low Speed Pulse Dial—Break Width Specifies the maximum length of the break signal in a low speed pulse dial. % Break on this screen determines the value that can be specified here. Low Speed Pulse Dial—Pulse Value Range 4 ´ n (n=6–20) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port Feature Guide References None Low Speed Pulse Dial—Make Width Specifies the minimum length of the make signal in a low speed pulse dial. % Break on this screen determines the value that can be specified here. Low Speed Pulse Dial—Pulse Value Range 4 ´ n (n=3–15) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port Feature Guide References None High Speed Pulse Dial—Pulse % Break Specifies the % break for a high speed pulse dial. This is the ratio between the break (on-hook) signal and make (off-hook) signal in a pulse dial. PC Programming Manual 235 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Value Range Other, 60 %, 67 % Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port Feature Guide References None High Speed Pulse Dial—Break Width Specifies the maximum length of the break signal in a high speed pulse dial. High Speed Pulse Dial— Pulse % Break on this screen determines the value that can be specified here. Value Range 4 ´ n (n=4–18) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port Feature Guide References None High Speed Pulse Dial—Make Width Specifies the minimum length of the make signal in a high speed pulse dial. % Break on this screen determines the value that can be specified here. Value Range 4 ´ n (n=3–15) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port 236 PC Programming Manual High Speed Pulse Dial—Pulse 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Feature Guide References None Pulse Type Selects the type of pulse dial transmission appropriate to your area. Value Range Normal, Sweden, New Zealand Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Option Card Equipment—Option 1 and Option 2 Indicates the type of the card that is installed on the LCOT card (reference only). Value Range None, Caller ID Card Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port— Caller ID Detection Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Caller ID—Caller ID Signalling Selects the type of Caller ID signalling provided by the telephone company. Value Range FSK, FSK (with Visual Caller ID), DTMF Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type PC Programming Manual 237 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Caller ID—Max Receive Time Specifies the maximum number of Caller ID series that are sent from the network. Value Range 0 (no limit), 1, 2, 3 Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Caller ID—Caller ID (FSK) Carrier Detection Enables the PBX to detect the carrier when receiving Caller ID. To enable this setting, Signalling on this screen should be set to FSK. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Caller ID—Caller ID (FSK) END Detection Selects the method used to detect the end of Caller ID information. 238 PC Programming Manual Caller ID—Caller ID 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Value Range Length + Timer, Timer Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Caller ID—Caller ID (FSK) Header Examination Enables the PBX to check the header of received Caller ID information. To enable this setting, Caller ID Signalling on this screen should be set to FSK. Caller ID— Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Caller ID—Caller ID (FSK) Detection Start Timer Specifies the length of time that the PBX waits before attempting to detect Caller ID information, after receiving a call. To enable this setting, Caller ID—Caller ID Signalling on this screen should be set to FSK. Value Range None, 80 ´ n (n=1–15) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 239 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Caller ID—Caller ID (FSK) Detection Timer Specifies the total time required by the PBX to detect Caller ID information. To enable this setting, ID—Caller ID Signalling on this screen should be set to FSK. Caller Value Range 80 ´ n (n=13–50) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Caller ID—Caller ID (DTMF) Start Code 1 and Start Code 2 Selects the DTMF code used to detect the beginning of a Caller ID series. Start Code 1 is prior to Start Code 2. Value Range None, *, #, A, B, C, D Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Caller ID—Caller ID (DTMF) Information Start Code Selects the DTMF code used to detect the beginning of the information segment of a Caller ID series. Value Range None, *, #, A, B, C, D 240 PC Programming Manual 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Caller ID—Caller ID (DTMF) End Code Selects the DTMF code used to detect the end of a Caller ID series. Value Range None, *, #, A, B, C, D Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Caller ID—Caller ID (DTMF) Information Code-PRIVATE, OUT OF AREA, TECHNICAL REASON, UNKNOWN NUMBER, RESTRICTED NUMBER Specifies the number used to identify each type of information code. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID PC Programming Manual 241 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Caller ID—Caller ID Header [03] Selects the type of the 3rd header in a Caller ID signal. Value Range DDN, Caller ID Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Pay Tone—Pay Tone Frequency Selects the frequency of the pay tone appropriate to your telephone company. Value Range 12kHz, 16kHz Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.3 Call Charge Services Pay Tone—Pay Tone Gain Specifies the signal strength of the pay tone. Value Range 0–31 dB Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References None 242 PC Programming Manual 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Feature Guide References 1.26.3 Call Charge Services Pay Tone—Pay Tone Pulse - MIN Specifies the minimum length that a received pay tone signal must be for the PBX to recognise it as a pay tone signal. Value Range 8 ´ n (n=1–250) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.3 Call Charge Services Pay Tone—Pay Tone Pulse - MAX Specifies the maximum length that a received pay tone signal can be for the PBX to recognise it as a pay tone signal. Value Range None, 8 ´ n (n=1–250) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.3 Call Charge Services Pay Tone—Pay Tone Pulse - Interval Specifies the maximum length of time between pay tone signals. Value Range 8 ´ n (n=1–250) ms PC Programming Manual 243 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.3 Call Charge Services Pay Tone—Sending Flash while end talk Enables the PBX to send a flash signal at the end of call to demand a pay tone signal. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.3 Call Charge Services 244 PC Programming Manual 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port Various settings can be programmed for each analogue trunk port. To change the status of ports, click Command. Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Connection Indicates the port status (reference only). This column offers two ways to open the screen to select the port command: • Click the desired cell in the column. • Select the desired cell in the column, and then click Command. PC Programming Manual 245 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port Value Range INS: The port is in service. OUS: The port is out of service. Maintenance Console Location 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port Programming Manual References 3.29 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port—Connection Command Feature Guide References None Busy Out Status Indicates the Busy Out status (reference only). Value Range Normal, Busy Out Maintenance Console Location 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.5.4.6 Trunk Busy Out Dialling Mode Selects the type of signal used to dial out to the analogue trunk. Value Range DTMF, Pulse Maintenance Console Location 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port Programming Manual References None 246 PC Programming Manual 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port Feature Guide References 1.5.4.4 Dial Type Selection CPC Signal Detection Time—Outgoing, Incoming Specifies the length of time required by the PBX to detect a CPC signal on outgoing or incoming trunk calls before disconnecting the line. When None is selected here, the line will not be disconnected when a CPC signal is not detected. Value Range None, 6.5 ms, 8 ´ n (n=1–112) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.11.10 Calling Party Control (CPC) Signal Detection DTMF Width Selects the length of the DTMF tone sent to the analogue trunk. Value Range 80 ms, 160 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Pulse Speed Selects the speed at which pulse dials are sent to the analogue trunk. Value Range Low, High PC Programming Manual 247 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port Maintenance Console Location 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Reverse Detection Selects the type of trunk call for which the reverse signal from the telephone company is detected. Value Range Disable: For no trunk call Outgoing: For outgoing trunk calls only Both Call: For both outgoing and incoming trunk calls Maintenance Console Location 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.5.4.5 Reverse Circuit Caller ID Detection Enables the PBX to detect a Caller ID signal from the analogue trunk. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port Programming Manual References 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID 248 PC Programming Manual 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port Paytone Detection Enables the PBX to receive a pay tone signal from the telephone company. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.3 Call Charge Services Pause Time Specifies the length of a pause. Value Range 1.5 s, 2.5 s, 3.5 s, 4.5 s Maintenance Console Location 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.5.4.7 Pause Insertion 1.5.4.8 Host PBX Access Code (Access Code to the Telephone Company from a Host PBX) 1.5.4.9 Special Carrier Access Code Flash Time Specifies the length of a flash signal. Value Range None, 16 ´ n (n=1–255) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port PC Programming Manual 249 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.11.7 External Feature Access (EFA) Disconnect Time Specifies the length of time after a trunk is disconnected, during which the PBX cannot seize the line. Value Range 0.5 s, 1.5 s, 2.0 s, 4.0 s, 12.0 s Maintenance Console Location 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.11.6 Flash/Recall/Terminate 250 PC Programming Manual 3.29 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port—Connection Command 3.29 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port— Connection Command Commands for the LCO ports can be programmed. INS Puts the port in service. Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.29 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port—Connection Command Programming Manual References 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port Feature Guide References None OUS Takes the port out of service. This enables a temporary non-use of the port, for example, for the purpose of repair. Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.29 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port—Connection Command Programming Manual References 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 251 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type The properties of the BRI or PRI card can be specified. ISDN CO / QSIG Master / QSIG Slave—T200 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the L2 command to ISDN. Value Range 0–600 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN CO / QSIG Master / QSIG Slave—T202 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after resending the request to use an ISDN line as a TIE line. Value Range 0–600 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.30.1 TIE Line Service ISDN CO / QSIG Master / QSIG Slave—T203 Specifies the length of time to detect no communication status of L2. Value Range 0–600 ´ 100 ms 252 PC Programming Manual 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN CO / QSIG Master / QSIG Slave—T301 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after making a call to ISDN. Value Range 0–18000 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN CO / QSIG Master / QSIG Slave—T302 Specifies the maximum time allowed between each digit on an incoming call. Applies to overlap receiving. Value Range 0–600 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 253 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type ISDN CO / QSIG Master / QSIG Slave—T303 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the SETUP (call setting) message to ISDN. Value Range 0–600 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN CO / QSIG Master / QSIG Slave—T304 Specifies the maximum time allowed between each digit on an outgoing call. Applies to overlap sending. Value Range 0–3000 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN CO / QSIG Master / QSIG Slave—T305 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the DISC (disconnection) message to ISDN. Value Range 0–3000 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type 254 PC Programming Manual 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN CO / QSIG Master / QSIG Slave—T308 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after receiving the Release message from ISDN. Value Range 0–600 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN CO / QSIG Master / QSIG Slave—T309 Specifies the length of time that the PBX tries to disconnect the data link, before disconnecting the call. Value Range 0–3000 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN CO / QSIG Master / QSIG Slave—T310 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a continuance message after receiving the Incoming Call Proceeding message. PC Programming Manual 255 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Value Range 0–3000 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN CO / QSIG Master / QSIG Slave—T313 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the Connect message. Value Range 0–600 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN CO / QSIG Master / QSIG Slave—T316 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the Restart message. Value Range 0–3000 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None 256 PC Programming Manual 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Feature Guide References None ISDN CO / QSIG Master / QSIG Slave—T318 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the Resume message. Value Range 0–600 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN CO / QSIG Master / QSIG Slave—T319 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the Suspend message. Value Range 0–600 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN CO / QSIG Master / QSIG Slave—T322 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the Status enquiry message. Value Range 0–600 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type PC Programming Manual 257 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN CO / QSIG Master / QSIG Slave—T3D3 Specifies the length of time that the PBX tries to establish L2 in "Permanent" mode. Value Range 0–3000 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN CO / QSIG Master / QSIG Slave—T3D9 Specifies the length of time that the PBX tries to disconnect L2 in "Call by Call" mode. Value Range 0–3000 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN Extension—T200 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the L2 command to ISDN. Value Range 0–600 ´ 100 ms 258 PC Programming Manual 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN Extension—T201 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after resending the TEI check request to ISDN. Value Range 0–600 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN Extension—T203 Specifies the length of time to detect no communication status of L2. Value Range 0–600 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 259 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type ISDN Extension—T301 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after making a call to ISDN. Value Range 0–18000 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN Extension—T302 Specifies the maximum time allowed between each digit on an incoming call. Applies to overlap receiving. Value Range 0–600 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN Extension—T303 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the SETUP (call setting) message to ISDN. Value Range 0–600 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type 260 PC Programming Manual 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN Extension—T304 Specifies the maximum time allowed between each digit on an outgoing call. Applies to overlap sending. Value Range 0–3000 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN Extension—T305 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the DISC (disconnection) message to ISDN. Value Range 0–3000 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN Extension—T306 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the DISC (disconnection) message to ISDN. This setting is used when inband tones are supplied. PC Programming Manual 261 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Value Range 0–3000 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN Extension—T307 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX maintains a suspended call, before restarting. Value Range 0–6000 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN Extension—T308 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after receiving the Release message from ISDN. Value Range 0–600 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None 262 PC Programming Manual 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Feature Guide References None ISDN Extension—T309 Specifies the length of time that the PBX tries to disconnect the data link, before disconnecting the call. Value Range 0–3000 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN Extension—T310 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after receiving the Incoming Call Proceeding message. Value Range 0–3000 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN Extension—T312 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the SETUP (call setting) message to ISDN. Value Range 0–600 ´ 100 ms PC Programming Manual 263 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN Extension—T316 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the Restart message. Value Range 0–3000 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN Extension—T320 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for packet protocol. Value Range 0–3000 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None 264 PC Programming Manual 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type ISDN Extension—T322 Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a reply after sending the Status enquiry message. Value Range 0–600 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN Extension—T3D3 Specifies the length of time that the PBX tries to establish L2 in "Permanent" mode. Value Range 0–3000 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN Extension—T3D9 Specifies the length of time that the PBX tries to disconnect L2 in "Call by Call" mode. Value Range 0–3000 ´ 100 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 265 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type Feature Guide References None 266 PC Programming Manual 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Various settings can be programmed for each BRI port. To change the status of ports, click Command. Main Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Type Selects the port type. Each ISDN connection in a QSIG network must have a master port on one PBX and a slave port on another PBX. ISDN extensions can belong to an incoming call distribution group or idle extension hunting group. In this case, an MSN can be assigned. PC Programming Manual 267 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Value Range CO: For connecting to public network Extension: For connecting to extension QSIG-Slave: For connecting to private network (slave port) QSIG-Master: For connecting to private network (master port) Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.1 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN)—SUMMARY 1.30.4.1 QSIG Standard Features—SUMMARY Connection Indicates the port status (reference only). This column offers two ways to open the screen to select the port command: • Click the desired cell in the column. • Select the desired cell in the column, and then click Command. Value Range INS: The port is in service. OUS: The port is out of service. Fault: The port is not communicating with the network. Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References 3.32 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—Connection Command Feature Guide References None LLC Information Enables the PBX to send LLC (Low Level Compatibility) information to the network when an outgoing call is made when the ISDN bearer mode is speech. Value Range Disable, Enable 268 PC Programming Manual 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Status Message Specifies whether the Status Message is sent to the network. Value Range No Transmission: Status Message is not sent. When Mandatory error detection: Send the Status Message when an error (Mandatory) is detected. When Option / Mandatory error detection: Send the Status Message when an error (Option or Mandatory) is detected. Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Status Receive Selects what happens to a call when the Status Message from the network does not match the actual status of the call. Value Range Ignore: Ignore the Status Message from the network. Disconnect: Disconnect the call. Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 269 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Feature Guide References None ISDN CO Parameters for ISDN CO are not applicable for the BRI extension port. Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Type Selects the port type. Each ISDN connection in a QSIG network must have a master port on one PBX and a slave port on another PBX. ISDN extensions can belong to an incoming call distribution group or idle extension hunting group. In this case, an MSN can be assigned. 270 PC Programming Manual 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Value Range CO: For connecting to public network Extension: For connecting to extension QSIG-Slave: For connecting to private network (slave port) QSIG-Master: For connecting to private network (master port) Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Connection Indicates the port status (reference only). This column offers two ways to open the screen to select the port command: • Click the desired cell in the column. • Select the desired cell in the column, and then click Command. Value Range INS: The port is in service. OUS: The port is out of service. Fault: The port is not communicating with the network. Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References 3.32 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—Connection Command Feature Guide References None Subscriber Number Specifies the number used as the CLIP number. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) PC Programming Manual 271 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) Ringback Tone to Outside Caller Enables the PBX to send a ringback tone to an outside caller when the network cannot send the tone. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN Outgoing Call Type Selects the method used to send dialled digits to the network. Value Range En-bloc: The PBX sends all of the dialled digits at once after the extension user completes dialling. The PBX recognises the end of dialling when (1) # is dialled, if programmed, (2) a preprogrammed telephone number is dialled, or (3) the inter-digit timer expires. Overlap: The PBX sends dialled digits one at a time. Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone— Dial—Extension Inter-digit 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 2— ISDN en Bloc Dial—[#] as End of Dial for en Bloc mode 5.4 [3-1-4] Dialling Plan 272 PC Programming Manual 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Feature Guide References 1.21.1.1 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN)—SUMMARY ISDN Centrex Enables the use of the telephone company’s ISDN Centrex Service features. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.1 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN)—SUMMARY BRI Data Link (P-MP) Mode Assigns one or two TEIs (Terminal Endpoint Identifier) to the BRI CO port. To use the ISDN Hold supplementary service with point-to-multipoint configuration, this parameter should be set to 2-link in some countries/areas. Value Range 1-link: One TEI is assigned to the BRI CO port. 2-link: Two TEIs are assigned to the BRI CO port. (Available when to P-MP.) Access Mode on the Network tab is set Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Networking Data Transfer Enables transmission of extension status data to connected PBXs in a network. This setting is only available when Port Type on this screen has been set to QSIG-Slave or QSIG-Master. A maximum of two ports of each BRI card can be assigned to transmit extension status information. PC Programming Manual 273 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Value Range No, Yes Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References Section 11 [9] Private Network Feature Guide References 1.30.5.1 Network Direct Station Selection (NDSS) ISDN Extension Parameters for ISDN Extension are not applicable for BRI ports assigned as CO ports. Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.11 ISDN Extension Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port 274 PC Programming Manual 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.11 ISDN Extension Port Type Selects the port type. Each ISDN connection in a QSIG network must have a master port on one PBX and a slave port on another PBX. ISDN extensions can belong to an incoming call distribution group or idle extension hunting group. In this case, an MSN can be assigned. Value Range CO: For connecting to public network Extension: For connecting to extension QSIG-Slave: For connecting to private network (slave port) QSIG-Master: For connecting to private network (master port) Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.11 ISDN Extension Connection Indicates the port status (reference only). This column offers two ways to open the screen to select the port command: • Click the desired cell in the column. • Select the desired cell in the column, and then click Command. Value Range INS: The port is in service. OUS: The port is out of service. Fault: The port is not communicating with the network. Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References 3.32 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—Connection Command PC Programming Manual 275 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Feature Guide References 1.21.1.11 ISDN Extension ISDN TE Power Enables the PBX to supply power to the ISDN TE (Terminal Equipment). This setting is only available when Port Type on this screen is set to Extension. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.11 ISDN Extension Ring Mode (ISDN MSN Last No. 0 or 00) Selects the ring mode when receiving an incoming call with an MSN ending with "0" or "00". This setting is only available when Port Type on this screen is set to Extension. Value Range Ring All Extension for MSN: Ring all ISDN extensions that are addressed with MSN. Ring an Extension for MSN: Ring only one of the ISDN extensions that are addressed with MSN. Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.11 ISDN Extension ISDN Extension Progress Tone Enables the PBX to send call progress tones to the ISDN extension. This setting is only available when Port Type on this screen is set to Extension. Value Range Disable, Enable 276 PC Programming Manual 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.11 ISDN Extension Network Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 277 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Port Type Selects the port type. Each ISDN connection in a QSIG network must have a master port on one PBX and a slave port on another PBX. ISDN extensions can belong to an incoming call distribution group or idle extension hunting group. In this case, an MSN can be assigned. Value Range CO: For connecting to public network Extension: For connecting to extension QSIG-Slave: For connecting to private network (slave port) QSIG-Master: For connecting to private network (master port) Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Connection Indicates the port status (reference only). This column offers two ways to open the screen to select the port command: • Click the desired cell in the column. • Select the desired cell in the column, and then click Command. Value Range INS: The port is in service. OUS: The port is out of service. Fault: The port is not communicating with the network. Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References 3.32 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—Connection Command Feature Guide References None Network Type Selects the network type of the port. 278 PC Programming Manual 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Value Range 0–56 (2 UK (Domestic), 5 Netherlands, 6 SwissNET2, 7 SwissNET3, 8 Euro ISDN (Standard), 14 France (Domestic), 19 Finland, 20 Norway, 27 Australia, 51 US National ISDN 2) Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.1 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN)—SUMMARY L1 Mode Selects the active mode of L1 (Layer 1) on the BRI port. Value Range Call, Permanent Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.1 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN)—SUMMARY L2 Mode Selects the active mode of L2 (Layer 2) on the BRI port. Value Range Call, Permanent Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 279 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Feature Guide References 1.21.1.1 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN)—SUMMARY Access Mode Selects the configuration of the BRI port. Value Range P-P: Point-to-Point P-MP: Point-to-multipoint Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.1 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN)—SUMMARY TEI Mode Specifies the TEI mode assigned to the BRI port. Value Range Automatic, Fix 0–Fix 63 Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.1 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN)—SUMMARY Network Numbering Plan Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot number 280 PC Programming Manual 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Type Selects the port type. Each ISDN connection in a QSIG network must have a master port on one PBX and a slave port on another PBX. ISDN extensions can belong to an incoming call distribution group or idle extension hunting group. In this case, an MSN can be assigned. Value Range CO: For connecting to public network Extension: For connecting to extension QSIG-Slave: For connecting to private network (slave port) QSIG-Master: For connecting to private network (master port) Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 281 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Feature Guide References None Connection Indicates the port status (reference only). This column offers two ways to open the screen to select the port command: • Click the desired cell in the column. • Select the desired cell in the column, and then click Command. Value Range INS: The port is in service. OUS: The port is out of service. Fault: The port is not communicating with the network. Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References 3.32 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—Connection Command Feature Guide References None Trunk Property Selects the trunk property of the port. Value Range Public: Public network VPN: Virtual Private Network Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.30.1 TIE Line Service 1.30.3 Virtual Private Network (VPN) Calling Party number—Numbering Plan ID—Public, Private Selects the numbering plan ID that applies to outgoing trunk calls routed through public and private networks. 282 PC Programming Manual 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Value Range Unknown, ISDN-Telephony, National Standard, Private Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Calling Party number—Type of Number—Public, Private Selects the type of number that applies to outgoing trunk calls routed through public or private networks. Value Range Unknown, International, National, Network, Subscriber Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Called Party number—Numbering Plan ID—Public, Private Selects the numbering plan ID that applies to incoming trunk calls routed through public and private networks. Value Range Unknown, ISDN-Telephony, National Standard, Private Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 283 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Feature Guide References None Called Party number—Type of Number—Public, Private Selects the type of number that applies to incoming trunk calls routed through public and private networks. Value Range Unknown, International, National, Network, Subscriber Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Supplementary Service Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number 284 PC Programming Manual 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Type Selects the port type. Each ISDN connection in a QSIG network must have a master port on one PBX and a slave port on another PBX. ISDN extensions can belong to an incoming call distribution group or idle extension hunting group. In this case, an MSN can be assigned. Value Range CO: For connecting to public network Extension: For connecting to extension QSIG-Slave: For connecting to private network (slave port) QSIG-Master: For connecting to private network (master port) Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Connection Indicates the port status (reference only). This column offers two ways to open the screen to select the port command: • Click the desired cell in the column. • Select the desired cell in the column, and then click Command. Value Range INS: The port is in service. OUS: The port is out of service. Fault: The port is not communicating with the network. Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port PC Programming Manual 285 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References 3.32 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—Connection Command Feature Guide References None COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E, 3PTY Specifies whether each ISDN or QSIG supplementary service is used. When using the Centralised VM feature, set CF (Rerouting) to "No". Value Range For COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E: No, Yes For 3PTY: No, Yes-3Pty Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) 1.21.1.3 Advice of Charge (AOC) 1.21.1.5 Call Forwarding (CF)—by ISDN (P-P) 1.21.1.7 Call Transfer (CT)—by ISDN 1.21.1.8 Three-party Conference (3PTY)—by ISDN 1.21.1.10 Completion of Calls to Busy Subscriber (CCBS) 1.30.4.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) and Calling/Connected Name Identification Presentation (CNIP/CONP)—by QSIG 1.30.4.3 Call Forwarding (CF)—by QSIG 1.30.4.4 Call Transfer (CT)—by QSIG 1.30.4.5 Completion of Calls to Busy Subscriber (CCBS)—by QSIG CCBS Option Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot number 286 PC Programming Manual 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Type Selects the port type. Each ISDN connection in a QSIG network must have a master port on one PBX and a slave port on another PBX. ISDN extensions can belong to an incoming call distribution group or idle extension hunting group. In this case, an MSN can be assigned. Value Range CO: For connecting to public network Extension: For connecting to extension QSIG-Slave: For connecting to private network (slave port) QSIG-Master: For connecting to private network (master port) Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 287 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Feature Guide References None Connection Indicates the port status (reference only). This column offers two ways to open the screen to select the port command: • Click the desired cell in the column. • Select the desired cell in the column, and then click Command. Value Range INS: The port is in service. OUS: The port is out of service. Fault: The port is not communicating with the network. Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References 3.32 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—Connection Command Feature Guide References None CCBS Type Selects the type of the call from the network initiated by the CCBS (Completion of Calls to Busy Subscriber) feature, from which the specified number of digits are deleted. CCBS Delete Digits on this screen specifies the number of digits to delete from the received number. Value Range ALL, Unknown, International, National, Network specific, Subscriber, Abbreviated Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.10 Completion of Calls to Busy Subscriber (CCBS) 288 PC Programming Manual 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port CCBS Delete Digits Specifies the number of digits to delete from the received number when receiving a call of the specified type initiated by the CCBS feature from the network. CCBS Type on this screen specifies the applicable type of call. Value Range 0–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.10 Completion of Calls to Busy Subscriber (CCBS) PC Programming Manual 289 3.32 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—Connection Command 3.32 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port— Connection Command Commands for the BRI ports can be programmed. INS Puts the port in service. Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.32 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—Connection Command Programming Manual References 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Feature Guide References None OUS Takes the port out of service. This enables a temporary non-use of the port, for example, for the purpose of repair. Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.32 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—Connection Command Programming Manual References 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Feature Guide References None 290 PC Programming Manual 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Various settings can be programmed for each PRI port. Main Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Type Selects the port type. Note • Each ISDN connection in a QSIG network must have a master port on one PBX and a slave port on another PBX. PC Programming Manual 291 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port • ISDN extensions can belong to an incoming call distribution group or idle extension hunting group. In this case, an MSN can be assigned. Value Range CO: For connecting to public network Extension: For connecting to extension QSIG-Slave: For connecting to private network (slave port) QSIG-Master: For connecting to private network (master port) Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.1 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN)—SUMMARY 1.30.4.1 QSIG Standard Features—SUMMARY Connection Indicates the port status (reference only). This column offers two ways to open the screen to select the port command: • Click the desired cell in the column. • Select the desired cell in the column, and then click Command. Value Range INS: The port is in service. OUS: The port is out of service. Fault: The port is not communicating with the network. Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References 3.34 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—Connection Command Feature Guide References None Status Message Specifies whether the Status Message is sent to the network. Value Range No Transmission: Status Message is not sent. 292 PC Programming Manual 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port When error detection (Mandatory): Send the Status Message when an error (Mandatory) is detected. When error detection (Option / Mandatory): Send the Status Message when an error (Option or Mandatory) is detected. Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Status Receive Selects what happens to a call when the Status Message from the network does not match the actual status of the call. Value Range Ignore: Ignore the Status Message from the network. Disconnect: Disconnect the call. Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None CRC4 Mode Enables the use of CRC4 for error checking. CRC (Cyclic Redundancy Check) is an error checking control technique that uses a specific binary prime divisor that results in a unique remainder. It is usually a 16- to 32-bit character. (Assignable only when using the PRI30 card.) Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port PC Programming Manual 293 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Line Coding Selects the line coding type of the PRI PCM (Pulse Code Modulation) for the port. This setting is only available when using the PRI23 card. Value Range B8ZS, AMI Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Frame Sequence Selects the type of frame sequence for the port. This setting is only available when using the PRI23 card. Value Range Extend Multi frame (ESF), 4-Frame Multi frame (F4), 12-Frame Multi frame (F12) Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None CO Setting CO Setting parameters are not applicable to ports assigned as Extension in 294 PC Programming Manual Port Type. 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Type Selects the port type. Note • • Each ISDN connection in a QSIG network must have a master port on one PBX and a slave port on another PBX. ISDN extensions can belong to an incoming call distribution group or idle extension hunting group. In this case, an MSN can be assigned. Value Range CO: For connecting to public network Extension: For connecting to extension QSIG-Slave: For connecting to private network (slave port) QSIG-Master: For connecting to private network (master port) PC Programming Manual 295 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Connection Indicates the port status (reference only). This column offers two ways to open the screen to select the port command: • Click the desired cell in the column. • Select the desired cell in the column, and then click Command. Value Range INS: The port is in service. OUS: The port is out of service. Fault: The port is not communicating with the network. Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References 3.34 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—Connection Command Feature Guide References None Subscriber Number Specifies the number used as the CLIP number. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None 296 PC Programming Manual 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) Ringback Tone to Outside Caller Enables the PBX to send a ringback tone to an outside caller when the network cannot send the tone. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN Outgoing Call Type Selects the method used to send dialled digits to the network. Value Range En-bloc: The PBX sends all of the dialled digits at once after the extension user completes dialling. The PBX recognises the end of dialling when (1) # is dialled, if programmed, (2) a preprogrammed telephone number is dialled, or (3) the inter-digit timer expires. Overlap: The PBX sends dialled digits one at a time. Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone— Dial—Extension Inter-digit 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 2— ISDN en Bloc Dial—[#] as End of Dial for en Bloc mode 5.4 [3-1-4] Dialling Plan Feature Guide References 1.21.1.1 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN)—SUMMARY ISDN Centrex Enables the use of the telephone company’s ISDN Centrex Service features. PC Programming Manual 297 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.1 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN)—SUMMARY Networking Data Transfer Enables transmission of extension status data to connected PBXs in a network. This setting is only available when Port Type on this screen has been set to QSIG-Slave or QSIG-Master. Value Range No, Yes Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References Section 11 [9] Private Network Feature Guide References 1.30.5.1 Network Direct Station Selection (NDSS) Loopback Test started by Network Enables a loopback test started from the network side, to be performed on the PRI23 card. Note The version of the PRI23 card must be 2.000 or later. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port 298 PC Programming Manual 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References Network Loopback Test Feature Guide References None Extension Setting Extension Setting parameters are applicable only for the PRI extension port. Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 299 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Port Type Selects the type of the port. Note • • Each ISDN connection in a QSIG network must have a master port on one PBX and a slave port on another PBX. ISDN extensions can belong to an incoming call distribution group or idle extension hunting group. In this case, an MSN can be assigned. Value Range CO: For connecting to public network Extension: For connecting to extension QSIG-Slave: For connecting to private network (slave port) QSIG-Master: For connecting to private network (master port) Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Connection Indicates the port status (reference only). This column offers two ways to open the screen to select the port command: • Click the desired cell in the column. • Select the desired cell in the column, and then click Command. Value Range INS: The port is in service. OUS: The port is out of service. Fault: The port is not communicating with the network. Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References 3.34 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—Connection Command Feature Guide References None 300 PC Programming Manual 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Ring Mode (ISDN MSN Last No. 0 or 00) Selects the ring mode when receiving an incoming call with an MSN ending with "0" or "00". Value Range Ring All Extension for MSN: Ring all ISDN extensions that are addressed with MSN. Ring AN Extension for MSN: Ring only one of the ISDN extensions that are addressed with MSN. Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.11 ISDN Extension Network Configuration Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port PC Programming Manual 301 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Type Selects the port type. Note • • Each ISDN connection in a QSIG network must have a master port on one PBX and a slave port on another PBX. ISDN extensions can belong to an incoming call distribution group or idle extension hunting group. In this case, an MSN can be assigned. Value Range CO: For connecting to public network Extension: For connecting to extension QSIG-Slave: For connecting to private network (slave port) QSIG-Master: For connecting to private network (master port) Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Connection Indicates the port status (reference only). This column offers two ways to open the screen to select the port command: • Click the desired cell in the column. • Select the desired cell in the column, and then click Command. Value Range INS: The port is in service. OUS: The port is out of service. Fault: The port is not communicating with the network. Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port 302 PC Programming Manual 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References 3.34 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—Connection Command Feature Guide References None Network Type Selects the network type of the port. Value Range 0–56 (2 UK (Domestic), 5 Netherlands, 6 SwissNET2, 7 SwissNET3, 8 Euro ISDN (Standard), 14 France (Domestic), 19 Finland, 20 Norway, 27 Australia, 51 US National ISDN 2) Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.1 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN)—SUMMARY Network Numbering Plan Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). PC Programming Manual 303 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Type Selects the port type. Note • • Each ISDN connection in a QSIG network must have a master port on one PBX and a slave port on another PBX. ISDN extensions can belong to an incoming call distribution group or idle extension hunting group. In this case, an MSN can be assigned. Value Range CO: For connecting to public network Extension: For connecting to extension QSIG-Slave: For connecting to private network (slave port) QSIG-Master: For connecting to private network (master port) Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Connection Indicates the port status (reference only). This column offers two ways to open the screen to select the port command: • Click the desired cell in the column. • Select the desired cell in the column, and then click Command. 304 PC Programming Manual 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Value Range INS: The port is in service. OUS: The port is out of service. Fault: The port is not communicating with the network. Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Trunk Property Selects the trunk property of the port. Value Range Public: Public network VPN: Virtual Private Network Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.30.1 TIE Line Service 1.30.3 Virtual Private Network (VPN) Calling Party Number—Numbering Plan ID—Public, Private Selects the numbering plan ID that applies to outgoing trunk calls routed through public and private networks. Value Range Unknown, ISDN-Telephony, National Standard, Private Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port PC Programming Manual 305 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Calling Party Number—Type of Number—Public, Private Selects the type of number that applies to outgoing trunk calls routed through public or private networks. Value Range Unknown, International, National, Network, Subscriber Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Called Party Number—Numbering Plan ID—Public, Private Selects the numbering plan ID that applies to incoming trunk calls routed through public and private networks. Value Range Unknown, ISDN-Telephony, National Standard, Private Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Called Party Number—Type of Number—Public, Private Selects the type of number that applies to incoming trunk calls routed through public and private networks. Value Range Unknown, International, National, Network, Subscriber 306 PC Programming Manual 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Supplementary Service Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 307 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Port Type Selects the port type. Note • • Each ISDN connection in a QSIG network must have a master port on one PBX and a slave port on another PBX. ISDN extensions can belong to an incoming call distribution group or idle extension hunting group. In this case, an MSN can be assigned. Value Range CO: For connecting to public network Extension: For connecting to extension QSIG-Slave: For connecting to private network (slave port) QSIG-Master: For connecting to private network (master port) Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Connection Indicates the port status (reference only). This column offers two ways to open the screen to select the port command: • Click the desired cell in the column. • Select the desired cell in the column, and then click Command. Value Range INS: The port is in service. OUS: The port is out of service. Fault: The port is not communicating with the network. Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None 308 PC Programming Manual 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E, E911, 3PTY Specifies whether each ISDN or QSIG supplementary service is used. The available services depend on the setting of Port Type on this screen. When using the Centralised VM feature, set CF (Rerouting) to "No". Value Range For COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E, E911: No, Yes For 3PTY: No, Yes-3Pty Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) 1.21.1.3 Advice of Charge (AOC) 1.21.1.5 Call Forwarding (CF)—by ISDN (P-P) 1.21.1.7 Call Transfer (CT)—by ISDN 1.21.1.8 Three-party Conference (3PTY)—by ISDN 1.21.1.10 Completion of Calls to Busy Subscriber (CCBS) 1.30.4.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) and Calling/Connected Name Identification Presentation (CNIP/CONP)—by QSIG 1.30.4.3 Call Forwarding (CF)—by QSIG 1.30.4.4 Call Transfer (CT)—by QSIG 1.30.4.5 Completion of Calls to Busy Subscriber (CCBS)—by QSIG CCBS Type Selects the type of call from the network initiated by the CCBS (Completion of Calls to Busy Subscriber) feature, from which the specified number of digits are deleted. CCBS Delete Digits on this screen specifies the number of digits to delete from the received number. Value Range ALL, Unknown, International, National, Network specific, Subscriber, Abbreviated Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 309 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Feature Guide References 1.21.1.10 Completion of Calls to Busy Subscriber (CCBS) CCBS Delete Digits Specifies the number of digits to delete from the received number when receiving a call of the specified type initiated by the CCBS feature from the network. CCBS Type on this screen specifies the applicable type of call. Value Range 0–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.10 Completion of Calls to Busy Subscriber (CCBS) 310 PC Programming Manual 3.34 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—Connection Command 3.34 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—Connection Command Commands for the PRI ports can be programmed. INS Puts the port in service. Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.34 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—Connection Command Programming Manual References 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Feature Guide References None OUS Takes the port out of service. This enables a temporary non-use of the port, for example, for the purpose of repair. Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.34 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—Connection Command Programming Manual References 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 311 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type The properties of the T1 card can be specified. Line Coding Selects the line coding type of T1 PCM (Pulse Code Modulation) used. Value Range B8ZS, AMI Maintenance Console Location 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Frame Sequence Selects the type of frame sequence used for communications. Value Range D4, ESF Maintenance Console Location 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ESF Frame Sequence Selects the values for C-bit and D-bit. To enable this setting, set to ESF. Value Range C=A, D=B; C=0, D=0; C=0, D=1; C=1, D=0; C=1, D=1 312 PC Programming Manual Frame Sequence on this screen should be 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Maintenance Console Location 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None LIU Send Option Selects the transmitting level (Transmit Pulse Amplitude) of LIU. Value Range Mode-1–Mode-8 Maintenance Console Location 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None LIU Receive Option Selects the receiving level (Receive Equalisation) of LIU. Value Range Automatic, 6 dB, 12 dB, 18 dB, 24 dB Maintenance Console Location 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 313 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type First Dial Timer (CO) Specifies the minimum time that the PBX waits after seizing a trunk, before sending the dialled digits to the telephone company. This allows the telephone company to have enough time to accept the dialled digits correctly. Value Range 0.5 ´ n (n=1–16) s Maintenance Console Location 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None First Dial Timer (DDI/DID/TIE) Specifies the minimum time that the PBX waits after seizing a DDI/DID or TIE line, before sending the dialled digits to the telephone company or to another PBX. This allows the telephone company or the other PBX to have enough time to accept the dialled digits correctly. Value Range 32 ´ n (n=1–255) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Answer Detection Timer Specifies the length of time required by the PBX to recognise the answer signal. This allows the telephone company to have enough time to accept the dialled digits correctly. Value Range 32 ´ n (n=1–255) ms 314 PC Programming Manual 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Maintenance Console Location 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Wink Signal Width Specifies the length of a wink signal. Value Range 32 ´ n (n=4–9) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None DTMF Tone—DTMF Inter-digit Pause Specifies the length of the DTMF inter-digit pause. This allows the telephone company to have enough time to accept the dialled digits correctly. Value Range 64 + 16 ´ n (n=0–11) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 315 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type DTMF Tone—DTMF Transmit Specifies the volume of the DTMF tone to be transmitted. Value Range 3-n (n=0–15) dB Maintenance Console Location 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None DTMF Tone—DTMF Receive Specifies the volume of the DTMF tone to be received. Value Range n-42–0 (n=0–31) dB Maintenance Console Location 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Pulse Dial—Pulse % Break Specifies the % break for pulse digits. This is the ratio between the break (on-hook) signal and make (off-hook) signal in a pulse dial. Value Range 60 %, 67 % Maintenance Console Location 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type 316 PC Programming Manual 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Pulse Dial—Pulse Type Selects the type of pulse dial transmission appropriate to your area. Value Range Normal, Sweden, New Zealand Maintenance Console Location 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Pulse Dial—Pulse Inter-digit Pause Specifies the length of the pulse inter-digit pause. This allows the telephone company to have enough time to accept the dialled digits correctly. Value Range 630 ms, 830 ms, 1030 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Pulse Dial—CO Feed Back Tone Specifies whether the pulse feedback tone is turned on or not. For outgoing trunk calls, audible tones can be heard as the dialled number is sent out, which informs the extension user that the number has been dialled. PC Programming Manual 317 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Value Range No, Yes Maintenance Console Location 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Pulse Dial—Maximum BREAK Width Specifies the maximum length of the break signal in a pulse dial. Value Range 8 ´ n (n=9–20) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Pulse Dial—Minimum MAKE Width Specifies the minimum length of the make signal in a pulse dial. Value Range 8 ´ n (n=1–5) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Programming Manual References None 318 PC Programming Manual 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Feature Guide References None Flash—Flash Signal Detection (OPX) Enables the PBX to detect hookswitch flash signals from an SLT connected to an OPX. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Flash—Minimum BREAK Width (OPX) Specifies the minimum length of the break signal in a flash signal from an SLT connected to an OPX. Value Range 8 ´ n (n=3–63) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Flash—Flash Width (OPX) Specifies the maximum length of a flash signal sent from an SLT connected to an OPX that the PBX can recognise as a hookswitch flash signal. Value Range 8 ´ n (n=3–191) ms PC Programming Manual 319 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Maintenance Console Location 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Flash—Flash Signal Detection (TIE) Enables the PBX to detect a hookswitch flash signal sent from a TIE line. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Flash—Minimum BREAK Width (TIE) Specifies the minimum length of the break signal in a flash signal sent from a TIE line. Value Range 8 ´ n (n=3–63) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None 320 PC Programming Manual 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Flash—Flash Width (TIE) Specifies the maximum length of a flash signal received from a TIE line that the PBX can recognise as a hookswitch flash signal. Value Range 8 ´ n (n=3–191) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Caller ID—Caller ID Start Code Selects the DTMF code used to detect the beginning of a Caller ID series. Value Range *, #, A–D Maintenance Console Location 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Caller ID—Caller ID Information End Code Selects the delimiter used to separate multiple parameters in a Caller ID series. Value Range *, #, A–D Maintenance Console Location 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type PC Programming Manual 321 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Caller ID—Caller ID End Code Selects the DTMF code used to detect the end of a Caller ID series. Value Range *, #, A–D Maintenance Console Location 3.35 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - T1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID 322 PC Programming Manual 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Various settings can be programmed for each T1 channel. To change the status of ports, click Command. Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None CH Indicates the channel number (reference only). Value Range Channel number Maintenance Console Location 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Connection Indicates the channel status (reference only). This column offers two ways to open the screen to select the channel command: • Click the desired cell in the column. • Select the desired cell in the column, and then click Command. PC Programming Manual 323 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Value Range INS: The channel is in service. OUS: The channel is out of service. Fault: The channel is not communicating with the network. Maintenance Console Location 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Subscriber Number Specifies the number used as the CLIP number. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) CO Dial Mode Selects the type of signal used to dial out to a trunk. Value Range DTMF, Pulse Maintenance Console Location 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Programming Manual References None 324 PC Programming Manual 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Feature Guide References 1.5.4.4 Dial Type Selection Channel Type Selects the channel type. Value Range Undefined: Not assigned GCOT: Ground Start Central Office LCOT: Loop Start Central Office DDI/DID: Direct Dialling In/Direct Inward Dialling TIE: TIE Line OPX: Off Premise Extension Maintenance Console Location 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.23.1 T1 Line Service Trunk Property Selects the trunk property of the TIE channel. Value Range Public: Use the DIL/DDI/DID method to distribute incoming trunk calls. Private: Use the TIE line service between two or more PBXs. Maintenance Console Location 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.1.1 Incoming Trunk Call Features—SUMMARY 1.21.1.1 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN)—SUMMARY 1.30.1 TIE Line Service PC Programming Manual 325 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port CPC Signal Detection (DID)—Outgoing, Incoming Specifies the length of time required by the PBX to detect a CPC signal on outgoing or incoming trunk calls before disconnecting the line. When None is selected here, the line will not be disconnected when a CPC signal is not detected. This setting is only available when Channel Type on this screen is set to DDI/DID. Value Range None, 80 ´ n (n=2–75) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.11.10 Calling Party Control (CPC) Signal Detection CPC Signal Detection (LCO/GCO)—Outgoing, Incoming Specifies the length of time required by the PBX to detect a CPC signal on outgoing or incoming trunk calls before disconnecting the line. When None is selected here, the line will not be disconnected when a CPC signal is not detected. This setting is only available when Channel Type on this screen is set to GCOT or LCOT. Value Range None, 8 ´ n (n=2–112) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.11.10 Calling Party Control (CPC) Signal Detection DTMF Width Selects the length of the DTMF tone sent to the T1 channel. Value Range 80 ms, 160 ms 326 PC Programming Manual 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Maintenance Console Location 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None CO Pulse Speed Selects the speed at which pulse dials are sent to the T1 channel. Value Range 10 pulse/s, 20 pulse/s Maintenance Console Location 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.5.4.4 Dial Type Selection Wink Signal Time-Out Specifies the length of time that the PBX waits to receive a wink signal after seizing a trunk. If a wink signal is not received before this timer expires, the trunk is released. Value Range 64 ´ n (n=1–128) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 327 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Start Signal Type Selects the type of the start signal. Value Range Immediate: Sends the dialled digits to the trunk when the First Dial Timer expires. Wink: Sends the dialled digits to the trunk when the wink signal is received. Maintenance Console Location 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Sending Caller ID to TIE Specifies whether Caller ID information is sent when the channel type is TIE. Value Range Yes, No Maintenance Console Location 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Receiving Caller ID from TIE Specifies whether Caller ID information is received when the channel type is TIE. Value Range Yes, No Maintenance Console Location 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port 328 PC Programming Manual 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Ringback Tone to Outside Caller Enables the PBX to send a ringback tone to an outside caller when the network cannot send the tone. This setting is only available when Channel Type on this screen is set to DDI/DID. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Dial Tone to Extension Enables the PBX to send a dial tone to an extension making a call when the network cannot send the tone. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Pause Time Specifies the length of a pause. PC Programming Manual 329 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Value Range 1.5 s, 2.5 s, 3.5 s, 4.5 s Maintenance Console Location 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.5.4.7 Pause Insertion 1.5.4.8 Host PBX Access Code (Access Code to the Telephone Company from a Host PBX) 1.5.4.9 Special Carrier Access Code Flash Time Specifies the length of a flash signal. Value Range None, 16 ´ n (n=1–255) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.11.7 External Feature Access (EFA) Disconnect Time Specifies the length of time after a trunk is disconnected, during which the PBX cannot seize the line. Value Range 0.5 s, 1.5 s, 2.0 s, 4.0 s, 12.0 s Maintenance Console Location 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Programming Manual References None 330 PC Programming Manual 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Feature Guide References 1.11.6 Flash/Recall/Terminate PC Programming Manual 331 3.37 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port—Connection Command 3.37 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port—Connection Command Commands for the T1 channels can be programmed. INS Puts the channel in service. Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.37 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port—Connection Command Programming Manual References 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Feature Guide References None OUS Takes the channel out of service. This enables a temporary non-use of the port, for example, for the purpose of repair. Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.37 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port—Connection Command Programming Manual References 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port Feature Guide References None 332 PC Programming Manual 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type The properties of the E1 card can be specified. To adjust related settings, click Line Signal Setting, MFC-R2 Setting 1, and MFC-R2 Setting 2. Line Coding Selects the line coding type of E1 PCM (Pulse Code Modulation) for the E1 card. Value Range HDB3, AMI Maintenance Console Location 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Frame Sequence Selects the type of frame sequence for the E1 card. Value Range PCM30, PCM30-CRC Maintenance Console Location 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Frame Option Selects the value for C-bit and D-bit. Value Range C=A, D=B; C=0, D=0; C=0, D=1; C=1, D=0; C=1, D=1 PC Programming Manual 333 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Maintenance Console Location 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None First Dial Timer (DDI/DID/TIE) Specifies the minimum time that the PBX waits after seizing a DDI/DID or TIE line, before sending the dialled digits to the telephone company or to another PBX. This allows the telephone company or the other PBX to have enough time to accept the dialled digits correctly. Value Range 32 ´ n (n=1–255) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Answer Detection Timer Specifies the length of time required by the PBX to recognise the answer signal. This allows the telephone company to have enough time to accept the dialled digits correctly. Value Range 32 ´ n (n=1–255) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None 334 PC Programming Manual 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Seizure ACK Wait Timer Specifies the length of time that the PBX waits for the seizure ACK signal. Value Range 0.5 ´ n (n=1–20) s Maintenance Console Location 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None LIU Send Option Indicates the transmitting level (Transmit Pulse Amplitude) of LIU (reference only). Value Range Mode 1–Mode 8 Maintenance Console Location 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None LIU Receive Option Selects the receiving level (Receive Equalisation) of LIU. Value Range Automatic, 6 dB, 12 dB, 18 dB, 24 dB Maintenance Console Location 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 335 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Feature Guide References None RAI Signal Detection Mode Selects the RAI signal detection mode. Value Range Type 1, Type 2 Maintenance Console Location 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None DTMF Tone—DTMF Inter-digit Pause Specifies the length of the DTMF inter-digit pause. Value Range 64 + 16 ´ n (n=0–11) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Pulse Dial—Pulse % Break Specifies the % break for pulse digits. This is the ratio between the break (on-hook) signal and make (off-hook) signal in a pulse dial. Value Range 60 %, 67 % 336 PC Programming Manual 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Maintenance Console Location 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Pulse Dial—Pulse Type Selects the type of pulse dial transmission appropriate to your area. Value Range Normal, Sweden, New Zealand Maintenance Console Location 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Pulse Dial—Pulse Inter-digit Pause Specifies the length of the pulse inter-digit pause. This allows the telephone company to have enough time to accept the dialled digits correctly. Value Range 630 ms, 830 ms, 1030 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 337 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Pulse Dial—CO Feed Back Tone Specifies whether the pulse feedback tone is turned on or not. For outgoing trunk calls, audible tones can be heard as the dialled number is sent out, which informs the extension user that the number has been dialled. Value Range No, Yes Maintenance Console Location 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Pulse Dial—Maximum BREAK Width Specifies the maximum length of the break signal in a pulse dial. Value Range 8 ´ n (n=9–20) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Pulse Dial—Minimum MAKE Width Specifies the minimum length of the make signal in a pulse dial. Value Range 8 ´ n (n=1–5) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type 338 PC Programming Manual 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Flash—Flash Detection Enables the PBX to detect a hookswitch flash signal sent from an E1 line. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Flash—Minimum BREAK Width Specifies the minimum length of the break signal in a flash signal sent from an E1 line. Value Range 8 ´ n (n=3–63) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Flash—Flash Width Specifies the maximum length of a flash signal sent from an E1 line that the PBX can recognise as a hookswitch flash signal. PC Programming Manual 339 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Value Range 8 ´ n (n=3–191) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Caller ID—Caller ID Start Code Selects the DTMF code used to detect the beginning of a Caller ID series. Value Range *, #, A–D Maintenance Console Location 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Caller ID—Caller ID Information End Code Selects the delimiter used to separate multiple parameters in a Caller ID series. Value Range *, #, A–D Maintenance Console Location 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Programming Manual References None 340 PC Programming Manual 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Caller ID—Caller ID End Code Selects the DTMF code used to detect the end of a Caller ID series. Value Range *, #, A–D Maintenance Console Location 3.38 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID PC Programming Manual 341 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting DR2 Setting Type Selects the control type of the DR2 (Digital System R2) signal. Value Range Normal, Option-1, Option-3 Maintenance Console Location 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Inter-digit Timer Specifies the pseudo-answer time. This setting is available only when Option-1 or Option-3 is selected in DR2 Setting Type on this screen. Value Range 3–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Bit Position for Dial Pulse Selects the position of the pulse dial control bit in a DR2 signal. Value Range A-bit, B-bit 342 PC Programming Manual 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting Maintenance Console Location 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Bit Position for Clear Back Selects the position of the clear-back signal control bit in a DR2 signal. Value Range A-bit, B-bit, A&B-bit Maintenance Console Location 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Forced Release Enables the PBX to send a forced release signal. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 343 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting Forced Release Pattern Selects the bit pattern for a forced release signal. Value Range A=0/B=0, A=0/B=1, A=1/B=0, A=1/B=1 Maintenance Console Location 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None E&M Signalling Type Selects the control bit of an E & M signal. Value Range Type-1:A bit=0, Type-2:A bit=1, Type-3:B bit=0, Type-4:B bit=1, Type-5:A bit=1,B bit=1 Maintenance Console Location 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Wink Signal Width Specifies the length of a wink signal. Value Range 32 ´ n (n=4–9) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting Programming Manual References None 344 PC Programming Manual 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting Feature Guide References None E&M-P Pulse Length—Seizure Specifies the length of a seizure signal. Value Range 150 ms, 600 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None E&M-P Pulse Length—Answer Specifies the length of an answer signal. Value Range 150 ms, 600 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None E&M-P Pulse Length—Clear Specifies the length of a clear signal. Value Range 150 ms, 600 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting PC Programming Manual 345 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None E&M-P Pulse Length—E&M-P Seizure ACK Specifies whether the PBX waits for an E & M-P seizure ACK signal. Value Range No, Yes Maintenance Console Location 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Meter Pulse Detection—Mode Specifies the mode for call charge meter pulses. Value Range No Detection: Meter pulses are not sent or received. Outgoing call only: Sends a call charge meter pulse for outgoing trunk calls. Both calls: Sends and receives call charge meter pulses. Maintenance Console Location 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Meter Pulse Detection—Bit Position Specifies the bit position of a call charge meter pulse. 346 PC Programming Manual 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting Value Range A-bit, B-bit, C-bit, D-bit Maintenance Console Location 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Meter Pulse Detection—Length Specifies the length that a call charge meter pulse must be for the PBX to recognise it as a call charge meter pulse. Value Range 8 ´ n (n=1–80) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None DSP Gain Adjustment—DTMF Transmit Specifies the output power of the DTMF signal sent from the DSP (Digital Signal Processor). Value Range -12 dB–3 dB Maintenance Console Location 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 347 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting Feature Guide References None DSP Gain Adjustment—DTMF Receive Specifies the strength range within which a DTMF signal must be for the DSP to recognise it as a DTMF signal. Value Range -42 - 0 dB – -11- 0 dB Maintenance Console Location 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None DSP Gain Adjustment—MFC-R2 Transmit Specifies the output power of MFC-R2 signals sent from the DSP. Value Range -31 dB–0 dB Maintenance Console Location 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None DSP Gain Adjustment—MFC-R2 Receive Specifies the strength range within which an MFC-R2 signal must be for the DSP to recognise it as an MFC-R2 signal. Value Range -38 - 0 dB – -23 - 0 dB 348 PC Programming Manual 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting Maintenance Console Location 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Frame Error Detection—Error Detection Specifies whether the PBX detects frame synchronisation errors. Value Range No, Yes Maintenance Console Location 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Frame Error Detection—Error Rate Specifies the number of frame errors per second which the PBX needs to recognise a remote alarm. To enable this setting, Frame Error Detection—Error Detection on this screen should be set to Yes. Value Range No limit, 16 ´ n (n=1–7) errors/s Maintenance Console Location 3.39 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—Line Signal Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 349 3.40 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 1 3.40 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 1 ANI Service—Mode Selects the ANI (Automatic Number Identification) service mode. Value Range None: ANI service is not activated. Incoming call only: Receives the caller’s number from the E1 line. Outgoing call only: Sends the caller’s number to the E1 line. Both calls: Sends and receives the caller’s number through the E1 line. Maintenance Console Location 3.40 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 1 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ANI Service—ANI Max. digits Specifies the maximum number of digits to be received via ANI when receiving a call with ANI. Value Range None, 1–16 Maintenance Console Location 3.40 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 1 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None MFC-R2 Timer—Forward Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for an MFC-R2 forward signal sent from the telephone company. Value Range 1–30 s 350 PC Programming Manual 3.40 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 1 Maintenance Console Location 3.40 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 1 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None MFC-R2 Timer—Backward Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for an MFC-R2 backward signal sent from the telephone company. Value Range 1–30 s Maintenance Console Location 3.40 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 1 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None MFC-R2 Timer—Disappearance Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for an MFC-R2 disappearance signal sent from the telephone company. Value Range 1–30 s Maintenance Console Location 3.40 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 1 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 351 3.40 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 1 Group-l Code Assignment—ANI Start Specifies the code used to indicate the beginning of an ANI number. Value Range Undefined, 1–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.40 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 1 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group-l Code Assignment—ANI Complete (1)–(4) Specifies the code used to indicate the end of an ANI number. Value Range ANI Complete (1): 1–15 ANI Complete (2)–(4): Undefined, 1–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.40 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 1 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group-l Code Assignment—ANI Reject Specifies the code used to reject an ANI number. Value Range 1–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.40 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 1 352 PC Programming Manual 3.40 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 1 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group-l Code Assignment—End of Digit Specifies the code used to recognise the end of each digit in an ANI number. Value Range Undefined, 1–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.40 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 1 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group-l Code Assignment—End of Digit Timer Specifies the length of time that the PBX waits for further signal before detecting the end of digit of an ANI number. Value Range 1–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.40 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 1 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group-ll Code Assignment—G-ll Code Outgoing Call Specifies the code for sending Group-ll code to the telephone company. PC Programming Manual 353 3.40 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 1 Value Range 1–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.40 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 1 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group-ll Code Assignment—G-ll Code Incoming Call [1]–[15] Specifies the destination of incoming trunk calls for each Group-ll code respectively. Value Range Undefined, Subscriber, Operator, Collect Call Maintenance Console Location 3.40 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 1 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group-ll Code Assignment—Group-ll ANI Specifies the Group-ll ANI start code. Value Range 1–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.40 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 1 Programming Manual References None 354 PC Programming Manual 3.40 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 1 Feature Guide References None MFC-R2 Group-1[*][#]—E1 MFC-R2 Group1[*] code Specifies the code value of the Group-1 code when the received Group-1 code is [*]. Value Range 11–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.40 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 1 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None MFC-R2 Group-1[*][#]—E1 MFC-R2 Group1[#] code Specifies the code value of the Group-1 code when the received Group-1 code is [#]. Value Range 11–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.40 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 1 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 355 3.41 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 3.41 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 Group-A Code Assignment—Address Complete Specifies the address complete (completion of dial reception) code sent to the telephone company. Value Range 1–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.41 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group-A Code Assignment—ANI Request Specifies the code used to request the telephone company to send an ANI number. Value Range 1–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.41 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group-A Code Assignment—ANI (N+1) Specifies the code used to request the telephone company to send the (N+1)th digit of an ANI number. Value Range 1–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.41 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 356 PC Programming Manual 3.41 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group-A Code Assignment—ANI (N+1) Additional Code Specifies the second code when two codes are needed to request the telephone company to send the (N+1)th digit of an ANI number. Value Range Undefined, 1–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.41 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group-A Code Assignment—Set up Speech Path Specifies the setup speech path code sent to the telephone company. Value Range Undefined, 1–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.41 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group-A Code Assignment—(First) Request Specifies the code used to request the telephone company to send the first digit of an ANI number. PC Programming Manual 357 3.41 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 Value Range Undefined, 1–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.41 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group-A Code Assignment—(N) Request Specifies the code used to request the telephone company to send the (N)th digit of an ANI number. Value Range Undefined, 1–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.41 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group-A Code Assignment—(N-1) Request Specifies the code used to request the telephone company to send the (N-1)th digit of an ANI number. Value Range Undefined, 1–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.41 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 Programming Manual References None 358 PC Programming Manual 3.41 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 Feature Guide References None Group-A Code Assignment—(N-2) Request Specifies the code used to request the telephone company to send the (N-2)th digit of an ANI number. Value Range Undefined, 1–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.41 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group-A Code Assignment—(N-3) Request Specifies the code used to request the telephone company to send the (N-3)th digit of an ANI number. Value Range Undefined, 1–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.41 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group-B Code Assignment—Idle (1) Specifies the code used normally to inform the telephone company that the status of the called destination is idle. Value Range Undefined, 1–15 PC Programming Manual 359 3.41 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 Maintenance Console Location 3.41 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group-B Code Assignment—Idle (2) Specifies the code used in special circumstances, such as an international call, to inform the telephone company that the status of the called destination is idle. Value Range Undefined, 1–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.41 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group-B Code Assignment—Idle (3) Specifies the code used to inform the telephone company that the status of the called destination is idle when the call is disconnected by the caller. Value Range Undefined, 1–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.41 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None 360 PC Programming Manual 3.41 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 Group-B Code Assignment—Busy Specifies the code used to inform the telephone company that the status of the called destination is busy. Value Range Undefined, 1–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.41 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group-B Code Assignment—Unallocated Specifies the code used to inform the telephone company that the received number is not defined. Value Range Undefined, 1–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.41 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group-B Code Assignment—Congestion Specifies the code used to inform the telephone company that the network is congested. Value Range Undefined, 1–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.41 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 361 3.41 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 Feature Guide References None Group-B Code Assignment—Out-of-Service Specifies the code used to inform the telephone company that the status of the called destination is out of service. Value Range Undefined, 1–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.41 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group-B Code Assignment—No Billing Specifies the code used to inform the telephone company that the call is not charged. Value Range Undefined, 1–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.41 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group-B Code Assignment—Collect Call Reject Specifies the code used to inform the telephone company that the collect call has been rejected. Value Range Undefined, 1–15 362 PC Programming Manual 3.41 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 Maintenance Console Location 3.41 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - E1 type—MFC-R2 Setting 2 Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 363 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Various settings can be programmed for each E1 channel. To change the status of ports, click Command. Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None CH Indicates the channel number (reference only). Value Range channel number Maintenance Console Location 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Connection Indicates the channel status (reference only). This column offers two ways to open the screen to select the channel command: • Click the desired cell in the column. • Select the desired cell in the column, and then click Command. 364 PC Programming Manual 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Value Range INS: The channel is in service. OUS: The channel is out of service. Fault: The channel is not communicating with the network. Maintenance Console Location 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Subscriber Number Specifies the number used as the CLIP number. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) Channel Type Selects the channel type. Value Range Undefined: Not assigned DR2: Digital System R2 E&M-P: Pulsed E & M E&M-C: Continuous E & M Maintenance Console Location 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port PC Programming Manual 365 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.22.1 E1 Line Service Trunk Property Selects the trunk property of the E & M channel. Value Range Public: Use the DIL/DDI/DID method to distribute incoming trunk calls. Private: Use the TIE line service between two or more PBXs. Maintenance Console Location 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.1.1 Incoming Trunk Call Features—SUMMARY 1.21.1.1 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN)—SUMMARY 1.30.1 TIE Line Service CO Dial Mode Selects the type of signal used to dial out to a trunk. If MFC-R2 is selected, the PBX (not the telephone company) sends a dial tone to the caller when making a trunk call using an E1 line. Value Range DTMF, Pulse, MFC-R2 Maintenance Console Location 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.5.4.4 Dial Type Selection 1.22.1 E1 Line Service 366 PC Programming Manual 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port E1 Receiver Type Selects the type of signal the PBX receives from the E1 line. This should be set to MFC-R2 when receiving ANI (Automatic Number Identification) numbers from the E1 line. Value Range DTMF, Pulse, MFC-R2, Undefined Maintenance Console Location 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.22.1 E1 Line Service Receive Digits Specifies the maximum number of digits to be received from a DDI/DID number when receiving a call with the DDI/DID number. Value Range 0–15 Maintenance Console Location 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None CPC Detection Time—Out, In Specifies the length of time required by the PBX to detect a CPC signal on outgoing or incoming trunk calls before disconnecting the line. When None is selected here, the line will not be disconnected when a CPC signal is not detected. Value Range None, 80 ´ n (n=2–75) ms PC Programming Manual 367 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Maintenance Console Location 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.11.10 Calling Party Control (CPC) Signal Detection DTMF Width Selects the length of the DTMF tone sent to the E1 channel. Value Range 80 ms, 160 ms Maintenance Console Location 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None CO Pulse Speed Selects the speed at which pulse dials are sent to the E1 channel. Value Range 10 pulse/s, 20 pulse/s Maintenance Console Location 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.5.4.4 Dial Type Selection 368 PC Programming Manual 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Wink Signal Time-Out Specifies the length of time that the PBX waits to receive a wink signal after seizing a trunk. If a wink signal is not received before this timer expires, the trunk is released. Value Range 64 ´ n (n=1–128) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Start Signal Type Selects the type of the start signal. Value Range Immediate: Sends the dialled digits to the trunk when the First Dial Timer expires. Wink: Sends the dialled digits to the trunk when the wink signal is received. Maintenance Console Location 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Sending Caller ID to TIE Specifies whether Caller ID information is sent when E&M-C. Channel Type on this screen is set to E&M-P or Value Range No, Yes Maintenance Console Location 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port PC Programming Manual 369 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Receiving Caller ID from TIE Specifies whether Caller ID information is received when E&M-C. Channel Type on this screen is set to E&M-P or Value Range No, Yes Maintenance Console Location 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Ringback Tone to Outside Caller Enables the PBX to send a ringback tone to an outside caller when the network cannot send the tone. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Dial Tone to Extension Enables the PBX to send a dial tone to an extension making a call when the network cannot send the tone. 370 PC Programming Manual 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Answer Wait Timer Selects the length of time that the PBX waits for the called outside party to answer an outgoing trunk call. The line will be disconnected automatically when this timer expires. Value Range None, 1 min, 2 min, 3 min, 4 min Maintenance Console Location 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Pause Time Specifies the length of a pause. Value Range 1.5 s, 2.5 s, 3.5 s, 4.5 s Maintenance Console Location 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 371 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Feature Guide References 1.5.4.7 Pause Insertion 1.5.4.8 Host PBX Access Code (Access Code to the Telephone Company from a Host PBX) 1.5.4.9 Special Carrier Access Code Flash Time Specifies the length of a flash signal. Value Range None, 16 ´ n (n=1–255) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Programming Manual References None, 16 ´ n (n=1–255) ms Feature Guide References None Disconnect Time Specifies the length of time after a trunk is disconnected, during which the PBX cannot seize the line. Value Range 0.5 s, 1.5 s, 2.0 s, 4.0 s, 12.0 s Maintenance Console Location 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.11.6 Flash/Recall/Terminate 372 PC Programming Manual 3.43 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port—Connection Command 3.43 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port—Connection Command Commands for the E1 channels can be programmed. INS Puts the channel in service. Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.43 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port—Connection Command Programming Manual References 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Feature Guide References None OUS Takes the channel out of service. This enables a temporary non-use of the channel, for example, for the purpose of repair. Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.43 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port—Connection Command Programming Manual References 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 373 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property The properties of the Optional Base card can be specified. To change the status of slots on the OPB card, click Command. The properties of the built-in 2-channel SVM (Simplified Voice Message) and OGM (Outgoing Message) features can also be specified on this screen. See 3.5 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property for details. Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Sub-Slot Indicates the sub-slot number (reference only). Value Range Sub-slot number Maintenance Console Location 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Feature Card Type Indicates the type of option card that is installed or pre-installed in each sub-slot (reference only). Note that only one ECHO16 card can be installed per OPB3 card. Value Range MSG4: 4-Channel Message Card 374 PC Programming Manual 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property DPH4: 4-Port Doorphone Card DPH2: 2-Port Doorphone Card ECHO16: 16-Channel Echo Canceller Card EIO4: 4-Port External Input/Output Card ESVM2: 2-Channel Simplified Voice Message Card ESVM4: 4-Channel Simplified Voice Message Card Maintenance Console Location 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Installation Manual References 1.3.1 Optional Equipment Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Status Indicates the status of the option card in each slot (reference only). This column offers two ways to open the screen to select the card command: • Click the desired cell in the column. • Select the desired cell in the column, and then click Command. Value Range INS: The card is in service. OUS: The card is out of service. Fault: The card has been removed from the sub-slot, or is not communicating with the PBX. Pre-Install: There is no card in the sub-slot, but the card type is programmed for the sub-slot. Idle: There is no card in the sub-slot, no programming of the card type for the sub-slot. Maintenance Console Location 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Programming Manual References 3.45 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property—Card Command Feature Guide References None Port Number Indicates the port number of the mounted option card (reference only). PC Programming Manual 375 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Status Indicates the port status of the mounted option card (reference only). Value Range INS: The card is in service. OUS: The card is out of service. Fault: The card is pulled out from the sub-slot, or is not communicating with the PBX. Maintenance Console Location 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Device Type Selects the type of connected output device (for output ports only). Value Range Relay, Ringer Maintenance Console Location 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Programming Manual References None 376 PC Programming Manual 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Feature Guide References 1.17.10 External Relay Control Input Signal Decision Time Specifies the minimum duration of continuous input from the triggered sensor before the PBX recognises the input and makes a sensor call. Value Range 32 ´ n (n=2–255) ms Maintenance Console Location 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.9 External Sensor Input Signal Detection Reopening Time Specifies the length of time after the sensor has been triggered during which any further input from the sensor will be ignored. Value Range 10 ´ n (n=1–255) s Maintenance Console Location 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.9 External Sensor SVM Feature Specifies whether or not to use the ESVM card for the SVM feature. It is possible to use the ESVM card for the SVM feature, as an MSG card (OGM feature), or both. Value Range Disable, Enable PC Programming Manual 377 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Maintenance Console Location 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Programming Manual References 3.5 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property— SVM Feature Feature Guide References 1.17.5 Outgoing Message (OGM) 1.17.7 Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM) MSG Feature Specifies whether or not to use the ESVM card as an MSG card (OGM feature). It is possible to use the ESVM card for the SVM feature, as an MSG card (OGM feature), or both. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Programming Manual References 3.5 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property— MSG Feature Feature Guide References 1.17.5 Outgoing Message (OGM) 1.17.7 Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM) 378 PC Programming Manual 3.45 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property—Card Command 3.45 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property—Card Command Commands for the service cards installed on the OPB card can be programmed. INS Puts the card in service. Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.45 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property—Card Command Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None OUS Takes the card out of service. Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.45 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property—Card Command Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Pre-INS Assigns the card type to a certain sub-slot (Pre-installation). Value Range MSG4: 4-Channel Message Card DPH4: 4-Port Doorphone Card DPH2: 2-Port Doorphone Card PC Programming Manual 379 3.45 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property—Card Command ECHO16: 16-Channel Echo Canceller Card EIO4: 4-Port External Input/Output Card ESVM2: 2-Channel Simplified Voice Message Card ESVM4: 4-Channel Simplified Voice Message Card Maintenance Console Location 3.45 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property—Card Command Installation Manual References 1.3.1 Optional Equipment Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Delete Assigns the card type to be deleted from the sub-slot. Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.45 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property—Card Command Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None 380 PC Programming Manual 3.46 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Option Card Setup 3.46 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Option Card Setup Option cards can be installed to and removed from the OPB3 cards installed in the PBX. Click the right and left arrow buttons (">", "<") to add or remove option cards. Option Card Type Selects the type of option card to install to the OPB3 card. Value Range MSG4: 4-Channel Message Card DPH4: 4-Port Doorphone Card DPH2: 2-Port Doorphone Card ECHO16: 16-Channel Echo Canceller Card EIO4: 4-Port External Input/Output Card ESVM2: 2-Channel Simplified Voice Message Card ESVM4: 4-Channel Simplified Voice Message Card Maintenance Console Location 3.46 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Option Card Setup Installation Manual References 1.3.1 Optional Equipment Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Feature Guide References None Slot 1–Slot 3 Selects the slot on the OPB3 card to install or remove the option card for. Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.46 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Option Card Setup Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property PC Programming Manual 381 3.46 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Option Card Setup Feature Guide References None Card Inserted Displays the type of option card currently installed to each slot of the OPB3 card Value Range MSG4: 4-Channel Message Card DPH4: 4-Port Doorphone Card DPH2: 2-Port Doorphone Card ECHO16: 16-Channel Echo Canceller Card EIO4: 4-Port External Input/Output Card ESVM2: 2-Channel Simplified Voice Message Card ESVM4: 4-Channel Simplified Voice Message Card Maintenance Console Location 3.46 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Option Card Setup Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Feature Guide References None 382 PC Programming Manual 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station Various portable station (PS) settings can be programmed. A maximum of 64 PSs can be registered. Information on 32 PSs is displayed at a time. To display other PSs, click the applicable tab. PS Registration and De-registration A PS must be registered to the PBX by programming both the PBX and PS before it can be used. Programming instructions of the PBX are given below; programming instructions of the PS are found in the Installation Manual. It is possible to de-register the PS later. Registration Follow the steps below to register the PS. 1. Click Registration. A dialogue box will appear. Non-registered (available) extension numbers and names are displayed on the left. 2. Highlight numbers and names and click the right arrow to select them for registration. Click Next. 3. If the registration is still in progress, the dialogue box will show "Registration Executing". If the registration is successful, the dialogue box will show "Registration Completed". Click Close. Once a PS is successfully registered, the status of the PS will update to show "Registered". De-registration Follow the steps below to de-register the PS. 1. Click De-registration. A dialogue box will appear. Registered extension numbers and names are displayed on the left. 2. Highlight numbers and names and click the right arrow to select them for de-registration. Click Next. A dialogue box will appear. 3. Click Confirm. • If the de-registration is successful, the dialogue box will show "De-registration Succeed". • If the de-registration is unsuccessful, the dialogue box will show "De-registration Error". De-registration will be terminated. 4. Click Close. If the PS is successfully de-registered, the status of the PS will update to show "None". Forced De-registration Follow the steps below to forcibly de-register the PS when normal de-registration has been unsuccessful or de-registration has been performed only on the PS. 1. Click Forced De-registration. A dialogue box will appear. Registered extension numbers and names are displayed on the left. 2. Highlight numbers and names and click the right arrow to select them for forced de-registration. Click Next. A dialogue box will appear. 3. Click OK. A dialogue box will appear. 4. Click Confirm. • If the de-registration is successful, the dialogue box will show "Forced De-registration Succeed". PC Programming Manual 383 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station 5. Click Close. Once the PS is successfully de-registered, the status of the PS will update to show "None". Personal Identification Number Specifies the Personal Identification Number (PIN) of the PBX, used to avoid registering a PS to the wrong PBX. Note that the same PIN should be entered at the PS, before the PS is registered to the PBX. Value Range 4 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.25.1 Portable Station (PS) Connection Index Indicates the PS number (reference only). Value Range 1–64 Maintenance Console Location 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.25.1 Portable Station (PS) Connection Extension No. Specifies the extension number of the PS. In Wireless XDP Parallel Mode, the PS can be used as a sub telephone with a wired main telephone (PT/SLT), and two of them will share one extension number of the main telephone. However, note that the PS extension number specified here will not be altered by the extension number of the main telephone even if the PS is in Wireless XDP Parallel Mode. 384 PC Programming Manual 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.25.1 Portable Station (PS) Connection 1.25.5 Wireless XDP Parallel Mode Extension Name Specifies the name of the PS. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station Programming Manual References 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— Extension Name Feature Guide References 1.25.1 Portable Station (PS) Connection Status Indicates whether a certain PS is registered (reference only). Value Range None, Registered Maintenance Console Location 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 385 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station Feature Guide References 1.25.1 Portable Station (PS) Connection 386 PC Programming Manual 3.48 [1-3] Option 3.48 [1-3] Option System options can be programmed. It is possible to clear the master CS information (Master CS Port and Radio System ID) by following the procedure below in batch mode: 1. Click Clear Master CS. 2. Click Yes. To abort the procedure, click No. If the system data is downloaded to the PBX after the master CS information has been cleared, it is necessary to register all PSs again in the interactive mode. Master CS information will be assigned automatically when a CS is connected to the PBX. Without the Radio System ID, PSs cannot be registered. System Wireless—System ID Indicates the radio system ID used to register a PS (reference only). Value Range Not applicable. Maintenance Console Location 3.48 [1-3] Option Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None New Card Installation—Card Status for any Card Selects the initial status of cards after installation. Value Range In Service, Out of Service Maintenance Console Location 3.48 [1-3] Option Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 387 3.48 [1-3] Option New Card Installation—Automatic Extension Number Set for Extension Card Selects whether extension numbers are assigned to extension ports automatically or manually. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 3.48 [1-3] Option Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None New Card Installation—ISDN Standard Mode for PRI23 Card Specifies whether a PRI23 card is automatically set to ISDN Standard mode or T1-LCOT mode when it is installed for the first time. Value Range ISDN Standard mode: The CCBS, CF, CT, and Centralised VM features are supported. DIL and DID call distribution are available for the D channel. T1-LCOT mode: DIL and DID call distribution are available for all 23B channels. The CCBS, CF, CT, and Centralised VM features are not available in this mode. Maintenance Console Location 3.48 [1-3] Option Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.1.2 Direct In Line (DIL) 1.1.1.3 Direct Inward Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI) 1.30.4.3 Call Forwarding (CF)—by QSIG 1.30.4.4 Call Transfer (CT)—by QSIG 1.30.4.5 Completion of Calls to Busy Subscriber (CCBS)—by QSIG 1.30.5.2 Centralised Voice Mail 388 PC Programming Manual 3.49 [1-4] Clock Priority 3.49 [1-4] Clock Priority Slot Number Selects and prioritises slot numbers for the BRI, PRI, T1, and E1 cards that are used to forward a clock pulse from an external source to the PBX. Obtain the master clock time from the outside line that the telephone company provides. To change Clock Priority, follow the steps below: 1. Assign a Clock Priority to each BRI, PRI, T1 and/or E1 card. 2. Set the status of the present clock source card to "OUS", then "INS". Note If multiple PBXs are used to establish a private network (TIE line service, QSIG network, etc.) without being connected through the telephone company, assign only one PBX as the clock source on the network. That PBX should have a card connected to a telephone company line selected as its clock source. All other PBXs should have cards connected to the network selected as the clock source. This enables all PBXs on the network to synchronise their timing. Value Range None, BRI2, PRI23, PRI30, T1, E1 Maintenance Console Location 3.49 [1-4] Clock Priority Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 389 3.49 [1-4] Clock Priority 390 PC Programming Manual Section 4 [2] System PC Programming Manual 391 4.1 [2-1-1] Date & Time—Date & Time Setting 4.1 [2-1-1] Date & Time—Date & Time Setting The date and time of the PBX can be programmed. The date and time will be shown on the display of extensions (e.g., PT, PS). This option is only available in Interactive mode. Date & Time Indicates the current date and time. Values can be entered by clicking the parameter you want to change and typing the new value, or by clicking the up/down arrows beside the date and time. Value Range Year: 2000–2099 Month: 01–12 Day: 01–31 Hour: 00–23 Minute: 00–59 Second: 00–59 Maintenance Console Location 4.1 [2-1-1] Date & Time—Date & Time Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None 392 PC Programming Manual 4.2 [2-1-2] Date & Time—SNTP / Daylight Saving 4.2 [2-1-2] Date & Time—SNTP / Daylight Saving Automatic clock adjustment and Summer time (daylight saving time) settings of the PBX can be programmed. Automatic clock adjustment can be performed using one of two methods, ISDN & Caller ID or SNTP (Simple Network Time Protocol). To set Summer time, click 4.3 [2-1-2] Date & Time—SNTP / Daylight Saving—Daylight Saving. Automatic Time Adjustment Enables the PBX to automatically adjust its clock every day according to the time information provided by the network. Value Range Disable, ISDN & Caller ID (FSK), SNTP Maintenance Console Location 4.2 [2-1-2] Date & Time—SNTP / Daylight Saving Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.3.5 Automatic Setup SNTP—SNTP Server—IP Address Specifies the IP address of an SNTP server. Value Range 1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255 Maintenance Console Location 4.2 [2-1-2] Date & Time—SNTP / Daylight Saving Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.3.5 Automatic Setup SNTP—SNTP Server—Port Number Specifies the port number used for communication with an SNTP server. Value Range 1–65535 PC Programming Manual 393 4.2 [2-1-2] Date & Time—SNTP / Daylight Saving Maintenance Console Location 4.2 [2-1-2] Date & Time—SNTP / Daylight Saving Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.3.5 Automatic Setup SNTP—Time Zone—Time Zone Specifies your local UTC (Coordinated Universal Time) time zone using the up and down arrows. Value Range -14:00–+14:00 Maintenance Console Location 4.2 [2-1-2] Date & Time—SNTP / Daylight Saving Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.3.5 Automatic Setup SNTP—Time Zone—Time Zone for PC Indicates the UTC (Coordinated Universal Time) time zone of the PC (reference only). Value Range -14:00–+14:00 Maintenance Console Location 4.2 [2-1-2] Date & Time—SNTP / Daylight Saving Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.3.5 Automatic Setup 394 PC Programming Manual 4.3 [2-1-2] Date & Time—SNTP / Daylight Saving—Daylight Saving 4.3 [2-1-2] Date & Time—SNTP / Daylight Saving— Daylight Saving Summer time can be programmed. Summer time sets the clock one hour forward at 2:00 AM on the start date, and one hour back at 2:00 AM on the end date. The start and end dates of a maximum of 20 different summer times can be programmed. Setting Enables Summer time. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.3 [2-1-2] Date & Time—SNTP / Daylight Saving—Daylight Saving Programming Manual References 4.2 [2-1-2] Date & Time—SNTP / Daylight Saving Feature Guide References 2.3.5 Automatic Setup Start Date—Year, Month, Day Specifies the start date of daylight savings time. Value Range Year: 2000–2099 Month: 1–12 Day: 1–31 Maintenance Console Location 4.3 [2-1-2] Date & Time—SNTP / Daylight Saving—Daylight Saving Programming Manual References 4.2 [2-1-2] Date & Time—SNTP / Daylight Saving Feature Guide References 2.3.5 Automatic Setup PC Programming Manual 395 4.3 [2-1-2] Date & Time—SNTP / Daylight Saving—Daylight Saving End Date—Year, Month, Day Specifies the end date of daylight savings time. Value Range Year: 2000–2099 Month: 1–12 Day: 1–31 Maintenance Console Location 4.3 [2-1-2] Date & Time—SNTP / Daylight Saving—Daylight Saving Programming Manual References 4.2 [2-1-2] Date & Time—SNTP / Daylight Saving Feature Guide References 2.3.5 Automatic Setup 396 PC Programming Manual 4.4 [2-2] Operator & BGM 4.4 [2-2] Operator & BGM Settings related to the PBX operator and audio sources can be specified. PBX Operator—Day, Lunch, Break, Night Specifies the extension number or floating extension number of incoming call distribution group to be designated as the PBX operator in each time mode (day/lunch/break/night). To select an extension number, click Destination Setting (see 2.1.6 Extension Number Setting). Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 4.4 [2-2] Operator & BGM Programming Manual References 4.6 [2-4] Week Table 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Feature Guide References 2.2.5 Operator Features BGM and Music on Hold—Music Source of BGM Selects the audio source of BGM. Value Range External BGM, Internal BGM 1, Internal BGM 2 Maintenance Console Location 4.4 [2-2] Operator & BGM Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.13.4 Music on Hold 1.17.4 Background Music (BGM) BGM and Music on Hold—Music Source of BGM2–7—OGM No. Selects the OGM number and name of the audio source of BGM. PC Programming Manual 397 4.4 [2-2] Operator & BGM Note To use this feature it is necessary to disable the SVM Feature setting for the corresponding card. Value Range None, OGM1–OGM64 Maintenance Console Location 4.4 [2-2] Operator & BGM Programming Manual References 3.5 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property— SVM Feature 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property— SVM Feature Feature Guide References 1.13.4 Music on Hold 1.17.4 Background Music (BGM) 1.17.5 Outgoing Message (OGM) BGM and Music on Hold—Music Source of BGM2–7—Card Selects the card (IPCMPR [ESVM Circuit] or ESVM) of the audio source of BGM. Cards must have the MSG Feature setting enabled to be available for selection. Value Range Available cards Maintenance Console Location 4.4 [2-2] Operator & BGM Programming Manual References 3.5 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property— MSG Feature 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property— MSG Feature Feature Guide References 1.13.4 Music on Hold 1.17.4 Background Music (BGM) 1.17.5 Outgoing Message (OGM) BGM and Music on Hold—Music on Hold Selects the audio source for Music on Hold. Value Range Tone, BGM, BGM2, BGM3, BGM4, BGM5, BGM6, BGM7 398 PC Programming Manual 4.4 [2-2] Operator & BGM Maintenance Console Location 4.4 [2-2] Operator & BGM Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.13.4 Music on Hold BGM and Music on Hold—Sound on Transfer Selects the audio source for Music for Transfer (either the same music source chosen for the Music on Hold, or ringback tone). Value Range Same as Music on Hold, Ringback Tone Maintenance Console Location 4.4 [2-2] Operator & BGM Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.12.1 Call Transfer PC Programming Manual 399 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Various system timers and counters can be programmed. Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone Automatic Redial—Repeat Counter Specifies the number of times Automatic Redial is attempted before being cancelled. Value Range 0–15 Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.6.1.4 Last Number Redial Automatic Redial—Repeat Interval Specifies the length of time between repeated Automatic Redial attempts. Value Range 10 ´ n (n=1–360) s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.6.1.4 Last Number Redial Automatic Redial—Redial Call Ring Duration Specifies the length of time that the PBX waits for the called party to answer an Automatic Redial attempt. This is the length of time that the called party’s extension will ring for each attempt. Value Range 10 ´ n (n=1–30) s 400 PC Programming Manual 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.6.1.4 Last Number Redial Automatic Redial—Analogue CO Mute / Busy Detection Timer Specifies the length of time before the PBX stops muting the caller’s voice and cancels busy tone detection when Automatic Redial to analogue trunk is performed. Value Range 0–15 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.6.1.4 Last Number Redial Dial—Hot Line (Pickup Dial) Start Specifies the length of time between going off-hook and the start of automatic dialling when the Hot Line feature is set. Value Range 0–15 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.6.1.7 Hot Line PC Programming Manual 401 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Dial—Extension First Digit Specifies the length of time after going off-hook within which the first digit of a feature number or destination must be dialled before a reorder tone is heard. Value Range 1–250 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.5.2 Automatic Extension Release Dial—Extension Inter-digit Specifies the length of time within which subsequent digits must be dialled before the PBX sends a reorder tone. Value Range 1–250 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.5.2 Automatic Extension Release Dial—Analogue CO First Digit Specifies the length of time within which the first digit of a telephone number must be sent to an analogue trunk. If no digit is sent before this time expires, the PBX recognises end of dialling and stops muting the caller’s voice over the analogue trunk. Value Range 1–15 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters 402 PC Programming Manual 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Dial—Analogue CO Inter-digit Specifies the length of time within which subsequent digits of a telephone number must be sent to an analogue trunk. If no digit is sent before this time expires, the PBX recognises end of dialling and stops muting the caller’s voice over the analogue trunk. Value Range 1–15 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Dial—Analogue CO Call Duration Start Specifies the length of time between the end of dialling and the start of the SMDR timer for outgoing analogue trunk calls. Value Range 0–60 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) PC Programming Manual 403 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Intercept Routing No Answer (IRNA)—Day, Lunch, Break, Night Specifies the length of time until an unanswered trunk call is redirected to the intercept routing destination in each time mode. Note that this setting is only valid for extensions whose Intercept No Answer Time—Day, Lunch, Break, Night is set to "0". Value Range 1–240 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Intercept No Answer Time— —Day, Lunch, Break, Night Intercept No Answer Time Feature Guide References 1.1.1.6 Intercept Routing Recall—Hold Recall Specifies the length of time until the holding extension receives a Hold Recall ring or alarm tone when a held call remains unretrieved. Value Range 0 (disable the Hold Recall)–240 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.13.1 Call Hold Recall—Transfer Recall Specifies the length of time that a transferred call waits to be answered, before being redirected to the Transfer Recall destination assigned to the original transferring extension. Value Range 1–240 s 404 PC Programming Manual 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.12.1 Call Transfer Recall—Call Park Recall Specifies the length of time that a parked call waits to be retrieved, before the Transfer Recall destination assigned to the extension that parked the call hears a Call Park Recall ring. Value Range 1–240 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.13.2 Call Park Recall—Disconnect after Recall Specifies the length of time after an extension with a trunk call on hold receives a Hold Recall tone that the held call is disconnected. Value Range 1–30 min Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.13.1 Call Hold PC Programming Manual 405 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Tone Length—Busy Tone / DND Tone Specifies the length of time that a busy/DND tone is heard when a call is made to an extension in busy status or DND mode. A reorder tone will be sent when this timer expires. (For a call through DISA, the call will be disconnected when this timer expires.) Value Range 0 (continuous)–15 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3.1.3 Do Not Disturb (DND) 1.8 Busy Line/Busy Party Features Tone Length—Reorder Tone for PT Handset Specifies the length of time that a reorder tone is heard when using a PT handset. The PT will return to idle status when this timer expires. Value Range 1–15 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.5.2 Automatic Extension Release Tone Length—Reorder Tone for PT Hands-free Specifies the length of time that a reorder tone is heard from the built-in speaker of a PT in hands-free mode. The PT will return to idle status when this timer expires. This setting is applied to PSs as well as PTs. Value Range 1–15 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters 406 PC Programming Manual 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.5.2 Automatic Extension Release 1.11.1 Hands-free Operation DISA / Door / Reminder / U. Conf DISA—Delayed Answer Timer Specifies the length of time that the caller hears a ringback tone before hearing an OGM. Value Range 0–30 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References 7.4 [5-3-2] Voice Message—DISA Message Feature Guide References 1.17.6 Direct Inward System Access (DISA) DISA—Mute & OGM Start Timer after answering Specifies the length of time until the caller hears an OGM after reaching the DISA line. Value Range 0.0–12.0 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References 7.4 [5-3-2] Voice Message—DISA Message Feature Guide References 1.17.6 Direct Inward System Access (DISA) DISA—No Dial Intercept Timer Specifies the length of time after the OGM finishes playing in which the caller must begin dialling before the call is redirected to the operator. PC Programming Manual 407 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Value Range 0–120 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References 4.4 [2-2] Operator & BGM 7.4 [5-3-2] Voice Message—DISA Message 8.6 [6-6] Tenant— Operator (Extension Number) Feature Guide References 1.17.6 Direct Inward System Access (DISA) DISA—2nd Dial Timer for AA Specifies the length of time in which the caller must dial the second digit before the DISA AA Service activates. Value Range 0–5 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References 7.4 [5-3-2] Voice Message—DISA Message Feature Guide References 1.17.6 Direct Inward System Access (DISA) DISA—Intercept Timer—Day, Lunch, Break, Night Specifies the length of time until an unanswered DISA call is intercepted and redirected to the intercept routing destination after the original destination receives the call in each time mode. Value Range 0–60 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters 408 PC Programming Manual 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Intercept Destination— Intercept Destination—When called party does not answer—Day, Lunch, Break, Night 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Intercept Destination— Intercept Destination—When called party does not answer—Day, Lunch, Break, Night 7.4 [5-3-2] Voice Message—DISA Message Feature Guide References 1.1.1.6 Intercept Routing 1.17.6 Direct Inward System Access (DISA) DISA—Disconnect Timer after Intercept Specifies the length of time that an intercepted DISA call rings at the intercept routing destination before being disconnected. Value Range 0–60 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References 7.4 [5-3-2] Voice Message—DISA Message Feature Guide References 1.17.6 Direct Inward System Access (DISA) DISA—CO-to-CO Call Prolong Counter Specifies the number of times that the caller can prolong a trunk-to-trunk call on a DISA line. (Selecting "0" enables the caller to prolong the trunk-to-trunk call without restriction.) Value Range 0–15 Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References 7.4 [5-3-2] Voice Message—DISA Message Feature Guide References 1.17.6 Direct Inward System Access (DISA) PC Programming Manual 409 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters DISA—CO-to-CO Call Prolong Time Specifies the length of time that a trunk-to-trunk call on a DISA line is prolonged each time that the caller prolongs the call. (Selecting "0" prevents the caller from prolonging the trunk-to-trunk call.) Value Range 0–7 min Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References 7.4 [5-3-2] Voice Message—DISA Message Feature Guide References 1.17.6 Direct Inward System Access (DISA) DISA—Progress Tone Continuation Time before Recording Message Specifies the length of time that a progress tone is sent to the manager extension before recording an OGM. Value Range 0–7 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References 7.4 [5-3-2] Voice Message—DISA Message Feature Guide References 1.17.5 Outgoing Message (OGM) DISA—Reorder Tone Duration Specifies the length of time that a reorder tone is sent to the caller before the call is disconnected. Value Range 1–15 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters 410 PC Programming Manual 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References 7.4 [5-3-2] Voice Message—DISA Message Feature Guide References 1.17.6 Direct Inward System Access (DISA) Doorphone—Call Ring Duration Specifies the length of time that a call from a doorphone rings until the call is cancelled when there is no answer. Value Range 10 ´ n (n=1–15) s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References 7.1 [5-1] Doorphone Feature Guide References 1.17.1 Doorphone Call Doorphone—Call Duration Specifies the length of time until an answered doorphone call is disconnected. Value Range 10 ´ n (n=0–30) s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References 7.1 [5-1] Doorphone Feature Guide References 1.17.1 Doorphone Call Doorphone—Open Duration Specifies the length of time that a door stays unlocked after being opened from an extension. Value Range 2–7 s PC Programming Manual 411 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References 7.1 [5-1] Doorphone Feature Guide References 1.17.2 Door Open Timed Reminder—Repeat Counter Specifies the number of times that an alarm is repeated. Value Range 1–15 Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.28.4 Timed Reminder Timed Reminder—Interval Time Specifies the length of time between the repeated alarms. Value Range 10 ´ n (n=1–120) s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.28.4 Timed Reminder 412 PC Programming Manual 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Timed Reminder—Alarm Ringing Duration Specifies the length of time that an alarm rings. Value Range 10 ´ n (n=1–30) s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.28.4 Timed Reminder Unattended Conference—Recall Start Timer Specifies the length of time until the conference originator receives an Unattended Conference Recall tone. Value Range 0–60 min Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.14.1.2 Conference Unattended Conference—Warning Tone Start Timer Specifies the length of time until the parties involved in an Unattended Conference receive a warning tone after the conference originator receives the Unattended Conference Recall tone but does not return to the conference. Value Range 0–240 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters PC Programming Manual 413 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.14.1.2 Conference Unattended Conference—Disconnect Timer Specifies the length of time until an Unattended Conference is disconnected after the parties involved in the conference receive a warning tone but the conference originator does not return to the conference. Value Range 0–240 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.14.1.2 Conference Miscellaneous Caller ID—Waiting to receive Specifies the length of time that the PBX waits to receive Caller ID from an analogue trunk. If the Caller ID is received through an analogue trunk card on which no Caller ID card is mounted or through a port to which Caller ID Detection is disabled, this timer is not applicable. Value Range 0–15 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References 5.3 [3-1-3] Caller ID Modification 8.1 [6-1] System Speed Dial Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID 414 PC Programming Manual 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Caller ID—Visual Caller ID Display Specifies the length of time that a Caller ID number, with the Call Waiting tone offered by an analogue line from the telephone company, is shown on the display. The Caller ID number flashes on the display for five seconds, followed by a 10-second pause, then flashes again for five seconds. Value Range 0–250 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.3.3 Call Waiting 1.8.4.2 Call Waiting Tone 1.18.1 Caller ID Extension PIN—Lock Counter Specifies the number of successive incorrect PIN entries allowed before the extension PIN is locked. A locked extension PIN can not be used until reset from the extension assigned as manager. (Specifying "None" disables this counter.) Value Range None, 1–15 Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.9.5 Walking COS 1.9.6 Verification Code Entry 1.28.1 Extension Personal Identification Number (PIN) External Sensor—Ring Duration Specifies the length of time that the PBX waits for the called party to answer before cancelling a sensor call. Value Range 10 ´ n (n=1–15) s PC Programming Manual 415 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.9 External Sensor Incoming Call Inter-digit Timer—DDI / DID Specifies the length of time between digits when receiving a DDI/DID number from a public network. The call will be redirected to a PBX operator when this timer expires. Value Range 0–30 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References 12.3 [10-3] DDI / DID Table Feature Guide References 1.1.1.3 Direct Inward Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI) Incoming Call Inter-digit Timer—TIE Specifies the length of time between digits when receiving a dialled number from a TIE line. The call will be redirected to a PBX operator when this timer expires. Value Range 3–30 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References 11.1 [9-1] TIE Table Feature Guide References 1.30.1 TIE Line Service 416 PC Programming Manual 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters PT Display—PT Last Display Duration in Idle Mode Specifies the length of time that the current information remains on the display after the extension returns to idle status. Value Range 1–15 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Air Synchronisation—Watching Degeneracy Specifies the length of time that a Slave CS can maintain an ongoing call after air synchronisation is lost. Value Range 0–300 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References 5.29 [3-11] Air Synchronisation Group 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Feature Guide References None Voice Mail (Caller from VM to CO)—On-hook Wait Time Specifies the length of time from when the VPS seizes a trunk (for example, to transfer a call) until the VPS goes on hook. If the time specified here is too short, the VPS will be unable to dial the number and make a connection. Value Range 1–30 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters PC Programming Manual 417 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.24 Voice Mail Features During Conversation—DTMF Signal Length Specifies the length of time that a DTMF signal is sent when a number is dialled from a PT or PS during a conversation. Value Range 80 ms, 160 ms, 240 ms, 320 ms Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None During Conversation—DTMF Inter-digit Pause Specifies the length of time between DTMF signals when numbers are dialled in succession from a PT or PS during a conversation. Value Range 64 + 16 ´ n (n=0–15) ms Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None During Conversation—Pause Signal Time Specifies the length of the pause inserted when the PAUSE button is pressed during a conversation. 418 PC Programming Manual 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Value Range 1.5 s, 2.5 s, 3.5 s, 4.5 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.5.4.7 Pause Insertion System Wireless—PS Out of Range Timer When the destination of an incoming call is a PS, specifies the length of time the PBX searches for the PS before setting its status to Out of Range. If "0" is assigned, the timer is controlled by the cell station. Value Range 0 s, 4 s, 8 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References 4.18 [2-9] System Options— System Wireless—Out of Range Registration Feature Guide References 1.30.6.1 PS Roaming by Network ICD Group SVM—Recording Time Specifies the maximum length of a message recorded by the SVM feature. Value Range 1–600 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References 6.9 [4-1-7] Wired Extension—Simplified Voice Message 6.16 [4-2-5] Portable Station—Simplified Voice Message PC Programming Manual 419 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Feature Guide References 1.17.7 Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM) SVM—Dial Tone Continuous Time Specifies the length of time that dial tone 3 is heard after all messages stored by the SVM feature for an extension are finished playing. Value Range 1–60 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References 6.9 [4-1-7] Wired Extension—Simplified Voice Message 6.16 [4-2-5] Portable Station—Simplified Voice Message Feature Guide References 1.17.7 Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM) Broadcasting—Ring Duration Specifies the length of time that a broadcasting call will ring. The broadcasting call will be established with members who answer within this time. If no members answer the call before this timer expires, the call is cancelled. Value Range 0–120 s Maintenance Console Location 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Programming Manual References 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Broadcasting Operation 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—Miscellaneous— Broadcasting Operation 5.27 [3-10] Broadcasting Group Feature Guide References 1.16.1 Broadcasting 420 PC Programming Manual 4.6 [2-4] Week Table 4.6 [2-4] Week Table A specific time mode (day, night, lunch, or break) can be selected for operation depending on the time of day. The time mode can be switched either automatically or manually. Select the desired switching mode from the Time Service Switching Mode option. Time Table numbers correspond to tenant numbers (for example, Tenant 1 uses Time Table 1). Select the desired Time Table from the Time Table No. list. When in Automatic Switching mode, the time modes of the tenant are switched as programmed in the corresponding Time Table. Manual switching is possible only from an authorised extension (determined by COS). • To adjust the currently displayed Time Table, click and drag the divisions between two time periods. • To programme the time blocks of the currently displayed Time Table, including adding or deleting time blocks, click Time Setting. PC Programming Manual 421 4.7 [2-4] Week Table—Time Setting 4.7 [2-4] Week Table—Time Setting The start times of 4 different time blocks can be programmed for each day of the week, for the selected Time Table, as well as the start and end times of up to 3 break periods. 1. Day/Lunch/Night—Day1 Start, Lunch Start, Day2 Start, Night Start—Setting Enables the setting of the start time for each time block. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.7 [2-4] Week Table—Time Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.3 Tenant Service 2.2.4 Time Service 1. Day/Lunch/Night—Day1 Start, Lunch Start, Day2 Start, Night Start—Hour, Minute Specifies the start time for each time block. Times can only be set when Lunch Start, Day2 Start, Night Start—Setting is set to Enable. Value Range 00:00–23:59 Maintenance Console Location 4.7 [2-4] Week Table—Time Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.3 Tenant Service 2.2.4 Time Service 2. Break—Break 1–3 Start—Setting Enables the setting of the start time for each break period. 422 PC Programming Manual 1. Day/Lunch/Night—Day1 Start, 4.7 [2-4] Week Table—Time Setting Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.7 [2-4] Week Table—Time Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.3 Tenant Service 2.2.4 Time Service 2. Break—Break 1–3 Start—Hour, Minute Specifies the start time for each break period. Times can only be set when Setting is set to Enable. 2. Break—Break 1–3 Start— Value Range 00:00–23:59 Maintenance Console Location 4.7 [2-4] Week Table—Time Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.3 Tenant Service 2.2.4 Time Service 2. Break—Break 1–3 End—Hour, Minute Specifies the end time for each break period. Times can only be set when Setting is set to Enable. 2. Break—Break 1–3 Start— Value Range 00:00–23:59 Maintenance Console Location 4.7 [2-4] Week Table—Time Setting PC Programming Manual 423 4.7 [2-4] Week Table—Time Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.3 Tenant Service 2.2.4 Time Service 424 PC Programming Manual 4.8 [2-5] Holiday Table 4.8 [2-5] Holiday Table A specific time mode (day, night, lunch, or break) can be selected for operation during holidays. Select the desired time mode from the Holiday Mode list. The start and end dates of a maximum of 24 different holidays can be programmed. Holiday Table—Setting Enables the setting of the holiday. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.8 [2-5] Holiday Table Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.4 Time Service Holiday Table—Start Date—Month Specifies the month of the holiday start date. Value Range 1–12 Maintenance Console Location 4.8 [2-5] Holiday Table Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.4 Time Service Holiday Table—Start Date—Day Specifies the day of the holiday start date. Value Range 1–31 PC Programming Manual 425 4.8 [2-5] Holiday Table Maintenance Console Location 4.8 [2-5] Holiday Table Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.4 Time Service Holiday Table—End Date—Month Specifies the month of the holiday end date. Value Range 1–12 Maintenance Console Location 4.8 [2-5] Holiday Table Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.4 Time Service Holiday Table—End Date—Day Specifies the day of the holiday end date. Value Range 1–31 Maintenance Console Location 4.8 [2-5] Holiday Table Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.4 Time Service 426 PC Programming Manual 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Details of the extension numbering schemes, feature access numbers, numbers to access other PBXs in a network, and KX-T7710 One-touch Dialling numbers can be programmed here. For more information on flexible numbering, see "2.3.6 Flexible Numbering/Fixed Numbering" in the Feature Guide. Extension The leading numbers and the number of additional digits of the extension numbers for a maximum of 64 different extension numbering schemes can be programmed. Leading Number Specifies the leading number of extension numbers and floating extension numbers. Value Range Max. 3 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings 5.20 [3-7-2] VM(DPT) Group—Unit Settings 5.23 [3-8-2] VM(DTMF) Group—Group Settings 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings 7.4 [5-3-2] Voice Message—DISA Message 13.1 [11-1] Main Feature Guide References None No. of Additional Digits Specifies the number of additional digits following the leading number. Value Range None: 0 digit X: 1 digit XX: 2 digits Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main PC Programming Manual 427 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Features Feature numbers to access various PBX features can be programmed. The following features are available while hearing a dial tone. Operator Call Specifies the feature number used to call the operator. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 4.4 [2-2] Operator & BGM 8.6 [6-6] Tenant Feature Guide References 2.2.5 Operator Features Idle Line Access (Local Access) Specifies the feature number used to make a trunk call by Idle Line Access (selects an idle trunk automatically). Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 5.2 [3-1-2] Trunk Group—Local Access Priority Feature Guide References 1.5.5.3 Trunk Access 428 PC Programming Manual 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Trunk Group Access Specifies the feature number used to make a trunk call using an idle trunk from a certain trunk group. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings Feature Guide References None TIE Line Access Specifies the feature number used to make a TIE line call. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 11.1 [9-1] TIE Table Feature Guide References 1.30.1 TIE Line Service Redial Specifies the feature number used to redial the last number dialled. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 429 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Feature Guide References 1.6.1.4 Last Number Redial System Speed Dialling / Personal Speed Dialling Specifies the feature number used to make a call using a System/Personal Speed Dialling number. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 6.4 [4-1-3] Wired Extension—Speed Dial 8.1 [6-1] System Speed Dial Feature Guide References 1.6.1.5 Speed Dialling—Personal/System Personal Speed Dialling - Programming Specifies the feature number used to programme Personal Speed Dialling numbers at an extension. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.6.1.5 Speed Dialling—Personal/System Doorphone Call Specifies the feature number used to make a call to a doorphone. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) 430 PC Programming Manual 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 7.1 [5-1] Doorphone Feature Guide References 1.17.1 Doorphone Call Group Paging Specifies the feature number used to page a certain paging group. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 5.10 [3-4] Paging Group Feature Guide References 1.15.1 Paging External BGM On / Off Specifies the feature number, available for manager extensions, used to turn on or off the external BGM. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 4.4 [2-2] Operator & BGM 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—Programming & Manager— Manager Feature Guide References 1.17.4 Background Music (BGM) PC Programming Manual 431 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main OGM Record / Clear / Playback Specifies the feature number, available for manager extensions, used to record, clear, or play back a certain OGM. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 7.4 [5-3-2] Voice Message—DISA Message 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—Programming & Manager— Manager Feature Guide References 1.17.5 Outgoing Message (OGM) Single CO Line Access Specifies the feature number used to make a trunk call using a certain trunk. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings Feature Guide References 1.5.5.3 Trunk Access Parallel Telephone (Ring) Mode Set / Cancel Specifies the feature number used to set or cancel an SLT connected in parallel with a DPT to ring when receiving an incoming call. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main 432 PC Programming Manual 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.11.9 Parallelled Telephone Group Call Pickup Specifies the feature number used to answer a call ringing at a certain call pickup group. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 5.8 [3-3] Call Pickup Group Feature Guide References 1.4.1.3 Call Pickup Directed Call Pickup Specifies the feature number used to answer a call ringing at a certain extension. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 3— Call Pickup Deny 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 3— Call Pickup Deny Feature Guide References 1.4.1.3 Call Pickup TAFAS Answer Specifies the feature number used to answer a trunk call notified through an external pager. PC Programming Manual 433 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 7.2 [5-2] External Pager Feature Guide References 1.17.3 Trunk Answer From Any Station (TAFAS) Group Paging Answer Specifies the feature number used to answer a page to a paging group. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 5.10 [3-4] Paging Group Feature Guide References 1.15.1 Paging Automatic Callback Busy Cancel Specifies the feature number used to cancel Automatic Callback Busy. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None 434 PC Programming Manual 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Feature Guide References 1.8.1 Automatic Callback Busy (Camp-on) User Remote Operation / Walking COS / Verification Code Specifies the feature number used to change the COS of an extension temporarily, and also change the feature settings (for example, FWD, DND) of an extension from another extension or through DISA. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—Optional Device & Other Extensions— by Other Extension Remote Operation Feature Guide References 1.9.5 Walking COS 1.9.6 Verification Code Entry Wireless XDP Parallel Mode Set / Cancel Specifies the feature number used to set or cancel Wireless XDP Parallel mode. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—Optional Device & Other Extensions— Parallel Mode Set by PS Accept Wireless XDP Feature Guide References 1.25.5 Wireless XDP Parallel Mode Account Code Entry Specifies the feature number used to enter an Account Code. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) PC Programming Manual 435 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.5.4.3 Account Code Entry Call Hold / Call Hold Retrieve Specifies the feature number used to hold a call or retrieve a call on hold from the holding extension. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.13.1 Call Hold Call Hold Retrieve : Specified with a Holding Extension Number Specifies the feature number used to retrieve a held call from a different extension by specifying a holding extension number. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.13.1 Call Hold 436 PC Programming Manual 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Call Park / Call Park Retrieve Specifies the feature number used to hold a call in a parking zone or retrieve a call held in a parking zone. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.13.2 Call Park Hold Retrieve : Specified with a Held CO Line Number Specifies the feature number used to retrieve a held trunk call from a different extension by specifying the held trunk number. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.13.1 Call Hold Door Open Specifies the feature number used to open a door. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main PC Programming Manual 437 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 7.1 [5-1] Doorphone Feature Guide References 1.17.2 Door Open External Relay Access Specifies the feature number used to activate a relay. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 7.6 [5-4] External Relay Feature Guide References 1.17.10 External Relay Control External Feature Access Specifies the feature number used to access the features of a host PBX or the telephone company. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.11.7 External Feature Access (EFA) ISDN Hold Specifies the feature number used to hold a call using the ISDN service of the telephone company, instead of the PBX feature. 438 PC Programming Manual 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.6 Call Hold (HOLD)—by ISDN COLR Set / Cancel Specifies the feature number used to set or cancel COLR, which suppresses the presentation of the called party’s number to the caller. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—Supplementary Service— COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E, 3PTY 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—Supplementary Service— COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E, E911, 3PTY Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) 1.30.4.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) and Calling/Connected Name Identification Presentation (CNIP/CONP)—by QSIG CLIR Set / Cancel Specifies the feature number used to set or cancel CLIR, which suppresses the presentation of the caller’s number to the called party. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main PC Programming Manual 439 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—Supplementary Service— COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E, 3PTY 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—Supplementary Service— COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E, E911, 3PTY Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) 1.30.4.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) and Calling/Connected Name Identification Presentation (CNIP/CONP)—by QSIG Switch CLIP of CO Line / Extension Specifies the feature number used to send either the CLIP number of the trunk in use (subscriber’s number) or the extension to the network. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—ISDN CO— Subscriber Number 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—CO Setting— Subscriber Number 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—ISDN CLIP— CLIP ID 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—ISDN CLIP— CLIP ID Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) MCID Specifies the feature number used to ask the telephone company to trace a malicious call. This feature can be used during a call or while hearing a reorder tone after the caller hangs up. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None 440 PC Programming Manual 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Feature Guide References 1.21.1.9 Malicious Call Identification (MCID) ISDN-FWD (MSN) Set / Cancel / Confirm Specifies the feature number used to set or cancel the FWD of incoming ISDN calls to an outside party using the ISDN service of the telephone company (instead of the PBX), or confirm the FWD setting. Extension users can set the FWD destination to the network on an MSN basis. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.4 Call Forwarding (CF)—by ISDN (P-MP) 1.21.1.5 Call Forwarding (CF)—by ISDN (P-P) Message Waiting Set / Cancel / Call Back Specifies the feature number used to set or cancel Message Waiting, or call back the caller. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.19.1 Message Waiting FWD/DND Set / Cancel: Call from CO & Extension Specifies the feature number used to set or cancel FWD/DND for incoming trunk and intercom calls. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) PC Programming Manual 441 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Feature Guide References 1.3.1 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND) FWD/DND Set / Cancel: Call from CO Specifies the feature number used to set or cancel FWD/DND for incoming trunk calls. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Feature Guide References 1.3.1 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND) FWD/DND Set / Cancel: Call from Extension Specifies the feature number used to set or cancel FWD/DND for incoming intercom calls. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Feature Guide References 1.3.1 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND) 442 PC Programming Manual 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main FWD No Answer Timer Set Specifies the feature number used to set the length of time before a call is forwarded. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) Group FWD Set / Cancel: Call from CO & Extension Specifies the feature number used to set or cancel FWD for incoming trunk and intercom calls to an incoming call distribution group. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Feature Guide References 1.3 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND) Features 1.3.1.1 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND)—SUMMARY Group FWD Set / Cancel: Call from CO Specifies the feature number used to set or cancel FWD for incoming trunk calls to an incoming call distribution group. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main PC Programming Manual 443 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Feature Guide References 1.3 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND) Features 1.3.1.1 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND)—SUMMARY Group FWD Set / Cancel: Call from Extension Specifies the feature number used to set or cancel FWD for incoming intercom calls to an incoming call distribution group. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Feature Guide References 1.3 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND) Features 1.3.1.1 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND)—SUMMARY Call Pickup Deny Set / Cancel Specifies the feature number used to set or cancel Call Pickup Deny (i.e., preventing other extensions from picking up calls to your extension). Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.4.1.3 Call Pickup 444 PC Programming Manual 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Paging Deny Set / Cancel Specifies the feature number used to set or cancel Paging Deny (i.e., preventing other extensions from paging your extension). Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 5.10 [3-4] Paging Group Feature Guide References 1.15.1 Paging Walking Extension Specifies the feature number used to use the same extension settings at a new extension. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.28.3 Walking Extension Features Data Line Security Set / Cancel Specifies the feature number used to set or cancel Data Line Security (i.e., preventing signals from other extensions during data transmission). Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main PC Programming Manual 445 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.11.5 Data Line Security Manual Call Waiting for Extension Call Specifies the feature number used to set or change the method of receiving a Call Waiting notification from an extension. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.3.3 Call Waiting Automatic Call Waiting Specifies the feature number used to set or cancel a Call Waiting notification from a trunk, doorphone, or a call via an incoming call distribution group. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.3.3 Call Waiting Executive Override Deny Set / Cancel Specifies the feature number used to set or cancel Executive Busy Override (i.e., preventing other extensions from joining your conversation). 446 PC Programming Manual 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—Extension Feature— Executive Busy Override 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—Programming & Manager— Executive Busy Override Deny Feature Guide References 1.8.2 Executive Busy Override Not Ready (Manual Wrap-up) Mode On / Off Specifies the feature number used to enter or leave Not Ready mode. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Feature Guide References 1.2.2.7 Log-in/Log-out Log-in / Log-out Specifies the feature number used to join or leave an incoming call distribution group. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings PC Programming Manual 447 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Feature Guide References 1.2.2.7 Log-in/Log-out Incoming Call Queue Monitor Specifies the feature number, available only for extensions assigned as a supervisor, used to monitor the status of an incoming call distribution group with the extension display. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Miscellaneous— Number Supervisor Extension Feature Guide References 1.2.2.8 Supervisory Feature Hot Line (Pickup Dial) Program Set / Cancel Specifies the feature number used to set/cancel the Hot Line feature, or programme the number to be automatically dialled. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone— Dial—Hot Line (Pickup Dial) Start Feature Guide References 1.6.1.7 Hot Line Absent Message Set / Cancel Specifies the feature number used to set or cancel the display of an Absent Message. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) 448 PC Programming Manual 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.19.2 Absent Message BGM Set / Cancel Specifies the feature number used to set or cancel the BGM heard through the telephone speaker while on-hook. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 4.4 [2-2] Operator & BGM Feature Guide References 1.17.4 Background Music (BGM) Remote Timed Reminder (Remote Wakeup Call) Specifies the feature number used to set or cancel a Timed Reminder remotely (Wake-up Call). Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.28.4 Timed Reminder PC Programming Manual 449 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Timed Reminder Set / Cancel Specifies the feature number used to set or cancel a Timed Reminder. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.28.4 Timed Reminder Printing Message Specifies the feature number used to select a Printing Message to be output on SMDR. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge—Main— SMDR for External Hotel Application 2—Printing Message 1–8 Feature Guide References 1.26.2 Printing Message Extension Dial Lock Set / Cancel Specifies the feature number used to lock or unlock an extension to make certain trunk calls and change the forwarding destination, using the Extension Dial Lock feature. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main 450 PC Programming Manual 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.9.3 Extension Dial Lock Time Service (Day / Lunch / Break / Night) Switch Specifies the feature number, available for manager extensions, used to change the time mode manually. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—Programming & Manager— 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—Programming & Manager— Time Service Switch Manager Feature Guide References 2.2.4 Time Service Remote Extension Dial Lock Off Specifies the feature number, available for manager extensions, used to unlock other extensions using the Extension Dial Lock feature. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—Programming & Manager— Manager Feature Guide References 1.9.3 Extension Dial Lock Remote Extension Dial Lock On Specifies the feature number, available for manager extensions, used to lock other extensions using the Extension Dial Lock feature. PC Programming Manual 451 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—Programming & Manager— Manager Feature Guide References 1.9.3 Extension Dial Lock Extension Feature Clear Specifies the feature number used to reset certain features of an extension to the default values. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.28.2 Extension Feature Clear Extension PIN Set / Cancel Specifies the feature number used to set a PIN for an extension. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None 452 PC Programming Manual 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Feature Guide References 1.28.1 Extension Personal Identification Number (PIN) Dial Information (CTI) Specifies the feature number used to send dial information to the CTI feature instead of the PBX. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.32.1 Computer Telephony Integration (CTI) Broadcasting Operation Specifies the feature number used to make a broadcasting call. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Miscellaneous— Broadcasting—Ring Duration 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—Miscellaneous— Broadcasting Operation 5.27 [3-10] Broadcasting Group Feature Guide References 1.16.1 Broadcasting Centralised BLF Monitor Cancel Specifies the feature number used to cancel monitoring of an extension using an NDSS button. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) PC Programming Manual 453 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 11.1 [9-1] TIE Table Feature Guide References 1.30.5.1 Network Direct Station Selection (NDSS) Busy Out Cancel Specifies the feature number used to cancel the Busy Out status of an analogue trunk. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 5— Busy Out—Busy Out for Analogue CO Feature Guide References 1.5.4.6 Trunk Busy Out Simplified Voice Message Access Specifies the feature number used to access the SVM feature to record, listen to and delete messages. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 6.9 [4-1-7] Wired Extension—Simplified Voice Message 6.16 [4-2-5] Portable Station—Simplified Voice Message Feature Guide References 1.17.7 Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM) 454 PC Programming Manual 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Other PBX Extension Other PBX extension numbers can be used to easily call extensions connected to PBXs at different locations in a TIE line network. The leading numbers of all PBXs in the network that will be called should be entered in this table. A maximum of 16 leading numbers can be programmed. Dial Specifies the leading extension number of the other PBX. Value Range Max. 3 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 11.1 [9-1] TIE Table— Leading Number Feature Guide References 1.30.1 TIE Line Service KX-T7710 The settings of the MESSAGE button and One-touch buttons on the KX-T7710 can be programmed. Dial Indicates the DTMF tone dial required by the PBX to recognise it and dial the preprogrammed number for each button (reference only). Value Range B: For MESSAGE button A1: For One-touch button 1 A2: For One-touch button 2 A3: For One-touch button 3 A4: For One-touch button 4 A5: For One-touch button 5 A6: For One-touch button 6 A7: For One-touch button 7 A8: For One-touch button 8 Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 455 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Feature Guide References 1.6.1.3 KX-T7710 One-touch Dialling Message Key—Phone Number Specifies the feature number or telephone number dialled when the MESSAGE button on the KX-T7710 is pressed. By default, this is set to the feature number used to call back a caller who left a message waiting indication, Message Waiting Set / Cancel / Call Back. This is available only when the position of the Mode switch lever on the KX-T7710 is set to "PBX". Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash]) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Message Waiting Set / Cancel / Call Back Feature Guide References 1.6.1.3 KX-T7710 One-touch Dialling One-touch Dial 01–08—Phone Number Specifies the number dialled when a one-touch button on the KX-T7710 is pressed. This is available only when the position of the Mode switch lever on the KX-T7710 is set to "PBX". Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash]) Maintenance Console Location 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.6.1.3 KX-T7710 One-touch Dialling 456 PC Programming Manual 4.10 [2-6-2] Numbering Plan—Quick Dial 4.10 [2-6-2] Numbering Plan—Quick Dial Quick Dialling numbers are used to call extensions or outside parties, or access certain features without having to dial their full numbers. It is possible to register Quick Dialling numbers that overlap with other registered numbers (refer to "Automatic Rerouting of VoIP Calls to Public Trunks" in the Feature Guide). A maximum of 80 Quick Dialling numbers can be programmed in Basic Memory, and a maximum of 4000 Quick Dialling numbers can be programmed in Expansion. To display other sets of numbers, click the applicable tab. For more information on flexible numbering, see "2.3.6 Flexible Numbering/Fixed Numbering" in the Feature Guide. Use quick dial for rerouting to public CO when TIE line does not work Specifies whether to check if the quick dial numbering plan is compatible (does not overlap) with the main numbering plan. Value Range Disable: Checks whether the quick dial numbering plan is compatible with the main numbering plan. Enable: Does not check whether the quick dial numbering plan is compatible with the main numbering plan. Maintenance Console Location 4.10 [2-6-2] Numbering Plan—Quick Dial Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.6.1.6 Quick Dialling 1.30.2 Voice over Internet Protocol (VoIP) Network 2.3.6 Flexible Numbering/Fixed Numbering Dial Specifies the Quick Dialling number. Value Range Basic Memory: Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Expand 1–4000: Max. 8 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 4.10 [2-6-2] Numbering Plan—Quick Dial Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 457 4.10 [2-6-2] Numbering Plan—Quick Dial Feature Guide References 1.6.1.6 Quick Dialling 1.30.2 Voice over Internet Protocol (VoIP) Network 2.3.6 Flexible Numbering/Fixed Numbering Phone Number Specifies the number to be dialled when the corresponding Quick Dialling number is used. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash]) Maintenance Console Location 4.10 [2-6-2] Numbering Plan—Quick Dial Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.6.1.6 Quick Dialling 1.30.2 Voice over Internet Protocol (VoIP) Network 2.3.6 Flexible Numbering/Fixed Numbering 458 PC Programming Manual 4.11 [2-6-3] Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature 4.11 [2-6-3] Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature Feature numbers used to access various PBX features can be programmed. The following features are available while hearing a busy, DND, or ringback tone. Each feature must have a unique feature number. For more information on flexible numbering, see "2.3.6 Flexible Numbering/Fixed Numbering" in the Feature Guide. BSS / OHCA / Whisper OHCA / DND Override Specifies the feature number used to notify a busy extension of a second call by Call Waiting, or call an extension in DND mode. Value Range 1 digit (0–9, *, or #) Maintenance Console Location 4.11 [2-6-3] Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 2— Manual C. Waiting for Extension Call 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 2— Manual C. Waiting for Extension Call Feature Guide References 1.1.3.3 1.3.1.3 1.8.4.2 1.8.4.3 1.8.4.4 Call Waiting Do Not Disturb (DND) Call Waiting Tone Off-hook Call Announcement (OHCA) Whisper OHCA Executive Busy Override Specifies the feature number used to interrupt an existing call to establish a three-party conference call. Value Range 1 digit (0–9, *, or #) Maintenance Console Location 4.11 [2-6-3] Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature Programming Manual References 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—Extension Feature— Executive Busy Override 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 3— Executive Override Deny 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 3— Executive Override Deny Feature Guide References 1.8.2 Executive Busy Override PC Programming Manual 459 4.11 [2-6-3] Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature Alternate Calling - Ring / Voice Specifies the feature number used to allow a caller to change the called extension’s preset call receiving method to ring tone or voice. Value Range 1 digit (0–9, *, or #) Maintenance Console Location 4.11 [2-6-3] Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.5.3 Intercom Call Message Waiting Set Specifies the feature number used to leave a Message Waiting notification. Value Range 1 digit (0–9, *, or #) Maintenance Console Location 4.11 [2-6-3] Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.19.1 Message Waiting Call Monitor Specifies the feature number used to listen to a busy extension’s conversation. Value Range 1 digit (0–9, *, or #) Maintenance Console Location 4.11 [2-6-3] Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature 460 PC Programming Manual 4.11 [2-6-3] Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature Programming Manual References 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—Extension Feature— Call Monitor 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 3— Executive Override Deny 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 3— Executive Override Deny Feature Guide References 1.8.3 Call Monitor Automatic Callback Busy Specifies the feature number used to reserve a busy line and receive callback ringing when the line becomes idle. Value Range 1 digit (0–9, *, or #) Maintenance Console Location 4.11 [2-6-3] Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.8.1 Automatic Callback Busy (Camp-on) BSS / OHCA / Whisper OHCA / DND Override-2 Specifies the feature number used to notify a busy extension of a second call by Call Waiting, or call an extension in DND mode. This is the same setting as BSS / OHCA / Whisper OHCA / DND Override on this screen, and can be used to provide two methods of activating the specified features. This can be useful, for example, if users prefer to use a separate feature number to activate DND Override. Value Range 1 digit (0–9, *, or #) Maintenance Console Location 4.11 [2-6-3] Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 2— Manual C. Waiting for Extension Call 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 2— Manual C. Waiting for Extension Call Feature Guide References 1.1.3.3 Call Waiting 1.3.1.3 Do Not Disturb (DND) PC Programming Manual 461 4.11 [2-6-3] Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature 1.8.4.2 Call Waiting Tone 1.8.4.3 Off-hook Call Announcement (OHCA) 1.8.4.4 Whisper OHCA 462 PC Programming Manual 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Each extension, doorphone port, incoming call distribution group, and trunk group is assigned a Class of Service (COS). Certain features can be programmed to behave differently depending on the COS. A maximum of 64 COS levels can be programmed. TRS Restrictions to features related to making trunk calls can be programmed for each COS. COS Name Specifies the name of the COS. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.1 Class of Service (COS) TRS Level—Day, Lunch, Break, Night Specifies the Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) level for making trunk calls in each time mode. Value Range 1: Allows all trunk calls 2–6: Restricts trunk calls according to the combination of the Denied and Exception Code Tables 7: Restricts all trunk calls Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References 4.6 [2-4] Week Table 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings—Main— COS 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Main— 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— COS 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— COS 7.1 [5-1] Doorphone— COS 9.1 [7-1] Denied Code 9.2 [7-2] Exception Code COS PC Programming Manual 463 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Feature Guide References 1.9.1 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) TRS Level on Extension Lock Specifies the TRS/Barring level for making trunk calls when an extension is locked using the Extension Dial Lock feature. Value Range 1: Allows all trunk calls 2–6: Restricts trunk calls according to the combination of the Denied and Exception Code Tables 7: Restricts all trunk calls Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— COS 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— COS 9.1 [7-1] Denied Code 9.2 [7-2] Exception Code Feature Guide References 1.9.3 Extension Dial Lock TRS Level for System Speed Dialling Specifies the TRS/Barring level for making a trunk call using System Speed Dialling numbers, which overrides the TRS/Barring set for the current time mode. Value Range 1: Allows all trunk calls 2–6: Restricts trunk calls according to the combination of the Denied and Exception Code Tables 7: Restricts all trunk calls Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— COS 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— COS 8.1 [6-1] System Speed Dial 9.5 [7-5] Miscellaneous— TRS Override by System Speed Dialling Feature Guide References 1.6.1.5 Speed Dialling—Personal/System 464 PC Programming Manual 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings 1.9.1 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) CO & SMDR COS Name Specifies the name of the COS. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.1 Class of Service (COS) Extension-CO Line Call Duration Limit Enables the extension-to-trunk call duration feature. The maximum call duration can be set using Extension-CO Duration Time on 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 2— Extension - CO Call Limitation—For Incoming Call 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings—Main— COS 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— COS 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— COS Feature Guide References 1.11.8 Trunk Call Limitation Transfer to CO Enables the transferring of calls to trunks. Value Range Disable, Enable PC Programming Manual 465 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— COS 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— COS Feature Guide References 1.12.1 Call Transfer Call Forward to CO Enables the forwarding of calls to trunks. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— COS 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— COS 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) Account Code Mode Specifies whether the entry of an account code is optional or mandatory when making a trunk call. Value Range Option, Forced Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— COS 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— COS 466 PC Programming Manual 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Feature Guide References 1.5.4.3 Account Code Entry CF (MSN) Enables forwarding of ISDN calls to an outside party using the ISDN service of the telephone company, instead of the PBX, on an MSN basis. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.4 Call Forwarding (CF)—by ISDN (P-MP) 1.21.1.5 Call Forwarding (CF)—by ISDN (P-P) Outgoing CO Call Printout (SMDR) Enables the automatic recording of information about outgoing trunk calls on SMDR. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— COS 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— COS 13.1 [11-1] Main Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) Extension Feature The use of features related to extension operations can be programmed for each COS. PC Programming Manual 467 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings COS Name Specifies the name of the COS. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.1 Class of Service (COS) Executive Busy Override Enables interrupting an existing call to establish a three-party conference call. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— COS 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— COS Feature Guide References 1.8.2 Executive Busy Override DND Override Enables making a call to an extension in DND mode by entering the feature number. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings 468 PC Programming Manual 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— COS 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— COS 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Feature Guide References 1.3.1.3 Do Not Disturb (DND) OHCA / Whisper OHCA Enables using OHCA/Whisper OHCA as a method of second call notification by entering the feature number. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— COS 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— COS Feature Guide References 1.8.4 Second Call Notification to Busy Extension 1.8.4.3 Off-hook Call Announcement (OHCA) 1.8.4.4 Whisper OHCA Call Monitor Enables listening to a busy extension’s conversation. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— COS 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— COS Feature Guide References 1.8.3 Call Monitor PC Programming Manual 469 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Call Pickup by DSS Enables using a DSS button to pick up a call to a specified extension. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— COS 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— COS 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Feature Guide References 1.4.1.3 Call Pickup Programming & Manager COS Name Specifies the name of the COS. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.1 Class of Service (COS) Executive Busy Override Deny Enables preventing other extensions from interrupting calls. Value Range Disable, Enable 470 PC Programming Manual 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— COS 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— COS Feature Guide References 2.2.1 Class of Service (COS) Group Forward Set Enables setting call forwarding for calls to an incoming call distribution group. Value Range Disable: An extension cannot set call forwarding for any group. Enable-All: An extension can set call forwarding for all groups. Enable-Group: An extension can only set call forwarding for the group to which the extension belongs. Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References 5.14 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Member List 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— COS 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— COS Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) Programming Mode Level Specifies the level of authorisation for performing PT programming. Value Range Disable: A PT user cannot perform any programming. PROG Only: A PT user can perform only personal programming. PROG and PROG **/*#: A PT user can perform both personal and system programming. Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— COS 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— COS PC Programming Manual 471 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Feature Guide References 2.3.2 PT Programming Manager Specifies the authorisation to use manager features. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— COS 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— COS Feature Guide References 2.2.6 Manager Features Time Service Switch Enables manual switching of time modes. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References 4.6 [2-4] Week Table 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— COS 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— COS Feature Guide References 2.2.4 Time Service PDN/SDN An SDN button allows a PT user to see the current status of the corresponding PDN extension, and to pick up or transfer calls to that extension easily. The settings here control how SDN buttons operate for extensions at each COS level. 472 PC Programming Manual 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings COS Name Specifies the name of the COS. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.1 Class of Service (COS) SDN Key Mode Selects what happens when an extension user presses an SDN button while on hook. Value Range Enhanced DSS: The registered (owner) extension is called. Standard SDN: A dial tone is heard. Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.7.1 Primary Directory Number (PDN)/Secondary Directory Number (SDN) Extension Making call by COS of SDN key’s owner Selects whether an extension that uses an SDN button to make calls is given the COS of the SDN button’s registered (owner) extension. This setting is only available when SDN Key Mode above is set to "Standard SDN". Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings PC Programming Manual 473 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—PDN/SDN— COS Name Feature Guide References 1.7.1 Primary Directory Number (PDN)/Secondary Directory Number (SDN) Extension SDN Key Assignment by PT Program Selects whether PT users can create SDN buttons on their own extensions using PT programming. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.7.1 Primary Directory Number (PDN)/Secondary Directory Number (SDN) Extension Optional Device & Other Extensions COS Name Specifies the name of the COS. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.1 Class of Service (COS) Door Unlock Enables using the door opener feature. 474 PC Programming Manual 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— COS 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— COS Feature Guide References 1.17.2 Door Open External Relay Access Enables access to external relays. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References 7.6 [5-4] External Relay Feature Guide References 1.17.10 External Relay Control Accept the Call from DISA Enables reception of calls from DISA. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— COS 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— COS 7.4 [5-3-2] Voice Message—DISA Message PC Programming Manual 475 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Feature Guide References 1.17.6 Direct Inward System Access (DISA) Remote Operation by Other Extension Allows the Walking COS feature to be used from a remote location (inside the PBX, or outside the PBX using DISA). Value Range Allow, Deny Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— COS 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— COS Feature Guide References 1.9.5 Walking COS Accept Wireless XDP Parallel Mode Set by PS Allows Wireless XDP Parallel Mode to be set by a PS. Value Range Allow, Deny Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— Feature Guide References 1.25.5 Wireless XDP Parallel Mode Miscellaneous COS Name Specifies the name of the COS. Value Range Max. 20 characters 476 PC Programming Manual COS 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.1 Class of Service (COS) Broadcasting Operation Enables making broadcasting calls. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Miscellaneous— Broadcasting—Ring Duration 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Broadcasting Operation 5.27 [3-10] Broadcasting Group Feature Guide References 1.16.1 Broadcasting Accept a collect call (for Brazil) Enables accepting collect calls. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 477 4.13 [2-7-2] Class of Service—External Call Block 4.13 [2-7-2] Class of Service—External Call Block Each COS can have different trunk groups available for making trunk calls, depending on the time mode (day/ lunch/break/night). Select the desired time mode from the list. Outgoing Trunk Group 1–64 Specifies the available trunk groups. Value Range Block (blue), Non Block Maintenance Console Location 4.13 [2-7-2] Class of Service—External Call Block Programming Manual References 4.6 [2-4] Week Table 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings Feature Guide References 1.5.5.3 Trunk Access 478 PC Programming Manual 4.14 [2-7-3] Class of Service—Internal Call Block 4.14 [2-7-3] Class of Service—Internal Call Block Internal Call Block determines the restrictions placed on making intercom calls. The extensions, incoming call distribution groups, and doorphones belonging to a certain COS can be programmed to not receive intercom calls from those belonging to a certain COS. COS Number of the Extension Which Receive the Call from Other Extension 1– 64 Specifies the combinations of COS levels for which intercom calls are blocked. Value Range Block (blue), Non Block Maintenance Console Location 4.14 [2-7-3] Class of Service—Internal Call Block Programming Manual References 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Main— 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— COS 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— COS 7.1 [5-1] Doorphone— COS COS Feature Guide References 1.1.2.2 Internal Call Block PC Programming Manual 479 4.15 [2-8-1] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from CO 4.15 [2-8-1] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from CO Different ring tone patterns can be selected for incoming trunk calls depending on the trunk group that the calls are received on. A maximum of 8 Ring Tone Pattern Tables can be programmed, and any pattern table can be selected for use by an extension. Ring Tone Pattern Plan 1–8 Specifies the ring tone pattern for incoming trunk calls. Value Range Single, Double, Triple, Option1, Option2 Maintenance Console Location 4.15 [2-8-1] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from CO Programming Manual References 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings— Trunk Group Number 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 1— Ring Pattern Table 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 1— Ring Pattern Table Feature Guide References 1.1.3.2 Ring Tone Pattern Selection 480 PC Programming Manual 4.16 [2-8-2] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from Doorphone 4.16 [2-8-2] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from Doorphone Different ring tone patterns can be selected for incoming doorphone calls depending on the doorphone port that the calls originate from. A maximum of 8 Ring Tone Pattern Tables can be programmed, and any pattern table can be selected for use by an extension. Ring Tone Pattern Plan 1–8 Specifies the ring tone pattern for incoming doorphone calls. Value Range Single, Double, Triple, S-Double, Option 1, Option 2 Maintenance Console Location 4.16 [2-8-2] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from Doorphone Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 1— Ring Pattern Table 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 1— Ring Pattern Table 7.1 [5-1] Doorphone Feature Guide References 1.1.3.2 Ring Tone Pattern Selection 1.17.1 Doorphone Call PC Programming Manual 481 4.17 [2-8-3] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from Others 4.17 [2-8-3] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from Others Different ring tone patterns can be selected for incoming intercom calls and ringing triggered by certain PBX features (Timed Reminder, Call Back, and Live Call Screening). A maximum of 8 Ring Tone Pattern Tables can be programmed, and any pattern table can be selected for use by an extension. For more information on ring tone patterns, see "1.1.3.2 Ring Tone Pattern Selection" in the Feature Guide. Extension—Ring Tone Pattern Plan 1–8 Specifies the ring tone pattern for incoming intercom calls. Value Range Single, Double, Triple, Option 1, Option 2 Maintenance Console Location 4.17 [2-8-3] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from Others Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 1— Ring Pattern Table 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 1— Ring Pattern Table Feature Guide References None Timed Reminder—Ring Tone Pattern Plan 1–8 Specifies the ring tone pattern for Timed Reminder alarms. Value Range Single, Double, Triple, Option 1, Option 2 Maintenance Console Location 4.17 [2-8-3] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from Others Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 1— Ring Pattern Table 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 1— Ring Pattern Table Feature Guide References None Call Back—Ring Tone Pattern Plan 1–8 Specifies the ring tone pattern for callback ringing by Automatic Callback Busy. 482 PC Programming Manual 4.17 [2-8-3] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from Others Value Range Single, Double, Triple, S-Double, Option 1, Option 2 Maintenance Console Location 4.17 [2-8-3] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from Others Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 1— Ring Pattern Table 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 1— Ring Pattern Table Feature Guide References None Live Call Screening—Ring Tone Pattern Plan 1–8 Specifies the ring tone pattern for LCS warning tones. Value Range Single, Double, Triple, Option 1, Option 2 Maintenance Console Location 4.17 [2-8-3] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from Others Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 1— Ring Pattern Table 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 1— Ring Pattern Table Feature Guide References None External Sensor—Ring Tone Pattern Plan 1–8 Specifies the ring tone pattern for calls from an external sensor. Value Range Single, Double, Triple, Option 1, Option 2 Maintenance Console Location 4.17 [2-8-3] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from Others Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 1— Ring Pattern Table 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 1— Ring Pattern Table PC Programming Manual 483 4.17 [2-8-3] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from Others Feature Guide References None 484 PC Programming Manual 4.18 [2-9] System Options 4.18 [2-9] System Options Various system settings can be programmed. Option 1 PT LCD—Date Display Selects the order that the month and date are shown on the displays of extensions. Value Range Date-Month, Month-Date Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PT LCD—Time Display Selects the time format shown on the displays of extensions. The time display format assigned here applies when setting the Timed Reminder feature. Value Range 12H, 24H Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.28.4 Timed Reminder PT LCD—Password / PIN Display Selects whether passwords and PINs (Personal Identification Number) are hidden or shown on the displays of extensions while being entered. Value Range Hide, Display PC Programming Manual 485 4.18 [2-9] System Options Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.28.1 Extension Personal Identification Number (PIN) PT Fwd / DND—Fwd LED Selects the light pattern of the FWD/DND button while the FWD feature is activated. Value Range On (Solid): Red on Flash: Slow red flashing Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Feature Guide References 1.3 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND) Features 1.20.3 LED Indication PT Fwd / DND—DND LED Selects the light pattern of the FWD/DND button while the DND feature is activated. Value Range On (Solid): Red on Flash: Slow red flashing Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND 486 PC Programming Manual 4.18 [2-9] System Options Feature Guide References 1.3 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND) Features 1.20.3 LED Indication PT Fwd / DND—Fwd/DND key mode when Idle Selects the function of the FWD/DND button (fixed button) when it is pressed in idle status. (A FWD/DND button customised on a flexible button is always in FWD/DND Cycle Switch mode, and the mode cannot be changed.) Value Range FWD/DND Setting Mode: Enter programming mode for the FWD/DND setting. FWD/DND Cycle Switch: Switch the FWD on/DND on/Off mode instead of entering the programming mode for the FWD/DND setting. (When there are separate FWD/DND settings for calls from trunks and calls from extensions, mode switching cannot be performed.) Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Feature Guide References 1.3 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND) Features PT Fwd / DND—Paging to DND Extension Specifies whether extensions can receive paging when in DND mode. Value Range Do Not Page, Page Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND 5.10 [3-4] Paging Group Feature Guide References 1.15.1 Paging PC Programming Manual 487 4.18 [2-9] System Options PT Operation—Off Hook Monitor for KX-T74xx/T75xx/T76xx Enables the use of Off-Hook Monitor with KX-T7400, KX-T7500, KX-T7600, or KX-DT300 series telephones and IP-PTs. Value Range Disable: The PT user’s voice is sent through the handsfree microphone. The other party’s voice is heard through the hands-free speaker. Enable: The PT user’s voice is sent through the handset microphone. The other party’s voice is heard through both the hands-free speaker and the handset. Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.11.2 Off-hook Monitor PT Operation—Privacy Release by SCO key Selects the function of the S-CO button during a trunk call. Value Range Enable: Pressing the S-CO button activates the Privacy Release feature Disable: Pressing the S-CO button switches the information shown on the PT display. Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.14.1.3 Privacy Release PT Operation—JOG Dial Speed Selects the speed at which items scroll on the display when the Jog Dial is used. Value Range Normal, High Speed Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options 488 PC Programming Manual 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PT Operation—PT Ring Off Setting Specifies whether incoming call ringing can be turned off at individual extensions. If disabled, users cannot prevent incoming calls from ringing. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.3.2 Ring Tone Pattern Selection PT Operation—Automatic Answer for Call from CO after Specifies the number of times a PT in Hands-free Answerback mode will ring before a conversation is established automatically when it receives a call from a trunk. Value Range No Ring, 1 Ring, 2 Rings, 3 Rings Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.4.1.4 Hands-free Answerback PT Operation—Automatic Hold by ICM / CO / ICD Group key Selects whether calls are disconnected or held when an INTERCOM, PDN, CO, or ICD Group button is pressed while having a conversation. PC Programming Manual 489 4.18 [2-9] System Options Value Range Disable (Disconnect), Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Feature Guide References 1.13.1 Call Hold PT Operation—Hold Key Mode Selects which extensions can retrieve a held call or a call that is transferred by Call Transfer without Announcement feature. Value Range Hold: Any extension can retrieve a held call. Exclusive Hold: Only the holding extension can retrieve a held call. Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.13.1 Call Hold Option 2 Extension Clear—Call Waiting Specifies whether the Call Waiting setting is cleared when Extension Feature Clear is performed. Value Range Clear, Do not clear Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options 490 PC Programming Manual 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.28.2 Extension Feature Clear Extension Clear—Fwd/DND Specifies whether the FWD/DND setting is cleared when Extension Feature Clear is performed. Value Range Clear, Do not clear Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.28.2 Extension Feature Clear Extension Clear—Hot Line (Pickup Dial) Specifies whether the Hot Line setting is cleared when Extension Feature Clear is performed. Value Range Clear, Do not clear Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.28.2 Extension Feature Clear CODEC—System CODEC Selects the codec type for DPTs and PSs. Value Range A-Law, µ-Law PC Programming Manual 491 4.18 [2-9] System Options Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None CODEC—Network CODEC Selects the codec type for ISDN or T1/E1 lines. Value Range A-Law, µ-Law Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN en Bloc Dial—[#] as End of Dial for en Bloc mode Specifies whether to automatically send "#" as an end code when dialling to an ISDN line; if used as the end code, "#" will not be dialled out as part of a number even when the "#" key is pressed. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—ISDN CO— ISDN Outgoing Call Type 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—CO Setting— ISDN Outgoing Call Type Feature Guide References 1.21.1.1 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN)—SUMMARY 492 PC Programming Manual 4.18 [2-9] System Options Redial—Automatic Redial when No Answer (ISDN) Selects whether Automatic Redial to an ISDN line is performed when the called party does not answer within a preprogrammed time period. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters— Automatic Redial—Redial Call Ring Duration Feature Guide References 1.6.1.4 Last Number Redial Redial—Automatic Redial for Analogue CO Selects whether Automatic Redial to an analogue CO line is performed when the called party does not answer within a preprogrammed time period. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters— Automatic Redial—Redial Call Ring Duration Feature Guide References 1.6.1.4 Last Number Redial Redial—Save Dial After Connection to Redial Memory Specifies whether any digits dialled after the called party answers (for example, to access a specific extension within another company) are also saved as part of the redial number. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options PC Programming Manual 493 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.6.1.4 Last Number Redial Redial—Call Log by Redial key Enables display of the Outgoing Call Log on a DPT by pressing the REDIAL button while on hook. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.6.1.4 Last Number Redial Extension - CO Call Limitation—For Incoming Call Selects whether the time limit for extension-to-trunk calls applies to outgoing calls only or for both outgoing and incoming calls. COS determines the use of this feature, and the length of the time limit can be assigned on a trunk group basis. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—CO & SMDR— Extension-CO Line Call Duration Limit 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings—Main— Extension-CO Duration Time Feature Guide References 1.11.8 Trunk Call Limitation 494 PC Programming Manual 4.18 [2-9] System Options Option 3 Confirmation Tone—Tone 1 : Called by Voice Enables the PBX to send Confirmation Tone 1. Confirmation Tone 1 is heard from a PT when it receives a call in voice-calling mode. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.1 Doorphone Call 1.29.2 Confirmation Tone Confirmation Tone—Tone 2 : Paged / Automatic Answer Enables the PBX to send Confirmation Tone 2. Confirmation Tone 2 is heard from a PT when it receives a call in Hands-free Answerback mode, or paging. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.4.1.4 Hands-free Answerback 1.15.1 Paging 1.29.2 Confirmation Tone Confirmation Tone—Tone 3-1 : Start Talking after Making Call / Call from Doorphone Enables the PBX to send Confirmation Tone 3-1. Confirmation Tone 3-1 is heard from an extension when, for example, it pages another extension, or from a doorphone when the doorphone button is pressed. Value Range Disable, Enable PC Programming Manual 495 4.18 [2-9] System Options Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.29.2 Confirmation Tone Confirmation Tone—Tone 3-2 : Start Talking after Answering Call Enables the PBX to send Confirmation Tone 3-2. Confirmation Tone 3-2 is heard from an extension when answering a call by, for example, the Call Pickup feature. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.29.2 Confirmation Tone Confirmation Tone—Tone 4-1 : Start Conference Enables the PBX to send Confirmation Tone 4-1. Confirmation Tone 4-1 is heard from an extension when a new party joins a conference call. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.14.1.2 Conference 1.29.2 Confirmation Tone 496 PC Programming Manual 4.18 [2-9] System Options Confirmation Tone—Tone 4-2 : Finish Conference Enables the PBX to send Confirmation Tone 4-2. Confirmation Tone 4-2 is heard from an extension when a party leaves a conference call. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.14.1.2 Conference 1.29.2 Confirmation Tone Confirmation Tone—Tone 5 : Hold Enables the PBX to send Confirmation Tone 5. Confirmation Tone 5 is heard from an extension when it holds a call. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.29.2 Confirmation Tone Dial Tone—Distinctive Dial Tone Enables the PBX to send dial tones at different frequencies depending on the setting of the extension. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options PC Programming Manual 497 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.29.1 Dial Tone Dial Tone—Dial Tone for Extension Selects the dial tone the PBX sends to extensions to inform about the features activated on them. Value Range Type A, Type B Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.29.1 Dial Tone Dial Tone—Dial Tone for ARS Selects the dial tone the PBX (instead of the network) sends to the caller when a call is made using the ARS feature, or ISDN En Bloc dialling. Value Range Type A, Type B Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port 10.1 [8-1] System Setting Feature Guide References 1.10.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS) 1.29.1 Dial Tone 498 PC Programming Manual 4.18 [2-9] System Options Echo Cancel—Conference Enables the use of the ECHO/EECHO card for conference calls. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.14.1.2 Conference Echo Cancel—CO-to-CO Enables the use of the ECHO/EECHO card for trunk-to-trunk calls. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Echo Cancel—Extension to Analogue Line Enables the use of the ECHO/EECHO card for extension-to-analogue trunk calls. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 499 4.18 [2-9] System Options Feature Guide References None Echo Cancel—Extension to Digital Line Enables the use of the ECHO/EECHO card for extension-to-ISDN/T1/E1 line calls. If set to "Enable", the echo canceller card is used for extension-to-ISDN/T1/E1 line calls. If set to "Disable", the echo canceller card is not used for extension-to-ISDN/T1/E1 line calls. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Option 4 DSS Key—DSS key mode for Incoming Call Enables the use of a DSS button to pick up an incoming call to another extension or an ICD group. Value Range ON or Flash, OFF Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.4.1.3 Call Pickup 1.20.3 LED Indication DSS Key—Call Pick-up by DSS key for Direct Incoming Call Specifies whether a DSS button will light up or flash when a call rings at the specified extension. To enable this setting, DSS Key—DSS key mode for Incoming Call on this screen must be set to ON or Flash. 500 PC Programming Manual 4.18 [2-9] System Options Value Range Disable: The DSS button will light up when a call arrives, but pressing it will not pick up the call. Enable: The DSS button will flash when a call arrives, and pressing it will pick up the call. Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.4.1.3 Call Pickup DSS Key—Call Pick-up by DSS key for ICD Group Call Specifies whether a DSS button will light up or flash when a call rings at the specified incoming call distribution group. To enable this setting, DSS Key—DSS key mode for Incoming Call on this screen must be set to ON or Flash. Value Range Disable: The DSS button will light up when a call arrives, but pressing it will not pick up the call. Enable: The DSS button will flash when a call arrives, and pressing it will pick up the call. Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.4.1.3 Call Pickup DSS Key—Automatic Transfer for Extension Call Specifies whether pressing a DSS or SDN button during an extension-to-extension call disconnects the current call or places the call on consultation hold. Value Range Disable: The PBX disconnects the current call, and calls the extension assigned to the DSS or SDN button. Enable: The PBX places the current call on consultation hold. Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options PC Programming Manual 501 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.12.1 Call Transfer Transfer—Transfer to busy Extension without BSS Operation Enables a transferred call to be queued when the transfer destination is busy. Value Range Disable: The call is not transferred. (If the transfer destination has enabled the call waiting notification feature, it is possible to inform the destination about the call transfer.) Enable: The transferred call is queued for the time period specified in Recall—Transfer Recall in 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters. Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters— Recall—Transfer Recall Feature Guide References 1.2.2.4 Queuing Feature 1.12.1 Call Transfer Transfer—Automatic Answer for Transferred Call Enables transferred calls (including direct extension calls) to be automatically answered, when using the Hands-free Answerback feature. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.4.1.4 Hands-free Answerback 502 PC Programming Manual 4.18 [2-9] System Options Send CLIP of CO Caller to ISDN—when Transfer (CLIP of Held Party) Enables the transfer of related CLIP information when a party on hold is transferred. When set to "Enable", the transfer destination will receive the original caller’s CLIP information, not the information of the extension that performed the transfer. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) Send CLIP of CO Caller to ISDN—when ICD Group with Cellular Phone Selects whether the CLIP number of the calling party or of the virtual PS is sent to the virtual PS’s forwarding destination to identify the origin of a trunk call received at an ICD Group containing a virtual PS. This setting only applies to calls automatically forwarded to public trunk lines using the virtual PS feature. Value Range Disable: The CLIP number assigned to the virtual PS is sent. Enable: The CLIP number of the calling party is sent. Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.2.2.3 Outside Destinations in Incoming Call Distribution Group 1.30.6 Network ICD Group Private Network—Public Call through Private Network—Minimum Public Caller ID Digits Specifies the minimum length of Caller ID required for a call from a private network to be considered as a call from a public network. Value Range 0–15 PC Programming Manual 503 4.18 [2-9] System Options Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Private Network—TIE Call by Extension Numbering (Optional SD Card Required) Enables extensions at two PBXs connected in a network (not including a VoIP network) to have the same leading number. For example, extension 101 is registered at PBX 1, and extension 102 is registered at PBX 2. Only the Extension Number Method is supported. If disabled, different leading numbers need to be assigned for extensions at each PBX. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References 11.1 [9-1] TIE Table— Leading Number Feature Guide References 1.30.1 TIE Line Service System Wireless—Out of Range Registration Selects whether the PBX can set the status of a PS to Out of Range if no signal is received from the PS for a preset length of time. This feature must be enabled to allow PS roaming. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters— 504 PC Programming Manual System Wireless—PS Out of Range Timer 4.18 [2-9] System Options Feature Guide References 1.30.6.1 PS Roaming by Network ICD Group System Wireless—SDN Delayed Ringing with LCD Selects whether call information (such as Caller ID) is shown on the display of a PDN extension PS (i.e., a PS with one or more PDN buttons) when a call is received while delayed ringing is set. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button— Parameter Selection (for SDN) Feature Guide References 1.7.1 Primary Directory Number (PDN)/Secondary Directory Number (SDN) Extension Option 5 SLT—SLT Hold Mode Selects how to hold a line and transfer a call with an SLT. For details of each mode, see "1.13.1 Call Hold" in the Feature Guide. Value Range Mode 1, Mode 2, Mode 3, Mode 4 Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.13.1 Call Hold Whisper OHCA—for SLT / APT / KX-T72xx Enables the use of Whisper OHCA to SLTs and IP-PTs, and DPTs other than KX-T7400 series, KX-T7500 series, KX-T7600 series, or KX-DT300 series. Value Range Disable, Enable PC Programming Manual 505 4.18 [2-9] System Options Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.8.4.4 Whisper OHCA Call Waiting—Automatic Call Waiting for Extension Call Selects whether Busy Station Signalling (BSS) is automatically performed when an extension user calls a busy extension. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.3.3 Call Waiting Busy Out—Busy Out for Analogue CO Enables the PBX to automatically set a trunk to Busy Out status when a loop current is not detected, preventing that trunk from being used. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.5.4.6 Trunk Busy Out 506 PC Programming Manual 4.18 [2-9] System Options ISDN Voice Path Connection—Connect when "Alert" is sent from ISDN Enables the voice path of an ISDN line to connect even when an "Alert" signal is received from the telephone company. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PT Feature Access—No. 1–8 Specifies the System Feature Access Menu (1–8) shown on the display of an extension. Value Range None, Call Back Cancel, Call Pickup Direct, Call Pickup Group, Doorphone Call, Door Open, Relay On, External BGM, Paging Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None ISDN Option—Fwd from ISDN to ISDN Specifies whether alert messages are sent to the ISDN network. This setting should be enabled for networks that disconnect a call if an alert message is not received. Value Range Mode1: Disable Mode2: Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options PC Programming Manual 507 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Option 6 (CTI) 1st Party CTI—System status retry interval timer Specifies the length of time until the alive check is retried when no response is received, for First Party Call Control CTI. Value Range 0–60 s Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.32.1 Computer Telephony Integration (CTI) 1st Party CTI—System status retry counter Specifies the number of times that the alive check is repeated for First Party Call Control CTI. When the alive check has been attempted the programmed number times without success, the PBX assumes that the logical connection with the CTI application software has been lost. Value Range 0–10 Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.32.1 Computer Telephony Integration (CTI) 508 PC Programming Manual 4.18 [2-9] System Options 3rd Party CTI—System status retry interval timer Specifies the length of time until the alive check is retried when no response is received, for Third Party Call Control CTI. Value Range 0–60 s Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.32.1 Computer Telephony Integration (CTI) 3rd Party CTI—System status retry counter Specifies the number of times that the alive check is repeated for Third Party Call Control CTI. When the alive check has been attempted the programmed number of times without success, the PBX assumes that the logical connection with the CTI application software has been lost. Value Range 0–10 Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.32.1 Computer Telephony Integration (CTI) 3rd Party CTI—CDR retry interval timer Specifies the length of time until the alive check of CDR is retried when no response is received, for Third Party Call Control CTI. Value Range 0–60 s Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options PC Programming Manual 509 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.32.1 Computer Telephony Integration (CTI) 3rd Party CTI—CDR retry counter Specifies the number of times that the alive check of CDR is repeated for Third Party Call Control CTI. When the alive check has been attempted the programmed number times, the association is released automatically. Value Range 0–10 Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.32.1 Computer Telephony Integration (CTI) CTI Multi PBX Control—PBX Name Specifies the name of the PBX, for network programming reference. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None CTI Multi PBX Control—USB Serial Number Specifies the serial number assigned to this PBX’s USB data transfers, used when multiple PBXs are connected via USB to one PC (for example, for CTI). 510 PC Programming Manual 4.18 [2-9] System Options Value Range 1–8 Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None CTI Make Call—SLT Ring Specifies whether to ring an SLT when a call is made from CTI, instead of the SLT. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.18 [2-9] System Options Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 511 4.19 [2-10] Extension CID Settings 4.19 [2-10] Extension CID Settings Various settings for extension Caller ID can be programmed. Extension Caller ID Modulation Type Specifies the modulation frequency to be used when sending Caller ID information to an SLT. Value Range V.23(ETSI), Bell202(Bellcore) Maintenance Console Location 4.19 [2-10] Extension CID Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Channel Seizure Signal Bits Specifies the number of seizure bits to send when sending Caller ID information to an SLT. Value Range 10 ´ n (n=3–40) bits Maintenance Console Location 4.19 [2-10] Extension CID Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Mark Signal Bits Specifies the number of mark bits to send when sending Caller ID information to an SLT. Value Range 10 ´ n (n=3–40) bits 512 PC Programming Manual 4.19 [2-10] Extension CID Settings Maintenance Console Location 4.19 [2-10] Extension CID Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Channel Seizure Wait Time Specifies the length of time that the PBX waits before starting to send the seizure signal following the first ring when sending Caller ID information to an SLT. Value Range 64 ´ n (n=5–35) ms Maintenance Console Location 4.19 [2-10] Extension CID Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Caller ID Signal Type Specifies the type of signal modulation to be used when sending Caller ID information to an SLT (reference only). Value Range FSK Maintenance Console Location 4.19 [2-10] Extension CID Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID PC Programming Manual 513 4.19 [2-10] Extension CID Settings Additional Local Trunk Access Code to Extension Caller ID Enables the PBX to automatically add a Trunk Access number to the received telephone number when sending the Caller ID number of an incoming trunk call to an SLT. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.19 [2-10] Extension CID Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Send Caller ID Date & Time to Extension Enables the PBX to send the date and time of an incoming call when sending Caller ID information to an SLT. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.19 [2-10] Extension CID Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Send Caller ID Name to Extension Enables the PBX to send the caller’s name when sending Caller ID information to an SLT. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.19 [2-10] Extension CID Settings 514 PC Programming Manual 4.19 [2-10] Extension CID Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Send Caller ID Long Distance to Extension Enables the PBX to send a call qualifier (Long Distance) (if received from the trunk) when sending Caller ID information to an SLT. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 4.19 [2-10] Extension CID Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID FSK Transmission Level Specifies the transmission level for FSK signal modulation. Value Range -14 dB, -12 dB, -10 dB, -8 dB, -6 dB, -4 dB, -2 dB, 0 dB Maintenance Console Location 4.19 [2-10] Extension CID Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID PC Programming Manual 515 4.20 [2-11-1] Audio Gain—Paging/MOH 4.20 [2-11-1] Audio Gain—Paging/MOH Gain levels for the External Pager/External BGM ports can be programmed. Paging—EPG (External Pager) Specifies the paging volume for the External Pager. Value Range -15–15 dB Maintenance Console Location 4.20 [2-11-1] Audio Gain—Paging/MOH Programming Manual References 5.10 [3-4] Paging Group Feature Guide References 1.15.1 Paging Paging—Paging Level from PT Speaker Specifies the volume when paging is broadcast through the speaker of a PT. Value Range -15dB, -12dB, -9dB, -6dB, -3dB, 0dB, 3dB, 6dB Maintenance Console Location 4.20 [2-11-1] Audio Gain—Paging/MOH Programming Manual References 5.10 [3-4] Paging Group Feature Guide References 1.15.1 Paging MOH—MOH (Music On Hold) Specifies the music volume for the External BGM. Value Range -11–11 dB 516 PC Programming Manual 4.20 [2-11-1] Audio Gain—Paging/MOH Maintenance Console Location 4.20 [2-11-1] Audio Gain—Paging/MOH Programming Manual References 4.4 [2-2] Operator & BGM Feature Guide References 1.13.4 Music on Hold 1.17.4 Background Music (BGM) PC Programming Manual 517 4.21 [2-11-2] Audio Gain—Card 4.21 [2-11-2] Audio Gain—Card Gain levels can be programmed for each type of card. Up Gain (To PBX) Specifies the volume for audio signals from the selected type of card to the PBX. Value Range -15–15 dB Maintenance Console Location 4.21 [2-11-2] Audio Gain—Card Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Down Gain (From PBX) Specifies the volume for audio signals from the PBX to the selected type of card. Value Range -15–15 dB Maintenance Console Location 4.21 [2-11-2] Audio Gain—Card Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None 518 PC Programming Manual Section 5 [3] Group PC Programming Manual 519 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings Trunks can be organised into trunk groups. The settings of each trunk group determine the settings of the trunks within that group. A maximum of 64 trunk groups can be programmed. For more information on trunk groups, see "2.2.2 Group" in the Feature Guide. Main Group Name Specifies the name of the trunk group for programming reference. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings Programming Manual References 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings Feature Guide References None COS Specifies the COS of the trunk group, applied when making a call from a trunk to another trunk with TIE Line Service. If you wish to prevent such calls from being made, ensure that the COS specified here has a TRS level of "7" assigned for all relevant time modes in 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings. Value Range 1–64 Maintenance Console Location 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings Programming Manual References 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings Feature Guide References 1.30.1 TIE Line Service 520 PC Programming Manual 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings Line Hunting Order Specifies the trunk hunting sequence for the trunk group. The hunting sequence can be programmed to start from the lowest or highest numbered trunks, or to rotate uniformly among all trunks. Value Range High -> Low, Low -> High, Rotation Maintenance Console Location 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings Programming Manual References 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings Feature Guide References 1.5.5.3 Trunk Access CO-CO Duration Time Specifies the length of time that a trunk-to-trunk call can be maintained before being disconnected. Value Range None, 1-60 min Maintenance Console Location 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings Programming Manual References 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings Feature Guide References 1.11.8 Trunk Call Limitation Extension-CO Duration Time Specifies the length of time that an extension-to-trunk call can be maintained before being disconnected. Value Range None, 1-60 min Maintenance Console Location 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings PC Programming Manual 521 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings Programming Manual References 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings 4.18 [2-9] System Options 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings Feature Guide References 1.11.8 Trunk Call Limitation Caller ID Modification Table Specifies the table to be used for modifying caller information (telephone number). Value Range 1–4 Maintenance Console Location 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings Programming Manual References 5.3 [3-1-3] Caller ID Modification 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Dialling Plan Table Specifies the table to be used for en-bloc dialling. Value Range 1–4 Maintenance Console Location 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings Programming Manual References 5.4 [3-1-4] Dialling Plan Feature Guide References None 522 PC Programming Manual 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings Tone Detection Group Name Specifies the name of the trunk group for programming reference. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings Programming Manual References 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings Feature Guide References None DISA Tone Detection—Silence Enables the disconnection of a DISA-originated trunk-to-trunk call by silence detection. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings Programming Manual References 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings Feature Guide References 1.17.6 Direct Inward System Access (DISA) DISA Tone Detection—Continuous Enables the disconnection of a DISA-originated trunk-to-trunk call by continuous signal detection. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings PC Programming Manual 523 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings Programming Manual References 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings Feature Guide References 1.17.6 Direct Inward System Access (DISA) DISA Tone Detection—Cyclic Enables the disconnection of a DISA-originated trunk-to-trunk call by cyclic signal detection. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings Programming Manual References 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings Feature Guide References 1.17.6 Direct Inward System Access (DISA) Simplified Voice Message Tone Detection—Silence Enables the disconnection of an SVM-originated trunk-to-trunk call by silence detection. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.7 Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM) Simplified Voice Message Tone Detection—Continuous Enables the disconnection of an SVM-originated trunk-to-trunk call by continuous signal detection. 524 PC Programming Manual 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.7 Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM) Simplified Voice Message Tone Detection—Cyclic Enables the disconnection of an SVM-originated trunk-to-trunk call by cyclic signal detection. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.7 Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM) Host PBX Access Code Group Name Specifies the name of the trunk group for programming reference. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings Programming Manual References 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings PC Programming Manual 525 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings Feature Guide References None Host PBX Access Code 1–10 Specifies the feature number used to access a trunk from the host PBX. Value Range Max. 10 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings Programming Manual References 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings Feature Guide References 1.5.4.8 Host PBX Access Code (Access Code to the Telephone Company from a Host PBX) Collect Call Reject (For Brazil) Group Name Specifies the name of the trunk group for programming reference. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings Programming Manual References 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings Feature Guide References None Collect Call Reject (for Brazil)—Mode Enables the PBX to automatically reject collect calls. This setting is only for users in Brazil. Value Range Disable, Enable 526 PC Programming Manual 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings Maintenance Console Location 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Collect Call Reject (for Brazil)—Wait Time Selects the length of time that the PBX waits before sending a flash signal to reject a collect call. This setting is only for users in Brazil. Value Range 500 ms, 1000 ms, 1500 ms, 2000 ms Maintenance Console Location 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Collect Call Reject (for Brazil)—Flashing Time Selects the length of the flash signal that the PBX sends to reject a collect call. This setting is only for users in Brazil. Value Range 1000 ms, 1500 ms, 2000 ms, 2500 ms Maintenance Console Location 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 527 5.2 [3-1-2] Trunk Group—Local Access Priority 5.2 [3-1-2] Trunk Group—Local Access Priority Trunk groups can be assigned a priority for Idle Line Access. When making a trunk call by Idle Line Access, the PBX will search trunk groups for an idle trunk according to the priority assigned here. Trunk Group No. & Name Specifies the trunk group assigned to the corresponding priority level. Select the blank option to not assign a trunk group to the priority. Value Range Trunk Group No. 1–64 Maintenance Console Location 5.2 [3-1-2] Trunk Group—Local Access Priority Programming Manual References 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings Feature Guide References 1.5.5.3 Trunk Access 528 PC Programming Manual 5.3 [3-1-3] Caller ID Modification 5.3 [3-1-3] Caller ID Modification The telephone numbers of incoming callers can be modified automatically according to preprogrammed modification tables, and then recorded for calling back. Leading Digits After the caller’s number is modified by the Length of Digits Modification Tables or CLIP Modification Tables, the PBX checks the leading digits of the modified number for an area code programmed in the Caller ID Modification Table assigned to that trunk group. If it finds such a code, it removes digits and adds a number to the modified number. If this number is stored as a System Speed Dialling number, the caller’s name can be shown on a PT display and the call can be routed to a certain extension (CLI destination). A maximum of 4 Caller ID Modification Tables, each containing 10 local/international call data and 1 long distance code, can be programmed. Each trunk group can select a table for use. Select the desired table from the Modification Table list. If the modified number does not contain an area code programmed here, the PBX applies the Long Distance Code settings to the modified number. Area Code (for Local / International Call Data 1–10) Specifies the leading number (area code) to look for in the incoming caller’s number. Value Range Max. 6 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 5.3 [3-1-3] Caller ID Modification Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Removed Number of Digits Specifies the number of digits to be removed from the beginning of the incoming caller’s number. Value Range 0–9 Maintenance Console Location 5.3 [3-1-3] Caller ID Modification Programming Manual References 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings— 8.1 [6-1] System Speed Dial Caller ID Modification Table PC Programming Manual 529 5.3 [3-1-3] Caller ID Modification Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Added Number Specifies the number to be added to the incoming caller’s number in the place of the removed digits. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 5.3 [3-1-3] Caller ID Modification Programming Manual References 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings— 8.1 [6-1] System Speed Dial Caller ID Modification Table Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Length of Digits The PBX adds a certain number of digits to the caller’s number depending on the length of digits, as programmed in the Length of Digits Modification Tables assigned to the trunk group. This modification is applied to incoming trunk calls routed through public networks when the type of network numbering plan is Unknown or not specified. A maximum of 4 Length of Digits Modification Tables can be programmed. Select the desired table from the Modification Table list. If the length of digits of an incoming trunk call is less than the Minimum Caller ID Digits (for National), the caller’s number is not modified. Minimum Caller ID Digits (for International) Specifies the minimum number of digits required in the caller’s number for it to be recognised as an international call. The value specified here must be larger than Minimum Caller ID Digits (for National). Value Range 1–31 Maintenance Console Location 5.3 [3-1-3] Caller ID Modification Programming Manual References 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port— 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port— 530 PC Programming Manual Calling Party number—Type of Number—Public, Private Called Party number—Type of Number—Public, Private 5.3 [3-1-3] Caller ID Modification Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Minimum Caller ID Digits (for National) Specifies the minimum number of digits required in the caller’s number for it to be recognised as a national call. The value specified here must be smaller than Minimum Caller ID Digits (for International). Value Range 0–30 Maintenance Console Location 5.3 [3-1-3] Caller ID Modification Programming Manual References 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port— 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port— Calling Party number—Type of Number—Public, Private Called Party number—Type of Number—Public, Private Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Added Number (for International) Specifies the number to be added to the incoming telephone number when the total number of digits exceeds Minimum Caller ID Digits (for International). Value Range Max. 8 digits (0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 5.3 [3-1-3] Caller ID Modification Programming Manual References 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port— 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port— Calling Party number—Type of Number—Public, Private Called Party number—Type of Number—Public, Private Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Added Number (for National) Specifies the number to be added to the incoming telephone number when the total number of digits exceeds Minimum Caller ID Digits (for National) but does not exceed Minimum Caller ID Digits (for International). PC Programming Manual 531 5.3 [3-1-3] Caller ID Modification Value Range Max. 8 digits (0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 5.3 [3-1-3] Caller ID Modification Programming Manual References 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port— 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port— Calling Party number—Type of Number—Public, Private Called Party number—Type of Number—Public, Private Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID CLIP When incoming caller information is sent through an ISDN line and the type of the network numbering plan is International, National, or Subscriber, the caller’s number can be modified as programmed in the Modification Tables assigned to the trunk group. The modified number will then be recorded, and it is used for sending to the network as a CLIP number. A maximum of 4 CLIP Modification Tables can be programmed. Select the desired table from the Modification Table list. Removed Number of Digits Specifies the number of leading digits to be removed from the incoming caller’s number for each type of network numbering plan. Value Range 0–9 Maintenance Console Location 5.3 [3-1-3] Caller ID Modification Programming Manual References 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port— 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port— Calling Party Number—Type of Number—Public, Private Called Party Number—Type of Number—Public, Private Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Added Number Specifies the number to be added to the incoming caller’s number in the place of the removed digits for each type of network numbering plan. 532 PC Programming Manual 5.3 [3-1-3] Caller ID Modification Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 5.3 [3-1-3] Caller ID Modification Programming Manual References 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port— 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port— Calling Party Number—Type of Number—Public, Private Called Party Number—Type of Number—Public, Private Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID PC Programming Manual 533 5.4 [3-1-4] Dialling Plan 5.4 [3-1-4] Dialling Plan The PBX sends all of the dialled digits at once after an extension user completes dialling. The PBX can recognise the end of dialling when the dialled telephone number starts with the programmed leading number and contains the programmed total number of digits. When the PBX recognises the end of dialling to an analogue trunk, the PBX cancels the muting of the caller’s voice sent to the analogue trunk immediately. If the PBX cannot recognise the end of dialling, the PBX mutes the caller’s voice sent to an analogue trunk from the time at which the last digit is dialled until the analogue trunk inter-digit timer expires. 4 tables can be programmed, each with a maximum of 50 leading numbers. Select the table to programme from the Dialling Plan Table list. To assign a set of leading numbers automatically, click Auto Assign. Leading Number Specifies the leading number to be regarded as the beginning of dialling. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, N [2,3,4,5,6,7,8,9], P [0, 1], and X [0-9, *, and #]) Maintenance Console Location 5.4 [3-1-4] Dialling Plan Programming Manual References 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone— Dial—Analogue CO First Digit 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone— Dial—Analogue CO Inter-digit 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings—Main— Dialling Plan Table Feature Guide References 1.21.1.1 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN)—SUMMARY Removed Number of Digits Specifies the number of leading digits to be removed from the number dialled by en-bloc dialling. Value Range 0–15 Maintenance Console Location 5.4 [3-1-4] Dialling Plan Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.1 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN)—SUMMARY 534 PC Programming Manual 5.4 [3-1-4] Dialling Plan Added Number Specifies the number to be added to the number dialled by en-bloc dialling in the place of the removed digits. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 5.4 [3-1-4] Dialling Plan Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.1 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN)—SUMMARY PC Programming Manual 535 5.5 [3-1-4] Dialling Plan—Auto Assign 5.5 [3-1-4] Dialling Plan—Auto Assign It is possible to assign a set of leading numbers automatically. Select Auto Assigning Table Selects the set of preset leading number values to assign to the active dialling plan table. When Type D is selected, you will be prompted to enter a 3-digit area code, and 7 "X"s, in cells 1 through 47 of the dialling plan table. Value Range Type A: 1:N11, 2:NXX XXXX, 3:1NXX NXX XXXX, 4-50: Not stored Type B: 1:N11, 2:NNX XXXX, 3:1NPX NXX XXXX, 4-50: Not stored Type C: 1:N11, 2:NXX XXXX, 3:1NNX XXXX, 4:1NPX NXX XXXX, 5-50: Not stored Type D: 1-47: Not stored, 48:N11, 49:NXX XXXX, 50:1NXX NXX XXXX Type E: 1:N11, 2:NXX NXX XXXX, 3:1NXX NXX XXXX, 4-50: Not stored Maintenance Console Location 5.5 [3-1-4] Dialling Plan—Auto Assign Programming Manual References 5.4 [3-1-4] Dialling Plan Feature Guide References None 536 PC Programming Manual 5.6 [3-1-5] Trunk Group—Charge Rate 5.6 [3-1-5] Trunk Group—Charge Rate The rate charged per pay tone signal (sent from the telephone company) can be assigned for each trunk group. Trunk Group Name Indicates the name of the trunk group (reference only). Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 5.6 [3-1-5] Trunk Group—Charge Rate Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Rate Specifies the call charge rate. The number of decimal places that can be specified here depends on the value set in Digits After Decimal Point in 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge. Charge Options— Value Range 0–9999999 Maintenance Console Location 5.6 [3-1-5] Trunk Group—Charge Rate Programming Manual References 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Feature Guide References 1.26.3 Call Charge Services PC Programming Manual 537 5.7 [3-2] User Group 5.7 [3-2] User Group Extensions can be assigned to a tenant according to their extension user groups. An extension user group can belong to only one tenant. However, one extension user group can belong to several call pickup groups and several paging groups. A maximum of 8 tenants can be programmed. User Group Name Specifies the name of the extension user group. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 5.7 [3-2] User Group Programming Manual References 5.8 [3-3] Call Pickup Group 5.10 [3-4] Paging Group 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— User Group 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— User Group Feature Guide References 2.2.2 Group Tenant Number Specifies the tenant to which the extension user group belongs. Value Range 1–8 Maintenance Console Location 5.7 [3-2] User Group Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 2.2.2 Group 2.2.3 Tenant Service 538 PC Programming Manual 5.8 [3-3] Call Pickup Group 5.8 [3-3] Call Pickup Group Extensions can be assigned to a call pickup group according to their extension user groups. One extension user group can belong to up to 8 call pickup groups. A maximum of 64 call pickup groups can be programmed. To assign extension user groups to call pickup groups easily, click All Setting. User Group Name Indicates the name of the extension user group (reference only). Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 5.8 [3-3] Call Pickup Group Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.4.1.3 Call Pickup 2.2.2 Group Pickup Group—1st–8th Selects the call pickup groups that the extension user group belongs to. One extension user group can be assigned to a maximum of 8 call pickup groups on this screen. To assign an extension user group to more than 8 call pickup groups, click All Setting. Value Range None, 01–64 Maintenance Console Location 5.8 [3-3] Call Pickup Group Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.4.1.3 Call Pickup 2.2.2 Group PC Programming Manual 539 5.9 [3-3] Call Pickup Group—All Setting 5.9 [3-3] Call Pickup Group—All Setting Extensions can be assigned to a call pickup group according to their extension user groups. One extension user group can belong to multiple call pickup groups. Call Pickup Group Name Specifies the name of the call pickup group. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 5.9 [3-3] Call Pickup Group—All Setting Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.4.1.3 Call Pickup 2.2.2 Group User Group 1–32 Specifies whether the extension user group belongs to the corresponding pickup group. Value Range ON (blue), OFF Maintenance Console Location 5.9 [3-3] Call Pickup Group—All Setting Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.4.1.3 Call Pickup 2.2.2 Group 540 PC Programming Manual 5.10 [3-4] Paging Group 5.10 [3-4] Paging Group Extensions can be assigned to a paging group according to their extension user groups. External pagers can also be assigned to a paging group. One extension user group or external pager can belong to multiple paging groups. A maximum of 32 paging groups can be programmed. To assign external pagers to paging groups, click External Pager. To assign extension user groups to paging groups easily, click All Setting. User Group Name Indicates the name of the extension user group (reference only). Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 5.10 [3-4] Paging Group Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.15.1 Paging 2.2.2 Group Paging Group—1st–8th Selects the paging groups that the extension user group belongs to. One extension user group can be assigned to a maximum of 8 paging groups on this screen. To assign an extension user group to more than 8 paging groups, click All Setting. Value Range None, 01–32 Maintenance Console Location 5.10 [3-4] Paging Group Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.15.1 Paging 2.2.2 Group PC Programming Manual 541 5.11 [3-4] Paging Group—All Setting 5.11 [3-4] Paging Group—All Setting Extensions can be assigned to a paging group according to their extension user groups. One extension user group or external pager can belong to multiple paging groups. Paging Group Name Specifies the name of the paging group. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 5.11 [3-4] Paging Group—All Setting Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.15.1 Paging 2.2.2 Group User Group 1–32 Specifies whether the extension user group belongs to the corresponding paging group. Value Range ON (blue), OFF (white) Maintenance Console Location 5.11 [3-4] Paging Group—All Setting Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.15.1 Paging 2.2.2 Group 542 PC Programming Manual 5.12 [3-4] Paging Group—External Pager 5.12 [3-4] Paging Group—External Pager External pagers can be assigned to a paging group. One external pager can belong to multiple paging groups. Paging Group Name Indicates the name of the paging group (reference only). Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 5.12 [3-4] Paging Group—External Pager Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.15.1 Paging 2.2.2 Group External Pager 1 Specifies whether the external pager belongs to the corresponding paging group. Value Range ON (blue), OFF Maintenance Console Location 5.12 [3-4] Paging Group—External Pager Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.15.1 Paging 2.2.2 Group External Pager 2 Specifies whether the external pager belongs to the corresponding paging group. Value Range ON (blue), OFF PC Programming Manual 543 5.12 [3-4] Paging Group—External Pager Maintenance Console Location 5.12 [3-4] Paging Group—External Pager Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.15.1 Paging 2.2.2 Group 544 PC Programming Manual 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group— Group Settings Extensions can be assigned as members of an incoming call distribution group. Calls to an incoming call distribution group are distributed to its member extensions as programmed. A maximum of 128 incoming call distribution groups can be programmed. To view a list of all programmed extension numbers and types, click Extension List View (see 2.5.8 Tool— Extension List View). To assign extensions to ICD groups and change extension settings, click Member List. For more information on ICD Groups, see "1.2.2.1 Incoming Call Distribution Group Features—SUMMARY" in the Feature Guide. Main Floating Extension Number Specifies the floating extension number of the incoming call distribution group. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group Name Specifies the name of the incoming call distribution group. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 545 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Distribution Method Selects the method for distributing calls to idle extensions of the incoming call distribution group. Value Range Ring, UCD, Priority Hunting Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.2.2.2 Group Call Distribution Call Waiting Distribution Selects the call waiting distribution method for busy extensions of the incoming call distribution group. Value Range All, Distribution Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.2.2.2 Group Call Distribution FWD Mode Specifies whether extensions in FWD mode ring when a call is received at the incoming call distribution group. Value Range No Ring, Ring Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND 546 PC Programming Manual 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Feature Guide References 1.2.2.2 Group Call Distribution DND Mode Specifies whether extensions in DND mode ring when a call is received at the incoming call distribution group. Value Range No Ring, Ring Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Feature Guide References 1.2.2.2 Group Call Distribution Tenant Number Specifies the tenant to which the incoming call distribution group belongs, to determine the Time Table and the audio source for the group. (The tenant number corresponds to the Time Table number.) Value Range 1–8 Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References 4.4 [2-2] Operator & BGM 4.6 [2-4] Week Table 8.6 [6-6] Tenant— Music On Hold Feature Guide References 1.13.4 Music on Hold 2.2.3 Tenant Service PC Programming Manual 547 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings COS Specifies the COS of the incoming call distribution group. Depending on the COS, calls from certain extensions are restricted as determined by the Internal Call Block feature. Also, when calls are forwarded or overflowed to a trunk, the TRS/Barring assigned for the COS of the incoming call distribution group applies. Value Range 1–64 Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings 4.13 [2-7-2] Class of Service—External Call Block 4.14 [2-7-3] Class of Service—Internal Call Block Feature Guide References 1.1.2.2 Internal Call Block CLIP on ICD Group Button Specifies the CLIP number sent to the network when making calls using the ICD Group button. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) Overflow Queuing Busy Floating Extension Number Specifies the floating extension number of the incoming call distribution group. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) 548 PC Programming Manual 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group Name Specifies the name of the incoming call distribution group. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Queuing Busy—Destination-Day, Lunch, Break, Night Specifies the overflow destination of calls that cannot be queued in each time mode. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause]) Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References 4.6 [2-4] Week Table Feature Guide References 1.2.2.6 Overflow Feature PC Programming Manual 549 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Queuing Busy—Queue Call Capacity Specifies the number of calls that can wait in a queue. Value Range None, 1–30 Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.2.2.4 Queuing Feature Overflow No Answer Floating Extension Number Specifies the floating extension number of the incoming call distribution group. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group Name Specifies the name of the incoming call distribution group. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings 550 PC Programming Manual 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Time out & Manual Queue Redirection—Destination-Day, Lunch, Break, Night Specifies the overflow destination of queued calls when they are not answered or are redirected by Manual Queue Redirection in each time mode. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause]) Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References 4.6 [2-4] Week Table Feature Guide References 1.2.2.4 Queuing Feature 1.2.2.6 Overflow Feature Time out & Manual Queue Redirection—Overflow Time Specifies the length of time calls wait in a queue before they are redirected to the overflow destination. Value Range None, 10 ´ n (n=1–125) s Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.2.2.4 Queuing Feature 1.2.2.6 Overflow Feature PC Programming Manual 551 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Hurry-up Level Specifies the number of calls to hold in the queue before prompting Manual Queue Redirection by flashing the Hurry-up button. Value Range None, 1–30 Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Feature Guide References 1.2.2.4 Queuing Feature Queuing Time Table Floating Extension Number Specifies the floating extension number of the incoming call distribution group. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group Name Specifies the name of the incoming call distribution group. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings 552 PC Programming Manual 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Queuing Time Table—Day, Lunch, Break, Night Specifies the Queuing Time Table to be used in each time mode. Value Range None, Table 1–Table 64 Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References 4.6 [2-4] Week Table Feature Guide References 1.2.2.4 Queuing Feature Queuing Time Table When Extension Ringing Enables the PBX to play messages/BGM to the caller according to the Queuing Time Table, when the call arrives at an extension without being queued or after being queued. Value Range Disable (Ringback Tone), Enable Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Miscellaneous Floating Extension Number Specifies the floating extension number of the incoming call distribution group. PC Programming Manual 553 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group Name Specifies the name of the incoming call distribution group. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Extension No Answer Redirection Time Specifies the length of time that a call queues at an extension before it is redirected to the next member extension of the incoming call distribution group, in UCD or Priority Hunting distribution method. Value Range None, 10 ´ n (n=1–15) s Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None 554 PC Programming Manual 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Feature Guide References 1.2.2.2 Group Call Distribution 1.2.2.4 Queuing Feature No. of Unanswered Calls for Automatic Log-out Specifies the number of consecutive unanswered calls before a member extension is automatically logged out from the incoming call distribution group. Value Range None, 1–15 Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.2.2.7 Log-in/Log-out Maximum No. of Busy Extension Specifies the number of extensions that can accept calls simultaneously in the incoming call distribution group. Value Range Max.: Call arrives at an idle extension. 1–32: Call will not arrive at an idle extension when the number of busy extensions exceeds the assigned number. Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.2.2.2 Group Call Distribution Last Extension Log-out Specifies whether the last extension logged-in to the incoming call distribution group is allowed to log out. Value Range Disable, Enable PC Programming Manual 555 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.2.2.7 Log-in/Log-out VIP Call Mode Enables VIP Call mode, to prioritise calls received from multiple incoming call distribution groups. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.2.2.5 VIP Call Supervisor Extension Number Specifies the extension number of the incoming call distribution group’s supervisor. The supervisor can monitor and control the status of each member of the group using a 6-line display PT. The supervisor extension need not belong to the group. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.2.2.8 Supervisory Feature 556 PC Programming Manual 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programmed Mailbox No. Specifies the mailbox number of the incoming call distribution group’s mailbox for Voice Processing Systems (VPS) with DTMF Integration. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.24.2 Voice Mail DTMF Integration Group Log / Group FWD To set extension numbers easily, click Destination Setting (see 2.1.6 Extension Number Setting). Floating Extension Number Specifies the floating extension number of the incoming call distribution group. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group Name Specifies the name of the incoming call distribution group. Value Range Max. 20 characters PC Programming Manual 557 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Incoming Call Log Memory Specifies the number of unanswered calls to the incoming call distribution group that can be logged in the call log memory. Value Range 0–100 Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.2 Incoming Call Log Group FWD Call from CO—Setting Indicates the current FWD status for incoming trunk calls (reference only). Value Range Off, On Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) 558 PC Programming Manual 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Group FWD Call from CO—Destination Specifies the forward destination of incoming trunk calls directed to the incoming call distribution group. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause]) Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) Group FWD Call from Extension—Setting Indicates the current FWD status for incoming intercom calls (reference only). Value Range Off, On Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) Group FWD Call from Extension—Destination Specifies the forward destination of incoming intercom calls directed to the incoming call distribution group. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret] and P [Pause]) Maintenance Console Location 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 559 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) 560 PC Programming Manual 5.14 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Member List 5.14 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group— Group Settings—Member List Each incoming call distribution group can have a maximum of 32 members (extensions) assigned to it, and each member can have its own delayed ringing and Wrap-up time settings. An extension can be a member of multiple incoming call distribution groups. An ICD Group can also contain cellular phones, and network ICD groups (ICD groups at other PBXs in a network) using virtual PS (see "1.25.6 Virtual PS" in the Feature Guide). The forward destination assigned to a virtual PS (e.g., a cellular phone) can act as a member of an ICD group. Select the desired ICD group (1–128) from the ICD Group No. list. To assign members to the group, enter directly or click Extension No. Setting (see 2.1.6 Extension Number Setting). To copy the members to another group, click Member list copy, select the group, and click OK. Extension Number Specifies the extension number of each member. In addition to the extension numbers of PT, SLT, PS, and T1-OPX extensions, floating extension numbers of PS Ring groups can also be specified. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 5.14 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Member List Programming Manual References 5.25 [3-9] PS Ring Group Feature Guide References 1.2.2.1 Incoming Call Distribution Group Features—SUMMARY Extension Name Indicates the name of the extension (reference only). Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 5.14 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Member List Programming Manual References 5.25 [3-9] PS Ring Group Feature Guide References 1.2.2.1 Incoming Call Distribution Group Features—SUMMARY PC Programming Manual 561 5.14 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Member List Delayed Ring Specifies the delayed ringing setting of each member. (Applicable when the call distribution method of the incoming call distribution group is set to Ring.) Value Range Immediate, 1–6 Rings, No Ring Maintenance Console Location 5.14 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Member List Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.2.2.2 Group Call Distribution Wrap-up Timer Specifies the length of time that must pass after completing a call before the member extension can accept another call. This timer is used when " Options—Wrap-up Timer based on" is set to "ICD Group Member" in 5.16 [3-5-3] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Miscellaneous. Value Range 10 ´ n (n=0–300) s Maintenance Console Location 5.14 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Member List Programming Manual References 5.16 [3-5-3] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Miscellaneous— Options—Wrap-up Timer based on 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 8— Wrap-up Timer 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 8— Wrap-up Timer Feature Guide References 1.2.2.7 Log-in/Log-out 562 PC Programming Manual 5.15 [3-5-2] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Queuing Time Table 5.15 [3-5-2] Incoming Call Distribution Group— Queuing Time Table A Queuing Time Table can contain up to 16 sequences which control how calls waiting in a queue are handled. A maximum of 64 Queuing Time Tables can be programmed. Queuing Sequence—Sequence 01–16 Specifies the command activated by the corresponding sequence. Value Range None: Redirects the call to the next sequence. Overflow: Redirects the call to the overflow destination when there is no answer. Disconnect: Disconnects the line. Sequence 01–16: Redirects the call to a different sequence. Wait 5 ´ n (n=1–16) s: If preceded by an OGM, plays the Music on Hold for the specified period of time; if not preceded by an OGM, sends a ringback tone for the specified period of time. OGM 01–64: Sends a certain OGM. Maintenance Console Location 5.15 [3-5-2] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Queuing Time Table Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.2.2.4 Queuing Feature 1.2.2.6 Overflow Feature 1.13.4 Music on Hold 1.17.5 Outgoing Message (OGM) PC Programming Manual 563 5.16 [3-5-3] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Miscellaneous 5.16 [3-5-3] Incoming Call Distribution Group— Miscellaneous Optional settings related to Incoming Call Distribution Groups can be programmed. Options—Call Log to ICD Group for Answered Call Selects whether answered calls to an ICD Group are also logged in the Incoming Call Log for the group, in addition to the log of the extension that answered the call. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 5.16 [3-5-3] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Miscellaneous Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.2.2.1 Incoming Call Distribution Group Features—SUMMARY Options—ICD Group Key Mode Selects whether ICD Group buttons at extensions operate as normal or in Enhanced Phantom button mode. When set to Enhanced Phantom mode, creating an ICD Group button at an extension using PT personal programming automatically registers the extension as a member of the relevant ICD Group. The extension user can also specify the delayed ringing settings. Value Range Group DN, Enhanced Phantom Maintenance Console Location 5.16 [3-5-3] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Miscellaneous Programming Manual References 5.14 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Member List— Delayed Ring Feature Guide References 1.2.2.1 Incoming Call Distribution Group Features—SUMMARY Options—Longest Idle Distribution (Optional SD Card Required) Selects whether incoming calls are distributed to idle extensions evenly in order (UCD), or to the extension that has been idle the longest (ACD). 564 PC Programming Manual 5.16 [3-5-3] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Miscellaneous Value Range Disable (UCD), Enable (ACD) Maintenance Console Location 5.16 [3-5-3] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Miscellaneous Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.2.2.2 Group Call Distribution Options—Wrap-up Timer based on Selects whether the ICD Group member wrap-up timer or extension wrap-up timer is used. If Extension is selected here, Wrap-up Timer on 5.14 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Member List becomes unavailable. If ICD Group Member is selected, Wrap-up Timer on 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings and 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings become unavailable. Value Range Extension: The timer is activated after all calls to or from the extension, including a retrieved call on hold. ICD Group Member: The timer is only activated after calls to the extension through an ICD Group. Maintenance Console Location 5.16 [3-5-3] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Miscellaneous Programming Manual References 5.14 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Member List— Wrap-up Timer 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 8— Wrap-up Timer 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 8— Wrap-up Timer Feature Guide References 1.2.2.7 Log-in/Log-out PC Programming Manual 565 5.17 [3-6] Extension Hunting Group 5.17 [3-6] Extension Hunting Group If an extension within an idle extension hunting group is called when it is busy or in DND mode, the call can be redirected to another extension in the same hunting group, according to a preprogrammed hunting type. If there is no idle extension in the group, the call can then be redirected to the overflow destination, which can be different depending on the time mode (day/lunch/break/night). A maximum of 64 hunting groups can be programmed, each containing up to 16 extensions. To assign members to the group, click Member List. To assign extensions as overflow destinations easily, click Destination Setting (see 2.1.6 Extension Number Setting). Hunting Group Name Specifies the name of the hunting group. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 5.17 [3-6] Extension Hunting Group Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.2.1 Idle Extension Hunting Hunting Type Specifies the hunting type for the hunting group. Value Range Circular: Circulates until the call is answered or overflowed Terminated: Terminates at the last extension Maintenance Console Location 5.17 [3-6] Extension Hunting Group Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.2.1 Idle Extension Hunting 2.2.2 Group 566 PC Programming Manual 5.17 [3-6] Extension Hunting Group Overflow—Day, Lunch, Break, Night Specifies the overflow destination of an unanswered call in each time mode. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash]) Maintenance Console Location 5.17 [3-6] Extension Hunting Group Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.2.1 Idle Extension Hunting PC Programming Manual 567 5.18 [3-6] Extension Hunting Group—Member List 5.18 [3-6] Extension Hunting Group—Member List Each hunting group can contain up to 16 extensions. Select the hunting group to programme from the Hunting Group No. list. To assign members to the group, enter the extension numbers in Extension Number or click Extension No. Setting (see 2.1.6 Extension Number Setting). Extension Number Specifies the extension number of the hunting group member. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 5.18 [3-6] Extension Hunting Group—Member List Programming Manual References 5.17 [3-6] Extension Hunting Group Feature Guide References 1.2.1 Idle Extension Hunting Extension Name Indicates the name of the extension, when an extension number is specified in (reference only). Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 5.18 [3-6] Extension Hunting Group—Member List Programming Manual References 5.17 [3-6] Extension Hunting Group Feature Guide References 1.2.1 Idle Extension Hunting 568 PC Programming Manual Extension Number above 5.19 [3-7-1] VM(DPT) Group—System Settings 5.19 [3-7-1] VM(DPT) Group—System Settings A Panasonic Voice Processing System (VPS) with DPT Integration can be connected to DPT ports of the PBX. The DPT ports that are connected to the VPS are called a VM (DPT) Group. 2 VM (DPT) Groups can be programmed. Call Waiting on VM Group Enables the queuing of calls when all extension ports of the VM (DPT) group are busy. (Call Waiting tone is not sent to any VM port.) Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 5.19 [3-7-1] VM(DPT) Group—System Settings Programming Manual References 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Feature Guide References 1.2.2.4 Queuing Feature 1.24.1 Voice Mail (VM) Group Intercept to Mailbox Enables the PBX to send the mailbox number of the called extension to the VPS when a call is redirected to the VM (DPT) group by Intercept Routing. When the VPS receives the mailbox number, the VPS answers the call with the appropriate mailbox. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 5.19 [3-7-1] VM(DPT) Group—System Settings Programming Manual References 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Intercept Destination— Intercept Destination—When called party does not answer—Day, Lunch, Break, Night 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Intercept Destination— Intercept Destination—When called party does not answer—Day, Lunch, Break, Night Feature Guide References 1.24.1 Voice Mail (VM) Group 1.24.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration PC Programming Manual 569 5.19 [3-7-1] VM(DPT) Group—System Settings Transfer Recall to Mailbox Enables the PBX to send the mailbox number of the transfer destination extension to the VPS in these situations: (1) when a call is transferred to an extension by the Call Transfer without Announcement feature using the Automated Attendant (AA) service of the VPS, and the call is not answered within a programmed time period; (2) when the VPS is assigned as the Transfer Recall destination of a certain extension. When the VPS receives the mailbox number, the VPS answers the call with the appropriate mailbox. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 5.19 [3-7-1] VM(DPT) Group—System Settings Programming Manual References 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Feature Guide References 1.24.1 Voice Mail (VM) Group 1.24.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration 570 PC Programming Manual 5.20 [3-7-2] VM(DPT) Group—Unit Settings 5.20 [3-7-2] VM(DPT) Group—Unit Settings A VM (DPT) group has a floating extension number, which can be assigned as the destination for redirected calls and incoming calls. To assign extension numbers to the group, click Member List. To view a list of all programmed extension numbers and types, click Extension List View. Floating Extension No. Specifies the floating extension number of the VM (DPT) group. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 5.20 [3-7-2] VM(DPT) Group—Unit Settings Programming Manual References 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Feature Guide References 1.24.1 Voice Mail (VM) Group 1.24.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration Group Name Specifies the name of the VM (DPT) group, which will be shown on the display of extensions that call the VM (DPT) group. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 5.20 [3-7-2] VM(DPT) Group—Unit Settings Programming Manual References 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Feature Guide References 1.24.1 Voice Mail (VM) Group 1.24.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration PC Programming Manual 571 5.21 [3-7-2] VM(DPT) Group—Unit Settings—Member List 5.21 [3-7-2] VM(DPT) Group—Unit Settings—Member List Displays information on the settings of all relevant ports. Only ports set to VM(DPT) in DPT Type—Type of 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port will be displayed. In addition, the other information displayed here can also be set in 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port. Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 5.21 [3-7-2] VM(DPT) Group—Unit Settings—Member List Programming Manual References DPT Type—Type 5.20 [3-7-2] VM(DPT) Group—Unit Settings Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 5.21 [3-7-2] VM(DPT) Group—Unit Settings—Member List Programming Manual References DPT Type—Type 5.20 [3-7-2] VM(DPT) Group—Unit Settings Feature Guide References 2.1.1 Extension Port Configuration VM Unit No. Indicates the unit number of the connected VPS (reference only). 572 PC Programming Manual 5.21 [3-7-2] VM(DPT) Group—Unit Settings—Member List Value Range 1, 2 Maintenance Console Location 5.21 [3-7-2] VM(DPT) Group—Unit Settings—Member List Programming Manual References DPT Type—Type 5.20 [3-7-2] VM(DPT) Group—Unit Settings Feature Guide References 1.24.1 Voice Mail (VM) Group VM Port No. Indicates the VM port number for the port (reference only). Value Range 1–12 Maintenance Console Location 5.21 [3-7-2] VM(DPT) Group—Unit Settings—Member List Programming Manual References DPT Type—Type 5.20 [3-7-2] VM(DPT) Group—Unit Settings Feature Guide References 1.24.1 Voice Mail (VM) Group Extension No. Indicates the extension number assigned to the VM port (reference only). Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 5.21 [3-7-2] VM(DPT) Group—Unit Settings—Member List Programming Manual References DPT Type—Type 5.20 [3-7-2] VM(DPT) Group—Unit Settings PC Programming Manual 573 5.21 [3-7-2] VM(DPT) Group—Unit Settings—Member List 5.23 [3-8-2] VM(DTMF) Group—Group Settings Feature Guide References 1.24.1 Voice Mail (VM) Group 1.24.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration Extension Name Indicates the name of the extension (reference only). Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 5.21 [3-7-2] VM(DPT) Group—Unit Settings—Member List Programming Manual References DPT Type—Type 5.20 [3-7-2] VM(DPT) Group—Unit Settings Feature Guide References 1.24.1 Voice Mail (VM) Group 1.24.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration 574 PC Programming Manual 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings A Panasonic Voice Processing System (VPS) with DTMF Integration can be connected to SLT ports of the PBX. The SLT ports that are connected to the VPS are called a VM (DTMF) Group. A maximum of 2 VM (DTMF) Groups can be programmed. For more information on Voice Mail groups and DTMF integration, see "1.24.1 Voice Mail (VM) Group" and "1.24.2 Voice Mail DTMF Integration" in the Feature Guide. VM DTMF Status Signal—Ringback Tone Specifies the DTMF status signal the PBX sends to the VPS when the called extension is ringing. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, and P [pause]) Maintenance Console Location 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None VM DTMF Status Signal—Busy Tone Specifies the DTMF status signal the PBX sends to the VPS when the called extension is busy. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, and P [pause]) Maintenance Console Location 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None VM DTMF Status Signal—Reorder Tone Specifies the DTMF status signal the PBX sends to the VPS when the dialled number is invalid. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, and P [pause]) PC Programming Manual 575 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings Maintenance Console Location 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None VM DTMF Status Signal—DND Tone Specifies the DTMF status signal the PBX sends to the VPS when the called extension is in DND mode. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, and P [pause]) Maintenance Console Location 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None VM DTMF Status Signal—Answer Specifies the DTMF status signal the PBX sends to the VPS when the called extension has answered the call. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, and P [pause]) Maintenance Console Location 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None 576 PC Programming Manual 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings VM DTMF Status Signal—Confirm Specifies the DTMF status signal the PBX sends to the VPS when a certain feature (e.g., Message Waiting) has been successfully set or cancelled on an extension. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, and P [pause]) Maintenance Console Location 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None VM DTMF Status Signal—Disconnect Specifies the DTMF status signal the PBX sends to the VPS when the caller hangs up. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, and P [pause]) Maintenance Console Location 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None VM DTMF Status Signal—FWD to VM Ringback Tone Specifies the DTMF status signal the PBX sends to the VPS when the call has been forwarded to the VPS and the PBX is calling another port of the VPS. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, and P [pause]) Maintenance Console Location 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings PC Programming Manual 577 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None VM DTMF Status Signal—FWD to VM Busy Tone Specifies the DTMF status signal the PBX sends to the VPS when the call has been forwarded to the VPS and all ports of the VPS are busy. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, and P [pause]) Maintenance Console Location 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None VM DTMF Status Signal—FWD to Extension Ringback Tone Specifies the DTMF status signal the PBX sends to the VPS when the call has been forwarded to another extension and the PBX is calling the destination extension. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, and P [pause]) Maintenance Console Location 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None VM DTMF Command—Recording Message Specifies the DTMF command the PBX sends to the VPS when a call is forwarded, intercepted, or transferred to the VPS, so that the caller can leave a message in a certain mailbox. 578 PC Programming Manual 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, H [mailbox number], and P [pause]) Maintenance Console Location 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None VM DTMF Command—Listening Message Specifies the DTMF command the PBX sends to the VPS when an extension user answers a message waiting notification from the VPS, so that the extension user can retrieve a new message in a certain mailbox without having to dial the mailbox number manually. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, H [mailbox number], and P [pause]) Maintenance Console Location 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.19.1 Message Waiting VM DTMF Command—Switching to AA Specifies the DTMF command the PBX sends to the VPS to switch from VM Service Mode to AA Service Mode. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, H [mailbox number], and P [pause]) Maintenance Console Location 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 579 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings Feature Guide References None VM DTMF Command—Switching to VM Specifies the DTMF command the PBX sends to the VPS to switch from AA Service Mode to VM Service Mode. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, H [mailbox number], and P [pause]) Maintenance Console Location 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Timing—DTMF Length for VM Specifies the length of DTMF signals the PBX sends to the VPS. Value Range 80 ms, 160 ms Maintenance Console Location 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Timing—Inter-digit Time Specifies the length of pause time between DTMF signals the PBX sends to the VPS. Value Range 80 ms, 160 ms Maintenance Console Location 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings 580 PC Programming Manual 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Timing—Waiting Time before Sending Follow on ID Specifies the length of time that the PBX waits before sending the Follow on ID to the VPS after the VPS has answered a call. Value Range 0.5 s, 1.0 s, 1.5 s, 2.0 s Maintenance Console Location 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Timing—Waiting Time before Sending VM DTMF Status Signal Specifies the length of time that the PBX waits before sending the DTMF status signal to the VPS after the VPS has finished dialling. Value Range 0.5 s, 1.0 s, 1.5 s, 2.0 s Maintenance Console Location 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Others—Call Waiting on VM Group Enables the queuing of calls when all extension ports of the VM (DTMF) group are busy. (Call Waiting tone is not sent to any VM port.) PC Programming Manual 581 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.2.2.4 Queuing Feature Others—FWD to the VPS Sequence Specifies which DTMF commands the VPS receives from the PBX when a call is forwarded to the VPS, so that the VPS can answer the call either with a mailbox or in the AA service mode. It is also possible to send no DTMF signal to the VPS. Value Range None, Answer by Mailbox, AA Maintenance Console Location 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Others—Intercept Routing to the VPS Sequence Specifies which DTMF commands the VPS receives from the PBX when a call is intercepted to the VPS, so that the VPS can answer the call either with a mailbox or in the AA service mode. It is also possible to send no DTMF signal to the VPS. Value Range None, Answer by Mailbox, AA Maintenance Console Location 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings 582 PC Programming Manual 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Others—Mailbox for Extension Specifies whether the mailboxes use the same numbers as the extensions and incoming call distribution groups, or use different numbers as programmed for each extension or incoming call distribution group. Value Range Extension Number, Programmed Mailbox Number Maintenance Console Location 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings Programming Manual References 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Miscellaneous— Programmed Mailbox No. 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 1— Programmed Mailbox No. 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 1— Programmed Mailbox No. Feature Guide References None Others—Message Waiting Lamp Control Specifies whether the PBX or VPS cancels the Message Waiting feature (e.g., turning off the MESSAGE button light) when an extension user answers the message waiting notification from the VPS. Value Range By PBX, By VM Maintenance Console Location 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 583 5.23 [3-8-2] VM(DTMF) Group—Group Settings 5.23 [3-8-2] VM(DTMF) Group—Group Settings A VM (DTMF) group has a floating extension number, and can be assigned as the destination for redirected calls and incoming calls. To assign members to the group, click Member List. To view a list of all programmed extension numbers and types, click Extension List View. Floating Ext. No. Specifies the floating extension number of the VM (DTMF) group. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 5.23 [3-8-2] VM(DTMF) Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.24.1 Voice Mail (VM) Group Group Name Specifies the name of the VM (DTMF) group, which will be shown on the display of extensions that call the VM (DTMF) group. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 5.23 [3-8-2] VM(DTMF) Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.24.1 Voice Mail (VM) Group Type Specifies the initial service mode in which the VPS answers calls. Value Range AA, VM 584 PC Programming Manual 5.23 [3-8-2] VM(DTMF) Group—Group Settings Maintenance Console Location 5.23 [3-8-2] VM(DTMF) Group—Group Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.24.2 Voice Mail DTMF Integration PC Programming Manual 585 5.24 [3-8-2] VM(DTMF) Group—Group Settings—Member List 5.24 [3-8-2] VM(DTMF) Group—Group Settings— Member List Select the group to programme from the VM(DTMF) Group Number list. To assign members to the group, enter directly or click Extension No. Setting (see 2.1.6 Extension Number Setting). To copy members to another group, click Member list copy, select the group, and click OK. Extension Number of the SLT Port Connected to VM Specifies the extension number assigned to the SLT port that is connected to the VPS. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 5.24 [3-8-2] VM(DTMF) Group—Group Settings—Member List Programming Manual References 5.23 [3-8-2] VM(DTMF) Group—Group Settings Feature Guide References 1.24.2 Voice Mail DTMF Integration Extension Name Indicates the name of the extension (reference only). Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 5.24 [3-8-2] VM(DTMF) Group—Group Settings—Member List Programming Manual References 5.23 [3-8-2] VM(DTMF) Group—Group Settings Feature Guide References 1.24.2 Voice Mail DTMF Integration 586 PC Programming Manual 5.25 [3-9] PS Ring Group 5.25 [3-9] PS Ring Group A PS ring group is a group of PS extensions that receives incoming calls. Each group has a floating extension number and name. One PS can belong to multiple PS ring groups. A maximum of 32 PS ring groups can be programmed, each containing up to 64 PS extensions. To add PSs to the PS Ring Group, click Member List. Floating Extension Number Specifies the floating extension number of the PS ring group. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 5.25 [3-9] PS Ring Group Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.25.2 PS Ring Group Group Name Specifies the name of the PS ring group, which will be shown on the display of extensions that call the PS ring group when Incoming Trunk Call Information Display on this screen is set to Called Number. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 5.25 [3-9] PS Ring Group Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.25.2 PS Ring Group Incoming Trunk Call Information Display Specifies the information of the incoming trunk call to be shown on the displays of the PSs that belong to the PS ring group. If the caller’s name or called party’s name is not recognised, the telephone number will be shown. PC Programming Manual 587 5.25 [3-9] PS Ring Group Value Range Caller ID, Called Number Maintenance Console Location 5.25 [3-9] PS Ring Group Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.25.2 PS Ring Group 588 PC Programming Manual 5.26 [3-9] PS Ring Group—Member List 5.26 [3-9] PS Ring Group—Member List Each PS Ring Group can have up to 64 PS extensions assigned. Select the group to programme from the PS Ring Group Number list. To assign members to the PS Ring Group, enter directly or click Extension No. Setting (see 2.1.6 Extension Number Setting). To copy members to another group, click Member list copy, select the group, and click OK. Extension Number Specifies the extension number of the PS assigned to the PS Ring Group. Value Range Max. 5 digits Maintenance Console Location 5.26 [3-9] PS Ring Group—Member List Programming Manual References 5.25 [3-9] PS Ring Group 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.25.2 PS Ring Group Extension Name Indicates the name of the PS (reference only). Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 5.26 [3-9] PS Ring Group—Member List Programming Manual References 5.25 [3-9] PS Ring Group 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.25.2 PS Ring Group PC Programming Manual 589 5.27 [3-10] Broadcasting Group 5.27 [3-10] Broadcasting Group A broadcasting group is a group of telephones (extensions or outside destinations) that ring when a broadcasting call is made. One destination number can be assigned to multiple broadcasting groups. Up to 31 members can be assigned to each of 8 broadcasting groups. To assign members to a group, click Member List. Broadcasting Group—Name Specifies the name of the broadcasting group. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 5.27 [3-10] Broadcasting Group Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.16.1 Broadcasting 590 PC Programming Manual 5.28 [3-10] Broadcasting Group—Member List 5.28 [3-10] Broadcasting Group—Member List Up to 31 members can be assigned to each broadcasting group. Select the group to programme from the Broadcasting Group Number list. To copy the numbers to another group, click Member list copy, select the group to copy to, and click OK. Dial Number Specifies the destination number of each member of the broadcasting group. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause]) Maintenance Console Location 5.28 [3-10] Broadcasting Group—Member List Programming Manual References 5.27 [3-10] Broadcasting Group Feature Guide References 1.16.1 Broadcasting Extension Name Indicates the name of the extension, when an extension number is specified in only). Dial Number above (reference Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 5.28 [3-10] Broadcasting Group—Member List Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.16.1 Broadcasting PC Programming Manual 591 5.29 [3-11] Air Synchronisation Group 5.29 [3-11] Air Synchronisation Group A name can be assigned to each Air Synchronisation Group for IP-CSs. For PBMPR Software File Version 2.0000, only one Air Synchronisation Group can be configured. Air Sync Group No Indicates the number of the Air Synchronisation Group (reference only). Value Range 1–8 Maintenance Console Location 5.29 [3-11] Air Synchronisation Group Programming Manual References 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Feature Guide References None Group Name Specifies a name for the Air Synchronisation Group. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 5.29 [3-11] Air Synchronisation Group Programming Manual References 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Feature Guide References None 592 PC Programming Manual Section 6 [4] Extension PC Programming Manual 593 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings For each slot in which an extension card is installed, a certain number of extension ports are displayed. For each extension port, various extension settings can be assigned. To search for a specific extension, enter the extension number or the extension name in the search box and click Find Next. To assign a set of CLIP numbers automatically, click CLIP Generate. To assign names and tenants to extension user groups, click Extension User Group Table. See 5.7 [3-2] User Group for more details. Main Shelf Indicates the shelf type (reference only). Value Range Physical, Virtual Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Slot Indicates the slot position of each extension card (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). 594 PC Programming Manual 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Feature Guide References None Extension Number Specifies the extension number of the extension. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.25 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port—Connection Command Feature Guide References None Extension Name Specifies the name of the extension. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 595 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Feature Guide References None Port Type Indicates the extension port type (reference only). Value Range DPT: DPT port (DLC) SLT: SLT port (SLC) S-Hybrid: Super Hybrid port (DHLC) S-Hybrid(SLT): XDP port of Super Hybrid port (DHLC) S-Hybrid(S-DPT): Digital XDP port of Super Hybrid port (DHLC) DPT(S-DPT): Digital XDP port of DPT port (DLC) ISDN: ISDN port (BRI) ISDN: ISDN port (PRI) OPX: T1-OPX port (T1) IP-EXT: Virtual IP-Extension port (V-IPEXT) SIP: Virtual SIP Extension port (V-SIPEXT) Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.1.1 Extension Port Configuration Telephone Type Indicates the type of telephone connected to the extension port (reference only). Value Range DPT (15V)/DPT (40V): DPT is connected. APT (15V): APT is connected. DSS: DSS Console is connected. VM: VPS is connected. SLT: SLT is connected (or no telephone is connected to the Super Hybrid or SLT port). ISDN-Ext: ISDN telephone is connected. No Connection: No telephone is connected. CS: CS is connected. CS-M: High-density CS is connected with its master port. CS-S1–3: High-density CS is connected with its slave port. IP-PT: IP-PT belonging to the V-IPEXT card is connected. SIP: SIP Extension is connected. 596 PC Programming Manual 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None User Group Specifies the extension user group to which the extension belongs. Extension user groups are used to compose tenants, call pickup groups and paging groups. Value Range 1–32 Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.2 Group 2.2.3 Tenant Service COS Specifies the COS of the extension. Value Range 1–64 Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Feature Guide References 2.2.1 Class of Service (COS) PC Programming Manual 597 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Extension PIN Specifies the PIN of the extension. CAUTION There is a risk that fraudulent telephone calls will be made if a third party discovers a personal identification number (PIN) (verification code PIN or extension PIN) of the PBX. The cost of such calls will be billed to the owner/renter of the PBX. To protect the PBX from this kind of fraudulent use, we strongly recommend: a. Keeping PINs secret. b. Selecting complex, random PINs that cannot be easily guessed. c. Changing PINs frequently. Value Range Max. 10 digits (consisting of 0-9) Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.28.1 Extension Personal Identification Number (PIN) Intercept Destination Shelf Indicates the shelf type (reference only). Value Range Physical, Virtual Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Slot Indicates the slot position of each extension card (reference only). 598 PC Programming Manual 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Feature Guide References None Extension Number Specifies the extension number of the extension. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.25 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port—Connection Command PC Programming Manual 599 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Feature Guide References None Extension Name Specifies the name of the extension. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Intercept Destination—When called party does not answer—Day, Lunch, Break, Night Specifies the Intercept Routing destination of calls in each time mode for Intercept Routing–No Answer and Intercept Routing–DND. Note that Intercept Routing–Busy calls are routed using Intercept Destination—When Called Party is Busy below. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause]) Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Intercept Destination— Called Party is Busy Intercept Destination—When Feature Guide References 1.1.1.6 Intercept Routing Intercept Destination—When Called Party is Busy Specifies the Intercept Routing destination of calls when the extension is busy. 600 PC Programming Manual 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause]) Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.1.6 Intercept Routing Intercept No Answer Time Shelf Indicates the shelf type (reference only). Value Range Physical, Virtual Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Slot Indicates the slot position of each extension card (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 601 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Feature Guide References None Extension Number Specifies the extension number of the extension. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.25 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port—Connection Command Feature Guide References None Extension Name Specifies the name of the extension. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings 602 PC Programming Manual 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Intercept No Answer Time—Day, Lunch, Break, Night Specifies the length of time until an unanswered call is redirected to the intercept routing destination in each time mode. When this setting is set to "0", the system timer is used. Value Range 0–240 s Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone— Lunch, Break, Night Intercept Routing No Answer (IRNA)—Day, Feature Guide References 1.1.1.6 Intercept Routing ISDN CLIP Shelf Indicates the shelf type (reference only). Value Range Physical, Virtual Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 603 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Slot Indicates the slot position of each extension card (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Feature Guide References None Extension Number Specifies the extension number of the extension. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.25 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port—Connection Command 604 PC Programming Manual 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Feature Guide References None Extension Name Specifies the name of the extension. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None CLIP ID Specifies the CLIP number sent to the public network to show on the called party’s telephone display when making a trunk call. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) CLIP on Extension/CO Selects the CLIP number to show on the called party’s telephone. Value Range Extension: Show the CLIP number specified in CLIP ID on the Option 1 tab. CO: Show the CLIP number specified in Subscriber Number in 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port or 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port. PC Programming Manual 605 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—ISDN CO— Subscriber Number 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—CO Setting— Subscriber Number 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—ISDN CLIP— CLIP ID Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) CLIR Specifies whether to restrict the display of the CLIP number on the called party’s telephone when making a public network trunk call. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) COLR Specifies whether to restrict the display of the CLIP number of the extension on the caller’s telephone display when answering a call. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) 606 PC Programming Manual 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Option 1 Shelf Indicates the shelf type (reference only). Value Range Physical, Virtual Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Slot Indicates the slot position of each extension card (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings PC Programming Manual 607 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Feature Guide References None Extension Number Specifies the extension number of the extension. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.25 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port—Connection Command Feature Guide References None Extension Name Specifies the name of the extension. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Wireless XDP Specifies the extension number of the PS with which Wireless XDP Parallel Mode is established. To enable Wireless XDP Parallel Mode, the PS must be turned off once and then turned on after assigning this setting. When changing the port type of an extension port in DPT Type—Type on the 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port screen, the Wireless XDP setting must be deleted first. 608 PC Programming Manual 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.25.5 Wireless XDP Parallel Mode Ring Pattern Table Specifies the Ring Tone Pattern Table to be used by the extension. Value Range 1–8 Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 4.15 [2-8-1] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from CO 4.16 [2-8-2] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from Doorphone 4.17 [2-8-3] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from Others Feature Guide References 1.1.3.2 Ring Tone Pattern Selection Programmed Mailbox No. Specifies the mailbox number of the extension’s mailbox for Voice Processing Systems (VPS) with DTMF Integration. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 609 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.24.2 Voice Mail DTMF Integration Transfer Recall Destination Specifies the transfer recall destination when an extension user transfers a call with the Call Transfer without Announcement feature and the transferred call is not answered within a certain time period. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.12.1 Call Transfer ARS Itemised Code Specifies the itemised billing code used by the ARS feature for identifying calls made from the extension for accounting and billing purposes. Value Range Max. 10 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 10.6 [8-5] Carrier Feature Guide References 1.9.6 Verification Code Entry 1.10.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS) Option 2 Shelf Indicates the shelf type (reference only). Value Range Physical, Virtual 610 PC Programming Manual 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Slot Indicates the slot position of each extension card (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 611 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Extension Number Specifies the extension number of the extension. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.25 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port—Connection Command Feature Guide References None Extension Name Specifies the name of the extension. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Manual C. Waiting for Extension Call Selects the method of receiving call waiting notification from other extensions. Value Range Off: No notification BSS: Tone from the handset or built-in speaker OHCA: Voice from the built-in speaker W-OHCA: Voice from the handset Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings 612 PC Programming Manual 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.3.3 Call Waiting 1.8.4.1 Second Call Notification to Busy Extension—SUMMARY Automatic C. Waiting Specifies whether to receive call waiting notifications for calls from a trunk, doorphone calls, and calls via an incoming call distribution group. Value Range Off, On Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.3.3 Call Waiting Pickup Dial Set Sets or cancels the Hot Line feature. The number specified in Pickup Dial No. on this screen is dialled automatically after going off-hook when the Hot Line feature is active. Value Range Off, On Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone— Dial—Hot Line (Pickup Dial) Start Feature Guide References 1.6.1.7 Hot Line Pickup Dial No. Specifies the number to be dialled automatically after going off-hook when the Hot Line feature is active. PC Programming Manual 613 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash]) Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.6.1.7 Hot Line Data Mode Sets or cancels the protection against tones or interruptions from other extensions during communication. Value Range Off, On Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.11.5 Data Line Security Option 3 Shelf Indicates the shelf type (reference only). Value Range Physical, Virtual Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None 614 PC Programming Manual 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Feature Guide References None Slot Indicates the slot position of each extension card (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Feature Guide References None Extension Number Specifies the extension number of the extension. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings PC Programming Manual 615 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.25 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port—Connection Command Feature Guide References None Extension Name Specifies the name of the extension. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Call Pickup Deny Specifies whether calls can be picked up by other extensions. Value Range Disable: Allows other extension users to pick up calls to your extension Enable: Prevents other extension users from picking up calls to your extension Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.4.1.3 Call Pickup Executive Override Deny Specifies whether calls can be interrupted by other extensions. 616 PC Programming Manual 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Value Range Disable: Allows other extension users to interrupt an existing call Enable: Prevents other extension users from interrupting an existing call Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.8.2 Executive Busy Override Absent Message Specifies the Personal Absent Message which, unlike the System Absent Message, can be customised for each extension. Value Range Max. 16 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.19.2 Absent Message Charge Limit Specifies the maximum limit of call charges allowed for the extension. When this limit is reached, the extension cannot be used to make further trunk calls. The number of decimal places that can be specified here depends on the value set in Charge Options— Digits After Decimal Point in 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge. Value Range 0–9999999 Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings PC Programming Manual 617 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Feature Guide References 1.9.2 Budget Management Intercom Call by Voice Selects the method of receiving intercom calls. When Deny Voice Call is selected, the extension will always ring when receiving calls, regardless of how the caller wants to make the call. Value Range Tone Call, Voice Call, Deny Voice Call Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.5.3 Intercom Call Option 4 Shelf Indicates the shelf type (reference only). Value Range Physical, Virtual Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Slot Indicates the slot position of each extension card (reference only). 618 PC Programming Manual 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Feature Guide References None Extension Number Specifies the extension number of the extension. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.25 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port—Connection Command PC Programming Manual 619 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Feature Guide References None Extension Name Specifies the name of the extension. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Outgoing Preferred Line Selects the line to be seized after going off-hook to make a call. Value Range No Line: No line is seized. Idle: An idle trunk is seized automatically from the programmed trunk groups. ICM/PDN: An extension line is seized, or, for a PDN extension, an idle PDN button is selected. F-1–F-84: A trunk programmed for a flexible button (F-1–F-84) is seized. A flexible button customised as a Single-CO, Group-CO, Loop-CO, or ICD Group button must be selected. Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Feature Guide References 1.5.5.2 Line Preference—Outgoing Incoming Preferred Line Selects the line on which an incoming call is answered after going off-hook. Note that even if a specific PDN button is selected here, a call ringing at any PDN button on the extension will be answered when going off-hook. 620 PC Programming Manual 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Value Range No Line: No line is selected. Select a line by pressing the desired Line Access button to answer a call. Ringing Line: The longest ringing call is selected. PDN: The call arriving at any PDN button is selected. F-1–F-84: The call arriving at a flexible button (F-1–F-84) is selected. A flexible button customised as a Single-CO, Group-CO, Loop-CO, or ICD Group button must be selected. Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Feature Guide References 1.4.1.2 Line Preference—Incoming Call Waiting Tone Type Selects the type of Call Waiting tone sent to the busy extension. Value Range CW Tone 1, CW Tone 2 Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.8.4.2 Call Waiting Tone LCS Recording Mode Specifies whether to continue or stop recording the message in the extension’s mailbox when the extension user answers a call that was being monitored. Value Range Stop Record, Keep Record Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings PC Programming Manual 621 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.24.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration LCS Answer Mode Specifies whether the extension’s mailbox is monitored in Hands-free or Private mode. Value Range Hands free: Monitor through the built-in speaker Private: Monitor through the handset or the built-in speaker after hearing a warning tone Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.11.1 Hands-free Operation 1.24.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration Option 5 Shelf Indicates the shelf type (reference only). Value Range Physical, Virtual Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Slot Indicates the slot position of each extension card (reference only). 622 PC Programming Manual 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Feature Guide References None Extension Number Specifies the extension number of the extension. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.25 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port—Connection Command PC Programming Manual 623 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Feature Guide References None Extension Name Specifies the name of the extension. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Display Language Selects the display language of the extension telephone. Value Range Language1–Language5 Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.20.4 Display Information Incoming Call Display Selects which caller information is shown on the first line of the extension’s display. Value Range Caller ID Name, CO Line Name, DDI/DID Name Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings 624 PC Programming Manual 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.20.4 Display Information Automatic LCD Switch when Start Talking Enables the first line of the display to show the call duration automatically after answering a trunk call. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.20.4 Display Information Key Pad Tone Specifies whether key pad tones are heard when dialling. Value Range Off, On Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Automatic Answer for CO Call Enables the extension to answer an incoming trunk call automatically after a certain number of rings without going off-hook, when Hands-free Answerback has been set on the extension. This setting is only effective when Forced Automatic Answer on this screen has been set to Off. PC Programming Manual 625 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.4.1.4 Hands-free Answerback Option 6 Shelf Indicates the shelf type (reference only). Value Range Physical, Virtual Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Slot Indicates the slot position of each extension card (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot 626 PC Programming Manual 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Feature Guide References None Extension Number Specifies the extension number of the extension. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.25 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port—Connection Command Feature Guide References None Extension Name Specifies the name of the extension. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings PC Programming Manual 627 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Forced Automatic Answer Specifies whether the extension automatically answers all incoming calls (both intercom and trunk calls) without going off-hook, regardless of the Hands-free Answerback setting. Value Range Off, On Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Flexible Button Programming Mode Specifies whether the extension user can modify all flexible buttons without limitation, or only the One-touch Dialling buttons. When the mode is set to One-touch Dial, there is no need to enter "2" before the number when customising a One-touch Dialling button. Value Range No Limitation, One-touch Dial Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None 628 PC Programming Manual 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings ICM Tone Selects the ring tone for incoming calls arriving at the INTERCOM button or PDN buttons. Note that the ring tone specified here is applied to all PDN buttons on an extension. Value Range KX-DT300 series (except KX-DT321)/KX-T7600 series (except KX-T7665)/IP-PT (except KX-NT265/ KX-NT321): 1–30 KX-DT321/KX-T7665/KX-NT265/KX-NT321: 1–8 (Even if ring tone 9–30 is selected, ring tone 1 is heard.) Other telephones: 1–8 (Even if ring tone 9–30 is selected, ring tone 2 is heard.) Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Display Lock / SVM Lock Locks or unlocks the Incoming Call Log and Simplified Voice Message Log display (i.e., specifies whether other extension users can see the Incoming Call Log and SVM Log information at the extension). Value Range Unlock, Lock Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.2 Incoming Call Log 1.17.7 Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM) Paging Deny Specifies whether paging of the extension from other extensions is enabled. Value Range Disable, Enable PC Programming Manual 629 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.15.1 Paging Option 7 Shelf Indicates the shelf type (reference only). Value Range Physical, Virtual Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Slot Indicates the slot position of each extension card (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot Feature Guide References None 630 PC Programming Manual 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Feature Guide References None Extension Number Specifies the extension number of the extension. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.25 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port—Connection Command Feature Guide References None Extension Name Specifies the name of the extension. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 631 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Feature Guide References None Character Input Mode Selects the character table to be used for entering characters. Value Range Table 1: Standard mode Table 2: Option mode Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Flash Mode during CO Conversation Selects the function of the FLASH/RECALL button during a trunk conversation. Value Range EFA, Terminate, Flash Recall Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.11.6 Flash/Recall/Terminate 1.11.7 External Feature Access (EFA) Incoming Call Log Memory Specifies the number of incoming trunk calls that are retained in the extension’s Incoming Call Log memory. Value Range 0–100 632 PC Programming Manual 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.2 Incoming Call Log Outgoing Call Log Memory Specifies the number of telephone numbers dialled by the extension that are retained in the extension’s Outgoing Call Log memory. Value Range 1–100 Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.6.1.4 Last Number Redial ISDN Bearer Selects the ISDN bearer mode. When Automatic is selected, the bearer mode is set automatically depending on the extension’s telephone type as follows: PT: Speech SLT: Audio Value Range Automatic, Speech, Audio Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.1 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN)—SUMMARY PC Programming Manual 633 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Option 8 Shelf Indicates the shelf type (reference only). Value Range Physical, Virtual Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Slot Indicates the slot position of each extension card (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings 634 PC Programming Manual 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Feature Guide References None Extension Number Specifies the extension number of the extension. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.25 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port—Connection Command Feature Guide References None Extension Name Specifies the name of the extension. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Group CW w/o Tone (Ring after Call) Enables an incoming call to an incoming call distribution group to arrive at a previously busy extension at the moment that the extension goes on-hook for the previous call. PC Programming Manual 635 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Extension Caller ID Sending Enables the extension to send Caller ID information to an SLT. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Incoming Call Wait Timer for Extension Caller ID Specifies the length of time that the ringing for a call is delayed when the call follows immediately after the previous unanswered call. When receiving two calls in quick succession (e.g., when a call waiting in a queue is directed to an extension immediately after the previous unanswered call stops ringing), some SLTs require a pause, after the first call stops ringing, to receive the second call’s Caller ID information. Value Range 0–15 s Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None 636 PC Programming Manual 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Wrap-up Timer Specifies the length of time that must pass after completing a call before an extension will accept another call when logged in as a member of an Incoming Call Distribution Group. This timer is used when " Options—Wrap-up Timer based on" is set to "Extension" in 5.16 [3-5-3] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Miscellaneous. Value Range 0–3000 s Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 5.14 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Member List— Wrap-up Timer 5.16 [3-5-3] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Miscellaneous— Options—Wrap-up Timer based on Feature Guide References 1.2.2.7 Log-in/Log-out Option 9 Shelf Indicates the shelf type (reference only). Value Range Physical, Virtual Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Slot Indicates the slot position of each extension card (reference only). PC Programming Manual 637 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Feature Guide References None Extension Number Specifies the extension number of the extension. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.25 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port—Connection Command 638 PC Programming Manual 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Feature Guide References None Extension Name Specifies the name of the extension. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PDN Delayed Ringing Specifies the delayed ringing setting for calls to a PDN extension (an extension with one or more PDN buttons). Value Range Immediate, 1 Ring, 2 Rings, 3 Rings, 4 Rings, 5 Rings, 6 Rings Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.7.1 Primary Directory Number (PDN)/Secondary Directory Number (SDN) Extension Built-in Communication Assistant Specifies whether to enable or disable the Communication Assistant (CA) application for each extension. This setting is not available when the corresponding extension is a SIP extension. Value Range Disable, Basic Only, Enable PC Programming Manual 639 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR—Port Number— Built-in Communication Assistant Server Feature Guide References 1.32.3 CA (Communication Assistant) FWD / DND Call Forwarding (FWD) and Do Not Disturb (DND) settings for each extension can be referred. FWD and DND settings can be programmed separately for each extension in 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND. Shelf Indicates the shelf type (reference only). Value Range Physical, Virtual Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Slot Indicates the slot position of each extension card (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot 640 PC Programming Manual 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port Feature Guide References None Extension Number Specifies the extension number of the extension. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.25 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port—Connection Command Feature Guide References None Extension Name Specifies the name of the extension. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings PC Programming Manual 641 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None FWD Set for Call from CO Indicates the current FWD status for incoming trunk calls (reference only). Value Range Off, On Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) DND Set for Call from CO Indicates the current DND status for incoming trunk calls (reference only). Value Range Off, On Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND Feature Guide References 1.3.1.3 Do Not Disturb (DND) FWD Mode for Call from CO Indicates the forwarding type of incoming trunk calls (reference only). Value Range None, FWD All, FWD Busy, FWD N/A, FWD Busy N/A 642 PC Programming Manual 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) FWD Destination for Call from CO Indicates the forwarding destination of incoming trunk calls (reference only). Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause]) Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) FWD Set for Call from Extension Indicates the current FWD status for incoming intercom calls (reference only). Value Range Off, On Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) PC Programming Manual 643 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings DND Set for Call from Extension Indicates the current DND status for incoming intercom calls (reference only). Value Range Off, On Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND Feature Guide References 1.3.1.3 Do Not Disturb (DND) FWD Mode for Call from Extension Indicates the forwarding type of incoming intercom calls (reference only). Value Range None, FWD All, FWD Busy, FWD N/A, FWD Busy N/A Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) FWD Destination for Call from Extension Indicates the forwarding destination of incoming intercom calls (reference only). Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause]) Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND 644 PC Programming Manual 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) FWD No Answer Time Indicates the length of time that an incoming call rings at the extension before the call is forwarded (reference only). Value Range 0–120 s Maintenance Console Location 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) PC Programming Manual 645 6.2 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—CLIP Generate 6.2 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings— CLIP Generate CLIP Generate allows the CLIP numbers for a set of locations in series to be programmed together. Pre-assigned CLIP numbers for those locations will be overwritten. If a number generated here is longer than 16 digits, the additional digits will be discarded. Location Entry—Beginning Entry Location (Ext. Number) Specifies the extension number of the first location to be programmed. Value Range Wired extension number Maintenance Console Location 6.2 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—CLIP Generate Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) Location Entry—Number to Generate Specifies the number of locations to be programmed. A CLIP number will only be assigned to connected wired extensions, even if the number entered here is larger than the total number of wired extensions. Value Range 1–total number of connected wired extensions Maintenance Console Location 6.2 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—CLIP Generate Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) Parameter—Deleting Digits Specifies the number of digits to be deleted from the start of an extension number when using it as part of the CLIP number. 646 PC Programming Manual 6.2 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—CLIP Generate Value Range 0–5 Maintenance Console Location 6.2 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—CLIP Generate Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) Parameter—Head of ID Specifies a prefix number to be applied to all generated CLIP numbers. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 6.2 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—CLIP Generate Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) Parameter—Tail of ID Specifies a suffix number to be applied to all generated CLIP numbers. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 6.2 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—CLIP Generate Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings PC Programming Manual 647 6.2 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—CLIP Generate Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) 648 PC Programming Manual 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND For each extension, separate Call Forwarding (FWD) and Do Not Disturb (DND) settings can be programmed for incoming intercom and trunk calls. Select the desired extension from the Extension Number / Name list. Call from CO—Present Button Status Specifies the status of the FWD/DND—External button. Value Range OFF, FWD, DND Maintenance Console Location 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3.1.1 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND)—SUMMARY Call from CO—FWD Status Availability Enables or disables the FWD feature for incoming trunk calls. Value Range OFF: Enables extensions to switch to FWD mode by pressing the FWD/DND button, if forward settings have been programmed. ON: Prevents extensions from switching to FWD mode by pressing the FWD/DND button. Maintenance Console Location 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) Call from CO—DND Status Availability Enables or disables the DND feature for incoming trunk calls. Value Range OFF: Enables extensions to switch to DND mode by pressing the FWD/DND button. ON: Prevents extensions from switching to DND mode by pressing the FWD/DND button. PC Programming Manual 649 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND Maintenance Console Location 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3.1.3 Do Not Disturb (DND) Call from CO—FWD Mode Specifies the circumstances when incoming trunk calls are forwarded. Value Range None, FWD All, FWD Busy, FWD N/A, FWD Busy N/A Maintenance Console Location 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) Call from CO—FWD Destination Specifies the forwarding destination of incoming trunk calls. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause]) Maintenance Console Location 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) 650 PC Programming Manual 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND Call from Extension—Present Button Status Specifies the status of the FWD/DND—Internal button. Value Range OFF, FWD, DND Maintenance Console Location 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3.1.1 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND)—SUMMARY Call from Extension—FWD Status Availability Enables or disables the FWD feature for incoming intercom calls. Value Range OFF: Enables extensions to switch to FWD mode by pressing the FWD/DND button, if forward settings have been programmed. ON: Prevents extensions from switching to FWD mode by pressing the FWD/DND button. Maintenance Console Location 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) Call from Extension—DND Status Availability Enables or disables the DND feature for intercom calls. Value Range OFF: Enables extensions to switch to DND mode by pressing the FWD/DND button. ON: Prevents extensions from switching to DND mode by pressing the FWD/DND button. Maintenance Console Location 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND PC Programming Manual 651 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3.1.3 Do Not Disturb (DND) Call from Extension—FWD Mode Specifies the circumstances when incoming intercom calls are forwarded. Value Range None, FWD All, FWD Busy, FWD N/A, FWD Busy N/A Maintenance Console Location 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) Call from Extension—FWD Destination Specifies the forwarding destination of incoming intercom calls. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause]) Maintenance Console Location 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) FWD No Answer Timer Specifies the length of time that an incoming call rings at the extension before the call is forwarded. Value Range 0–120 s 652 PC Programming Manual 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND Maintenance Console Location 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) PC Programming Manual 653 6.4 [4-1-3] Wired Extension—Speed Dial 6.4 [4-1-3] Wired Extension—Speed Dial Personal Speed Dialling allows extension users to dial frequently dialled numbers using two-digit speed dialling numbers (00–99). A maximum of 100 Personal Speed Dialling numbers can be programmed for each extension. Select the desired extension from the Extension Number / Name list. The available speed dialling numbers are shown in sets of 20. Select the desired set from the Personal Speed Dialling No. list. Speed Dialling Name Specifies the name of the Personal Speed Dialling number to call using the Personal Speed Dialling Directory shown on the extension’s display. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.4 [4-1-3] Wired Extension—Speed Dial Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.6.1.5 Speed Dialling—Personal/System Dialling Number Specifies the number to be dialled by the Personal Speed Dialling number. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash]) Maintenance Console Location 6.4 [4-1-3] Wired Extension—Speed Dial Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.6.1.5 Speed Dialling—Personal/System 654 PC Programming Manual 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Each flexible button can be customised to allow one-touch access to a certain feature. A maximum of 84 flexible buttons can be customised for each extension. Select the desired extension from the Extension Number / Name list. To copy the flexible button settings of an extension to another extension, click Copy To. For more information on flexible buttons, see "1.20.2 Flexible Buttons" in the Feature Guide. Type Specifies the feature to be assigned to the flexible button. Value Range Not Stored, Loop CO, Single CO, Group CO, DSS, One-touch, ICD Group, Message Waiting, FWD/DND (Both), FWD/DND (External), FWD/DND (Internal), Group Fwd (Both), Group Fwd (External), Group Fwd (Internal), Account, Conference, Terminate, EFA, Charge, Call Park, Call Log, Log-in/Log-out, Hurry-up, Wrap-up, System Alarm, Time Service, Answer, Release, TRS Level Change, ISDN Service, CLIR, COLR, ISDN Hold, Headset, Time Service - Automatic/Manual, Check In, Check Out, Cleaned Up, Two-way Record, Two-way Transfer, LCS, Voice Mail Transfer, NDSS, CTI, PDN, SDN Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References 6.6 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button—Flexible button data copy Feature Guide References None Parameter Selection (for Single CO) Specifies the trunk to be accessed. Value Range 1–128 Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.5.5.3 Trunk Access PC Programming Manual 655 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Parameter Selection (for Group CO) Specifies the trunk group to be accessed. Value Range 1–64 Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.5.5.3 Trunk Access Parameter Selection (for Call Park) Specifies whether a call is parked in an idle parking zone automatically or in a specific parking zone. Value Range Automatic, Specific Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.13.2 Call Park Parameter Selection (for Log-in/Log-out) Specifies which incoming call distribution groups that the extension belongs to are logged in to or logged out from. Value Range None: The incoming call distribution group is selected manually. All: All incoming call distribution groups that the extension belongs to. Incoming Group: A pre-specified incoming call distribution group Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button 656 PC Programming Manual 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.2.2.7 Log-in/Log-out Parameter Selection (for Time Service) Selects which time modes are switched manually. Value Range All (Day/Night/Lunch/Break), Day/Night/Break, Day/Night/Lunch, Day/Night Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.4 Time Service Parameter Selection (for TRS Level Change) Specifies the TRS/Barring level to be used temporarily on a certain extension. Value Range 1–7 Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.9.1 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) 1.9.4 Dial Tone Transfer Parameter Selection (for Time Service - Automatic/Manual) Specifies the Time Table to be used when the Time Service Switching Mode is set to Automatic. PC Programming Manual 657 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Value Range 1–8 Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.4 Time Service Parameter Selection (for SDN) Specifies the delayed ringing setting for calls arriving at an SDN button. Value Range Immediate, 1 Ring, 2 Rings, 3 Rings, 4 Rings, 5 Rings, 6 Rings, No Ring Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.7.1 Primary Directory Number (PDN)/Secondary Directory Number (SDN) Extension Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for DSS) Specifies the number of an extension to be accessed. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None 658 PC Programming Manual 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Feature Guide References None Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for ICD Group) Specifies the floating extension number of an incoming call distribution group to be accessed. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Message Waiting) Specifies the number of an extension or floating extension number of an incoming call distribution group for which messages are checked. If this cell is left empty, the extension will check its own messages only. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Group Fwd (Both)) Specifies the floating extension number of an incoming call distribution group for which both intercom and trunk calls are forwarded. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) PC Programming Manual 659 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND) Features Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Group Fwd (External)) Specifies the floating extension number of an incoming call distribution group for which trunk calls are forwarded. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND) Features Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Group Fwd (Internal)) Specifies the floating extension number of an incoming call distribution group for which intercom calls are forwarded. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND) Features 660 PC Programming Manual 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Call Log) Specifies the extension’s own number or the floating extension number of an incoming call distribution group for which call log information is displayed. If the cell is left empty, the extension will display its own call log information. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Log-in/Log-out) Specifies the floating extension number of an incoming call distribution group to log-in to or log-out from. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.2.2.7 Log-in/Log-out Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Hurry-up) Specifies the floating extension number of the incoming call distribution group whose longest waiting call will be redirected (Manual Queue Redirection). Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button PC Programming Manual 661 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.2.2.4 Queuing Feature Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Two-way Record) Specifies the floating extension number of the VM (DPT) group containing the extension’s mailbox. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.24.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Two-way Transfer) Specifies the floating extension number of the VM (DPT) group containing the desired mailbox. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.24.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Voice Mail Transfer) Specifies the floating extension number of the VM (DTMF/DPT) group containing the desired mailbox. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) 662 PC Programming Manual 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.24.2 Voice Mail DTMF Integration 1.24.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for SDN) Specifies the floating extension number of the PDN extension corresponding to this SDN button. Note that the extension specified here must have a PDN button registered for the SDN button to function. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.7.1 Primary Directory Number (PDN)/Secondary Directory Number (SDN) Extension Dial (for One-touch) Specifies the number to be dialled. The PBX can have a maximum of 2000 One-touch Dialling buttons for extensions and DSS Consoles. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash]) Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.6.1.2 One-touch Dialling PC Programming Manual 663 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Dial (for ISDN Service) Specifies the number required to access the telephone company’s ISDN service. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash]) Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.12 ISDN Service Access by Keypad Protocol Dial (for NDSS) Specifies the network extension number of the extension to be accessed using Network Direct Station Selection. Note that only extension numbers that have been previously registered in 11.4 [9-4] NDSS Key Table can be specified here. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash]) Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.30.5.1 Network Direct Station Selection (NDSS) Label Name Specifies the name of each flexible button on the KX-NT366/KX-NT400 IP-PT. The name specified here is displayed on the LCD for each button. A maximum of 48 flexible buttons can be customised for this extension. Value Range Max. 12 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button 664 PC Programming Manual 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.31.4 Self Labelling (KX-NT366 and KX-NT400 only) Optional Parameter (Ringing Tone Type Number) (for Time Service) Specifies the Time Table to be used for changing time modes in the Automatic Switching mode. Value Range 1–8 Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.4 Time Service Optional Parameter (Ringing Tone Type Number) (for Loop CO, Single CO, Group CO, ICD Group, SDN) Specifies the ring tone type. Value Range KX-DT300 series (except KX-DT321)/KX-T7600 series (except KX-T7665)/IP-PT (except KX-NT265/ KX-NT321): 1–30 KX-DT321/KX-T7665/KX-NT265/KX-NT321: 1–8 (Even if ring tone 9–30 is selected, ring tone 1 is heard.) Other telephones: 1–8 (Even if ring tone 9–30 is selected, ring tone 2 is heard.) Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 665 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Optional Parameter (Ringing Tone Type Number) (for Call Park) Specifies the number of the parking zone a call is to be parked in when a Call Park button with Selection (for Call Park) on this screen set to Specific is pressed. Parameter Value Range 0–99 Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.13.2 Call Park Ext No. of Mailbox (for Two-way Transfer) Specifies the number of the extension whose mailbox will be used to record conversations using One-touch Two-way Transfer. (For example, a secretary can record a conversation into the mailbox of a boss.) If the cell is left empty, the extension user must specify the number of an extension each time. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.24.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration 666 PC Programming Manual 6.6 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button—Flexible button data copy 6.6 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button— Flexible button data copy The flexible button settings of an extension can be copied to different extensions. Destination Extension Line Select the number and name of the extension that will receive the copied settings. Multiple extensions can be selected. To select all extensions at once, click Select All. When selecting multiple extensions, note that if the source extension has an SDN button, the copy operation cannot be performed. Maintenance Console Location 6.6 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button—Flexible button data copy Programming Manual References 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 667 6.7 [4-1-5] Wired Extension—PF Button 6.7 [4-1-5] Wired Extension—PF Button Each Programmable Feature (PF) button can be customised to access a certain feature with one touch. A maximum of 12 PF buttons can be customised for each extension. Select the desired extension from the Extension Number / Name list. Type Specifies whether to store a dialling number for the one-touch access. Value Range Not Stored, One Touch Maintenance Console Location 6.7 [4-1-5] Wired Extension—PF Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.20.2 Flexible Buttons Dial Specifies the number to be dialled. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash]) Maintenance Console Location 6.7 [4-1-5] Wired Extension—PF Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.20.2 Flexible Buttons 668 PC Programming Manual 6.8 [4-1-6] Wired Extension—NDSS Link Data - Send 6.8 [4-1-6] Wired Extension—NDSS Link Data - Send It is possible to cancel the transmission of an extension’s status data over the network. Select the desired extension from the Extension Number / Name list. Network BLF Data to NDSS Key of Other PBX - Other PBX (Network PBX ID=1) Selects whether extension status data is transmitted over the network for the selected extension. This setting is automatically set to ON when the feature is used, and can only be manually changed from ON to OFF, to cancel data transmission. Value Range OFF, ON Maintenance Console Location 6.8 [4-1-6] Wired Extension—NDSS Link Data - Send Programming Manual References 11.1 [9-1] TIE Table Feature Guide References 1.30.5.1 Network Direct Station Selection (NDSS) PC Programming Manual 669 6.9 [4-1-7] Wired Extension—Simplified Voice Message 6.9 [4-1-7] Wired Extension—Simplified Voice Message The Built-in Simplified Voice Message feature can be provided for each extension. This screen allows you to specify which extension uses this feature, and the maximum number of messages that can be stored for each extension. For more information on Simplified Voice Message, see "1.17.7 Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM)" in the Feature Guide. Shelf Indicates the shelf type (reference only). Value Range Physical, Virtual Maintenance Console Location 6.9 [4-1-7] Wired Extension—Simplified Voice Message Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 6.9 [4-1-7] Wired Extension—Simplified Voice Message Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). 670 PC Programming Manual 6.9 [4-1-7] Wired Extension—Simplified Voice Message Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 6.9 [4-1-7] Wired Extension—Simplified Voice Message Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Extension Number Indicates the extension number (reference only). Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.9 [4-1-7] Wired Extension—Simplified Voice Message Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station Feature Guide References None Extension Name Indicates the name of the extension (reference only). Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.9 [4-1-7] Wired Extension—Simplified Voice Message Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— Extension Name PC Programming Manual 671 6.9 [4-1-7] Wired Extension—Simplified Voice Message Feature Guide References None Simplified Voice Message Selects which card (IPCMPR or ESVM) to use to store and play back greetings and messages for the extension. Each extension must be assigned to a specific card and block within the card, and can only use the assigned card/block. If two cards are used in the PBX, you should assign a number of extensions to each card, to ensure that the necessary resources, such as message recording space, are available for each extension. Value Range None, Card1(A), Card1(B), Card2(A), Card2(B) Maintenance Console Location 6.9 [4-1-7] Wired Extension—Simplified Voice Message Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Maximum SVM Log Specifies the maximum number of voice messages (not including greeting messages) that can be stored for the extension. Value Range 1–100 Maintenance Console Location 6.9 [4-1-7] Wired Extension—Simplified Voice Message Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None 672 PC Programming Manual 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings For each Portable Station (PS), various extension settings can be assigned. A maximum of 64 PSs can be programmed. To assign names and tenants to extension user groups, click Extension User Group Table. See 5.7 [3-2] User Group for more details. Main Extension Number Indicates the extension number of the PS (reference only). Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Extension No. Feature Guide References None Extension Name Specifies the name of the PS. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Extension Name Feature Guide References None Property Indicates the property (reference only). PC Programming Manual 673 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Value Range Portable Station Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None User Group Specifies the extension user group to which the PS belongs. The extension user group is used to compose tenants, call pickup groups and paging groups. Value Range 1–32 Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.2 Group 2.2.3 Tenant Service COS Specifies the COS of the PS. Value Range 1–64 Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings 674 PC Programming Manual 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 2.2.1 Class of Service (COS) Extension PIN Specifies the PIN of the PS. CAUTION There is a risk that fraudulent telephone calls will be made if a third party discovers a personal identification number (PIN) (verification code PIN or extension PIN) of the PBX. The cost of such calls will be billed to the owner/renter of the PBX. To protect the PBX from this kind of fraudulent use, we strongly recommend: a. Keeping PINs secret. b. Selecting complex, random PINs that cannot be easily guessed. c. Changing PINs frequently. Value Range Max. 10 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.28.1 Extension Personal Identification Number (PIN) Intercept Destination Extension Number Indicates the extension number of the PS (reference only). Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Extension No. Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 675 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Extension Name Specifies the name of the PS. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Extension Name Feature Guide References None Intercept Destination—When called party does not answer—Day, Lunch, Break, Night Specifies the Intercept Routing destination of calls in each time mode for Intercept Routing–No Answer and Intercept Routing–DND. Note that Intercept Routing–Busy calls are routed using Intercept Destination—When Called Party is Busy below. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause]) Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Intercept Destination— Called Party is Busy Intercept Destination—When Feature Guide References 1.1.1.6 Intercept Routing Intercept Destination—When Called Party is Busy Specifies the Intercept Routing destination of calls when the extension is busy. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause]) 676 PC Programming Manual 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.1.6 Intercept Routing Intercept No Answer Time Extension Number Indicates the extension number of the PS (reference only). Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Extension No. Feature Guide References None Extension Name Specifies the name of the PS. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Extension Name Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 677 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Intercept No Answer Time—Day, Lunch, Break, Night Specifies the length of time until an unanswered call is redirected to the intercept routing destination in each time mode. When this setting is set to "0", the system timer is used. Value Range 0–240 s Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone— Lunch, Break, Night Feature Guide References 1.1.1.6 Intercept Routing ISDN CLIP Extension Number Indicates the extension number of the PS (reference only). Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Extension No. Feature Guide References None Extension Name Specifies the name of the PS. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings 678 PC Programming Manual Intercept Routing No Answer (IRNA)—Day, 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Extension Name Feature Guide References None CLIP ID Specifies the CLIP number sent to the public network to show on the called party’s telephone display when making a trunk call. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) CLIP on Extension/CO Selects the CLIP number to show on the called party’s telephone. Value Range Extension: Show the CLIP number specified in CLIP ID on the Option 1 tab. CO: Show the CLIP number specified in Subscriber Number in 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port or 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port. Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—ISDN CO— Subscriber Number 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—CO Setting— Subscriber Number 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—ISDN CLIP— CLIP ID Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) PC Programming Manual 679 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings CLIR Specifies whether to restrict the display of the CLIP number on the called party’s telephone when making a public network trunk call. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) COLR Specifies whether to restrict the display of the CLIP number of the PS on the caller’s telephone display when answering a call. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) Option 1 Extension Number Indicates the extension number of the PS (reference only). Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings 680 PC Programming Manual 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Extension No. Feature Guide References None Extension Name Specifies the name of the PS. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Extension Name Feature Guide References None Ring Pattern Table Specifies the Ring Tone Pattern Table to be used by the PS. Value Range 1–8 Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 4.15 [2-8-1] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from CO 4.16 [2-8-2] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from Doorphone 4.17 [2-8-3] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from Others Feature Guide References 1.1.3.2 Ring Tone Pattern Selection Programmed Mailbox No. Specifies the mailbox number of the PS’s mailbox for Voice Processing Systems (VPS) with DTMF Integration. PC Programming Manual 681 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.24.2 Voice Mail DTMF Integration Transfer Recall Destination Specifies the transfer recall destination when an extension user transfers a call with the Call Transfer without Announcement feature and the transferred call is not answered within a certain time period. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.12.1 Call Transfer ARS Itemised Code Specifies the itemised billing code used by the ARS feature for identifying the calls made from the PS for accounting and billing purposes. Value Range Max. 10 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 10.6 [8-5] Carrier 682 PC Programming Manual 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.9.6 Verification Code Entry 1.10.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS) Option 2 Extension Number Indicates the extension number of the PS (reference only). Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Extension No. Feature Guide References None Extension Name Specifies the name of the PS. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Extension Name Feature Guide References None Manual C. Waiting for Extension Call Selects the method of receiving call waiting notification from other extensions. Value Range Off: No notification BSS: Tone from the handset or built-in speaker PC Programming Manual 683 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.3.3 Call Waiting Automatic C. Waiting Specifies whether to receive call waiting notification for a call from trunk, a doorphone call or a call via an incoming call distribution group. Value Range Off, On Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.3.3 Call Waiting Pickup Dial Set Sets or cancels the Hot Line feature. The number specified in Pickup Dial No. on this screen is dialled automatically after going off-hook when the Hot Line feature is active. Value Range Off, On Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone— Feature Guide References 1.6.1.7 Hot Line 684 PC Programming Manual Dial—Hot Line (Pickup Dial) Start 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Pickup Dial No. Specifies the number to be dialled automatically after going off-hook when the Hot Line feature is active. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash]) Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.6.1.7 Hot Line Option 3 Extension Number Indicates the extension number of the PS (reference only). Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Extension No. Feature Guide References None Extension Name Specifies the name of the PS. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings PC Programming Manual 685 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Extension Name Feature Guide References None Call Pickup Deny Specifies whether calls can be picked up by other extensions. Value Range Disable: Allows other extension users to pick up calls to your PS Enable: Prevents other extension users from picking up calls to your PS Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.4.1.3 Call Pickup Executive Override Deny Specifies whether calls can be interrupted by other extensions. Value Range Disable: Allows other extension users to interrupt an existing call Enable: Prevents other extension users from interrupting an existing call Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.8.2 Executive Busy Override Absent Message Specifies the Personal Absent Message which, unlike the System Absent Message, can be customised for each PS. 686 PC Programming Manual 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Value Range Max. 16 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.19.2 Absent Message Charge Limit Specifies the maximum limit of call charges allowed for the PS. When this limit is reached, the PS cannot be used to make further trunk calls. The number of decimal places that can be specified here depends on the value set in Charge Options— Digits After Decimal Point in 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge. Value Range 0–9999999 Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Feature Guide References 1.9.2 Budget Management Option 4 Extension Number Indicates the extension number of the PS (reference only). Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings PC Programming Manual 687 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Extension No. Feature Guide References None Extension Name Specifies the name of the PS. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Extension Name Feature Guide References None Outgoing Preferred Line Selects the line to be seized after going off-hook to make a call. Value Range No Line: No line is seized. Idle: An idle trunk is seized automatically from the programmed trunk groups. ICM/PDN: An extension line is seized, or, for a PDN extension, an idle PDN button is selected. F-1–F-12: A trunk programmed for a flexible button (F-1–F-12) is seized. A flexible button customised as a Single-CO, Group-CO, Loop-CO, or ICD Group button must be selected. Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Feature Guide References 1.5.5.2 Line Preference—Outgoing 688 PC Programming Manual 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Incoming Preferred Line Selects the line on which an incoming call is answered after going off-hook. Note that even if a specific PDN button is selected here, a call ringing at any PDN button on the extension will be answered when going off-hook. Value Range No Line: No line is selected. Select a line by pressing the desired Line Access button to answer a call. Ringing Line: The longest ringing call is selected. PDN: The call arriving at any PDN button is selected. F-1–F-12: The call arriving at a flexible button (F-1–F-12) is selected. A flexible button customised as a Single-CO, Group-CO, Loop-CO, or ICD Group button must be selected. Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Feature Guide References 1.4.1.2 Line Preference—Incoming Call Waiting Tone Type Selects the type of Call Waiting tone sent to the busy extension. Value Range CW Tone 1, CW Tone 2 Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.8.4.2 Call Waiting Tone LCS Recording Mode Specifies whether to continue or stop recording the message in the PS’s mailbox when the PS user answers a call that was being monitored. Value Range Stop Record, Keep Record PC Programming Manual 689 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.24.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration Option 5 Extension Number Indicates the extension number of the PS (reference only). Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Extension No. Feature Guide References None Extension Name Specifies the name of the PS. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Feature Guide References None 690 PC Programming Manual Extension Name 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Display Language Selects the display language of the PS. Value Range Language1–Language5 Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.20.4 Display Information Incoming Call Display Selects which caller information is shown on the first line of the PS’s display. Value Range Caller ID Name, CO Line Name, DDI/DID Name Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.20.4 Display Information Automatic LCD Switch when Start Talking Enables the first line of the display to show the call duration automatically after answering a trunk call. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 691 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.20.4 Display Information Option 6 Extension Number Indicates the extension number of the PS (reference only). Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Extension No. Feature Guide References None Extension Name Specifies the name of the PS. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Extension Name Feature Guide References None Flexible Button Programming Mode Specifies whether the PS user can modify all flexible buttons without limitation, or only the One-touch Dialling buttons. When the mode is set to One-touch Dial, there is no need to enter "2" before the number when customising a One-touch Dialling button. Value Range No Limitation, One-touch Dial 692 PC Programming Manual 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.6.1.2 One-touch Dialling SVM Lock Selects whether Simplified Voice Message Log information can be displayed at the extension or other extensions. Value Range Lock, Unlock Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 6.16 [4-2-5] Portable Station—Simplified Voice Message Feature Guide References 1.17.7 Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM) Option 7 Extension Number Indicates the extension number of the PS (reference only). Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Extension No. Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 693 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Extension Name Specifies the name of the PS. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Extension Name Feature Guide References None Character Input Mode Selects the character table to be used for entering characters. Value Range Table 1: Standard mode Table 2: Option mode Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Flash Mode during CO Conversation Selects the function of the FLASH/RECALL button during a trunk conversation. Value Range EFA, Terminate, Flash Recall Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings 694 PC Programming Manual 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.11.6 Flash/Recall/Terminate 1.11.7 External Feature Access (EFA) Incoming Call Log Memory Specifies the number of incoming trunk calls that are retained in the PS’s Incoming Call Log memory. Value Range 0–100 Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.18.2 Incoming Call Log Outgoing Call Log Memory Specifies the number of telephone numbers dialled by the PS that are retained in the PS’s Outgoing Call Log memory. Value Range 1–100 Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.6.1.4 Last Number Redial ISDN Bearer Selects the ISDN bearer mode. When Automatic is selected, the bearer mode is set automatically depending on the type of the PS. PC Programming Manual 695 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Value Range Automatic, Speech, Audio Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.1 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN)—SUMMARY Option 8 Extension Number Indicates the extension number of the PS (reference only). Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Extension No. Feature Guide References None Extension Name Specifies the name of the PS. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— 696 PC Programming Manual Extension Name 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Feature Guide References None Group CW w/o Tone (Ring after Call) Enables an incoming call to an incoming call distribution group to arrive at a previously busy extension at the moment that the extension goes on-hook for the previous call. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Wrap-up Timer Specifies the length of time that must pass after completing a call before a PS will accept another call when logged in as a member of an Incoming Call Distribution Group. This timer is used when " Options—Wrap-up Timer based on" is set to "Extension" in 5.16 [3-5-3] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Miscellaneous. Value Range 0–3000 s Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 5.14 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Member List— Wrap-up Timer 5.16 [3-5-3] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Miscellaneous— Options—Wrap-up Timer based on Feature Guide References 1.2.2.7 Log-in/Log-out Option 9 Extension Number Indicates the extension number of the PS (reference only). PC Programming Manual 697 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Extension No. Feature Guide References None Extension Name Specifies the name of the PS. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Extension Name Feature Guide References None PDN Delayed Ringing Specifies the delayed ringing setting for calls to a PDN extension (an extension with one or more PDN buttons). Value Range Immediate, 1 Ring, 2 Rings, 3 Rings, 4 Rings, 5 Rings, 6 Rings Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References None 698 PC Programming Manual 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.7.1 Primary Directory Number (PDN)/Secondary Directory Number (SDN) Extension Built-in Communication Assistant Specifies whether to enable or disable the Communication Assistant (CA) application for each extension. Value Range Disable, Basic Only, Enable Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR—Port Number— Built-in Communication Assistant Server Feature Guide References 1.32.3 CA (Communication Assistant) FWD / DND Reference Call Forwarding (FWD) and Do Not Disturb (DND) settings for each PS can be referred. FWD and DND settings can be programmed separately for each PS in 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND. Extension Number Indicates the extension number of the PS (reference only). Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Extension No. Feature Guide References None Extension Name Specifies the name of the PS. PC Programming Manual 699 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Extension Name Feature Guide References None FWD Set for Call from CO Indicates the current FWD status for incoming trunk calls (reference only). Value Range Off, On Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) DND Set for Call from CO Indicates the current DND status for incoming trunk calls (reference only). Value Range Off, On Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND 700 PC Programming Manual 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.3.1.3 Do Not Disturb (DND) FWD Mode for Call from CO Indicates the forwarding type of incoming trunk calls (reference only). Value Range None, FWD All, FWD Busy, FWD N/A, FWD Busy N/A Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) FWD Destination for Call from CO Indicates the forwarding destination of incoming trunk calls (reference only). Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause]) Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) FWD Set for Call from Extension Indicates the current FWD status for incoming intercom calls (reference only). Value Range Off, On Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings PC Programming Manual 701 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) DND Set for Call from Extension Indicates the current DND status for incoming intercom calls (reference only). Value Range Off, On Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Feature Guide References 1.3.1.3 Do Not Disturb (DND) FWD Mode for Call from Extension Indicates the forwarding type of incoming intercom calls (reference only). Value Range None, FWD All, FWD Busy, FWD N/A, FWD Busy N/A Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) FWD Destination for Call from Extension Indicates the forwarding destination of incoming intercom calls (reference only). Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause]) 702 PC Programming Manual 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) FWD No Answer Time Indicates the length of time that an incoming call rings at the PS before the call is forwarded (reference only). Value Range 0–120 s Maintenance Console Location 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Programming Manual References 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) PC Programming Manual 703 6.11 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—CLIP Generate 6.11 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings— CLIP Generate CLIP Generate allows the CLIP numbers for a set of locations in series to be programmed together. Pre-assigned CLIP numbers for those locations will be overwritten. If a number generated here is longer than 16 digits, the additional digits will be discarded. Location Entry—Beginning Entry Location (Ext. Number) Specifies the extension number of the first location to be programmed. Value Range PS extension number Maintenance Console Location 6.11 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—CLIP Generate Programming Manual References 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) Location Entry—Number to Generate Specifies the number of locations to be programmed. A CLIP number will only be assigned to registered PS extensions, even if the number entered here is larger than the total number of PS extensions. Value Range 1–total number of connected wired extensions Maintenance Console Location 6.11 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—CLIP Generate Programming Manual References 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) Parameter—Deleting Digits Specifies the number of digits to be deleted from the start of an extension number when using it as part of the CLIP number. 704 PC Programming Manual 6.11 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—CLIP Generate Value Range 0–4 Maintenance Console Location 6.11 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—CLIP Generate Programming Manual References 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) Parameter—Head of ID Specifies a prefix number to be applied to all generated CLIP numbers. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 6.11 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—CLIP Generate Programming Manual References 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) Parameter—Tail of ID Specifies a suffix number to be applied to all generated CLIP numbers. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 6.11 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—CLIP Generate Programming Manual References 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings PC Programming Manual 705 6.11 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—CLIP Generate Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) 706 PC Programming Manual 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND For each PS, separate Call Forwarding (FWD) and Do Not Disturb (DND) settings can be programmed for incoming intercom and trunk calls. Select the desired PS from the Extension Number / Name list. Call from CO—Present Button Status Specifies the status of the FWD/DND—External button. Value Range OFF, FWD, DND Maintenance Console Location 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3.1.1 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND)—SUMMARY Call from CO—FWD Status Availability Enables or disables the FWD feature for incoming trunk calls. Value Range OFF: Enables extensions to switch to FWD mode by pressing the FWD/DND button, if forward settings have been programmed. ON: Prevents extensions from switching to FWD mode by pressing the FWD/DND button. Maintenance Console Location 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) Call from CO—DND Status Availability Enables or disables the DND feature for incoming trunk calls. Value Range OFF: Enables extensions to switch to DND mode by pressing the FWD/DND button. ON: Prevents extensions from switching to DND mode by pressing the FWD/DND button. PC Programming Manual 707 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Maintenance Console Location 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3.1.3 Do Not Disturb (DND) Call from CO—FWD Mode Specifies the circumstances when incoming trunk calls are forwarded. Value Range None, FWD All, FWD Busy, FWD N/A, FWD Busy N/A Maintenance Console Location 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) Call from CO—FWD Destination Specifies the forwarding destination of incoming trunk calls. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause]) Maintenance Console Location 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) 708 PC Programming Manual 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Call from Extension—Present Button Status Specifies the status of the FWD/DND—Internal button. Value Range OFF, FWD, DND Maintenance Console Location 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3.1.1 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND)—SUMMARY Call from Extension—FWD Status Availability Enables or disables the FWD feature for incoming intercom calls. Value Range OFF: Enables extensions to switch to FWD mode by pressing the FWD/DND button, if forward settings have been programmed. ON: Prevents extensions from switching to FWD mode by pressing the FWD/DND button. Maintenance Console Location 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) Call from Extension—DND Status Availability Enables or disables the DND feature for incoming intercom calls. Value Range OFF: Enables extensions to switch to DND mode by pressing the FWD/DND button. ON: Prevents extensions from switching to DND mode by pressing the FWD/DND button. Maintenance Console Location 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND PC Programming Manual 709 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3.1.3 Do Not Disturb (DND) Call from Extension—FWD Mode Specifies the circumstances when incoming intercom calls are forwarded. Value Range None, FWD All, FWD Busy, FWD N/A, FWD Busy N/A Maintenance Console Location 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) Call from Extension—FWD Destination Specifies the forwarding destination of incoming intercom calls. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause]) Maintenance Console Location 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) FWD No Answer Timer Specifies the length of time that an incoming call rings at the PS before the call is forwarded. Value Range 0–120 s 710 PC Programming Manual 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Maintenance Console Location 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) PC Programming Manual 711 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Each flexible button can be customised to allow one-touch access to a certain feature. A maximum of 12 flexible buttons can be customised for each PS. Select the desired PS from the Extension Number / Name list. To copy values from one location to another, click the Copy To button. For more information on flexible buttons, see "1.20.2 Flexible Buttons" in the Feature Guide. Type Specifies the feature to be assigned to the flexible button. Value Range Not Stored, Loop CO, Single CO, Group CO, DSS, One-touch, ICD Group, Message Waiting, FWD/DND (Both), FWD/DND (External), FWD/DND (Internal), Group Fwd (Both), Group Fwd (External), Group Fwd (Internal), Account, Conference, Terminate, EFA, Charge, Call Park, Log-in/Log-out, Hurry-up, Wrap-up, Time Service, TRS Level Change, ISDN Service, CLIR, COLR, ISDN Hold, Time Service - Automatic/Manual, Two-way Record, Two-way Transfer, LCS, Voice Mail Transfer, NDSS, CTI, PDN, SDN Maintenance Console Location 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Programming Manual References 6.14 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button—Flexible button data copy Feature Guide References None Parameter Selection (for Single CO) Specifies the trunk to be accessed. Value Range 1–128 Maintenance Console Location 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.5.5.3 Trunk Access Parameter Selection (for Group CO) Specifies the trunk group to be accessed. 712 PC Programming Manual 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Value Range 1–64 Maintenance Console Location 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.5.5.3 Trunk Access Parameter Selection (for Call Park) Specifies whether a call is parked in an idle parking zone automatically, or in a specific parking zone. Value Range Automatic, Specific Maintenance Console Location 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.13.2 Call Park Parameter Selection (for Log-in/Log-out) Specifies which incoming call distribution groups that the PS belongs to are logged in to or logged out from. Value Range None: The incoming call distribution group is selected manually. All: All incoming call distribution groups that the PS belongs to. Incoming Group: A pre-specified incoming call distribution group Maintenance Console Location 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 713 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Feature Guide References 1.2.2.7 Log-in/Log-out Parameter Selection (for Time Service) Selects which time modes are switched manually. Value Range All (Day/Night/Lunch/Break), Day/Night/Break, Day/Night/Lunch, Day/Night Maintenance Console Location 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.4 Time Service Parameter Selection (for TRS Level Change) Specifies the TRS/Barring level to be used temporarily on a certain PS. Value Range 1–7 Maintenance Console Location 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.9.1 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) 1.9.4 Dial Tone Transfer Parameter Selection (for Time Service - Automatic/Manual) Specifies the Time Table to be used when the Time Service Switching Mode is set to Automatic. Value Range 1–8 714 PC Programming Manual 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Maintenance Console Location 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.4 Time Service Parameter Selection (for SDN) Specifies the delayed ringing setting for calls arriving at an SDN button. The value specified here is only used when System Wireless—SDN Delayed Ringing with LCD on 4.18 [2-9] System Options is set to "Enable". Value Range Immediate, 1 Ring, 2 Rings, 3 Rings, 4 Rings, 5 Rings, 6 Rings, No Ring Maintenance Console Location 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Programming Manual References 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 4— System Wireless—SDN Delayed Ringing with LCD Feature Guide References 1.7.1 Primary Directory Number (PDN)/Secondary Directory Number (SDN) Extension Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for DSS) Specifies the number of an extension to be accessed. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 715 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for ICD Group) Specifies the floating extension number of an incoming call distribution group to be accessed. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Message Waiting) Specifies the number of an extension or floating extension number of an incoming call distribution group for which messages are checked. If this cell is left empty, the PS will check its own messages only. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Group Fwd (Both)) Specifies the floating extension number of an incoming call distribution group for which both intercom and trunk calls are forwarded. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button 716 PC Programming Manual 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND) Features Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Group Fwd (External)) Specifies the floating extension number of an incoming call distribution group for which trunk calls are forwarded. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND) Features Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Group Fwd (Internal)) Specifies the floating extension number of an incoming call distribution group for which intercom calls are forwarded. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND) Features Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Log-in/Log-out) Specifies the floating extension number of an incoming call distribution group to log-in to or log-out from. PC Programming Manual 717 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Hurry-up) Specifies the floating extension number of the incoming call distribution group whose longest waiting call will be redirected (Manual Queue Redirection). Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.2.2.4 Queuing Feature Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Two-way Record) Specifies the floating extension number of the VM (DPT) group containing the PS’s mailbox. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None 718 PC Programming Manual 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Feature Guide References 1.24.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Two-way Transfer) Specifies the floating extension number of the VM (DPT) group containing the desired mailbox. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.24.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Voice Mail Transfer) Specifies the floating extension number of the VM (DTMF/DPT) group containing the desired mailbox. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.24.2 Voice Mail DTMF Integration 1.24.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for SDN) Specifies the floating extension number of the corresponding (owner) extension for the SDN button. Note that the extension specified here must have a PDN button registered for the SDN button to function. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) PC Programming Manual 719 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Maintenance Console Location 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.7.1 Primary Directory Number (PDN)/Secondary Directory Number (SDN) Extension Dial (for One-touch) Specifies the number to be dialled. The PBX can have a maximum of 500 One-touch Dialling buttons for PSs. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash]) Maintenance Console Location 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.6.1.2 One-touch Dialling Dial (for ISDN Service) Specifies the number required to access the telephone company’s ISDN service. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash]) Maintenance Console Location 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.12 ISDN Service Access by Keypad Protocol 720 PC Programming Manual 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Dial (for NDSS) Specifies the network extension number of the extension to be accessed using Network Direct Station Selection. Note that only extension numbers that have been previously registered in 11.4 [9-4] NDSS Key Table can be specified here. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash]) Maintenance Console Location 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.30.5.1 Network Direct Station Selection (NDSS) Optional Parameter (or Ringing Tone Type Number) (for Time Service) Specifies the Time Table to be used for changing time modes in the Automatic Switching mode. Value Range 1–8 Maintenance Console Location 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.4 Time Service Optional Parameter (or Ringing Tone Type Number) (for Call Park) Specifies the number of the parking zone a call is to be parked in when a Call Park button with Selection (for Call Park) on this screen set to Specific is pressed. Parameter Value Range 0–99 Maintenance Console Location 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button PC Programming Manual 721 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.13.2 Call Park Ext No. of Mailbox (for Two-way Transfer) Specifies the number of the extension whose mailbox will be used to record conversations using One-touch Two-way Transfer. (For example, a secretary can record a conversation into the mailbox of a boss.) If the cell is left empty, the extension user must specify the number of an extension each time. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.24.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration 722 PC Programming Manual 6.14 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button—Flexible button data copy 6.14 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button— Flexible button data copy The flexible button settings of a PS can be copied to different PSs. Destination Extension Line Select the number and name of the PS that will receive the copied settings. Multiple PSs can be selected. To select all PSs at once, click Select All. When selecting multiple extensions, note that if the source extension has an SDN button, the copy operation cannot be performed. Maintenance Console Location 6.14 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button—Flexible button data copy Programming Manual References 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 723 6.15 [4-2-4] Portable Station—NDSS Link Data - Send 6.15 [4-2-4] Portable Station—NDSS Link Data - Send It is possible to cancel the transmission of an extension’s status data over the network. Select the desired extension from the Extension Number / Name list. Network BLF Data to NDSS Key of Other PBX - Other PBX (Network PBX ID=1) Selects whether extension status data is transmitted over the network for the selected extension. This setting is automatically set to ON when the feature is used, and can only be manually changed from ON to OFF, to cancel data transmission. Value Range OFF, ON Maintenance Console Location 6.15 [4-2-4] Portable Station—NDSS Link Data - Send Programming Manual References 11.4 [9-4] NDSS Key Table Feature Guide References 1.30.5.1 Network Direct Station Selection (NDSS) 724 PC Programming Manual 6.16 [4-2-5] Portable Station—Simplified Voice Message 6.16 [4-2-5] Portable Station—Simplified Voice Message The Built-in Simplified Voice Message feature can be provided for each PS. This screen allows you to specify which extension uses this feature, and the maximum number of messages that can be stored for each extension. For more information on Simplified Voice Message, see "1.17.7 Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM)" in the Feature Guide. Extension Number Indicates the extension number (reference only). Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.16 [4-2-5] Portable Station—Simplified Voice Message Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station Feature Guide References None Extension Name Indicates the name of the extension (reference only). Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 6.16 [4-2-5] Portable Station—Simplified Voice Message Programming Manual References 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Extension Name 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings— Extension Name Feature Guide References None Simplified Voice Message Selects which card (IPCMPR or ESVM) to use to store and play back greetings and messages for the extension. PC Programming Manual 725 6.16 [4-2-5] Portable Station—Simplified Voice Message Each extension must be assigned to a specific card and block within the card, and can only use the assigned card/block. If two cards are used in the PBX, you should assign a number of extensions to each card, to ensure that the necessary resources, such as message recording space, are available for each extension. Value Range None, Card1(A), Card1(B), Card2(A), Card2(B) Maintenance Console Location 6.16 [4-2-5] Portable Station—Simplified Voice Message Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot Feature Guide References 1.17.7 Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM) Maximum of SVM Log Specifies the maximum number of voice messages (not including greeting messages) that can be stored for the extension. Value Range 1–100 Maintenance Console Location 6.16 [4-2-5] Portable Station—Simplified Voice Message Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.7 Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM) 726 PC Programming Manual 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console A DSS Console can be used in conjunction with a PT. A maximum of 8 DSS Consoles can be programmed. The DPT Type—Type of the extension port that DSS Console is connected must be set to DSS in 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port. Each flexible DSS button can be customised to access a certain feature. A maximum of 66 flexible DSS buttons can be customised for each DSS Console. Select the desired DSS Console from the DSS Console No. list. To copy DSS Console setting values from one location to another, click the Copy to button. For more information on flexible buttons, see "1.20.2 Flexible Buttons" in the Feature Guide. Pair Extension Specifies the extension number of the PT to be used in pair with the DSS Console. Note that if one or more SDN buttons have been set at the DSS Console, they must be deleted before this setting can be changed. Value Range None, Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Type Specifies the feature to be assigned to the flexible DSS button. Value Range Not Stored, Loop CO, Single CO, Group CO, DSS, One-touch, ICD Group, Message Waiting, FWD/DND (Both), FWD/DND (External), FWD/DND (Internal), Group Fwd (Both), Group Fwd (External), Group Fwd (Internal), Account, Conference, Terminate, EFA, Charge, Call Park, Call Log, Log-in/Log-out, Hurry-up, Wrap-up, System Alarm, Time Service, Answer, Release, TRS Level Change, ISDN Service, CLIR, COLR, ISDN Hold, Headset, Time Service - Automatic/Manual, Check In, Check Out, Cleaned Up, Two-way Record, Two-way Transfer, LCS, Voice Mail Transfer, NDSS, CTI, SDN Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References 6.18 [4-3] DSS Console—DSS key data copy PC Programming Manual 727 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Feature Guide References 1.20.2 Flexible Buttons Parameter Selection (for Single CO) Specifies the trunk to be accessed. Value Range 1–128 Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.5.5.3 Trunk Access Parameter Selection (for Group CO) Specifies the trunk group to be accessed. Value Range 1–64 Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.5.5.3 Trunk Access Parameter Selection (for Call Park) Specifies whether a call is parked in an idle parking zone automatically or in a specific parking zone. Value Range Automatic, Specific Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console 728 PC Programming Manual 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.13.2 Call Park Parameter Selection (for Log-in/Log-out) Specifies which incoming call distribution groups that the paired extension belongs to are logged in to or logged out from. Value Range None: The incoming call distribution group is selected manually. All: All incoming call distribution groups that the paired extension belongs to. Incoming Group: A pre-specified incoming call distribution group Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.2.2.7 Log-in/Log-out Parameter Selection (for Time Service) Selects which time modes are switched manually. Value Range All (Day/Night/Lunch/Break), Day/Night/Break, Day/Night/Lunch, Day/Night Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.4 Time Service Parameter Selection (for TRS Level Change) Specifies the TRS/Barring level to be used temporarily on a certain extension. PC Programming Manual 729 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Value Range 1–7 Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.9.1 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) 1.9.4 Dial Tone Transfer Parameter Selection (for Time Service - Automatic/Manual) Specifies the Time Table to be used when the Time Service Switching Mode is set to Automatic. Value Range 1–8 Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.4 Time Service Parameter Selection (for SDN) Specifies the delayed ringing setting for calls arriving at an SDN button. Value Range Immediate, 1 Ring, 2 Rings, 3 Rings, 4 Rings, 5 Rings, 6 Rings, No Ring Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None 730 PC Programming Manual 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Feature Guide References 1.7.1 Primary Directory Number (PDN)/Secondary Directory Number (SDN) Extension Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for DSS) Specifies the number of an extension to be accessed. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for ICD Group) Specifies the floating extension number of an incoming call distribution group to be accessed. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Message Waiting) Specifies the number of an extension or floating extension number of an incoming call distribution group for which messages are checked. If this cell is left empty, the paired extension will check its own messages only. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) PC Programming Manual 731 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Group Fwd (Both)) Specifies the floating extension number of an incoming call distribution group for which both intercom and trunk calls are forwarded. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND) Features Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Group Fwd (External)) Specifies the floating extension number of an incoming call distribution group for which trunk calls are forwarded. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND) Features 732 PC Programming Manual 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Group Fwd (Internal)) Specifies the floating extension number of an incoming call distribution group for which intercom calls are forwarded. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.3 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND) Features Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Call Log) Specifies the paired extension’s number or the floating extension number of an incoming call distribution group for which call log information is displayed. If the cell is left empty, the paired extension will display its own call log information. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Log-in/Log-out) Specifies the floating extension number of an incoming call distribution group to log-in to or log-out from. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console PC Programming Manual 733 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Hurry-up) Specifies the floating extension number of the incoming call distribution group whose longest waiting call will be redirected (Manual Queue Redirection). Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.2.2.4 Queuing Feature Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Two-way Record) Specifies the floating extension number of the VM (DPT) group containing the paired extension’s mailbox. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.24.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Two-way Transfer) Specifies the floating extension number of the VM (DPT) group containing the desired mailbox. 734 PC Programming Manual 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.24.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Voice Mail Transfer) Specifies the floating extension number of the VM (DTMF/DPT) group containing the desired mailbox. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.24.2 Voice Mail DTMF Integration 1.24.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for SDN) Specifies the floating extension number of the PDN extension corresponding to the SDN button. Note that the extension specified here must have a PDN button registered for the SDN button to function. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 735 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Feature Guide References 1.1.1.2 Direct In Line (DIL) Dial (for One-touch) Specifies the number to be dialled. The PBX can have a maximum of 2000 One-touch Dialling buttons for extensions and DSS Consoles. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash]) Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.6.1.2 One-touch Dialling Dial (for ISDN Service) Specifies the number required to access the telephone company’s ISDN service. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash]) Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.21.1.12 ISDN Service Access by Keypad Protocol Dial (for NDSS) Specifies the network extension number of the extension to be accessed using Network Direct Station Selection. Note that only extension numbers that have been previously registered in 11.4 [9-4] NDSS Key Table can be specified here. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash]) 736 PC Programming Manual 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.30.5.1 Network Direct Station Selection (NDSS) Optional Parameter (Ringing Tone Type Number) (for Time Service) Specifies the Time Table to be used for changing time modes in the Automatic Switching mode. Value Range 1–8 Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.4 Time Service Optional Parameter (Ringing Tone Type Number) (for Loop CO, Single CO, Group CO, ICD Group, SDN) Specifies the ring tone type. Value Range KX-DT300 series (except KX-DT321)/KX-T7600 series (except KX-T7665)/IP-PT (except KX-NT265/ KX-NT321): 1–30 KX-DT321/KX-T7665/KX-NT265/KX-NT321: 1–8 (Even if ring tone 9–30 is selected, ring tone 1 is heard.) Other telephones: 1–8 (Even if ring tone 9–30 is selected, ring tone 2 is heard.) Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 737 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Feature Guide References None Optional Parameter (Ringing Tone Type Number) (for Call Park) Specifies the number of the parking zone a call is to be parked in when a Call Park button with Selection (for Call Park) on this screen set to Specific is pressed. Parameter Value Range 0–99 Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.13.2 Call Park Ext No. of Mailbox (for Two-way Transfer) Specifies the number of the extension whose mailbox will be used to record conversations using One-touch Two-way Transfer. (For example, a secretary can record a conversation into the mailbox of a boss.) If the cell is left empty, the extension user must specify the number of an extension each time. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.24.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration 738 PC Programming Manual 6.18 [4-3] DSS Console—DSS key data copy 6.18 [4-3] DSS Console—DSS key data copy The flexible DSS button settings of a DSS Console can be copied to different DSS Consoles. Select the DSS Console that has the setting to copy to other DSS Consoles from the DSS Console No./ Pair Extension list, then click Copy To. Destination DSS Console Select the number of the DSS Console and paired extension. Multiple DSS Consoles can be selected. To select all DSS Consoles at once, click Select All. When selecting multiple extensions, note that if the source extension has an SDN button, the copy operation cannot be performed. Maintenance Console Location 6.18 [4-3] DSS Console—DSS key data copy Programming Manual References 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 739 6.18 [4-3] DSS Console—DSS key data copy 740 PC Programming Manual Section 7 [5] Optional Device PC Programming Manual 741 7.1 [5-1] Doorphone 7.1 [5-1] Doorphone The settings to establish doorphone calls can be programmed. To assign destinations for doorphone calls easily, click Destination Setting (see 2.1.6 Extension Number Setting). Physical Location—Slot Indicates the slot to which the doorphone is connected (reference only). Value Range Slot and sub-slot number Maintenance Console Location 7.1 [5-1] Doorphone Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.1 Doorphone Call Physical Location—Port Indicates the port number to which the doorphone is connected (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 7.1 [5-1] Doorphone Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.1 Doorphone Call Name Specifies the doorphone name. Value Range Max. 20 characters 742 PC Programming Manual 7.1 [5-1] Doorphone Maintenance Console Location 7.1 [5-1] Doorphone Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.1 Doorphone Call Destination—Day, Lunch, Break, Night Specifies the destination number of doorphone calls for each port in each time mode. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause]) Maintenance Console Location 7.1 [5-1] Doorphone Programming Manual References 4.6 [2-4] Week Table Feature Guide References 1.17.1 Doorphone Call Tenant Number Specifies the tenant number for the doorphone port in order to apply the Time Table (day/lunch/break/night). Value Range 1–8 Maintenance Console Location 7.1 [5-1] Doorphone Programming Manual References 4.6 [2-4] Week Table Feature Guide References 1.17.1 Doorphone Call 2.2.3 Tenant Service PC Programming Manual 743 7.1 [5-1] Doorphone COS Specifies the Class of Service (COS) number. COS programming determines the doorphone ports that are able to make trunk calls, and sets restrictions on intercom calls from certain extensions (Internal Call Block). Value Range 1–64 Maintenance Console Location 7.1 [5-1] Doorphone Programming Manual References 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—TRS— 4.14 [2-7-3] Class of Service—Internal Call Block TRS Level—Day, Lunch, Break, Night Feature Guide References 1.1.2.2 Internal Call Block 1.17.1 Doorphone Call VM Trunk Group Number Specifies the number of the VM trunk group sent to the VPS when the doorphone call destination is the floating extension number of a VM (DPT) group. The VM trunk group number is used to allow the VPS to send the applicable greeting message to the caller. Value Range 1–48 Maintenance Console Location 7.1 [5-1] Doorphone Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.1 Doorphone Call 1.24.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration 744 PC Programming Manual 7.2 [5-2] External Pager 7.2 [5-2] External Pager Settings for external pagers (external speakers) can be specified. Click Extension List View to view a list of all programmed extension numbers and types (see 2.5.8 Tool— Extension List View). Page Number 1, Page Number 2—Floating Extension Number Specifies the floating extension number of the external pager. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 7.2 [5-2] External Pager Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.15.1 Paging 1.17.3 Trunk Answer From Any Station (TAFAS) 1.17.4 Background Music (BGM) Page Number 1, Page Number 2—Name Specifies the name of the external pager. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 7.2 [5-2] External Pager Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.15.1 Paging 1.17.3 Trunk Answer From Any Station (TAFAS) 1.17.4 Background Music (BGM) PC Programming Manual 745 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System Direct Inward System Access (DISA) enables outside callers to access specific PBX features as if the caller were using an SLT extension of the PBX. For more information on DISA, see "1.17.6 Direct Inward System Access (DISA)" in the Feature Guide. Option 1 DISA Security—DISA Security Mode Selects the DISA security mode to prevent unauthorised access to the PBX. In Trunk or All Security mode, the caller is required to override security by Walking COS or Verification Code Entry in order to enable the restricted feature temporarily. Value Range None: Intercom calls, TIE line calls, and trunk calls can be made. Trunk: Intercom calls and TIE line calls without PBX code can be made. TIE line calls with PBX code and trunk calls are restricted. All: All calls are restricted. Maintenance Console Location 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.9.5 Walking COS 1.9.6 Verification Code Entry DISA Security—Remote Walking COS through DISA without PIN (Optional SD Card Required) Enables registered caller ID numbers to be automatically recognised as PBX extensions when calling through DISA, and to use the Walking COS features without entering a PIN. Value Range Disable, Enable (Get DISA) Maintenance Console Location 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System Programming Manual References None 746 PC Programming Manual 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System Feature Guide References None DISA Intercept—Intercept when destination through DISA sets DND Selects how DISA calls are handled if the destination sets DND, and disables Idle Extension Hunting. Value Range Busy Tone, Enable, Busy Message Maintenance Console Location 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None DISA Intercept—Intercept when all DISA ports are busy Selects how DISA calls are handled if all DISA ports are currently in use. Value Range to Operator, to AA-0, to AA-9, Disable (Busy Tone) Maintenance Console Location 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None DISA Intercept—Intercept when No Dial after DISA answers Selects how DISA calls are handled if the caller does not select any option from the menu. Value Range to Operator, to AA-0, to AA-9, Disable (Reorder Tone) Maintenance Console Location 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System PC Programming Manual 747 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None CO-CO with DISA—DISA to Public CO Specifies whether the DISA port of the message card is released when a trunk-to-public trunk call using DISA is established. To enable this setting, " CO-CO with DISA—Fwd/Transfer to Public CO" on this screen should be set to "Enable". Setting this to "Disable" will free up DISA ports faster, but prevent DISA being used to detect the end of a call and disconnect the trunk quickly. Value Range Disable (Release DISA): The DISA port of the message card is released when a trunk-to-public trunk call using DISA is established. Enable: DISA stays connected for the duration of the call, to allow detection of the end of the call. Maintenance Console Location 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System Programming Manual References 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System—Option 1— CO-CO with DISA—Fwd/Transfer to Public CO Feature Guide References None CO-CO with DISA—DISA to Private Network Specifies whether the DISA port of the message card is released when a trunk-to-private trunk call using DISA is established. To enable this setting, " CO-CO with DISA—Fwd/Transfer to Private Network" on this screen should be set to "Enable". Setting this to "Disable" will free up DISA ports faster, but prevent DISA being used to detect the end of a call and disconnect the trunk quickly. Value Range Disable (Release DISA): The DISA port of the message card is released when a trunk-to-private trunk call using DISA is established. Enable: DISA stays connected for the duration of the call, to allow detection of the end of the call. Maintenance Console Location 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System 748 PC Programming Manual 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System Programming Manual References 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System—Option 1— CO-CO with DISA—Fwd/Transfer to Private Network Feature Guide References None CO-CO with DISA—Fwd/Transfer to Public CO Enables trunk-to-public trunk calls to be established using DISA. Value Range Disable: Trunk-to-public trunk calls are established without using DISA. Enable (Get DISA): Trunk-to-public trunk calls are established using DISA, and DISA can be used to detect the end of the call. Maintenance Console Location 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System Programming Manual References 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System—Option 1— CO-CO with DISA—DISA to Public CO Feature Guide References None CO-CO with DISA—Fwd/Transfer to Private Network Enables trunk-to-private trunk calls to be established using DISA. Value Range Disable: Trunk-to-private trunk calls are established without using DISA. Enable (Get DISA): Trunk-to-private trunk calls are established using DISA, and DISA can be used to detect the end of the call. Maintenance Console Location 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System Programming Manual References 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System—Option 1— CO-CO with DISA—DISA to Private Network Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 749 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System CO-CO with DISA—Transfer by DTMF "#" (Optional SD Card Required) Specifies whether an outside party such as a cellular phone can transfer a trunk call to an extension within the PBX by dialling "#" + extension number. Value Range Disable: "#" is ignored if dialled. Enable (as "Flash"): The current trunk call will be placed on hold, then transferred to the extension whose number is entered. Maintenance Console Location 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None CO-CO with DISA—Return to DISA Top Menu by DTMF "*" Enables a trunk caller to return to the DISA top menu by pressing " " while hearing a ringback, reorder, or busy tone. If disabled, retrying the call is possible by pressing " ". Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Option 2 DISA Cyclic Tone Detection Selects the cyclic tone detection mode. Cyclic tone detection is used to determine the end of a call for a DISA trunk-to-trunk conversation established through an analogue trunk. To apply changes to this setting, follow the steps below: 1. Change this setting. 2. Set the status of the OPB3 card to "OUS", then "INS". 750 PC Programming Manual 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System Value Range Fixed: The number of times of a tone pattern (a set of tone-on and tone-off) that the PBX receives is fixed to 4 times in the ranges of: A C B C D C D D , = 100–1300 ms, = 90 ms, = 90 ms Option: The tone pattern that the PBX receives is optional as specified in DISA Cyclic Tone Option on this screen. Maintenance Console Location 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System Programming Manual References 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Feature Guide References None DISA Cyclic Tone Option—Tone On Maximum Time Specifies the maximum duration of the cyclic tone that will be recognised by the PBX. When the tone sent from the telephone company is shorter than the value set here, the PBX recognises it as a tone-on. Note that this option can only be set when DISA Cyclic Tone Detection on this screen is set to "Option". To apply changes to this setting, follow the steps below: 1. Change this setting. 2. Set the status of the OPB3 card to "OUS", then "INS". Value Range 10 ´ n (n=11–400) ms Maintenance Console Location 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 751 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System DISA Cyclic Tone Option—Tone Off Maximum Time Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a cyclic tone to be sent from the telephone company before recognising it as a tone-off. When no tone is detected within the time set here, the PBX recognises it as a tone-off. Note that this option can only be set when DISA Cyclic Tone Detection on this screen is set to "Option". To apply changes to this setting, follow the steps below: 1. Change this setting. 2. Set the status of the OPB3 card to "OUS", then "INS" Value Range 10 ´ n (n=11–400) ms Maintenance Console Location 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Feature Guide References None DISA Cyclic Tone Option—Repeating Times of ON/OFF for Detection Specifies the number of times the tone pattern (a set of tone-on and tone-off) must be received to establish reception of the cyclic tone. This determines the end of call. Note that this option can only be set when DISA Cyclic Tone Detection on this screen is set to "Option". Value Range 3–16 Maintenance Console Location 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Timed Reminder Message—Day, Lunch, Break, Night Specifies the prerecorded message to play when a Timed Reminder call is answered in each time mode. Value Range None, 1–64 752 PC Programming Manual 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System Maintenance Console Location 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System Programming Manual References 7.4 [5-3-2] Voice Message—DISA Message Feature Guide References 1.28.4 Timed Reminder Recording Mode Specifies the sound quality of messages recorded on the ESVM card when using it as an MSG card. Increasing the recording quality reduces the total length of recording time available on the card. To apply changes to this setting, follow the steps below: 1. Change this setting. 2. Set the status of the OPB3 card to "OUS", then "INS". Value Range Low: About 120 minutes of messages can be recorded per card. Middle: About 60 minutes of messages can be recorded per card. High: About 20 minutes of messages can be recorded per card. Maintenance Console Location 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.7 Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM) PC Programming Manual 753 7.4 [5-3-2] Voice Message—DISA Message 7.4 [5-3-2] Voice Message—DISA Message Outgoing messages (OGM) for DISA calls can be specified. A maximum of 64 OGMs can be programmed. To view a list of all programmed extension numbers and types, click Extension List View (see 2.5.8 Tool— Extension List View). To assign AA destinations easily, click Extension No. Setting (see 2.1.6 Extension Number Setting). Floating Extension Number Specifies the floating extension number of the OGM. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 7.4 [5-3-2] Voice Message—DISA Message Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.5 Outgoing Message (OGM) 1.17.6 Direct Inward System Access (DISA) Name Specifies the name of the OGM. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 7.4 [5-3-2] Voice Message—DISA Message Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.5 Outgoing Message (OGM) 1.17.6 Direct Inward System Access (DISA) 1 Digit AA Destination (Extension Number)—Dial 0–9 Specifies the destination for each DISA Automated Attendant (AA) number. After listening to an OGM, the caller can be directed to the destination by dialling a 1-digit DISA AA number. 754 PC Programming Manual 7.4 [5-3-2] Voice Message—DISA Message Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 7.4 [5-3-2] Voice Message—DISA Message Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.5 Outgoing Message (OGM) 1.17.6 Direct Inward System Access (DISA) Busy / DND Message No. Selects the OGM to be played for the caller when the destination party is busy or sets DND. Value Range None, 1–64 Maintenance Console Location 7.4 [5-3-2] Voice Message—DISA Message Programming Manual References 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System Feature Guide References 1.17.6 Direct Inward System Access (DISA) Fax Extension Specifies the extension number to which to transfer a call when a fax signal is detected. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 7.4 [5-3-2] Voice Message—DISA Message Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 755 7.4 [5-3-2] Voice Message—DISA Message Feature Guide References 1.17.8 Automatic Fax Transfer 756 PC Programming Manual 7.5 [5-3-3] Voice Message—SVM 7.5 [5-3-3] Voice Message—SVM Settings related to Built-in Simplified Voice Message feature can be specified. This feature can be accessed via the IPCMPR card or ESVM card. SVM Card No.1, 2—Slot Number Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 7.5 [5-3-3] Voice Message—SVM Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot Feature Guide References 1.17.7 Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM) SVM Card No.1, 2—Floating Extension Number Specifies the floating extension number used to access the SVM feature. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 7.5 [5-3-3] Voice Message—SVM Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.7 Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM) SVM Card No.1, 2—Card Name Specifies the name of the card, for programming reference. Value Range Max. 20 characters PC Programming Manual 757 7.5 [5-3-3] Voice Message—SVM Maintenance Console Location 7.5 [5-3-3] Voice Message—SVM Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.7 Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM) Recording Mode Specifies the sound quality of messages recorded by the SVM feature. Increasing the recording quality reduces the total length of recording time available with this feature. Value Range Low: About 120 minutes of messages can be recorded. Middle: About 60 minutes of messages can be recorded. High: About 40 minutes (IPCMPR)/20 minutes (ESVM) of messages can be recorded. Maintenance Console Location 7.5 [5-3-3] Voice Message—SVM Programming Manual References 6.9 [4-1-7] Wired Extension—Simplified Voice Message 6.16 [4-2-5] Portable Station—Simplified Voice Message Feature Guide References 1.17.7 Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM) Remote Access Selects whether the Walking COS feature can be used while listening to a greeting message from the SVM feature. Using Walking COS, a user can access his or her message box remotely. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 7.5 [5-3-3] Voice Message—SVM Programming Manual References 6.9 [4-1-7] Wired Extension—Simplified Voice Message 6.16 [4-2-5] Portable Station—Simplified Voice Message 758 PC Programming Manual 7.5 [5-3-3] Voice Message—SVM Feature Guide References 1.17.7 Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM) SVM Cyclic Tone Detection Selects the cyclic tone detection mode. Cyclic tone detection is used to determine the end of a call when an extension user records a greeting message or callers leave voice messages in a message box. To apply changes to this setting, follow the steps below: 1. Change this setting. 2. Set the status of the IPCMPR card or OPB3 card to "OUS", then "INS". See 3.5 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property or 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property. Value Range Fixed: The number of times of a tone pattern (a set of tone-on and tone-off) that the PBX receives is fixed to 4 times in the ranges of: A C B C D C D D , = 100–1300 ms, = 90 ms, = 90 ms Option: The tone pattern that the PBX receives is optional as specified in SVM Cyclic Tone Option on this screen. Maintenance Console Location 7.5 [5-3-3] Voice Message—SVM Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot Feature Guide References 1.17.7 Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM) SVM Cyclic Tone Option—Tone On Maximum Time Specifies the maximum duration of the cyclic tone that will be recognised by the PBX. When the tone sent from the telephone company is shorter than the value set here, the PBX recognises it as a tone-on. Note that this option can only be set when SVM Cyclic Tone Detection on this screen is set to "Option". To apply changes to this setting, follow the steps below: 1. Change this setting. 2. Set the status of the IPCMPR card or OPB3 card to "OUS", then "INS". See 3.5 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property or 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property. Value Range 20 ´ n (n=6–200) ms Maintenance Console Location 7.5 [5-3-3] Voice Message—SVM PC Programming Manual 759 7.5 [5-3-3] Voice Message—SVM Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot Feature Guide References 1.17.7 Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM) SVM Cyclic Tone Option—Tone Off Maximum Time Specifies the maximum time that the PBX waits for a cyclic tone to be sent from the telephone company before recognising it as a tone-off. When no tone is detected within the time set here, the PBX recognises it as a tone-off. Note that this option can only be set when SVM Cyclic Tone Detection on this screen is set to "Option". To apply changes to this setting, follow the steps below: 1. Change this setting. 2. Set the status of the IPCMPR card or OPB3 card to "OUS", then "INS". See 3.5 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property or 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property. Value Range 20 ´ n (n=6–200) ms Maintenance Console Location 7.5 [5-3-3] Voice Message—SVM Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot Feature Guide References 1.17.7 Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM) SVM Cyclic Tone Option—Repeating Times of ON/OFF for Detection Specifies the number of times the tone pattern (a set of tone-on and tone-off) must be received to establish reception of the cyclic tone. This determines the end of call. Note that this option can only be set when SVM Cyclic Tone Detection on this screen is set to "Option". Value Range 3–16 Maintenance Console Location 7.5 [5-3-3] Voice Message—SVM Programming Manual References None 760 PC Programming Manual 7.5 [5-3-3] Voice Message—SVM Feature Guide References 1.17.7 Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM) PC Programming Manual 761 7.6 [5-4] External Relay 7.6 [5-4] External Relay Settings related to external relays can be programmed. External Relay No. Indicates the number of the external relay (reference only). Value Range 1–16 Maintenance Console Location 7.6 [5-4] External Relay Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.10 External Relay Control Physical Location—Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot and sub-slot number Maintenance Console Location 7.6 [5-4] External Relay Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.10 External Relay Control Physical Location—Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number 762 PC Programming Manual 7.6 [5-4] External Relay Maintenance Console Location 7.6 [5-4] External Relay Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.10 External Relay Control Name Specifies the relay name. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 7.6 [5-4] External Relay Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.10 External Relay Control Relay Activate Time Specifies the length of time that the relay stays on when activated. Value Range 1–7 s Maintenance Console Location 7.6 [5-4] External Relay Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.10 External Relay Control PC Programming Manual 763 7.6 [5-4] External Relay COS Number Specifies the Class of Service (COS) number. COS programming determines the extensions that are able to activate relays. Value Range 1–64 Maintenance Console Location 7.6 [5-4] External Relay Programming Manual References 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—Optional Device & Other Extensions— Feature Guide References 1.1.2.2 Internal Call Block 1.17.10 External Relay Control 764 PC Programming Manual External Relay Access 7.7 [5-5] External Sensor 7.7 [5-5] External Sensor Settings related to external sensors can be programmed. To assign destinations for sensor calls easily, click Destination Setting (see 2.1.6 Extension Number Setting). External Sensor No. Indicates the number of the external sensor (reference only). Value Range 1–16 Maintenance Console Location 7.7 [5-5] External Sensor Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.9 External Sensor Physical Location—Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot and sub-slot number Maintenance Console Location 7.7 [5-5] External Sensor Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.9 External Sensor Physical Location—Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number PC Programming Manual 765 7.7 [5-5] External Sensor Maintenance Console Location 7.7 [5-5] External Sensor Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.9 External Sensor Name Specifies the sensor name. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 7.7 [5-5] External Sensor Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.9 External Sensor Destination—Day, Lunch, Break, Night Specifies the destination number of sensor calls for each port in each time mode. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, [ ] [Secret], and P [Pause]) Maintenance Console Location 7.7 [5-5] External Sensor Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.17.9 External Sensor 766 PC Programming Manual 7.7 [5-5] External Sensor Tenant No. Specifies the tenant to which the sensor belongs, to determine the Time Table for the sensor. (The tenant number corresponds to the Time Table number.) Value Range 1–8 Maintenance Console Location 7.7 [5-5] External Sensor Programming Manual References 4.6 [2-4] Week Table Feature Guide References 1.17.9 External Sensor 2.2.3 Tenant Service PC Programming Manual 767 7.7 [5-5] External Sensor 768 PC Programming Manual Section 8 [6] Feature PC Programming Manual 769 8.1 [6-1] System Speed Dial 8.1 [6-1] System Speed Dial The System Speed Dialling Table is used to store frequently dialled numbers as well as callers who should be automatically routed to certain extensions when they call (Calling Line Identification [CLI] distribution). The System Speed Dialling Table is available for all extension users when making or receiving a call. A maximum of 1000 System Speed Dialling numbers (e.g., telephone numbers, feature numbers) can be programmed with other related parameters. 100 numbers are displayed at a time. To display other sets of numbers, click the applicable tab. Memory Selects the System Speed Dialling Table to be programmed. Whether a tenant uses the basic System Speed Dialling Table or the additional table depends on the setting of System Speed Dial in 8.6 [6-6] Tenant. Value Range Basic Memory: the standard table Expansion for Tenant 1–8: additional tables Maintenance Console Location 8.1 [6-1] System Speed Dial Programming Manual References 8.6 [6-6] Tenant— System Speed Dial Feature Guide References 1.6.1.5 Speed Dialling—Personal/System 1.18.1 Caller ID 2.2.3 Tenant Service Name Specifies a name for the System Speed Dialling number. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 8.1 [6-1] System Speed Dial Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.6.1.5 Speed Dialling—Personal/System 1.18.1 Caller ID 770 PC Programming Manual 8.1 [6-1] System Speed Dial CO Line Access Number + Telephone Number Specifies the telephone number (including the Trunk Access number) or feature number assigned to the System Speed Dialling number. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], [ ] [Secret], P [Pause], and F [Flash]) Maintenance Console Location 8.1 [6-1] System Speed Dial Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.6.1.5 Speed Dialling—Personal/System 1.18.1 Caller ID CLI Destination Specifies the CLI destination (extension) to which incoming calls from the programmed telephone number are routed. If a Caller ID Modification Table is being used, the modified number must match the telephone number above (CO Line Access Number + Telephone Number) in order for the call to be routed correctly. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 8.1 [6-1] System Speed Dial Programming Manual References 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings—CLI for DIL— CLI Ring for DIL—Day, Lunch, Break, Night 12.3 [10-3] DDI / DID Table— CLI Ring for DDI/DID—Day, Lunch, Break, Night Feature Guide References 1.1.1.5 Calling Line Identification (CLI) Distribution 1.18.1 Caller ID PC Programming Manual 771 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Various settings related to the hospitality features of the PBX can be set. Main Hotel Operator—Extension 1–4 Specifies the numbers of the extensions designated as hotel operators. Value Range 100–699 Maintenance Console Location 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.27.1 Hospitality Features—SUMMARY 1.27.2 Room Status Control SMDR for External Hotel Application 1—Room Status Control Selects whether check-in and check-out data is output on SMDR. Value Range No Print, Print Maintenance Console Location 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Programming Manual References 13.1 [11-1] Main Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) 1.27.2 Room Status Control SMDR for External Hotel Application 1—Timed Reminder (Wake-up Call) Selects whether Timed Reminder data is output on SMDR. Value Range No Print, Print 772 PC Programming Manual 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Maintenance Console Location 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Programming Manual References 13.1 [11-1] Main Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) 1.28.4 Timed Reminder SMDR for External Hotel Application 2—Printing Message 1–8 Specifies the text of the message output on SMDR when this Printing Message is selected from an extension. The "%" character can be used in a message, and requires a number to be entered in its place when the message is selected from an extension. This character can be used a maximum of seven times in a Printing Message. Value Range Max. 16 characters Maintenance Console Location 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Programming Manual References 13.1 [11-1] Main Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) 1.26.2 Printing Message Bill Checkout Billing—Billing for Guest Activates call billing features for the PBX. Value Range OFF, ON Maintenance Console Location 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Programming Manual References 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR PC Programming Manual 773 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Feature Guide References 1.27.3 Call Billing for Guest Room Checkout Billing—LCD for "Telephone" Specifies the name of charge item 1 as shown on the display of the hotel operator extension when entering room charges. Value Range Max. 12 characters Maintenance Console Location 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.27.3 Call Billing for Guest Room Checkout Billing—LCD for "Minibar" Specifies the name of charge item 2 as shown on the display of the hotel operator extension when entering room charges. Value Range Max. 12 characters Maintenance Console Location 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.27.3 Call Billing for Guest Room Checkout Billing—LCD for "Others" Specifies the name of charge item 3 as shown on the display of the hotel operator extension when entering room charges. Value Range Max. 12 characters 774 PC Programming Manual 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Maintenance Console Location 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.27.3 Call Billing for Guest Room Checkout Billing—Bill (SMDR) for "Telephone" Specifies the name of charge item 1 as printed on the guest bill. Value Range Max. 12 characters Maintenance Console Location 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.27.3 Call Billing for Guest Room Checkout Billing—Bill (SMDR) for "Minibar" Specifies the name of charge item 2 as printed on the guest bill. Value Range Max. 12 characters Maintenance Console Location 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.27.3 Call Billing for Guest Room PC Programming Manual 775 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Checkout Billing—Bill (SMDR) for "Others" Specifies the name of charge item 3 as printed on the guest bill. Value Range Max. 12 characters Maintenance Console Location 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.27.3 Call Billing for Guest Room SMDR for External Hotel Application—Language for Bill (SMDR) Specifies the language used for standard items shown on guest bills printed out using the Call Billing feature. Value Range Language 1–Language 5 Maintenance Console Location 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.27.3 Call Billing for Guest Room SMDR for External Hotel Application—Header 1–3 Specifies the text printed at the top of the guest bill. Value Range Max. 80 characters Maintenance Console Location 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Programming Manual References None 776 PC Programming Manual 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Feature Guide References 1.27.3 Call Billing for Guest Room SMDR for External Hotel Application—Footer 1–3 Specifies the text printed at the bottom of the guest bill. Value Range Max. 80 characters Maintenance Console Location 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.27.3 Call Billing for Guest Room Charge Margin & Tax—Margin Rate for "Telephone" (%) Specifies the percentage margin to be added to telephone charges displayed on the guest bill. Value Range 0.00–99.99 % Maintenance Console Location 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.3 Call Charge Services 1.27.3 Call Billing for Guest Room Margin & Tax—Tax Rate for "Telephone" (%) Specifies the percentage tax rate to be used when calculating guest telephone charges. Value Range 0.00–99.99 % PC Programming Manual 777 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Maintenance Console Location 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.27.3 Call Billing for Guest Room Margin & Tax—Tax Rate for "Minibar" (%) Specifies the percentage tax rate to be used when calculating guest charges for charge item 2. Value Range 0.00–99.99 % Maintenance Console Location 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.27.3 Call Billing for Guest Room Margin & Tax—Tax Rate for "Others" (%) Specifies the percentage tax rate to be used when calculating guest charges for charge item 3. Value Range 0.00–99.99 % Maintenance Console Location 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.27.3 Call Billing for Guest Room 778 PC Programming Manual 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Charge Options—Digits After Decimal Point Specifies the number of digits to display after the decimal point for the currency in use. Value Range 0–6 Maintenance Console Location 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 3— Charge Limit 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 3— Charge Limit 8.3 [6-3] Verification Code— Budget Management Feature Guide References 1.20.4 Display Information 1.26.3 Call Charge Services 1.27.3 Call Billing for Guest Room Charge Options—Currency Specifies the currency characters shown on the display of the extension and the SMDR. Value Range Max. 3 characters Maintenance Console Location 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 3— Charge Limit 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 3— Charge Limit 8.3 [6-3] Verification Code— Budget Management Feature Guide References 1.20.4 Display Information 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) 1.26.3 Call Charge Services 1.27.3 Call Billing for Guest Room Charge Options—Currency Display Position Specifies whether the currency characters are displayed before or after the call charge. Value Range Head, Tail PC Programming Manual 779 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Maintenance Console Location 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 3— Charge Limit 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 3— Charge Limit 8.3 [6-3] Verification Code— Budget Management Feature Guide References 1.26.3 Call Charge Services Charge Options—Action at Charge Limit Selects what happens when the amount of the call charge reaches the preprogrammed limit during a conversation. Value Range Alarm: Only a warning tone is heard. Alarm + Disconnect: A warning tone is heard, and then the call is disconnected. Maintenance Console Location 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 3— Charge Limit 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 3— Charge Limit Feature Guide References 1.9.2 Budget Management Charge Options—Meter Start on Answer Detection Enables the PBX to start counting the call charge when the answer signal from the telephone company is detected. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Programming Manual References 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 3— Charge Limit 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 3— Charge Limit 780 PC Programming Manual 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Feature Guide References 1.26.3 Call Charge Services PC Programming Manual 781 8.3 [6-3] Verification Code 8.3 [6-3] Verification Code A verification code is used to override the Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) of the extension in use to make a certain trunk call, or to identify the call for accounting and billing purposes. A maximum of 1000 verification codes can be programmed with other related parameters. 100 codes are displayed at a time. To display other sets of codes, click the applicable tab. Verification Code Specifies the verification code. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 8.3 [6-3] Verification Code Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.9.6 Verification Code Entry User Name Specifies the user name assigned to the verification code. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 8.3 [6-3] Verification Code Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.9.6 Verification Code Entry Verification Code PIN Specifies the PIN to be entered when making a trunk call with the verification code. CAUTION There is a risk that fraudulent telephone calls will be made if a third party discovers a personal identification number (PIN) (verification code PIN or extension PIN) of the PBX. 782 PC Programming Manual 8.3 [6-3] Verification Code The cost of such calls will be billed to the owner/renter of the PBX. To protect the PBX from this kind of fraudulent use, we strongly recommend: a. Keeping PINs secret. b. Selecting complex, random PINs that cannot be easily guessed. c. Changing PINs frequently. Value Range Max. 10 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 8.3 [6-3] Verification Code Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.9.6 Verification Code Entry COS Number Specifies the COS that applies when making a trunk call with the verification code. Value Range 1–64 Maintenance Console Location 8.3 [6-3] Verification Code Programming Manual References 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings Feature Guide References 1.9.6 Verification Code Entry 2.2.1 Class of Service (COS) Itemised Billing Code for ARS Specifies the itemised billing code used by the ARS feature for identifying calls made with a verification code for accounting and billing purposes. Value Range Max. 10 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 8.3 [6-3] Verification Code PC Programming Manual 783 8.3 [6-3] Verification Code Programming Manual References 10.6 [8-5] Carrier Feature Guide References 1.10.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS) Budget Management Specifies the limit of the call charge that will be counted on the verification code. The number of decimal places that can be specified here depends on the value set in Digits After Decimal Point in 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge. Value Range 0–9999999 Maintenance Console Location 8.3 [6-3] Verification Code Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.9.2 Budget Management 784 PC Programming Manual Charge Options— 8.4 [6-4] Second Dial Tone 8.4 [6-4] Second Dial Tone A programmed Pause time can be inserted automatically between the Second Dial Tone Waiting code and the following digits. When a programmed Second Dial Tone Waiting code is dialled after seizing a trunk, a preprogrammed number of pauses are inserted after the code. A maximum of 100 Second Dial Tone Waiting codes can be programmed. 20 codes are displayed at a time. To display other sets of codes, click the applicable tab. Second Dial Tone Waiting Code Specifies the Second Dial Tone Waiting code. Value Range Max. 4 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 8.4 [6-4] Second Dial Tone Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.5.4.7 Pause Insertion Pause Repeating Counter Specifies the number of pauses to be inserted when waiting for the second dial tone. Value Range 0–20 Maintenance Console Location 8.4 [6-4] Second Dial Tone Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.5.4.7 Pause Insertion PC Programming Manual 785 8.5 [6-5] Absent Message 8.5 [6-5] Absent Message When a display PT user calls an extension, a message is shown on the caller’s telephone display describing the reason for absence. A maximum of 8 Absent Messages can be programmed, and any extension user can select one of them. Absent Message Specifies the message for display. Value Range Max. 16 characters Maintenance Console Location 8.5 [6-5] Absent Message Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.19.2 Absent Message 786 PC Programming Manual 8.6 [6-6] Tenant 8.6 [6-6] Tenant A maximum of 8 tenants can share the PBX. Each tenant is composed of specified extension user groups. The PBX offers each tenant its own Time Table and system resources. To assign extensions as operators easily, click Extension No. Setting (see 2.1.6 Extension Number Setting). Music On Hold Specifies the audio source to be used for Music on Hold. Value Range Same as System Setting, BGM, BGM2, BGM3, BGM4, BGM5, BGM6, BGM7, Tone Maintenance Console Location 8.6 [6-6] Tenant Programming Manual References 4.4 [2-2] Operator & BGM Feature Guide References 1.13.4 Music on Hold 2.2.3 Tenant Service Operator (Extension Number) Specifies the extension number or the floating extension number of an incoming call distribution group to be designated as the tenant operator. When this parameter is left unspecified, the PBX operator serves as the tenant operator. Value Range 100–699 Maintenance Console Location 8.6 [6-6] Tenant Programming Manual References 4.4 [2-2] Operator & BGM Feature Guide References 2.2.3 Tenant Service 2.2.5 Operator Features ARS Mode Specifies the ARS mode used when making a trunk call. PC Programming Manual 787 8.6 [6-6] Tenant Value Range Off: ARS is disabled. On for Local Access Operation: ARS operates when an extension user makes a call using any Idle Line Access method. On for Any CO Access Operation: ARS operates when an extension user makes a call using any Trunk Access method. Same as System Setting: The setting specified in ARS Mode in 10.1 [8-1] System Setting is applied. Maintenance Console Location 8.6 [6-6] Tenant Programming Manual References 10.1 [8-1] System Setting Feature Guide References 1.10.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS) 2.2.3 Tenant Service System Speed Dial Specifies which system speed dialling table is used by the tenant. Value Range Same as System Setting: PBX common system speed dialling numbers are used. Tenant Exclusive: Individual tenant system speed dialling numbers are used. Maintenance Console Location 8.6 [6-6] Tenant Programming Manual References 8.1 [6-1] System Speed Dial Feature Guide References 1.6.1.5 Speed Dialling—Personal/System 2.2.3 Tenant Service 788 PC Programming Manual Section 9 [7] TRS PC Programming Manual 789 9.1 [7-1] Denied Code 9.1 [7-1] Denied Code Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) prohibits an extension from making certain trunk calls. Each time mode of every COS is assigned one of the seven TRS/Barring levels. TRS/Barring level 7 provides the maximum restriction (all trunk calls are prohibited) and level 1 provides the minimum (all trunk calls are allowed). TRS/Barring levels 2–6 are used to restrict calls according to the combination of Denied Code Tables here and Exception Code Tables in 9.2 [7-2] Exception Code. If the leading digits of the dialled number are not found in the applicable Denied Code Tables, the call is made. A maximum of 100 denied codes can be programmed for each level. 20 codes are displayed at a time. To display other sets of codes, click the applicable tab. Denied Code Tables—Level 2–Level 6 Specifies the leading digits of toll restricted numbers for each level. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0-9, *, #, and X) Maintenance Console Location 9.1 [7-1] Denied Code Programming Manual References 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—TRS— 9.2 [7-2] Exception Code Feature Guide References 1.9.1 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) 790 PC Programming Manual TRS Level—Day, Lunch, Break, Night 9.2 [7-2] Exception Code 9.2 [7-2] Exception Code Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) prohibits an extension from making certain trunk calls. Each time mode of every COS is assigned one of the seven TRS/Barring levels. TRS/Barring level 7 provides the maximum restriction (all trunk calls are prohibited) and level 1 provides the minimum (all trunk calls are allowed). TRS/Barring levels 2–6 are used to restrict calls according to the combination of Denied Code Tables in 9.1 [7-1] Denied Code and Exception Code Tables here. A call denied by the applicable Denied Code Tables is checked against the applicable Exception Code Tables, and if a match is found, the call is made. A maximum of 100 exception codes can be programmed for each level. 20 codes are displayed at a time. To display other sets of codes, click the applicable tab. Exception Code Tables—Level 2–Level 6 Specifies the leading digits of the numbers to be exempted from toll restriction/call barring for each level. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0-9, *, #, and X) Maintenance Console Location 9.2 [7-2] Exception Code Programming Manual References 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—TRS— 9.1 [7-1] Denied Code TRS Level—Day, Lunch, Break, Night Feature Guide References 1.9.1 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) PC Programming Manual 791 9.3 [7-3] Special Carrier 9.3 [7-3] Special Carrier If the PBX has access to multiple telephone companies, a Special Carrier Access Code is required each time a trunk call is made. By programming these Special Carrier Access Codes here, Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) can restrict or allow calls to be made by ignoring the codes and looking at the telephone number only. If a Special Carrier Access Code is found in the dialled number, TRS/Barring will look only at the following digits. A maximum of 20 Special Carrier Access Codes can be programmed. Special Carrier Access Code Specifies a Special Carrier Access Code. Special Carrier Access Codes and Host PBX Access codes should be unique. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 9.3 [7-3] Special Carrier Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.5.4.9 Special Carrier Access Code 1.9.1 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) 792 PC Programming Manual 9.4 [7-4] Emergency Dial 9.4 [7-4] Emergency Dial Any extension user can dial the programmed emergency numbers at any time after seizing a trunk. The restrictions imposed on the extension, such as Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring), Account Code— Forced mode, and Extension Dial Lock are disregarded. A maximum of 10 emergency numbers can be programmed. Emergency Number Specifies the numbers used for making emergency calls. It is not necessary to start the emergency number with a Trunk Access number. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, T [Transfer], P [Pause], and F [Flash]) Maintenance Console Location 9.4 [7-4] Emergency Dial Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.5.4.2 Emergency Call PC Programming Manual 793 9.5 [7-5] Miscellaneous 9.5 [7-5] Miscellaneous Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) prohibits an extension from making certain trunk calls. The following optional settings can be programmed to activate a TRS/Barring check, override TRS/Barring, or switch between TRS/Barring methods. TRS Override by System Speed Dialling Enables an outgoing trunk call to override TRS/Barring when the call is made using System Speed Dialling. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 9.5 [7-5] Miscellaneous Programming Manual References 8.1 [6-1] System Speed Dial Feature Guide References 1.9.1 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) TRS Check for Dial "* #" Enables a TRS/Barring check for the user-dialled " " and "#". This is useful in preventing unauthorised calls which could possibly be made through certain telephone company exchanges. Value Range No Check, Check Maintenance Console Location 9.5 [7-5] Miscellaneous Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.9.1 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) Mode when Dial Time-out before TRS Check Selects whether a trunk is disconnected if the TRS/Barring check has not been completed when the trunk Inter-digit timer expires. Value Range Disconnect: The trunk is disconnected as soon as the timer expires. 794 PC Programming Manual 9.5 [7-5] Miscellaneous Keep: The TRS/Barring check is performed when the timer expires. Maintenance Console Location 9.5 [7-5] Miscellaneous Programming Manual References 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Feature Guide References 1.9.1 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) Dial Digits Limitation After Answering—Dial Digits Specifies a limit to be placed on the number of digits which can be dialled after an extension user receives a trunk call. If the number of dialled digits exceeds the programmed limit, the line will be disconnected. Value Range None, 1–7 Maintenance Console Location 9.5 [7-5] Miscellaneous Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.9.1 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) 1.11.8 Trunk Call Limitation TRS Check after EFA Enables TRS/Barring to check the digits dialled after External Feature Access (EFA) during a trunk call. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 9.5 [7-5] Miscellaneous Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 795 9.5 [7-5] Miscellaneous Feature Guide References 1.9.1 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) 1.11.7 External Feature Access (EFA) TRS Table Mode for Level N (N=2_6) Selects the method of TRS/Barring to be used for restricting calls. The level of TRS/Barring is determined by the telephone codes set in the Denied Code Tables and Exception Code Tables. Value Range Deny Table 2_N + Except Table N_6: The Denied Code Tables for the higher levels are applied to all levels below it, and the Exception Code Tables for the lower levels are applied to all levels above it. Deny Table N + Except Table N: Each level has its own separate set of denied codes and exception codes, which are only applied to that level. Maintenance Console Location 9.5 [7-5] Miscellaneous Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.9.1 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) 796 PC Programming Manual Section 10 [8] ARS PC Programming Manual 797 10.1 [8-1] System Setting 10.1 [8-1] System Setting Automatic Route Selection (ARS) automatically selects the appropriate carrier at the time a trunk call is made, according to the programmed settings. The user-dialled number will be checked and modified in order to connect it to the appropriate carrier. ARS Mode Selects the condition to determine when to operate ARS. Value Range Off: ARS is disabled. On for Local Access Operation: ARS operates when an extension user makes a call using Idle Line Access method. On for Any CO Access Operation: ARS operates when an extension user makes a call using Idle Line Access, Trunk Access, or S-CO Line Access method. Maintenance Console Location 10.1 [8-1] System Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.5.5.3 Trunk Access 1.10.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS) Mode When Any Carrier is not programmed for the Dial Selects what happens when the dialled number is not found in Number. Leading Number in 10.2 [8-2] Leading Value Range Disconnect: the line will be disconnected. Local Access: the dialled number will be handled by Idle Line Access method. Maintenance Console Location 10.1 [8-1] System Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.10.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS) 798 PC Programming Manual 10.2 [8-2] Leading Number 10.2 [8-2] Leading Number Specifies the area codes and/or telephone numbers as leading numbers that will be routed by the ARS feature. A maximum of 1000 different leading numbers can be programmed, and each leading number can select a Routing Plan Table number, which determines the ARS procedure. The additional (remaining) number of digits can also be specified for each leading number. The additional (remaining) number of digits must be specified only when "#", for example, is needed after the dialled number. The "#" will be added after the programmed number of digits of the user-dialled number (excluding the leading number). 100 leading numbers are displayed at a time. To display other sets of leading numbers, click the applicable tab. Leading Number Specifies the leading number. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, and X) Maintenance Console Location 10.2 [8-2] Leading Number Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.10.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS) Additional Number of Digits Specifies the additional (remaining) number of digits following each leading number. Value Range 0–15 Maintenance Console Location 10.2 [8-2] Leading Number Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.10.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS) PC Programming Manual 799 10.2 [8-2] Leading Number Routing Plan Number Specifies the Routing Plan Table number used for each leading number. Value Range 1–16 Maintenance Console Location 10.2 [8-2] Leading Number Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.10.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS) 800 PC Programming Manual 10.3 [8-3] Routing Plan Time 10.3 [8-3] Routing Plan Time The start and end times of a maximum of 4 different time blocks are shown for each day of the week. There are 16 Routing Plan Tables, and each Routing Plan Table can have its own time blocks. Select the desired Routing Plan Table number from the Routing Plan list. • To adjust the currently displayed Routing Plan, click and drag the divisions between two time periods. • To programme the time blocks of the currently displayed Routing Plan, including adding or deleting time blocks, click Time Setting. PC Programming Manual 801 10.4 [8-3] Routing Plan Time—Time Setting 10.4 [8-3] Routing Plan Time—Time Setting The start times of a maximum of 4 different time blocks can be programmed for each day of the week, for the selected Routing Plan. Each time block automatically ends when the subsequent block begins. Time-A–D—Setting Enables the setting of the start time for each time block. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 10.4 [8-3] Routing Plan Time—Time Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.10.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS) Time-A–D—Hour, Minute Specifies the start time for each time block. Value Range 00:00–23:59 Maintenance Console Location 10.4 [8-3] Routing Plan Time—Time Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.10.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS) 802 PC Programming Manual 10.5 [8-4] Routing Plan Priority 10.5 [8-4] Routing Plan Priority The carrier priority (1 through 6) in a Routing Plan Table can be programmed for each time zone of each day of the week. Select the desired Routing Plan Table number from the Routing Plan list. Select the desired day of the week by clicking the applicable tab. Time-A–Time-D Specifies the carrier to be given priority for each time zone. Value Range None, 1–10 Maintenance Console Location 10.5 [8-4] Routing Plan Priority Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.10.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS) PC Programming Manual 803 10.6 [8-5] Carrier 10.6 [8-5] Carrier Carrier It is possible to specify how user-dialled numbers are modified for connecting to the appropriate carrier. A maximum of 10 different carriers can be programmed to be used with the ARS feature. Carrier Name Specifies the carrier name. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 10.6 [8-5] Carrier Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.10.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS) Removed Number of Digits Specifies the number of leading digits to remove from the user-dialled number. Value Range 0–15 Maintenance Console Location 10.6 [8-5] Carrier Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.10.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS) Modify Command Specifies the commands to modify the user-dialled number to access the carrier. For details of each command, see the Feature Guide. Value Range Max. 16 characters (consisting of 0–9, *, #, C, P, A, G, I and H) 804 PC Programming Manual 10.6 [8-5] Carrier Maintenance Console Location 10.6 [8-5] Carrier Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.10.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS) Carrier Access Code Specifies the carrier access code. The carrier access code can be added to the user-dialled number by specifying "C" in Modify Command on this screen. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, and P [Pause]) Maintenance Console Location 10.6 [8-5] Carrier Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.10.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS) TRG 01–TRG 64 Selects the trunk groups that connect to the carrier. TRG 01–TRG 64 Enables each trunk group for each carrier. If a cell is highlighted in blue, that trunk group is enabled for use with that carrier. Value Range OFF (white), ON (blue) Maintenance Console Location 10.6 [8-5] Carrier Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 805 10.6 [8-5] Carrier Feature Guide References 1.10.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS) Authorisation Code for Tenant Specifies an Authorisation code for each tenant. The Authorisation codes can be added to the user-dialled number by specifying "A" command in Modify Command on the Carrier tab. Authorisation Code for Tenant—Tenant 1–Tenant 8 Specifies the Authorisation code of each carrier for each tenant. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 10.6 [8-5] Carrier Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.10.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS) 2.2.3 Tenant Service 806 PC Programming Manual 10.7 [8-6] Leading Number Exception 10.7 [8-6] Leading Number Exception Specifies telephone numbers that will not be connected using the ARS feature. When the user-dialled number includes a leading number exception, the PBX sends the number to a trunk by the Idle Line Access method if ARS Mode in 10.1 [8-1] System Setting is "on". A maximum of 200 different leading number exceptions can be programmed. 40 leading number exception entries are displayed on the screen at a time. To display other sets, click the applicable tab. Leading Number Exception Specifies the leading number exception. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, and X) Maintenance Console Location 10.7 [8-6] Leading Number Exception Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.10.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS) PC Programming Manual 807 10.8 [8-7] Authorisation Code for TRG 10.8 [8-7] Authorisation Code for TRG An Authorisation code can be specified for each trunk group. The Authorisation codes entered here can be added to user-dialled numbers by adding "G" to the Modify Command specified on the Carrier tab of screen 10.6 [8-5] Carrier. 8 trunk groups are displayed on the screen at a time. To display other groups, click the applicable tab. Authorisation Code for Trunk Group—TRG 01–TRG 64 Specifies the Authorisation code of each carrier for each trunk group. Value Range Max. 10 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 10.8 [8-7] Authorisation Code for TRG Programming Manual References 10.6 [8-5] Carrier—Carrier— Modify Command Feature Guide References 1.10.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS) 808 PC Programming Manual Section 11 [9] Private Network PC Programming Manual 809 11.1 [9-1] TIE Table 11.1 [9-1] TIE Table A TIE line is a privately leased communication line between two or more PBXs, which provides cost effective communications between company members at different locations. A maximum of 32 TIE Line Routing and Modification Tables can be programmed. It is necessary to make unified tables with all PBXs at different locations in a TIE line network in order to identify the trunk route to be used when an extension makes or receives a TIE line call. There are two types of routing methods: the Extension Number Method, where all extensions in the network are given a unique extension number; and the PBX Code Method, where each PBX is given a unique code, which is dialled before the extension number to call an extension at another PBX. Two priority sets (from a total of 8) are displayed at a time. To display other priority sets, click the applicable tab. Using a private network, up to 8 PBXs can share one VPS (centralised VM) connected to another PBX. This VPS can provide voice mail for extensions attached to any of the PBXs in the network. Only extension numbers of 4 digits or less, using the Extension Number Method, are supported. Own PBX Code Specifies the PBX code of the local PBX, when using PBX Code Method numbering on a TIE line network. If this cell is left empty, the Extension Number Method is used. Value Range Max. 7 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 11.1 [9-1] TIE Table Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.30.1 TIE Line Service Priority 1–Priority 8 Leading Number Specifies the leading number for other PBX extension numbers or the PBX code of others in the TIE line network. Value Range Max. 3 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 11.1 [9-1] TIE Table 810 PC Programming Manual 11.1 [9-1] TIE Table Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.30.1 TIE Line Service Removed Number of Digits Specifies the number of leading digits of the dialled number to be removed for each priority. Value Range 0–15 Maintenance Console Location 11.1 [9-1] TIE Table Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.30.1 TIE Line Service Added Number Specifies the number to be added to the dialled number in place of the removed digits for each priority. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, #, and P [Pause]) Maintenance Console Location 11.1 [9-1] TIE Table Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.30.1 TIE Line Service Trunk Group Specifies the trunk group to be used for TIE line calls for each priority. Value Range None, 1–64 PC Programming Manual 811 11.1 [9-1] TIE Table Maintenance Console Location 11.1 [9-1] TIE Table Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.30.1 TIE Line Service Centralised VM Leading Number Specifies the leading number for other PBX extension numbers or the PBX code of other PBXs in the TIE line network. Value Range Max. 3 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 11.1 [9-1] TIE Table Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.30.1 TIE Line Service Enhanced QSIG Call Information (Optional SD Card Required) Enables Network Message Waiting information to be sent from the PBX to which the VPS is attached to extensions connected to other PBXs in the network. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 11.1 [9-1] TIE Table Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.30.5.2 Centralised Voice Mail 812 PC Programming Manual 11.2 [9-2] Network Data Transmission 11.2 [9-2] Network Data Transmission Settings related to the transmission of extension BLF (Busy Line Field) data or Message Waiting notifications over a network of PBXs can be programmed. Extension BLF data is used to show the status of a monitored extension attached to another PBX on a Network DSS (NDSS) button. Network Message Waiting notifications are used for the Centralised VM feature, and a VPS can send notifications to extensions connected to any PBX in the network. Network Data Transmission for Centralised Operator Feature—Network PBX ID Specifies the Network ID of the PBX, for Network Direct Station Selection (NDSS). This parameter must be set in correspondence with the Network IDs assigned to other PBXs in the network. Network IDs 1-8 can only be assigned to one PBX each within a network. Assigning the same Network ID to two PBXs will cause network data transmission problems. Changing this value in Interactive mode will automatically clear any NDSS Link Data. Value Range 0: The PBX retransmits BLF data sent by other PBXs. 1: The PBX receives BLF data sent by other PBXs. 2–8: The PBX transmits BLF data over the network. Maintenance Console Location 11.2 [9-2] Network Data Transmission Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.30.5.1 Network Direct Station Selection (NDSS) Network Data Transmission for Centralised Operator Feature—Data Transmission VoIP->ISDN Selects whether to re-send BLF data received from a VoIP port through any ISDN ports that are set to transmit BLF data. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 11.2 [9-2] Network Data Transmission Programming Manual References 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—ISDN CO— Networking Data Transfer 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—CO Setting— Networking Data Transfer PC Programming Manual 813 11.2 [9-2] Network Data Transmission Feature Guide References 1.30.5.1 Network Direct Station Selection (NDSS) Network Data Transmission for Centralised Operator Feature—Data Transmission ISDN->VoIP Selects whether to re-send BLF data received from an ISDN port through any VoIP ports that are set to transmit BLF data. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 11.2 [9-2] Network Data Transmission Programming Manual References 11.3 [9-3] Network Operator (VoIP)— IP-GW Card Slot No. to notify BLF data to Network Operator Feature Guide References 1.30.5.1 Network Direct Station Selection (NDSS) Network Data Transmission for Centralised Operator Feature—Data Transmission Counter Specifies the maximum number of "hops", or transmissions between two PBXs, before a packet of BLF data is discarded. Value Range 1–63 Maintenance Console Location 11.2 [9-2] Network Data Transmission Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.30.5.1 Network Direct Station Selection (NDSS) Network Data Transmission for Centralised Operator Feature—Data Broadcasting Interval Timer Specifies the frequency of BLF data transmission. The PBX will send data over the network periodically according to the interval specified here. 814 PC Programming Manual 11.2 [9-2] Network Data Transmission Value Range 100 ´ n (n=0–30) ms Maintenance Console Location 11.2 [9-2] Network Data Transmission Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.30.5.1 Network Direct Station Selection (NDSS) Network MSW Data Transmission for Centralised VM Feature—Data Re-transmission : Repeat Counter Specifies the number of times re-transmission of network message waiting notifications is repeated before being cancelled. Value Range 0–10 Maintenance Console Location 11.2 [9-2] Network Data Transmission Programming Manual References 11.1 [9-1] TIE Table— Enhanced QSIG Call Information (Optional SD Card Required) Feature Guide References 1.30.5.2 Centralised Voice Mail Network MSW Data Transmission for Centralised VM Feature—Data Re-transmission : Repeat Timer Specifies the length of time between repeated re-transmission of network message waiting notifications. Value Range 10–240 s Maintenance Console Location 11.2 [9-2] Network Data Transmission PC Programming Manual 815 11.2 [9-2] Network Data Transmission Programming Manual References 11.1 [9-1] TIE Table— Enhanced QSIG Call Information (Optional SD Card Required) Feature Guide References 1.30.5.2 Centralised Voice Mail 816 PC Programming Manual 11.3 [9-3] Network Operator (VoIP) 11.3 [9-3] Network Operator (VoIP) This screen allows network operators to be programmed. A network operator is an extension at a remote PBX that will monitor other PBX extensions using Network Direct Station Selection (NDSS). The settings on this screen should be programmed at the PBX that is to be monitored ( Network Data Transmission for Centralised Operator Feature—Network PBX ID 2–8). Up to 8 network operators can be programmed. Network Operator Extension No. Specifies the number of an extension at the monitor PBX (the PBX whose Network Data Transmission for Centralised Operator Feature—Network PBX ID is set to 1 in 11.2 [9-2] Network Data Transmission). Any extension at the monitor PBX can be specified here. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 11.3 [9-3] Network Operator (VoIP) Programming Manual References 11.2 [9-2] Network Data Transmission— Network PBX ID Network Data Transmission for Centralised Operator Feature— Feature Guide References 1.30.5.1 Network Direct Station Selection (NDSS) IP-GW Card Slot No. to notify BLF data to Network Operator Specifies the slot number of the card used to send extension status data. This setting is only required when using VoIP to transmit data. Value Range For KX-NCP500: Undefined, 1, 2, 3, V1, V2 For KX-NCP1000: Undefined, 1, 2, 3, 4, V1, V2, V3, V4 Maintenance Console Location 11.3 [9-3] Network Operator (VoIP) Programming Manual References 3.1 [1-1] Slot Feature Guide References 1.30.5.1 Network Direct Station Selection (NDSS) PC Programming Manual 817 11.4 [9-4] NDSS Key Table 11.4 [9-4] NDSS Key Table Extensions at up to 7 other PBXs that will be monitored using Network Direct Station Selection (NDSS) can be registered. A maximum of 250 extensions can be registered. To create an NDSS button to monitor an extension, the extension must be registered here first. To clear NDSS link data, click the NDSS Clear button. Note that the parameters on this screen can only be set when the Network Data Transmission for Centralised Operator Feature—Network PBX ID is set to 1 in the 11.2 [9-2] Network Data Transmission screen. Network Extension No. Specifies the number of the remote extension (attached to another PBX) that will be monitored. The number input here can use either Extension Number Method or PBX Code Method. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 11.4 [9-4] NDSS Key Table Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.30 Networking Features—1.30.1 TIE Line Service 1.30.5.1 Network Direct Station Selection (NDSS) Network Extension Name for Programming Reference Specifies the name of the network extension. This name is only shown here, not on the displays of extensions. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 11.4 [9-4] NDSS Key Table Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.30.5.1 Network Direct Station Selection (NDSS) 818 PC Programming Manual 11.4 [9-4] NDSS Key Table Network PBX ID of Network Extension to be monitored Indicates the Network Data Transmission for Centralised Operator Feature—Network PBX ID of the PBX that the extension is connected to (reference only). Value Range None, 1–8 Maintenance Console Location 11.4 [9-4] NDSS Key Table Programming Manual References 11.2 [9-2] Network Data Transmission— Network PBX ID Network Data Transmission for Centralised Operator Feature— Feature Guide References 1.30.5.1 Network Direct Station Selection (NDSS) PC Programming Manual 819 11.4 [9-4] NDSS Key Table 820 PC Programming Manual Section 12 [10] CO & Incoming Call PC Programming Manual 821 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings Trunks can be assigned a name, and grouped into a maximum of 64 trunk groups. Shelf Indicates the shelf type to which each trunk card belongs (reference only). Value Range Physical, Virtual Maintenance Console Location 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Slot Indicates the slot position of each trunk card (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number 822 PC Programming Manual 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings Maintenance Console Location 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Card Type Indicates the type of card to which the trunk is connected (reference only). Value Range Card type Maintenance Console Location 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None CO Name Specifies the trunk name which is shown on the extension’s display when receiving a call from the trunk. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.20.4 Display Information PC Programming Manual 823 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings Trunk Group Number Specifies the trunk group number to which the trunk belongs. Value Range 1–64 Maintenance Console Location 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.2 Group 824 PC Programming Manual 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Direct In Line (DIL) or Direct Dialling In (DDI)/Direct Inward Dialling (DID) can be selected for each trunk as the method of distributing incoming trunk calls to certain destinations. For each trunk to which DIL distribution is set, different destinations can be programmed depending on the time mode (day/lunch/break/night). If desired, Calling Line Identification (CLI) distribution can be used in conjunction with DIL distribution. DIL For each trunk to which DIL distribution is set, different DIL destinations can be programmed depending on the time mode (day/lunch/break/night). Generally, DIL distribution is used for trunk calls from analogue trunks. Tenant number and VM trunk group number can also be programmed for each trunk. To assign DIL destination numbers, enter directly or click Destination Setting (see 2.1.6 Extension Number Setting). Shelf Indicates the shelf type (reference only). Value Range Physical, Virtual Maintenance Console Location 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Slot Indicates the slot position of each trunk card (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 825 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Card Type Indicates the trunk card type (reference only). Value Range Card type Maintenance Console Location 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.1.1 Incoming Trunk Call Features—SUMMARY Trunk Property Indicates the networking type of each trunk (reference only). Value Range Public, Private(TIE), VPN Maintenance Console Location 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Programming Manual References None 826 PC Programming Manual 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Feature Guide References 1.1.1.1 Incoming Trunk Call Features—SUMMARY 1.30.1 TIE Line Service 1.30.3 Virtual Private Network (VPN) Distribution Method Selects the distribution method for incoming trunk calls. The value range of this setting depends on the card type and Trunk Property assigned for each trunk. Value Range DIL: Distribution depends on the trunk through which the calls arrive DDI/DID: Distribution depends on the DDI/DID number of the calls MSN: Distribution depends on the MSN of the calls Maintenance Console Location 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.1.1 Incoming Trunk Call Features—SUMMARY DIL Destination—Day, Lunch, Break, Night Specifies the DIL destination in each time mode. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Programming Manual References 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main Feature Guide References 1.1.1.2 Direct In Line (DIL) 1.30.1 TIE Line Service Tenant Number Specifies the tenant number, to determine the Time Table by which calls are distributed depending on the time of day. PC Programming Manual 827 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Value Range 1–8 Maintenance Console Location 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.1.2 Direct In Line (DIL) 2.2.3 Tenant Service 2.2.4 Time Service VM Trunk Group No. Specifies the number of the VM trunk group sent to the VPS when the DIL destination is the floating extension number of a VM (DPT) Group. The VM trunk group number is used to allow the VPS to send the applicable greeting message to the caller. Value Range 1–48 Maintenance Console Location 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.1.2 Direct In Line (DIL) 1.24.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration CLI for DIL When CLI distribution is enabled for a trunk to which DIL distribution is set, incoming trunk calls will be distributed to the CLI destinations (instead of the DIL destinations) if the caller’s identification number is found in the System Speed Dialling Table. CLI distribution can be enabled or disabled for each time mode (day/lunch/break/night) on a trunk basis. Shelf Indicates the shelf type (reference only). 828 PC Programming Manual 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Value Range Physical, Virtual Maintenance Console Location 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Slot Indicates the slot position of each trunk card (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 829 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Feature Guide References None Card Type Indicates the trunk card type (reference only). Value Range Card type Maintenance Console Location 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.1.1 Incoming Trunk Call Features—SUMMARY Trunk Property Indicates the networking type of each trunk (reference only). Value Range Public, Private(TIE), VPN Maintenance Console Location 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.1.1 Incoming Trunk Call Features—SUMMARY 1.30.1 TIE Line Service 1.30.3 Virtual Private Network (VPN) Distribution Method Selects the distribution method for incoming trunk calls. The value range of this setting depends on the card type and Trunk Property assigned for each trunk. Value Range DIL: Distribution depends on the trunk through which the calls arrive DDI/DID: Distribution depends on the DDI/DID number of the calls MSN: Distribution depends on the MSN of the calls 830 PC Programming Manual 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Maintenance Console Location 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.1.1 Incoming Trunk Call Features—SUMMARY CLI Ring for DIL—Day, Lunch, Break, Night Enables CLI distribution in each time mode. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.1.2 Direct In Line (DIL) 1.1.1.5 Calling Line Identification (CLI) Distribution DDI / DID / TIE / MSN For each trunk to which DDI/DID distribution is set, or for each trunk whose Trunk Property on this screen is Private (TIE), modification parameters for DDI/DID number and TIE line call numbers can be programmed. Shelf Indicates the shelf type (reference only). Value Range Physical, Virtual Maintenance Console Location 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 831 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Feature Guide References None Slot Indicates the slot position of each trunk card (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Card Type Indicates the trunk card type (reference only). Value Range Card type Maintenance Console Location 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings 832 PC Programming Manual 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.1.1 Incoming Trunk Call Features—SUMMARY Trunk Property Indicates the networking type of each trunk (reference only). Value Range Public, Private(TIE), VPN Maintenance Console Location 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.1.1 Incoming Trunk Call Features—SUMMARY 1.30.1 TIE Line Service 1.30.3 Virtual Private Network (VPN) Distribution Method Selects the distribution method for incoming trunk calls. The value range of this setting depends on the card type and Trunk Property assigned for each trunk. Value Range DIL: Distribution depends on the trunk through which the calls arrive DDI/DID: Distribution depends on the DDI/DID number of the calls MSN: Distribution depends on the MSN of the calls Maintenance Console Location 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.1.1 Incoming Trunk Call Features—SUMMARY 1.1.1.3 Direct Inward Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI) 1.1.1.4 Multiple Subscriber Number (MSN) Ringing Service PC Programming Manual 833 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings DDI/DID/TIE/MSN—Remove Digit Specifies the number of leading digits to be removed from the incoming called number for DDI/DID distribution or for TIE line service. Value Range 0–15 Maintenance Console Location 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.1.3 Direct Inward Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI) 1.1.1.4 Multiple Subscriber Number (MSN) Ringing Service 1.30.1 TIE Line Service DDI/DID/TIE/MSN—Additional Dial Specifies the number to be added to the incoming called number in the place of the removed digits for DDI/ DID distribution or for TIE line service. Value Range Max. 8 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.1.3 Direct Inward Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI) 1.1.1.4 Multiple Subscriber Number (MSN) Ringing Service 1.30.1 TIE Line Service 834 PC Programming Manual 12.3 [10-3] DDI / DID Table 12.3 [10-3] DDI / DID Table Incoming trunk calls with DDI/DID numbers can be distributed to specific destinations. Each DDI/DID number has a destination programmed for each time mode (day/lunch/break/night). When CLI distribution is enabled for a DDI/DID number, incoming trunk calls with that DDI/DID number will be distributed to the CLI destinations (instead of the DDI/DID destinations) if the caller’s identification number is found in the System Speed Dialling Table, which is used as the Caller ID Table. CLI distribution can be enabled or disabled for each time mode (day/lunch/break/night) on a DDI/DID number basis. A maximum of 1000 DDI/DID numbers can be programmed with other related parameters. 100 numbers are displayed at a time. To display other sets of numbers, click the applicable tab. To assign DDI/DID destination numbers, enter directly or click Destination Setting (see 2.1.6 Extension Number Setting). It is possible to programme DDI/DID numbers and DDI/DID destinations in each time mode (day/lunch/break/night) for a set of locations in series at once by clicking Automatic Registration, or to programme DDI/DID names for a set of locations in series at once by clicking Name Generate. DDI / DID Number Specifies the DDI/DID number. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 12.3 [10-3] DDI / DID Table Programming Manual References 12.4 [10-3] DDI/DID Table—Automatic Registration Feature Guide References 1.1.1.3 Direct Inward Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI) DDI / DID Name Specifies the name for the DDI/DID number which is shown on the extension’s display when receiving a call with the DDI/DID number. The name of the DDI/DID number can be printed out on SMDR. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 12.3 [10-3] DDI / DID Table Programming Manual References 12.5 [10-3] DDI/DID Table—Name Generate 13.1 [11-1] Main—SMDR Options— Option—DDI/DID Number & Name PC Programming Manual 835 12.3 [10-3] DDI / DID Table Feature Guide References 1.1.1.3 Direct Inward Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI) DDI / DID Destination—Day, Lunch, Break, Night Specifies the DDI/DID destination in each time mode. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 12.3 [10-3] DDI / DID Table Programming Manual References 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main 12.4 [10-3] DDI/DID Table—Automatic Registration Feature Guide References 1.1.1.3 Direct Inward Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI) 1.30.1 TIE Line Service Tenant Number Specifies the tenant number, to determine the Time Table by which calls are distributed depending on the time of day. Value Range 1–8 Maintenance Console Location 12.3 [10-3] DDI / DID Table Programming Manual References 4.6 [2-4] Week Table Feature Guide References 1.1.1.3 Direct Inward Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI) VM Trunk Group No. Specifies the number of the VM trunk group sent to the VPS when the DID destination is the floating extension number of a VM (DPT) Group. The VM trunk group number is used to allow the VPS to send the applicable greeting message to the caller. Value Range 1–48 836 PC Programming Manual 12.3 [10-3] DDI / DID Table Maintenance Console Location 12.3 [10-3] DDI / DID Table Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.1.3 Direct Inward Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI) 1.24.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration CLI Ring for DDI/DID—Day, Lunch, Break, Night Enables CLI distribution in each time mode. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 12.3 [10-3] DDI / DID Table Programming Manual References 8.1 [6-1] System Speed Dial Feature Guide References 1.1.1.3 Direct Inward Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI) 1.1.1.5 Calling Line Identification (CLI) Distribution PC Programming Manual 837 12.4 [10-3] DDI/DID Table—Automatic Registration 12.4 [10-3] DDI/DID Table—Automatic Registration Automatic Registration allows DDI/DID numbers and DDI/DID destinations in each time mode (day/lunch/ break/night) to be programmed at once for a set of locations in series. Beginning Entry Location Specifies the number of the first location to be programmed. Value Range 1–1000 Maintenance Console Location 12.4 [10-3] DDI/DID Table—Automatic Registration Programming Manual References 12.3 [10-3] DDI / DID Table Feature Guide References 1.1.1.3 Direct Inward Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI) Generate DDI/DID Number (From) Specifies the DID number of the first location to be programmed. DDI/DID numbers for subsequent locations will be generated automatically, by adding one to the value of the previous location. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 12.4 [10-3] DDI/DID Table—Automatic Registration Programming Manual References 12.3 [10-3] DDI / DID Table Feature Guide References 1.1.1.3 Direct Inward Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI) Number of Registration Specifies the number of locations to be programmed. Value Range 1–1000 838 PC Programming Manual 12.4 [10-3] DDI/DID Table—Automatic Registration Maintenance Console Location 12.4 [10-3] DDI/DID Table—Automatic Registration Programming Manual References 12.3 [10-3] DDI / DID Table Feature Guide References 1.1.1.3 Direct Inward Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI) Destination—Day, Lunch, Break, Night Specifies the number of the DDI/DID destination in each time mode for the first location to be programmed. If the same destination is to be used for all locations for a certain time mode, click the appropriate Same all check box. If the Same all check box for a certain time mode is not clicked, the destination numbers for subsequent locations will be generated automatically, by adding one to the value of the previous location for that time mode. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 12.4 [10-3] DDI/DID Table—Automatic Registration Programming Manual References 12.3 [10-3] DDI / DID Table Feature Guide References 1.1.1.3 Direct Inward Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI) PC Programming Manual 839 12.5 [10-3] DDI/DID Table—Name Generate 12.5 [10-3] DDI/DID Table—Name Generate Name Generate allows DDI/DID names to be programmed at once for a set of locations in series. If a name generated here is longer than 20 characters, the additional characters will be discarded. Beginning Entry Location Specifies the number of the first location to be programmed. Value Range 1–1000 Maintenance Console Location 12.5 [10-3] DDI/DID Table—Name Generate Programming Manual References 12.3 [10-3] DDI / DID Table Feature Guide References 1.1.1.3 Direct Inward Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI) Number to Generate Specifies the number of locations to be programmed. Value Range 1–1000 Maintenance Console Location 12.5 [10-3] DDI/DID Table—Name Generate Programming Manual References 12.3 [10-3] DDI / DID Table Feature Guide References 1.1.1.3 Direct Inward Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI) No. of Digits to Delete Specifies the number of digits to be deleted from the start of a DDI/DID number when using it as part of the DDI/DID name. Value Range 0–32 840 PC Programming Manual 12.5 [10-3] DDI/DID Table—Name Generate Maintenance Console Location 12.5 [10-3] DDI/DID Table—Name Generate Programming Manual References 12.3 [10-3] DDI / DID Table Feature Guide References 1.1.1.3 Direct Inward Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI) Name Prefix Specifies the text to be included at the start of each DDI/DID name. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 12.5 [10-3] DDI/DID Table—Name Generate Programming Manual References 12.3 [10-3] DDI / DID Table Feature Guide References 1.1.1.3 Direct Inward Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI) Name Suffix Specifies the text to be included at the end of each DDI/DID name. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 12.5 [10-3] DDI/DID Table—Name Generate Programming Manual References 12.3 [10-3] DDI / DID Table Feature Guide References 1.1.1.3 Direct Inward Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI) PC Programming Manual 841 12.6 [10-4] MSN Table 12.6 [10-4] MSN Table Incoming ISDN-BRI (Basic Rate Interface) line calls with Multiple Subscriber Numbers (MSNs) can be distributed to a certain destination. Each MSN has a destination programmed for each time mode (day/lunch/ break/night). A maximum of 10 MSNs can be programmed for each ISDN-BRI port. To use this feature, Access Mode in 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port must be set to P-MP. MSN To assign MSN destination numbers, enter directly or click Destination Setting (see 2.1.6 Extension Number Setting). Slot Indicates the slot position of the BRI card that is set to MSN distribution (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 12.6 [10-4] MSN Table Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number of the BRI card that is set to MSN distribution (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 12.6 [10-4] MSN Table Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None 842 PC Programming Manual 12.6 [10-4] MSN Table MSN Number Specifies the MSN. Value Range Max. 16 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 12.6 [10-4] MSN Table Programming Manual References 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Feature Guide References 1.1.1.4 Multiple Subscriber Number (MSN) Ringing Service MSN Name Specifies the name for the MSN which is shown on the extension’s display when receiving a call with the MSN. Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 12.6 [10-4] MSN Table Programming Manual References 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Feature Guide References 1.1.1.4 Multiple Subscriber Number (MSN) Ringing Service MSN Destination—Day, Lunch, Break, Night Specifies the MSN destination in each time mode. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 12.6 [10-4] MSN Table Programming Manual References 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port PC Programming Manual 843 12.6 [10-4] MSN Table Feature Guide References 1.1.1.4 Multiple Subscriber Number (MSN) Ringing Service Tenant Number Specifies the tenant number, to determine the Time Table by which calls are distributed depending on the time of day. Value Range 1–8 Maintenance Console Location 12.6 [10-4] MSN Table Programming Manual References 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port 4.6 [2-4] Week Table Feature Guide References 1.1.1.4 Multiple Subscriber Number (MSN) Ringing Service VM Trunk Group No. Specifies the number of the VM trunk group sent to the VPS when the MSN destination is the floating extension number of a VM (DPT) Group. The VM trunk group number is used to allow the VPS to send the applicable greeting message to the caller. Value Range 1–48 Maintenance Console Location 12.6 [10-4] MSN Table Programming Manual References 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port Feature Guide References 1.1.1.4 Multiple Subscriber Number (MSN) Ringing Service CLI for MSN When CLI distribution is enabled for an ISDN-BRI line to which MSN distribution is set, incoming trunk calls will be distributed to the CLI destinations (instead of the MSN destinations) if the caller’s identification number is found in the System Speed Dialling Table. CLI distribution can be enabled or disabled for each time mode (day/lunch/break/night) on a trunk basis. 844 PC Programming Manual 12.6 [10-4] MSN Table Slot Indicates the slot position of the BRI card that is set to MSN distribution (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 12.6 [10-4] MSN Table Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number of the BRI card that is set to MSN distribution (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 12.6 [10-4] MSN Table Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None CLI Ring for MSN—Day, Lunch, Break, Night Enables CLI distribution in each time mode. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 12.6 [10-4] MSN Table Programming Manual References 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port PC Programming Manual 845 12.6 [10-4] MSN Table Feature Guide References 1.1.1.4 Multiple Subscriber Number (MSN) Ringing Service 1.1.1.5 Calling Line Identification (CLI) Distribution 846 PC Programming Manual 12.7 [10-5] Miscellaneous 12.7 [10-5] Miscellaneous The Intercept Routing feature can activate when the destination of an incoming call is unavailable, or when there is no destination for the call, to reroute the call to an alternate destination. Intercept—Intercept Routing - DND (Destination sets DND.) Enables the Intercept Routing—DND feature to activate when the original destination is in DND mode. Value Range Disable (Busy Tone): Sends a busy tone to the caller. (However, a call through an LCOT or T1 [LCOT/ GCOT] card will ring at the original destination while the caller hears a ringback tone.) Enable: Redirects the call to the intercept destination Maintenance Console Location 12.7 [10-5] Miscellaneous Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.1.6 Intercept Routing 1.3.1.3 Do Not Disturb (DND) Intercept—Routing to Operator - No Destination (Destination is not programmed.) Enables the Intercept Routing—No Destination feature to activate when there is no destination for the call. (The Intercept Routing—No Destination feature always works for calls through an LCOT or T1 [LCOT/GCOT] card, even when this feature is disabled.) Value Range Disable (Reorder Tone): Sends a reorder tone to the caller Enable: Redirects the call to an operator Maintenance Console Location 12.7 [10-5] Miscellaneous Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.1.7 Intercept Routing—No Destination PC Programming Manual 847 12.7 [10-5] Miscellaneous Intercept—Intercept Routing for Extension Call Enables the Intercept Routing feature to operate for extension calls. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 12.7 [10-5] Miscellaneous Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.1.1.7 Intercept Routing—No Destination 848 PC Programming Manual Section 13 [11] Maintenance PC Programming Manual 849 13.1 [11-1] Main 13.1 [11-1] Main SMDR Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) automatically records detailed information about incoming and outgoing calls. SMDR Format—Type Selects the format of SMDR output. Value Range Type A: 80 digits without call charge information Type B: 80 digits with call charge information Type C: 120 digits Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) SMDR Format—Port Selects the Serial Interface port that is used to output the SMDR data. Value Range None, LAN, RS-232C Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) SMDR Format—Page Length (Number of Lines) Specifies the number of lines on a page of output paper. Match the SMDR output to the paper size being used in the printer. 850 PC Programming Manual 13.1 [11-1] Main Value Range 4–99 Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) SMDR Format—Blank Footer Length (Number of Lines) Specifies the number of lines to be skipped at the end of every page. The number of lines for the skip perforation should be shorter than the page length. Value Range 0–95 Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) SMDR Format—Date Format Selects the printed date format. Value Range MM-DD-YY, DD-MM-YY, YY-MM-DD, YY-DD-MM Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 851 13.1 [11-1] Main Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) SMDR Format—Time Format (12H / 24H) Selects whether times are displayed using the 12- or 24-hour format. Value Range 12H, 24H Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) Print Information—Outgoing Call Specifies whether the dialled digits of outgoing trunk calls are printed. Class of Service (COS) programming determines the printable records. Value Range No Print, Print Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—CO & SMDR— Outgoing CO Call Printout (SMDR) Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) Print Information—Incoming Call Specifies whether the information relating to incoming trunk calls, such as caller’s identification name and number, is printed. Value Range No Print, Print 852 PC Programming Manual 13.1 [11-1] Main Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) Print Information—Intercom Call Specifies whether the dialled digits of outgoing intercom calls are printed. Value Range No Print, Print Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) Print Information—Log-in / Log-out Specifies whether the log-in/log-out status is printed. Value Range No Print, Print Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.2.2.7 Log-in/Log-out 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) PC Programming Manual 853 13.1 [11-1] Main Print Information—Hotel Room Status Selects whether check-in and check-out data is output on SMDR. Value Range No Print, Print Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) 1.27.2 Room Status Control Print Information—Timed Reminder (Wake-up Call) Selects whether Timed Reminder data is output on SMDR. Value Range No Print, Print Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) 1.28.4 Timed Reminder Print Information—Error Log Specifies whether PBX error log information is output to SMDR. Value Range No Print, Print Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main 854 PC Programming Manual 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) 2.4.3 Local Alarm Information SMDR Options Option—ARS Dial Selects the type of the dialled number to be printed for a call with the ARS feature. Value Range Dial before ARS Modification: The user-dialled number Dial after ARS Modification: The ARS modified number Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.5.4.8 Host PBX Access Code (Access Code to the Telephone Company from a Host PBX) 1.10 Automatic Route Selection (ARS) Features 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) Option—Caller ID Number & Name Selects the printing format of caller identifications for incoming trunk calls. Value Range None, Number, Name, Name + Number Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) PC Programming Manual 855 13.1 [11-1] Main Option—DDI/DID Number & Name Selects the printing format of incoming trunk calls with a DDI/DID number. Value Range None, Number, Name, Name + Number Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) Option—Secret Dial Selects the printing format of calls with a secret dial. The secret dial conceals all or part of the dialled number. Note that selecting Dial before ARS Modification in Option—ARS Dial on this screen indicates the dialled numbers as dots regardless of this setting. Value Range Print "...." (Secret), Print Dialled Number Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.6.1.1 Memory Dialling Features—SUMMARY 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) Option—Privacy Mode Selects whether private dialling is enabled or disabled, and how many digits to hide when enabled. To enable this setting, Print Information—Outgoing Call on the SMDR tab should be set to Print. Value Range Print Dialled Number: Disables private dialling; all dialled numbers are shown on SMDR. No Print: No dialled number will be shown on SMDR. Secret "X", Secret "XX", Secret "XXX", Secret "XXXX": The selected number of digits at the end of dialled telephone numbers, and any additional digits dialled after connection, are shown on SMDR as "X". 856 PC Programming Manual 13.1 [11-1] Main Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References 13.1 [11-1] Main—SMDR— Print Information—Outgoing Call Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) Option—Condition Code "RC" Specifies whether the time of receiving an incoming trunk call is printed. Value Range No Print, Print Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) Option—Condition Code "AN" Specifies whether the time of answering an incoming trunk call is printed. Value Range No Print, Print Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) PC Programming Manual 857 13.1 [11-1] Main Option—Caller ID Modification Specifies whether Caller ID numbers are recorded on SMDR as received (before being modified by the PBX) or after being modified. Value Range Before Modification, After Modification Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References 5.3 [3-1-3] Caller ID Modification Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) LAN—SMDR Port Number Specifies the port number used to output SMDR data via the LAN. Value Range 1–65535 Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) LAN—SMDR Password Specifies the password used to output the SMDR data via the LAN. Value Range Max. 10 characters Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main 858 PC Programming Manual 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) LAN—New Line Code for Telnet Specifies the new line code for a terminal emulator. If the terminal emulator automatically feeds lines with a carriage return, select CR (Carriage Return). If not, select CR+LF (Line Feed). Value Range CR+LF, CR Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) RS-232C Communication—Baud Rate Specifies the data transmission speed from the PBX to the printer or personal computer. To ensure stable transmission, when changing this setting to 57600 or 115200 bps, set Communication —Flow on this screen to Hardware. Value Range 2400 bps, 4800 bps, 9600 bps, 19200 bps, 38400 bps, 57600 bps, 115200 bps Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References 13.1 [11-1] Main—RS-232C— Communication—Flow Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) PC Programming Manual 859 13.1 [11-1] Main Communication—NL Code Specifies the NL (New Line) code for the printer or personal computer. If the printer or personal computer automatically feeds lines with a carriage return, select CR (Carriage Return). If not, select CR+LF (Line Feed). Value Range CR+LF, CR Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) Communication—Parity Bit Selects a parity bit code that indicates what type of parity is used to detect an error in the string of bits composing a character. Make an appropriate selection depending on the requirements of the printer or personal computer. Value Range None, Mark, Space, Even, Odd Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) Communication—Word Length Specifies the number of bits in each byte of a character. When connecting the Maintenance Console to the PBX using an RS-232C cable, assign the following values to the Serial Interface (RS-232C) port of the PBX: Word Length: 8 bit, Parity Bit: None, Stop Bit: 1 bit Notice Do not use the following combinations: • Word Length: 8 bit, Parity Bit: Space, Stop Bit: 1 bit • Word Length: 8 bit, Parity Bit: Mark, Stop Bit: 2 bit 860 PC Programming Manual 13.1 [11-1] Main • Word Length: 8 bit, Parity Bit: Space, Stop Bit: 2 bit Value Range 7 bit, 8 bit Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) Communication—Flow Enables the hardware flow control. Value Range None, Hardware Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References None Communication—Stop Bit Selects a stop bit code that indicates the end of a bit string which composes a character. Select an appropriate value depending on the requirements of the printer or personal computer. Value Range 1 bit, 2 bit Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 861 13.1 [11-1] Main Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) External Modem Command—Automatic Initialisation Specifies the command to automatically initialise an external modem when it is plugged into the Serial Interface (RS-232C) port of the PBX. Value Range Max. 30 characters Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.3.1 PC Programming External Modem Command—Manual Initialisation 1–Manual Initialisation 5 Specifies the command to manually initialise an external modem. The command specified here is controlled by PT system programming (External Modem Control [801]). Value Range Max. 30 characters Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.3.1 PC Programming Maintenance Local Alarm Display—Extension 1, Extension 2 Specifies the extension numbers of PTs that will be notified by the PBX about local alarms. When the PBX detects a PBX error, the System Alarm button on the PT turns on red. When this button is pressed, the display will show the error number, and the button light will turn off automatically. 862 PC Programming Manual 13.1 [11-1] Main Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.4.3 Local Alarm Information Daily Test Start Time—Set Enables the daily self check of the PBX for local alarm and error log. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.4.3 Local Alarm Information Daily Test Start Time—Hour Specifies the hour of the PBX daily self check start time. Value Range 0–23 Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 863 13.1 [11-1] Main Feature Guide References 2.4.3 Local Alarm Information Daily Test Start Time—Minute Specifies the minute of the PBX daily self check start time. Value Range 0–59 Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.4.3 Local Alarm Information Error Log for Centralised VM—Network MSW Transmission (Counter) Enables error information to be logged in the PBX if network message waiting information is deleted after re-transmission is repeated for the number of times specified in Network MSW Data Transmission for Centralised VM Feature—Data Re-transmission : Repeat Counter in 11.2 [9-2] Network Data Transmission. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References 11.1 [9-1] TIE Table— Enhanced QSIG Call Information (Optional SD Card Required) 11.2 [9-2] Network Data Transmission— Network MSW Data Transmission for Centralised VM Feature— Data Re-transmission : Repeat Counter Feature Guide References 1.30.5.2 Centralised Voice Mail Error Log for Centralised VM—Network MSW Transmission (Buffer) Enables error information to be logged in the PBX if the quantity of network message waiting information being re-transmitted is larger than the transmission buffer. 864 PC Programming Manual 13.1 [11-1] Main Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References 11.1 [9-1] TIE Table— Enhanced QSIG Call Information (Optional SD Card Required) Feature Guide References 1.30.5.2 Centralised Voice Mail Syslog Syslog Enables the PBX to output local alarm information to a syslog server. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.1.2 Syslog Record Management Syslog—Syslog Server IP Address Specifies the IP address of a syslog server. Value Range 1.0.0.0–223.255.255.255 Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None PC Programming Manual 865 13.1 [11-1] Main Feature Guide References 1.26.1.2 Syslog Record Management Syslog—Major Selects whether to output major alarm information to a syslog server. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.1.2 Syslog Record Management Syslog—Minor Selects whether to output minor alarm information to a syslog server. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 1.26.1.2 Syslog Record Management Remote Remote—Analogue Remote (Modem) Floating Extension Number Specifies the floating extension number for analogue remote maintenance. To enable this setting, an RMT card must be installed, and Remote—Remote Programming on this screen must be enabled. Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) 866 PC Programming Manual 13.1 [11-1] Main Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.3.1 PC Programming Remote—ISDN Remote Floating Extension Number Specifies the floating extension number for ISDN remote maintenance. To enable this setting, Remote Programming on this screen must be enabled. Remote— Value Range Max. 5 digits (consisting of 0–9) Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.3.1 PC Programming Remote—Remote Programming Enables system programming, diagnosis, and data upload from a remote location. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.3.1 PC Programming PC Programming Manual 867 13.1 [11-1] Main Remote—Password Lock Counter for Remote Programming Specifies the number of successive incorrect password entries allowed before remote access is locked. Value Range None, 1–15 Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.3.1 PC Programming Remote—Remote Maintenance Dial Number (Own Telephone number for reference) Specifies the telephone number of the PBX used to access the PBX from a remote location for maintenance purposes. This number can be specified by Quick Setup. Value Range Max. 32 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.3.4 Quick Setup Password Passwords authorise the user to programme the extension and the PBX by a PT or a personal computer. System Password - PT Programming—Prog ** : User Level Specifies the user level system password to authorise the PT user to access only the permitted system programming. Value Range 4–10 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) 868 PC Programming Manual 13.1 [11-1] Main Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.3.2 PT Programming System Password - PT Programming—Prog *# : Administrator Level Specifies the administrator level system password to authorise the PT user to access all system programming. Value Range 4–10 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.3.2 PT Programming Manager Password - PT Programming—Prog *1 Specifies the manager password to authorise the PT user to access manager programming. Value Range 4–10 digits (consisting of 0–9, *, and #) Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.2.6 Manager Features PC Programming Manual 869 13.1 [11-1] Main System Password - PC Programming—User Level Specifies the system password used to access Maintenance Console at User Level. This password can only be set in Interactive mode. Value Range 4–10 characters Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.3.1 PC Programming System Password - PC Programming—Administrator Level Specifies the system password used to access Maintenance Console at Administrator Level. This password can only be set in Interactive mode. Value Range 4–10 characters Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.3.1 PC Programming System Password - PC Programming—Installer Level Specifies the system password used to access Maintenance Console at Installer Level. This password can only be set in Interactive mode. Value Range 4–10 characters Maintenance Console Location 13.1 [11-1] Main 870 PC Programming Manual 13.1 [11-1] Main Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.3.1 PC Programming PC Programming Manual 871 13.2 [11-2] PT Programming Access 13.2 [11-2] PT Programming Access The programming items accessible at User and Administrator level can be specified. 100 programming item numbers are displayed at a time. To display other sets of numbers, click the applicable tab. Program Number Indicates the programming item number (reference only). Value Range 000–999 Maintenance Console Location 13.2 [11-2] PT Programming Access Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.3.2 PT Programming PROG** Selects whether User Level PT users can access each system programming item. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 13.2 [11-2] PT Programming Access Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.3.2 PT Programming 872 PC Programming Manual 13.3 [11-3] Power Failure Transfer 13.3 [11-3] Power Failure Transfer When the power supply to the PBX fails, power failure transfer (PFT) switches the current connections to Auxiliary Connections, so that certain SLTs and trunks can be connected. Auxiliary Connections allow trunk calls to be made during a power failure. One trunk card and one extension card that are physically connected by RJ45 cable can be specified. The conversations through the lines specified here will be maintained even when the power returns. Trunk Card Slot No. Specifies the position of the trunk card to be used. Value Range None, Small Free Slot 1, Small Free Slot 2, Small Free Slot 3, Small Free Slot 4 (KX-NCP1000 only) Maintenance Console Location 13.3 [11-3] Power Failure Transfer Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.4.1 Power Failure Transfer Extension Card Slot No. Specifies the position of the extension card to be used. Value Range None, Small Free Slot 1, Small Free Slot 2, Small Free Slot 3, Small Free Slot 4 (KX-NCP1000 only) Maintenance Console Location 13.3 [11-3] Power Failure Transfer Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.4.1 Power Failure Transfer PC Programming Manual 873 13.4 [11-4-1] SNMP—System Setting 13.4 [11-4-1] SNMP—System Setting Using SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol), it is possible for a PC assigned as an SNMP manager to manage and receive PBX system status information, such as alarm information and general system activity. The related PBX system settings can be programmed. This option is only available at Installer level. SNMP Agent Function Enables the PBX to use its SNMP agent function. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 13.4 [11-4-1] SNMP—System Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.4.4 Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) System Monitor Port Number (Receive) Specifies the port number used to receive SNMP data requests from an SNMP manager. Value Range 1–65535 Maintenance Console Location 13.4 [11-4-1] SNMP—System Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.4.4 Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) System Monitor MIB - SysContact Specifies the name and contact information of the system administrator. Value Range Max. 255 characters 874 PC Programming Manual 13.4 [11-4-1] SNMP—System Setting Maintenance Console Location 13.4 [11-4-1] SNMP—System Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.4.4 Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) System Monitor MIB - SysName Specifies an administrative name for the system. Value Range Max. 255 characters Maintenance Console Location 13.4 [11-4-1] SNMP—System Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.4.4 Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) System Monitor MIB - SysLocation Specifies a physical location for the system. Value Range Max. 255 characters Maintenance Console Location 13.4 [11-4-1] SNMP—System Setting Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.4.4 Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) System Monitor PC Programming Manual 875 13.5 [11-4-2] SNMP—Manager 13.5 [11-4-2] SNMP—Manager It is possible to assign up to two PCs as SNMP managers. The settings related to SNMP manager activity can be programmed for each SNMP manager, indicated as No.1 and No.2 on the screen. This option is only available at Installer level. Manager IP Address Specifies the IP address of an SNMP manager. Value Range 0.0.0.0–223.255.255.255 Maintenance Console Location 13.5 [11-4-2] SNMP—Manager Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.4.4 Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) System Monitor Community Name Specifies a community name of an SNMP manager. Value Range Max. 255 characters Maintenance Console Location 13.5 [11-4-2] SNMP—Manager Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.4.4 Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) System Monitor TRAP Port Number (Send) Specifies a port number used to send TRAP to an SNMP manager. Value Range 1–65535 876 PC Programming Manual 13.5 [11-4-2] SNMP—Manager Maintenance Console Location 13.5 [11-4-2] SNMP—Manager Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.4.4 Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) System Monitor TRAP Cold Start Selects whether the PBX sends Cold Start TRAP to an SNMP manager or not. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 13.5 [11-4-2] SNMP—Manager Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.4.4 Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) System Monitor TRAP Authentication Failure Selects whether the PBX sends Authentication Failure TRAP to an SNMP manager or not. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 13.5 [11-4-2] SNMP—Manager Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.4.4 Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) System Monitor PC Programming Manual 877 13.5 [11-4-2] SNMP—Manager TRAP Alarm - Major Selects whether the PBX sends Major Alarm TRAP to an SNMP manager or not. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 13.5 [11-4-2] SNMP—Manager Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.4.4 Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) System Monitor TRAP Alarm - Minor Selects whether the PBX sends Minor Alarm TRAP to an SNMP manager or not. Value Range Disable, Enable Maintenance Console Location 13.5 [11-4-2] SNMP—Manager Programming Manual References None Feature Guide References 2.4.4 Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) System Monitor 878 PC Programming Manual 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation It is possible to create up to 8 Air Synchronisation Groups for CSs. For PBMPR Software File Version 2.0000, only one Air Synchronisation Group can be configured. Index Indicates the CS number (reference only). Value Range 1–16 Maintenance Console Location 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Programming Manual References 5.29 [3-11] Air Synchronisation Group Feature Guide References None Slot Type Indicates the slot type (reference only). Value Range Physical, Virtual Maintenance Console Location 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Programming Manual References 5.29 [3-11] Air Synchronisation Group Feature Guide References None Slot Indicates the slot position (reference only). Value Range Slot number PC Programming Manual 879 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Maintenance Console Location 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Programming Manual References 5.29 [3-11] Air Synchronisation Group Feature Guide References None Port Indicates the port number (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Programming Manual References 5.29 [3-11] Air Synchronisation Group Feature Guide References None CS Name Indicates the name of the CS (reference only). Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Programming Manual References 5.29 [3-11] Air Synchronisation Group Feature Guide References None 880 PC Programming Manual 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Connection Indicates the port status (reference only). To change the status of the port, select the desired cell in the column, and then click Command. Value Range INS: The port is in service. OUS: The port is out of service. Fault: The port is not communicating with the network. Maintenance Console Location 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Programming Manual References 5.29 [3-11] Air Synchronisation Group Feature Guide References None Status Indicates whether a certain CS is registered (reference only). Value Range -, Registered Maintenance Console Location 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Programming Manual References 5.29 [3-11] Air Synchronisation Group Feature Guide References None CS Class Specifies the classification of each CS within the Air Synchronisation Group. This parameter can only be modified when Connection on this screen is set to OUS. Value Range Sync Master CS1, Sync Master CS2, Sync Slave CS Maintenance Console Location 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation PC Programming Manual 881 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Programming Manual References 5.29 [3-11] Air Synchronisation Group Feature Guide References None Primary CS—Index Specifies the number of the primary CS. Value Range 1–16 Maintenance Console Location 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Programming Manual References 5.29 [3-11] Air Synchronisation Group Feature Guide References None Primary CS—Slot Indicates the slot position of the primary CS (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Programming Manual References 5.29 [3-11] Air Synchronisation Group Feature Guide References None Primary CS—Port Indicates the port number of the primary CS (reference only). Value Range Port number 882 PC Programming Manual 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Maintenance Console Location 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Programming Manual References 5.29 [3-11] Air Synchronisation Group Feature Guide References None Primary CS—CS Name Indicates the name of the primary CS (reference only). Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Programming Manual References 5.29 [3-11] Air Synchronisation Group Feature Guide References None Secondary CS—Index Specifies the number of the secondary CS. Value Range 1–16 Maintenance Console Location 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Programming Manual References 5.29 [3-11] Air Synchronisation Group Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 883 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Secondary CS—Slot Indicates the slot position of the secondary CS (reference only). Value Range Slot number Maintenance Console Location 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Programming Manual References 5.29 [3-11] Air Synchronisation Group Feature Guide References None Secondary CS—Port Indicates the port number of the secondary CS (reference only). Value Range Port number Maintenance Console Location 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Programming Manual References 5.29 [3-11] Air Synchronisation Group Feature Guide References None Secondary CS—CS Name Indicates the name of the secondary CS (reference only). Value Range Max. 20 characters Maintenance Console Location 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Programming Manual References 5.29 [3-11] Air Synchronisation Group 884 PC Programming Manual 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Feature Guide References None PC Programming Manual 885 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation 886 PC Programming Manual Section 14 Appendix PC Programming Manual 887 14.1.1 KX-NCP500/KX-NCP1000 PBMPR Software File Version 2.0xxx 14.1 Revision History 14.1.1 KX-NCP500/KX-NCP1000 PBMPR Software File Version 2.0xxx New Contents • 2.6.17 Utility—CS Status Monitor • 2.6.19 Utility—File Transfer FTP to IP Equipment—IP-CS/NT400 • 3.1 [1-1] Slot To access IP-PT port properties • 3.20 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IPCS • 3.21 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS • 3.22 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IPCS—Connection Command • 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port DPT Type—Air Sync Group No → → DPT Type—Air Sync Group Name • 4.4 [2-2] Operator & BGM → BGM and Music on Hold—Music Source of BGM2–7—OGM No. → BGM and Music on Hold—Music Source of BGM2–7—Card • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Miscellaneous— • 5.29 [3-11] Air Synchronisation Group • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings Find Next feature • 13.6 [11-5] Air Synchronisation Air Synchronisation—Watching Degeneracy Changed Contents 888 • 1.2.1 Installing and Starting the Maintenance Console Starting the Maintenance Console and Assigning the Basic Items (Quick Setup) • 2.6.14 Utility—IP Extension Statistical Information • 2.6.15 Utility—CS Information • 2.6.20 Utility—Card Software Timed Update • 3.3 [1-1] Slot—Activation Key PC Programming Manual 14.1.1 KX-NCP500/KX-NCP1000 PBMPR Software File Version 2.0xxx • 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension • 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station • 4.4 [2-2] Operator & BGM— • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters Dial—Extension First Digit → → Dial—Extension Inter-digit • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 1— • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings Maximum length of extension number • 8.6 [6-6] Tenant— BGM and Music on Hold—Music on Hold Wireless XDP Music On Hold PC Programming Manual 889 14.1.1 KX-NCP500/KX-NCP1000 PBMPR Software File Version 2.0xxx 890 PC Programming Manual Feature Programming References PC Programming Manual 891 Feature Programming References Absent Message • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Absent Message Set / Cancel • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 3— Absent Message • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 3— Absent Message • 8.5 [6-5] Absent Message Feature Guide References 1.19.2 Absent Message Account Code Entry • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Account Code Entry • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—CO & SMDR— Account Code Mode Feature Guide References 1.5.4.3 Account Code Entry Advice of Charge (AOC) • 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—Supplementary Service— • COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E, 3PTY 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—Supplementary Service— COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E, E911, 3PTY Feature Guide References 1.21.1.3 Advice of Charge (AOC) Automatic Callback Busy (Camp-on) • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Automatic Callback Busy Cancel • 4.11 [2-6-3] Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature— Automatic Callback Busy Feature Guide References 1.8.1 Automatic Callback Busy (Camp-on) Automatic Extension Release • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone – Dial—Extension First Digit – Dial—Extension Inter-digit – Tone Length—Reorder Tone for PT Handset – Tone Length—Reorder Tone for PT Hands-free Feature Guide References 1.5.2 Automatic Extension Release Automatic Route Selection (ARS) • 2.5.9 Tool—Import – ARS - Leading Digit – ARS - Except Code – ARS - Routing Plan • 2.5.10 Tool—Export • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone— Dial—Extension Inter-digit • 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 3— Dial Tone—Dial Tone for ARS 892 PC Programming Manual Feature Programming References • • • • • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 1— ARS Itemised Code 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 1— ARS Itemised Code 8.3 [6-3] Verification Code— Itemised Billing Code for ARS Section 10 [8] ARS 13.1 [11-1] Main—SMDR Options— Option—ARS Dial Feature Guide References 1.10.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS) Automatic Setup • 2.5 Tool—2.5.2 Tool—BRI Automatic Configuration • 4.2 [2-1-2] Date & Time—SNTP / Daylight Saving— Automatic Time Adjustment Feature Guide References 2.3.5 Automatic Setup Background Music (BGM) • 4.4 [2-2] Operator & BGM BGM and Music on Hold—Music Source of BGM – • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features External BGM On / Off – – BGM Set / Cancel • 4.20 [2-11-1] Audio Gain—Paging/MOH— MOH—MOH (Music On Hold) • 7.2 [5-2] External Pager Feature Guide References 1.17.4 Background Music (BGM) Broadcasting • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Miscellaneous— Broadcasting—Ring Duration • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Broadcasting Operation • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—Miscellaneous— Broadcasting Operation • 5.27 [3-10] Broadcasting Group • 5.28 [3-10] Broadcasting Group—Member List Feature Guide References 1.16.1 Broadcasting Budget Management • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 3— Charge Limit • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 3— Charge Limit • 8.3 [6-3] Verification Code— Budget Management • 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge—Charge— Charge Options—Action at Charge Limit Feature Guide References 1.9.2 Budget Management Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM) • 2.5.5 Tool—Simplified Voice Message—Delete All Recording • 2.5.6 Tool—Simplified Voice Message—Check Current Usage PC Programming Manual 893 Feature Programming References • • • • • • • • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Miscellaneous – SVM—Recording Time – SVM—Dial Tone Continuous Time 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Simplified Voice Message Access 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings—Tone Detection Simplified Voice Message Tone Detection—Silence – – Simplified Voice Message Tone Detection—Continuous – Simplified Voice Message Tone Detection—Cyclic 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 6— Display Lock / SVM Lock 6.9 [4-1-7] Wired Extension—Simplified Voice Message 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 6— SVM Lock 6.16 [4-2-5] Portable Station—Simplified Voice Message 7.5 [5-3-3] Voice Message—SVM Feature Guide References 1.17.7 Built-in Simplified Voice Message (SVM) Call Billing for Guest Room • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— Extension PIN • 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge— Checkout Billing—LCD for "Telephone" • 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge—Charge Margin & Tax—Margin Rate for "Telephone" (%) – – Margin & Tax—Tax Rate for "Telephone" (%) – Margin & Tax—Tax Rate for "Minibar" (%) – Margin & Tax—Tax Rate for "Others" (%) Feature Guide References 1.27.3 Call Billing for Guest Room Call Charge Services • 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type – Pay Tone—Pay Tone Frequency – Pay Tone—Sending Flash while end talk • 5.6 [3-1-5] Trunk Group—Charge Rate • 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button— Type • 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button— Type • 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console— Type • 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge—Charge Margin & Tax—Margin Rate for "Telephone" (%) – – Margin & Tax—Tax Rate for "Telephone" (%) – Charge Options—Digits After Decimal Point – Charge Options—Currency – Charge Options—Currency Display Position – Charge Options—Action at Charge Limit – Charge Options—Meter Start on Answer Detection Feature Guide References 1.26.3 Call Charge Services 894 PC Programming Manual Feature Programming References Call Forwarding (CF)—by ISDN (P-MP) • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— ISDN-FWD (MSN) Set / Cancel / Confirm • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—CO & SMDR— CF (MSN) Feature Guide References 1.21.1.4 Call Forwarding (CF)—by ISDN (P-MP) Call Forwarding (CF)—by ISDN (P-P) • 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—Supplementary Service— • • • COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E, 3PTY 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—Supplementary Service— COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E, E911, 3PTY 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— ISDN-FWD (MSN) Set / Cancel / Confirm 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—CO & SMDR— CF (MSN) Feature Guide References 1.21.1.5 Call Forwarding (CF)—by ISDN (P-P) Call Forwarding (CF)—by QSIG • 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—Supplementary Service— • COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E, 3PTY 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—Supplementary Service— COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E, E911, 3PTY Feature Guide References 1.30.4.3 Call Forwarding (CF)—by QSIG Call Forwarding (FWD) • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— FWD No Answer Timer Set • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings – CO & SMDR— Call Forward to CO – Programming & Manager— Group Forward Set – Optional Device & Other Extensions— Remote Operation by Other Extension • 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings—Main – CO-CO Duration Time – Extension-CO Duration Time • 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Group Log / Group FWD • 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND • 6.12 [4-2-2] Portable Station—FWD/DND Feature Guide References 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD) Call Hold • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone Recall—Hold Recall – – Recall—Disconnect after Recall • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features – Call Hold / Call Hold Retrieve – Call Hold Retrieve : Specified with a Holding Extension Number PC Programming Manual 895 Feature Programming References – • Hold Retrieve : Specified with a Held CO Line Number 4.18 [2-9] System Options – Option 1— PT Operation—Automatic Hold by ICM / CO / ICD Group key – Option 1— PT Operation—Hold Key Mode – Option 5— SLT—SLT Hold Mode Feature Guide References 1.13.1 Call Hold Call Hold (HOLD)—by ISDN • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— ISDN Hold • 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button— Type • 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button— Type • 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console— Type Feature Guide References 1.21.1.6 Call Hold (HOLD)—by ISDN Call Monitor • 4.11 [2-6-3] Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature— Call Monitor • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—CO & SMDR— Call Monitor • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings – Option 2— Data Mode – Option 3— Executive Override Deny • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 3— Executive Override Deny Feature Guide References 1.8.3 Call Monitor Call Park • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters – Recall—Call Park Recall – Recall—Disconnect after Recall • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Call Park / Call Park Retrieve • 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button – Type – Parameter Selection (for Call Park) – Optional Parameter (Ringing Tone Type Number) (for Call Park) • 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Type – – Parameter Selection (for Call Park) – Optional Parameter (or Ringing Tone Type Number) (for Call Park) • 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console – Type – Parameter Selection (for Call Park) – Optional Parameter (Ringing Tone Type Number) (for Call Park) Feature Guide References 1.13.2 Call Park 896 PC Programming Manual Feature Programming References Call Pickup • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features Group Call Pickup – – Directed Call Pickup – Call Pickup Deny Set / Cancel • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—CO & SMDR— Call Pickup by DSS • 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 4 DSS Key—DSS key mode for Incoming Call – – DSS Key—Call Pick-up by DSS key for Direct Incoming Call – DSS Key—Call Pick-up by DSS key for ICD Group Call • 5.8 [3-3] Call Pickup Group • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 3— Call Pickup Deny • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 3— Call Pickup Deny Feature Guide References 1.4.1.3 Call Pickup Call Transfer • 4.4 [2-2] Operator & BGM— BGM and Music on Hold—Sound on Transfer • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone— Recall—Transfer Recall • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—CO & SMDR— Transfer to CO • 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 4 – DSS Key—Automatic Transfer for Extension Call – Transfer—Transfer to busy Extension without BSS Operation • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 1— Transfer Recall Destination • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 1— Transfer Recall Destination Feature Guide References 1.12.1 Call Transfer Call Transfer (CT)—by ISDN • 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—Supplementary Service— • COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E, 3PTY 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—Supplementary Service— COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E, E911, 3PTY Feature Guide References 1.21.1.7 Call Transfer (CT)—by ISDN Call Transfer (CT)—by QSIG • 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—Supplementary Service— • COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E, 3PTY 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—Supplementary Service— COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E, E911, 3PTY Feature Guide References 1.30.4.4 Call Transfer (CT)—by QSIG Call Waiting • 3.27 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - LCO type— Caller ID—Caller ID Signalling PC Programming Manual 897 Feature Programming References • • • • • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features – Manual Call Waiting for Extension Call – Automatic Call Waiting 4.11 [2-6-3] Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature BSS / OHCA / Whisper OHCA / DND Override – – BSS / OHCA / Whisper OHCA / DND Override-2 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 5— Call Waiting—Automatic Call Waiting for Extension Call 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings – Option 2— Manual C. Waiting for Extension Call – Option 2— Automatic C. Waiting – Option 4— Call Waiting Tone Type 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings – Option 2— Manual C. Waiting for Extension Call – Option 2— Automatic C. Waiting – Option 4— Call Waiting Tone Type Feature Guide References 1.1.3.3 Call Waiting Call Waiting Tone • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Miscellaneous— Caller ID—Visual Caller ID Display • 4.11 [2-6-3] Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature – BSS / OHCA / Whisper OHCA / DND Override – BSS / OHCA / Whisper OHCA / DND Override-2 • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings – Option 2— Manual C. Waiting for Extension Call – Option 2— Automatic C. Waiting – Option 4— Call Waiting Tone Type • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings – Option 2— Manual C. Waiting for Extension Call – Option 2— Automatic C. Waiting – Option 4— Call Waiting Tone Type Feature Guide References 1.8.4.2 Call Waiting Tone Caller ID • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Miscellaneous Caller ID—Waiting to receive – – Caller ID—Visual Caller ID Display • 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 4— Private Network—Public Call through Private Network— • • • • • 898 Minimum Public Caller ID Digits 4.19 [2-10] Extension CID Settings 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings—Main— Caller ID Modification Table 5.3 [3-1-3] Caller ID Modification 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 8 – Extension Caller ID Sending – Incoming Call Wait Timer for Extension Caller ID 8.1 [6-1] System Speed Dial PC Programming Manual Feature Programming References Feature Guide References 1.18.1 Caller ID Calling Line Identification (CLI) Distribution • 8.1 [6-1] System Speed Dial Name – – CO Line Access Number + Telephone Number – CLI Destination • 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings—CLI for DIL— CLI Ring for DIL—Day, Lunch, Break, Night • 12.3 [10-3] DDI / DID Table— CLI Ring for DDI/DID—Day, Lunch, Break, Night • 12.6 [10-4] MSN Table— CLI Ring for MSN—Day, Lunch, Break, Night Feature Guide References 1.1.1.5 Calling Line Identification (CLI) Distribution Calling Party Control (CPC) Signal Detection • 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port— CPC Signal Detection Time—Outgoing, Incoming • 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port CPC Signal Detection (DID)—Outgoing, Incoming – – CPC Signal Detection (LCO/GCO)—Outgoing, Incoming • 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port— CPC Detection Time—Out, In Feature Guide References 1.11.10 Calling Party Control (CPC) Signal Detection Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) • 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port – ISDN CO— Subscriber Number – Supplementary Service— COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, • • • • • • • • CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E, 3PTY 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port – CO Setting— Subscriber Number – Supplementary Service— COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E, E911, 3PTY 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port— Subscriber Number 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port— Subscriber Number 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features – COLR Set / Cancel – CLIR Set / Cancel – Switch CLIP of CO Line / Extension 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 4— Send CLIP of CO Caller to ISDN—when Transfer (CLIP of Held Party) 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Main— CLIP on ICD Group Button 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings – Main— Extension Number – ISDN CLIP— CLIP ID – ISDN CLIP— CLIP on Extension/CO – ISDN CLIP— CLIR – ISDN CLIP— COLR 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button— Type PC Programming Manual 899 Feature Programming References • • • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings – ISDN CLIP— CLIP ID – ISDN CLIP— CLIP on Extension/CO – ISDN CLIP— CLIR – ISDN CLIP— COLR 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button— Type 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console— Type Feature Guide References 1.21.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) and Calling/Connected Name Identification Presentation (CNIP/CONP)—by QSIG • 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—Supplementary Service— COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, • • • • CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E, 3PTY 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—Supplementary Service— COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E, E911, 3PTY 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features COLR Set / Cancel – – CLIR Set / Cancel 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main – Extension Number – Extension Name 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main Extension Number – – Extension Name Feature Guide References 1.30.4.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) and Calling/Connected Name Identification Presentation (CNIP/CONP)—by QSIG Centralised Voice Mail • 3.48 [1-3] Option— New Card Installation—ISDN Standard Mode for PRI23 Card • 11.1 [9-1] TIE Table—Centralised VM • 11.2 [9-2] Network Data Transmission – Network MSW Data Transmission for Centralised VM Feature—Data Re-transmission : Repeat Counter Network MSW Data Transmission for Centralised VM Feature—Data Re-transmission : Repeat Timer 13.1 [11-1] Main—Maintenance – Error Log for Centralised VM—Network MSW Transmission (Counter) – Error Log for Centralised VM—Network MSW Transmission (Buffer) – • Feature Guide References 1.30.5.2 Centralised Voice Mail Class of Service (COS) • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— COS • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— COS 900 PC Programming Manual Feature Programming References Feature Guide References 2.2.1 Class of Service (COS) Completion of Calls to Busy Subscriber (CCBS) • 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—Supplementary Service COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E, – 3PTY – CCBS Option • 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—Supplementary Service COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E, – E911, 3PTY – CCBS Type – CCBS Delete Digits Feature Guide References 1.21.1.10 Completion of Calls to Busy Subscriber (CCBS) Completion of Calls to Busy Subscriber (CCBS)—by QSIG • 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—Supplementary Service— • COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E, 3PTY 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—Supplementary Service— COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E, E911, 3PTY Feature Guide References 1.30.4.5 Completion of Calls to Busy Subscriber (CCBS)—by QSIG Computer Telephony Integration (CTI) • 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— • 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 6 (CTI) Dial Information (CTI) Feature Guide References 1.32.1 Computer Telephony Integration (CTI) Conference • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—DISA / Door / Reminder / U. Conf – Unattended Conference—Recall Start Timer – Unattended Conference—Warning Tone Start Timer – Unattended Conference—Disconnect Timer • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—CO & SMDR— Transfer to CO • 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 3 Confirmation Tone—Tone 4-1 : Start Conference – – Confirmation Tone—Tone 4-2 : Finish Conference – Echo Cancel—Conference • 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button— Type • 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button— Type • 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console— Type Feature Guide References 1.14.1.2 Conference PC Programming Manual 901 Feature Programming References Confirmation Tone • 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 3 Confirmation Tone—Tone 1 : Called by Voice – – Confirmation Tone—Tone 2 : Paged / Automatic Answer – Confirmation Tone—Tone 3-1 : Start Talking after Making Call / Call from Doorphone – Confirmation Tone—Tone 3-2 : Start Talking after Answering Call – Confirmation Tone—Tone 4-1 : Start Conference – Confirmation Tone—Tone 4-2 : Finish Conference – Confirmation Tone—Tone 5 : Hold Feature Guide References 1.29.2 Confirmation Tone DHCP • 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR— DHCP Client Feature Guide References 2.4.5 Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) Assignment Dial Tone • 4.18 – – – [2-9] System Options—Option 3 Dial Tone—Distinctive Dial Tone Dial Tone—Dial Tone for Extension Dial Tone—Dial Tone for ARS Feature Guide References 1.29.1 Dial Tone Dial Tone Transfer • 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button – Type – Parameter Selection (for TRS Level Change) • 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Type – – Parameter Selection (for TRS Level Change) • 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console – Type – Parameter Selection (for TRS Level Change) Feature Guide References 1.9.4 Dial Tone Transfer Dial Type Selection • 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port – Dialling Mode – DTMF Width – Pulse Speed • 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port CO Dial Mode – – DTMF Width 902 PC Programming Manual Feature Programming References • – CO Pulse Speed 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port – CO Dial Mode – DTMF Width – CO Pulse Speed Feature Guide References 1.5.4.4 Dial Type Selection Direct In Line (DIL) • 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings—DIL – DIL Destination—Day, Lunch, Break, Night – Tenant Number – VM Trunk Group No. Feature Guide References 1.1.1.2 Direct In Line (DIL) Direct Inward Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI) • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Miscellaneous— Incoming Call Inter-digit Timer—DDI / DID • 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings—DDI / DID / TIE / MSN – Distribution Method – DDI/DID/TIE/MSN—Remove Digit – DDI/DID/TIE/MSN—Additional Dial • 12.3 [10-3] DDI / DID Table Feature Guide References 1.1.1.3 Direct Inward Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI) Direct Inward System Access (DISA) • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—DISA / Door / Reminder / U. Conf – DISA—Delayed Answer Timer – DISA—Mute & OGM Start Timer after answering – DISA—No Dial Intercept Timer – DISA—2nd Dial Timer for AA – DISA—Intercept Timer—Day, Lunch, Break, Night – DISA—Disconnect Timer after Intercept – DISA—CO-to-CO Call Prolong Counter – DISA—CO-to-CO Call Prolong Time – DISA—Progress Tone Continuation Time before Recording Message – DISA—Reorder Tone Duration • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Miscellaneous— Extension PIN—Lock Counter • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—Optional Device & Other Extensions— • • from DISA 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings—Tone Detection DISA Tone Detection—Silence – – DISA Tone Detection—Continuous – DISA Tone Detection—Cyclic 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Intercept Destination— called party does not answer—Day, Lunch, Break, Night Accept the Call Intercept Destination—When PC Programming Manual 903 Feature Programming References • • • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Intercept Destination— When called party does not answer—Day, Lunch, Break, Night 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System 7.4 [5-3-2] Voice Message—DISA Message Intercept Destination— Feature Guide References 1.17.6 Direct Inward System Access (DISA) Display Information • 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 5— PT Feature Access—No. 1–8 • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 5 – Display Language – Incoming Call Display – Automatic LCD Switch when Start Talking • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 5 – Display Language – Incoming Call Display Automatic LCD Switch when Start Talking – • 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge—Charge – Charge Options—Digits After Decimal Point – Charge Options—Currency – Charge Options—Currency Display Position • 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings— CO Name Feature Guide References 1.20.4 Display Information Do Not Disturb (DND) • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone— Tone Length—Busy Tone / DND Tone • 4.11 [2-6-3] Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature BSS / OHCA / Whisper OHCA / DND Override – – BSS / OHCA / Whisper OHCA / DND Override-2 • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—Extension Feature— DND Override • 6.3 [4-1-2] Wired Extension—FWD/DND – Call from CO—DND Status Availability – Call from Extension—DND Status Availability Feature Guide References 1.3.1.3 Do Not Disturb (DND) Door Open • 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property— Device Type • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—DISA / Door / Reminder / U. Conf— Doorphone—Open Duration • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Door Open • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—Optional Device & Other Extensions— Door Unlock Feature Guide References 1.17.2 Door Open 904 PC Programming Manual Feature Programming References Doorphone Call • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—DISA / Door / Reminder / U. Conf Doorphone—Call Ring Duration – – Doorphone—Call Duration • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Doorphone Call • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—TRS— TRS Level—Day, Lunch, Break, Night • 4.16 [2-8-2] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from Doorphone • 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 3— Confirmation Tone—Tone 1 : Called by Voice • 7.1 [5-1] Doorphone Feature Guide References 1.17.1 Doorphone Call E1 Line Service • 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port • 3.43 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port—Connection Command Feature Guide References 1.22.1 E1 Line Service Emergency Call • 9.4 [7-4] Emergency Dial Feature Guide References 1.5.4.2 Emergency Call Executive Busy Override • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Executive Override Deny Set / Cancel • 4.11 [2-6-3] Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature— Executive Busy Override • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings – CO & SMDR— Executive Busy Override – Programming & Manager— Executive Busy Override Deny • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 3— Executive Override Deny • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 3— Executive Override Deny Feature Guide References 1.8.2 Executive Busy Override Extension Dial Lock • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features – Extension Dial Lock Set / Cancel – Remote Extension Dial Lock Off – Remote Extension Dial Lock On • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—TRS— TRS Level on Extension Lock Feature Guide References 1.9.3 Extension Dial Lock Extension Feature Clear • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Extension Feature Clear PC Programming Manual 905 Feature Programming References • 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 2 – Extension Clear—Call Waiting – Extension Clear—Fwd/DND – Extension Clear—Hot Line (Pickup Dial) Feature Guide References 1.28.2 Extension Feature Clear Extension Personal Identification Number (PIN) • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Miscellaneous— Extension PIN—Lock Counter • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Extension PIN Set / Cancel • 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 1— PT LCD—Password / PIN Display • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— Extension PIN • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— Extension PIN Feature Guide References 1.28.1 Extension Personal Identification Number (PIN) Extension Port Configuration • 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port • 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console— Pair Extension Feature Guide References 2.1.1 Extension Port Configuration External Feature Access (EFA) • 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port— Flash Time • 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port— Flash Time • 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port— Flash Time • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— External Feature Access • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 7— Flash Mode during CO Conversation • 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button— Type • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 7— Flash Mode during CO Conversation • 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button— Type • 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console— Type • 9.5 [7-5] Miscellaneous— TRS Check after EFA Feature Guide References 1.11.7 External Feature Access (EFA) External Relay Control • 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property— Device Type • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— External Relay Access • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—Optional Device & Other Extensions— • Access 7.6 [5-4] External Relay Feature Guide References 1.17.10 External Relay Control 906 PC Programming Manual External Relay Feature Programming References External Sensor • 3.44 [1-1] Slot—OPB3 Card Property Input Signal Decision Time – – Input Signal Detection Reopening Time • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Miscellaneous— External Sensor—Ring Duration • 4.17 [2-8-3] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from Others— External Sensor—Ring Tone Pattern Plan 1–8 • 7.7 [5-5] External Sensor Feature Guide References 1.17.9 External Sensor Flash/Recall/Terminate • 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port— Disconnect Time • 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port— Disconnect Time • 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port— Disconnect Time • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 7— Flash Mode during CO Conversation • 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button— Type • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 7— Flash Mode during CO Conversation • 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button— Type • 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console— Type Feature Guide References 1.11.6 Flash/Recall/Terminate Flexible Buttons • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Miscellaneous— PT Display—PT Last Display Duration in Idle Mode • 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button • 6.6 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button—Flexible button data copy • 6.7 [4-1-5] Wired Extension—PF Button • 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button • 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Feature Guide References 1.20.2 Flexible Buttons Flexible Numbering/Fixed Numbering • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main – Extension – Features – Other PBX Extension • 4.10 [2-6-2] Numbering Plan—Quick Dial • 4.11 [2-6-3] Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature Feature Guide References 2.3.6 Flexible Numbering/Fixed Numbering Floating Extension • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Extension • 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Main Floating Extension Number – PC Programming Manual 907 Feature Programming References – • • • • • • Group Name 5.20 [3-7-2] VM(DPT) Group—Unit Settings— Floating Extension No. 5.23 [3-8-2] VM(DTMF) Group—Group Settings— Floating Ext. No. 5.25 [3-9] PS Ring Group— Floating Extension Number 7.2 [5-2] External Pager— Page Number 1, Page Number 2—Floating Extension Number 7.4 [5-3-2] Voice Message—DISA Message— Floating Extension Number 13.1 [11-1] Main—Remote – Remote—Analogue Remote (Modem) Floating Extension Number – Remote—ISDN Remote Floating Extension Number Feature Guide References 2.3.7 Floating Extension FWD/DND Button, Group FWD Button • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features – FWD/DND Set / Cancel: Call from CO & Extension – FWD/DND Set / Cancel: Call from CO FWD/DND Set / Cancel: Call from Extension – – Group FWD Set / Cancel: Call from CO & Extension – Group FWD Set / Cancel: Call from CO – Group FWD Set / Cancel: Call from Extension • 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 1 PT Fwd / DND—Fwd LED – – PT Fwd / DND—DND LED – PT Fwd / DND—Fwd/DND key mode when Idle • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—FWD / DND • 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button – Type – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Group Fwd (Both)) – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Group Fwd (External)) – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Group Fwd (Internal)) • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—FWD / DND Reference • 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button – Type – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Group Fwd (Both)) – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Group Fwd (External)) – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Group Fwd (Internal)) • 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Type – – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Group Fwd (Both)) – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Group Fwd (External)) – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Group Fwd (Internal)) Feature Guide References 1.3.1.4 FWD/DND Button, Group FWD Button Group • Section 5 [3] Group Feature Guide References 908 PC Programming Manual Feature Programming References 2.2.2 Group Group Call Distribution • 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings—Main— Line Hunting Order • 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings – Main— Distribution Method – Main— Call Waiting Distribution – Miscellaneous— Extension No Answer Redirection Time – Miscellaneous— Maximum No. of Busy Extension • 5.16 [3-5-3] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Miscellaneous – Options—Wrap-up Timer based on – Options—Longest Idle Distribution (Optional SD Card Required) • 5.14 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Member List— Delayed Ring • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 8— Wrap-up Timer • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 8— Wrap-up Timer Feature Guide References 1.2.2.2 Group Call Distribution Hands-free Answerback • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone— • • Tone Length—Reorder Tone for PT Hands-free 4.18 [2-9] System Options – Option 1— PT Operation—Automatic Answer for Call from CO after – Option 3— Confirmation Tone—Tone 2 : Paged / Automatic Answer – Option 4— Transfer—Automatic Answer for Transferred Call 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings – Option 5— Automatic Answer for CO Call – Option 6— Forced Automatic Answer Feature Guide References 1.4.1.4 Hands-free Answerback Hands-free Operation • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone— • Tone Length—Reorder Tone for PT Hands-free 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 4— LCS Answer Mode Feature Guide References 1.11.1 Hands-free Operation Headset Operation • 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port— Headset OFF/ON • 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button— Type • 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console— Type Feature Guide References 1.11.4 Headset Operation PC Programming Manual 909 Feature Programming References Host PBX Access Code (Access Code to the Telephone Company from a Host PBX) • 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings—Host PBX Access Code • 13.1 [11-1] Main—SMDR Options— Option—ARS Dial Feature Guide References 1.5.4.8 Host PBX Access Code (Access Code to the Telephone Company from a Host PBX) Hot Line • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone— Dial—Hot Line (Pickup Dial) Start • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Hot Line (Pickup Dial) Program Set / Cancel • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 2 Pickup Dial Set – – Pickup Dial No. • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 2 – Pickup Dial Set – Pickup Dial No. Feature Guide References 1.6.1.7 Hot Line Idle Extension Hunting • 5.17 [3-6] Extension Hunting Group • 5.18 [3-6] Extension Hunting Group—Member List Feature Guide References 1.2.1 Idle Extension Hunting Incoming Call Distribution Group Features • 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings – Main – Overflow Queuing Busy – Overflow No Answer – Miscellaneous • 5.14 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Member List • 5.16 [3-5-3] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Miscellaneous Feature Guide References 1.2.2 Incoming Call Distribution Group Features Incoming Call Log • 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Miscellaneous— • • • 910 Number 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings – Option 5— Incoming Call Display – Option 6— Display Lock / SVM Lock – Option 7— Incoming Call Log Memory 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button— Type 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings – Option 5— Incoming Call Display – Option 7— Incoming Call Log Memory PC Programming Manual Supervisor Extension Feature Programming References • 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console— Type Feature Guide References 1.18.2 Incoming Call Log Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) • 2.5.2 Tool—BRI Automatic Configuration • 3.30 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - BRI type/PRI type • 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port • 3.32 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—Connection Command • 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port • 3.34 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—Connection Command • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone— Dial—Extension Inter-digit • 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 2— ISDN en Bloc Dial—[#] as End of Dial for en Bloc mode • 5.5 [3-1-4] Dialling Plan—Auto Assign • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings – Main— Extension Number – Option 7— ISDN Bearer • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 7— ISDN Bearer Feature Guide References 1.21.1 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) Intercept Routing • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone— • • • • • Intercept Routing No Answer (IRNA)—Day, Lunch, Break, Night 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—DISA / Door / Reminder / U. Conf— DISA—Intercept Timer—Day, Lunch, Break, Night 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Overflow No Answer— Time out & Manual Queue Redirection—Destination-Day, Lunch, Break, Night 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings – Intercept Destination – Intercept No Answer Time 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings – Intercept Destination – Intercept No Answer Time 12.7 [10-5] Miscellaneous Feature Guide References 1.1.1.6 Intercept Routing Intercept Routing—No Destination • 4.4 [2-2] Operator & BGM— PBX Operator—Day, Lunch, Break, Night • 12.7 [10-5] Miscellaneous— Intercept—Routing to Operator - No Destination (Destination is not programmed.) Feature Guide References 1.1.1.7 Intercept Routing—No Destination PC Programming Manual 911 Feature Programming References Intercom Call • 4.11 [2-6-3] Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature— • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings – Main— Extension Number – Main— Extension Name – Option 3— Intercom Call by Voice • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main Extension Number – – Extension Name Alternate Calling - Ring / Voice Feature Guide References 1.5.3 Intercom Call Internal Call Block • 4.14 [2-7-3] Class of Service—Internal Call Block— • • • • • COS Number of the Extension Which Receive the Call from Other Extension 1–64 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Main— COS 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— COS 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— COS 7.1 [5-1] Doorphone— COS 7.6 [5-4] External Relay— COS Number Feature Guide References 1.1.2.2 Internal Call Block Internal Call Features • 7.1 [5-1] Doorphone— Destination—Day, Lunch, Break, Night Feature Guide References 1.1.2 Internal Call Features IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) • 3.14 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual IP Extension • 3.15 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual IP Extension Feature Guide References 1.31.1 IP Proprietary Telephone (IP-PT) ISDN Extension • 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—ISDN Extension • 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—Extension Setting Feature Guide References 1.21.1.11 ISDN Extension ISDN Service Access by Keypad Protocol • 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Type – – Dial (for ISDN Service) • 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button 912 PC Programming Manual Feature Programming References – – • Type Dial (for ISDN Service) 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console – Type – Dial (for ISDN Service) Feature Guide References 1.21.1.12 ISDN Service Access by Keypad Protocol KX-T7710 One-touch Dialling • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—KX-T7710 Feature Guide References 1.6.1.3 KX-T7710 One-touch Dialling Last Number Redial • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone Automatic Redial—Repeat Counter – – Automatic Redial—Repeat Interval – Automatic Redial—Redial Call Ring Duration – Automatic Redial—Analogue CO Mute / Busy Detection Timer • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Redial • 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 2 – Redial—Automatic Redial when No Answer (ISDN) – Redial—Save Dial After Connection to Redial Memory – Redial—Call Log by Redial key • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 7— Outgoing Call Log Memory • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 7— Outgoing Call Log Memory Feature Guide References 1.6.1.4 Last Number Redial LED Indication • 4.18 [2-9] System Options – Option 1— PT Fwd / DND—Fwd LED – Option 1— PT Fwd / DND—DND LED – Option 4— DSS Key—DSS key mode for Incoming Call Feature Guide References 1.20.3 LED Indication Line Preference—Incoming • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 4— Incoming Preferred Line • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 4— Incoming Preferred Line Feature Guide References 1.4.1.2 Line Preference—Incoming Line Preference—Outgoing • 4.13 [2-7-2] Class of Service—External Call Block PC Programming Manual 913 Feature Programming References • • • 5.2 [3-1-2] Trunk Group—Local Access Priority 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 4— Outgoing Preferred Line 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 4— Outgoing Preferred Line Feature Guide References 1.5.5.2 Line Preference—Outgoing Local Alarm Information • 2.6.7 Utility—Message File Transfer PBX to PC • 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button— Type • 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button— Type • 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console— Type • 13.1 [11-1] Main – SMDR— Print Information—Error Log – Maintenance— Local Alarm Display—Extension 1, Extension 2 – Maintenance— Daily Test Start Time—Set – Maintenance— Daily Test Start Time—Hour – Maintenance— Daily Test Start Time—Minute Feature Guide References 2.4.3 Local Alarm Information Log-in/Log-out • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features Log-in / Log-out – – Not Ready (Manual Wrap-up) Mode On / Off • 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Miscellaneous – No. of Unanswered Calls for Automatic Log-out – Last Extension Log-out • 5.16 [3-5-3] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Miscellaneous— Options—Wrap-up Timer based on • 5.14 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Member List— Wrap-up Timer • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 8— Wrap-up Timer • 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button – Type – Parameter Selection (for Log-in/Log-out) – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Log-in/Log-out) • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 8— Wrap-up Timer • 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Type – – Parameter Selection (for Log-in/Log-out) – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Log-in/Log-out) • 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Type – – Parameter Selection (for Log-in/Log-out) – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Log-in/Log-out) • 13.1 [11-1] Main—SMDR— Print Information—Log-in / Log-out Feature Guide References 1.2.2.7 Log-in/Log-out 914 PC Programming Manual Feature Programming References Malicious Call Identification (MCID) • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— MCID Feature Guide References 1.21.1.9 Malicious Call Identification (MCID) Manager Features • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—Programming & Manager— Manager • 13.1 [11-1] Main—Password— Manager Password - PT Programming—Prog *1 Feature Guide References 2.2.6 Manager Features Message Waiting • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Message Waiting Set / Cancel / Call Back • 4.11 [2-6-3] Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature— Message Waiting Set • 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 3— Dial Tone—Distinctive Dial Tone • 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings— VM DTMF Command—Listening Message • 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button— Type • 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button— Type • 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console— Type Feature Guide References 1.19.1 Message Waiting Multiple Subscriber Number (MSN) Ringing Service • 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings—DDI / DID / TIE / MSN Distribution Method – – DDI/DID/TIE/MSN—Remove Digit – DDI/DID/TIE/MSN—Additional Dial • 12.6 [10-4] MSN Table Feature Guide References 1.1.1.4 Multiple Subscriber Number (MSN) Ringing Service Music on Hold • 4.4 [2-2] Operator & BGM – BGM and Music on Hold—Music Source of BGM – BGM and Music on Hold—Music on Hold • 4.20 [2-11-1] Audio Gain—Paging/MOH— MOH—MOH (Music On Hold) Feature Guide References 1.13.4 Music on Hold Network Direct Station Selection (NDSS) • 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—ISDN CO— Networking Data Transfer • 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—CO Setting— Networking Data Transfer • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—Programming & Manager— Manager • 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Type – PC Programming Manual 915 Feature Programming References – • • • • • • • Dial (for NDSS) 6.8 [4-1-6] Wired Extension—NDSS Link Data - Send 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button – Type – Dial (for NDSS) 6.15 [4-2-4] Portable Station—NDSS Link Data - Send 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Type – – Dial (for NDSS) 11.2 [9-2] Network Data Transmission 11.3 [9-3] Network Operator (VoIP) 11.4 [9-4] NDSS Key Table Feature Guide References 1.30.5.1 Network Direct Station Selection (NDSS) Network ICD Group • 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 4— Send CLIP of CO Caller to ISDN—when ICD Group with Cellular Phone Feature Guide References 1.30.6 Network ICD Group Off-hook Call Announcement (OHCA) • 4.11 [2-6-3] Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature BSS / OHCA / Whisper OHCA / DND Override – – BSS / OHCA / Whisper OHCA / DND Override-2 • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—CO & SMDR— OHCA / Whisper OHCA Feature Guide References 1.8.4.3 Off-hook Call Announcement (OHCA) Off-hook Monitor • 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 1— PT Operation—Off Hook Monitor for KX-T74xx/T75xx/T76xx Feature Guide References 1.11.2 Off-hook Monitor One-touch Dialling • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 6— Flexible Button Programming Mode • 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Type – – Dial (for One-touch) • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 6— Flexible Button Programming Mode • 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Type – – Dial (for One-touch) • 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console – Type – Dial (for One-touch) 916 PC Programming Manual Feature Programming References Feature Guide References 1.6.1.2 One-touch Dialling Operator Features • 4.4 [2-2] Operator & BGM— PBX Operator—Day, Lunch, Break, Night • 8.6 [6-6] Tenant— Operator (Extension Number) Feature Guide References 2.2.5 Operator Features Outgoing Message (OGM) • 2.6.6 Utility—Message File Transfer PC to PBX • 2.6.7 Utility—Message File Transfer PBX to PC • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—DISA / Door / Reminder / U. Conf— • • • • DISA—Progress Tone Continuation Time before Recording Message 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— OGM Record / Clear / Playback 5.15 [3-5-2] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Queuing Time Table— Queuing Sequence—Sequence 01–16 7.4 [5-3-2] Voice Message—DISA Message— Floating Extension Number 5.14 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Member List— Delayed Ring Feature Guide References 1.17.5 Outgoing Message (OGM) Outside Destinations in Incoming Call Distribution Group • 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 4— Send CLIP of CO Caller to ISDN—when ICD Group with Cellular Phone Feature Guide References 1.2.2.3 Outside Destinations in Incoming Call Distribution Group Overflow Feature • 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings – Overflow Queuing Busy – Overflow No Answer • 5.15 [3-5-2] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Queuing Time Table Feature Guide References 1.2.2.6 Overflow Feature Paging • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features Group Paging – – Group Paging Answer – Paging Deny Set / Cancel • 4.18 [2-9] System Options – Option 1— PT Fwd / DND—Paging to DND Extension – Option 3— Confirmation Tone—Tone 2 : Paged / Automatic Answer • 4.20 [2-11-1] Audio Gain—Paging/MOH PC Programming Manual 917 Feature Programming References – – • • • • Paging—EPG (External Pager) Paging—Paging Level from PT Speaker 5.10 [3-4] Paging Group 5.11 [3-4] Paging Group—All Setting 5.12 [3-4] Paging Group—External Pager 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 6— Paging Deny Feature Guide References 1.15.1 Paging Parallelled Telephone • 3.23 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Extension Type— APT/SLT Parallel Ring • 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port XDP Mode – – Parallel Telephone Ringing • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Parallel Telephone (Ring) Mode Set / Cancel Feature Guide References 1.11.9 Parallelled Telephone Password Security • 2.1.2 Access Levels • 13.1 [11-1] Main—Password Feature Guide References 2.3.3 Password Security Pause Insertion • 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port— Pause Time • 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port— Pause Time • 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port— Pause Time • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Miscellaneous— During Conversation—Pause Signal Time • 8.4 [6-4] Second Dial Tone Feature Guide References 1.5.4.7 Pause Insertion PC Phone/PC Console • 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port DPT Type—Type – – DPT Type—Location No. Feature Guide References 1.32.2 PC Phone/PC Console PDN (Primary Directory Number)/SDN (Secondary Directory Number) Extension • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—PDN/SDN • 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 4— System Wireless—SDN Delayed Ringing with LCD • 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button – Type 918 PC Programming Manual Feature Programming References – – – • • Parameter Selection (for SDN) Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for SDN) Optional Parameter (Ringing Tone Type Number) (for Loop CO, Single CO, Group CO, ICD Group, SDN) 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Type – – Parameter Selection (for SDN) – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for SDN) 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Type – – Parameter Selection (for SDN) – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for SDN) – Optional Parameter (Ringing Tone Type Number) (for Loop CO, Single CO, Group CO, ICD Group, SDN) Feature Guide References 1.7.1 Primary Directory Number (PDN)/Secondary Directory Number (SDN) Extension Ping • 2.6.18 Utility—Ping Feature Guide References 2.4.6 Packet Internet Groper (PING) Confirmation Portable Station (PS) Connection • 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station Feature Guide References 1.25.1 Portable Station (PS) Connection Power Failure Transfer • 13.3 [11-3] Power Failure Transfer Feature Guide References 2.4.1 Power Failure Transfer Printing Message • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Printing Message • 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge—Main— SMDR for External Hotel Application 2—Printing Message 1–8 Feature Guide References 1.26.2 Printing Message Privacy Release • 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 1— PT Operation—Privacy Release by SCO key • 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button— Type • 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button— Type • 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console— Type Feature Guide References PC Programming Manual 919 Feature Programming References 1.14.1.3 Privacy Release PS Directory • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— Extension Name • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— Extension Name • 8.1 [6-1] System Speed Dial Name – – CO Line Access Number + Telephone Number Feature Guide References 1.25.3 PS Directory PS Ring Group • 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Main— • 5.25 [3-9] PS Ring Group • 5.26 [3-9] PS Ring Group—Member List Distribution Method Feature Guide References 1.25.2 PS Ring Group PS Roaming by Network ICD Group • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Miscellaneous— System Wireless—PS Out of Range Timer • 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 4— System Wireless—Out of Range Registration Feature Guide References 1.30.6.1 PS Roaming by Network ICD Group PT Programming • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—Programming & Manager— • 13.1 [11-1] Main—Password System Password - PT Programming—Prog ** : User Level – – System Password - PT Programming—Prog *# : Administrator Level – Manager Password - PT Programming—Prog *1 Programming Mode Level Feature Guide References 2.3.2 PT Programming Queuing Feature • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Incoming Call Queue Monitor • 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 4— Transfer—Transfer to busy Extension without BSS Operation • 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings – Overflow Queuing Busy – Overflow No Answer – Queuing Time Table – Miscellaneous— Extension No Answer Redirection Time – Miscellaneous— Maximum No. of Busy Extension • 5.19 [3-7-1] VM(DPT) Group—System Settings— Call Waiting on VM Group • 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings— Others—Call Waiting on VM Group • 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Type – 920 PC Programming Manual Feature Programming References • • – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Hurry-up) 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button – Type – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Hurry-up) 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Type – – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Hurry-up) Feature Guide References 1.2.2.4 Queuing Feature Quick Dialling • 4.10 [2-6-2] Numbering Plan—Quick Dial Feature Guide References 1.6.1.6 Quick Dialling Reverse Circuit • 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port— Reverse Detection Feature Guide References 1.5.4.5 Reverse Circuit Ring Tone Pattern Selection • 4.15 [2-8-1] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from CO— Ring Tone Pattern Plan 1–8 • 4.16 [2-8-2] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from Doorphone— Ring Tone Pattern Plan 1–8 • 4.17 [2-8-3] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from Others— Extension—Ring Tone Pattern Plan 1–8 • 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 1— PT Operation—PT Ring Off Setting • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 1— Ring Pattern Table • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 1— Ring Pattern Table Feature Guide References 1.1.3.2 Ring Tone Pattern Selection Room Status Control • 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button— • 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console— Type • 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge – Main— Hotel Operator—Extension 1–4 – Bill— Checkout Billing—Billing for Guest Type Feature Guide References 1.27.2 Room Status Control Self Labelling (KX-NT366 and KX-NT400 only) • 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button— Label Name Feature Guide References 1.31.4 Self Labelling (KX-NT366 and KX-NT400 only) PC Programming Manual 921 Feature Programming References SIP (Session Initiation Protocol) Extension • 3.17 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - Virtual SIP Extension • 3.18 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port • 3.19 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Virtual SIP Extension Port—Connection Command Feature Guide References 1.31.2 SIP (Session Initiation Protocol) Extension SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol) • 13.4 [11-4-1] SNMP—System Setting • 13.5 [11-4-2] SNMP—Manager Feature Guide References 2.4.4 Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) System Monitor Software Upgrading • 2.6.2 Utility—File Transfer PC to PBX (SD Card) Feature Guide References 2.3.8 Software Upgrading Special Carrier Access Code • 9.3 [7-3] Special Carrier Feature Guide References 1.5.4.9 Special Carrier Access Code Speed Dialling—Personal/System • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features System Speed Dialling / Personal Speed Dialling – – Personal Speed Dialling - Programming • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—TRS— TRS Level for System Speed Dialling • 6.4 [4-1-3] Wired Extension—Speed Dial • 8.1 [6-1] System Speed Dial • 8.6 [6-6] Tenant— System Speed Dial Feature Guide References 1.6.1.5 Speed Dialling—Personal/System Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone— Dial—Analogue CO Call Duration Start • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—CO & SMDR— Outgoing CO Call Printout (SMDR) • 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge – Main— SMDR for External Hotel Application 2—Printing Message 1–8 – Charge— Charge Options—Currency • 13.1 [11-1] Main – SMDR – SMDR Options – RS-232C 922 PC Programming Manual Feature Programming References Feature Guide References 1.26.1.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) Supervisory Feature • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Incoming Call Queue Monitor • 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Miscellaneous— Supervisor Extension Number Feature Guide References 1.2.2.8 Supervisory Feature T1 Line Service • 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port • 3.37 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port—Connection Command Feature Guide References 1.23.1 T1 Line Service Tenant Service • 4.4 [2-2] Operator & BGM PBX Operator—Day, Lunch, Break, Night – – BGM and Music on Hold—Music on Hold • 4.6 [2-4] Week Table • 4.8 [2-5] Holiday Table • 4.14 [2-7-3] Class of Service—Internal Call Block • 5.7 [3-2] User Group • 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Main— Tenant Number • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— User Group • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— User Group • 7.1 [5-1] Doorphone— Tenant Number • 7.7 [5-5] External Sensor— Tenant No. • 8.6 [6-6] Tenant • Section 10 [8] ARS • 10.6 [8-5] Carrier—Authorisation Code for Tenant • 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings—DIL— Tenant Number • 12.3 [10-3] DDI / DID Table— Tenant Number • 12.6 [10-4] MSN Table—MSN— Tenant Number Feature Guide References 2.2.3 Tenant Service Three-party Conference (3PTY)—by ISDN • 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—Supplementary Service— • COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E, 3PTY 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—Supplementary Service— COLP, CLIR, COLR, CNIP, CONP, CNIR, CONR, CF (Rerouting), CT, CCBS, AOC-D, AOC-E, E911, 3PTY Feature Guide References 1.21.1.8 Three-party Conference (3PTY)—by ISDN PC Programming Manual 923 Feature Programming References TIE Line Service • 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—Network Numbering Plan— Trunk Property • 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—Network Numbering Plan— Trunk Property • 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port— Trunk Property • 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port— Trunk Property • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Miscellaneous— Incoming Call Inter-digit Timer—TIE • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features – Idle Line Access (Local Access) – Trunk Group Access – TIE Line Access • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Other PBX Extension • 4.10 [2-6-2] Numbering Plan—Quick Dial— Use quick dial for rerouting to public CO when TIE line does • • • • • • not work 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—TRS— TRS Level—Day, Lunch, Break, Night 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 4— Private Network—TIE Call by Extension Numbering (Optional SD Card Required) 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings—Main— COS 11.1 [9-1] TIE Table 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings – DIL— Trunk Property – DIL— DIL Destination—Day, Lunch, Break, Night – DDI / DID / TIE / MSN 12.3 [10-3] DDI / DID Table— DDI / DID Destination—Day, Lunch, Break, Night Feature Guide References 1.30.1 TIE Line Service Time Service • 4.6 [2-4] Week Table • 4.8 [2-5] Holiday Table • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Time Service (Day / Lunch / Break / Night) Switch • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—Programming & Manager— Time Service Switch • 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Type – – Parameter Selection (for Time Service) – Parameter Selection (for Time Service - Automatic/Manual) – Optional Parameter (Ringing Tone Type Number) (for Time Service) • 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Type – – Parameter Selection (for Time Service) – Parameter Selection (for Time Service - Automatic/Manual) – Optional Parameter (or Ringing Tone Type Number) (for Time Service) • 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console – Type – Parameter Selection (for Time Service) – Parameter Selection (for Time Service - Automatic/Manual) – Optional Parameter (Ringing Tone Type Number) (for Time Service) Feature Guide References 2.2.4 Time Service 924 PC Programming Manual Feature Programming References Timed Reminder • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—DISA / Door / Reminder / U. Conf Timed Reminder—Repeat Counter – – Timed Reminder—Interval Time – Timed Reminder—Alarm Ringing Duration • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features Remote Timed Reminder (Remote Wakeup Call) – – Timed Reminder Set / Cancel • 4.17 [2-8-3] Ring Tone Patterns—Call from Others— Timed Reminder—Ring Tone Pattern Plan 1–8 • 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 1— PT LCD—Time Display • 7.3 [5-3-1] Voice Message—DISA System— Timed Reminder Message—Day, Lunch, Break, Night • 8.2 [6-2] Hotel & Charge—Main— SMDR for External Hotel Application 1—Timed Reminder (Wake-up • Call) 13.1 [11-1] Main—SMDR— Print Information—Timed Reminder (Wake-up Call) Feature Guide References 1.28.4 Timed Reminder Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—TRS – TRS Level—Day, Lunch, Break, Night – TRS Level for System Speed Dialling • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— COS • 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Type – – Parameter Selection (for TRS Level Change) • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— COS • 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button – Type – Parameter Selection (for TRS Level Change) • 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console – Type – Parameter Selection (for TRS Level Change) • 9.1 [7-1] Denied Code • 9.2 [7-2] Exception Code • 9.3 [7-3] Special Carrier • 9.5 [7-5] Miscellaneous Feature Guide References 1.9.1 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) Trunk Access • 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port— Connection • 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port— Connection • 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port— Connection • 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port— Connection • 3.36 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - T1 Port— Connection • 3.42 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - E1 Port— Connection • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features Idle Line Access (Local Access) – PC Programming Manual 925 Feature Programming References – – • • • • • • • • Trunk Group Access Single CO Line Access 4.13 [2-7-2] Class of Service—External Call Block 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings—Main— Line Hunting Order 5.2 [3-1-2] Trunk Group—Local Access Priority 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button – Type – Parameter Selection (for Single CO) – Parameter Selection (for Group CO) 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Type – – Parameter Selection (for Single CO) – Parameter Selection (for Group CO) 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Type – – Parameter Selection (for Single CO) – Parameter Selection (for Group CO) 10.1 [8-1] System Setting— ARS Mode 12.1 [10-1] CO Line Settings— CO Name Feature Guide References 1.5.5.3 Trunk Access Trunk Answer From Any Station (TAFAS) • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— TAFAS Answer • 4.20 [2-11-1] Audio Gain—Paging/MOH— Paging—EPG (External Pager) • 7.2 [5-2] External Pager Feature Guide References 1.17.3 Trunk Answer From Any Station (TAFAS) Trunk Busy Out • 3.28 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - LCO Port— Busy Out Status • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Busy Out Cancel • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—Programming & Manager— Manager • 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 4— Busy Out—Busy Out for Analogue CO Feature Guide References 1.5.4.6 Trunk Busy Out Trunk Call Limitation • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—CO & SMDR— Extension-CO Line Call Duration Limit • 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 2— Extension - CO Call Limitation—For Incoming Call • 5.1 [3-1-1] Trunk Group—TRG Settings—Main – CO-CO Duration Time – Extension-CO Duration Time • 9.5 [7-5] Miscellaneous— Dial Digits Limitation After Answering—Dial Digits Feature Guide References 1.11.8 Trunk Call Limitation 926 PC Programming Manual Feature Programming References Verification Code Entry • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Miscellaneous— Extension PIN—Lock Counter • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— User Remote Operation / Walking COS / Verification • • • Code 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings – Option 1— ARS Itemised Code – Option 3— Charge Limit 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings – Option 1— ARS Itemised Code – Option 3— Charge Limit 8.3 [6-3] Verification Code Feature Guide References 1.9.6 Verification Code Entry VIP Call • 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Miscellaneous— VIP Call Mode Feature Guide References 1.2.2.5 VIP Call Virtual Private Network (VPN) • 3.31 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - BRI Port—Network Numbering Plan— • 3.33 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - PRI Port—Network Numbering Plan— • 10.2 [8-2] Leading Number— Leading Number • 11.1 [9-1] TIE Table Leading Number – – Removed Number of Digits – Added Number Trunk Property Trunk Property Feature Guide References 1.30.3 Virtual Private Network (VPN) Virtual PS • 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station— Registration Feature Guide References 1.25.6 Virtual PS Voice Mail (VM) Group • 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port— DPT Type—Type • 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port— DPT Type—VM Unit No. • 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port— DPT Type—VM Port No. • 5.19 [3-7-1] VM(DPT) Group—System Settings • 5.20 [3-7-2] VM(DPT) Group—Unit Settings • 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings • 5.23 [3-8-2] VM(DTMF) Group—Group Settings Feature Guide References 1.24.1 Voice Mail (VM) Group PC Programming Manual 927 Feature Programming References Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Dial / IRNA / Recall / Tone— Recall—Transfer Recall • 5.19 [3-7-1] VM(DPT) Group—System Settings • 5.20 [3-7-2] VM(DPT) Group—Unit Settings • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 4 – LCS Recording Mode – LCS Answer Mode • 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button Type – – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Two-way Record) – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Two-way Transfer) – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Voice Mail Transfer) – Ext No. of Mailbox (for Two-way Transfer) • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 4— LCS Recording Mode • 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button Type – – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Two-way Record) – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Two-way Transfer) – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Voice Mail Transfer) – Ext No. of Mailbox (for Two-way Transfer) • 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Type – – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Two-way Record) – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Two-way Transfer) – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Voice Mail Transfer) – Ext No. of Mailbox (for Two-way Transfer) • 7.1 [5-1] Doorphone— VM Trunk Group Number • 12.2 [10-2] DIL Table & Port Settings—DIL Tenant Number – – VM Trunk Group No. • 12.3 [10-3] DDI / DID Table – Tenant Number – VM Trunk Group No. • 12.6 [10-4] MSN Table—MSN – Tenant Number – VM Trunk Group No. Feature Guide References 1.24.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration Voice Mail DTMF Integration • 4.5 [2-3] Timers & Counters—Miscellaneous— Voice Mail (Caller from VM to CO)—On-hook Wait Time • 5.13 [3-5-1] Incoming Call Distribution Group—Group Settings—Miscellaneous— Programmed Mailbox • • • • 928 No. 5.22 [3-8-1] VM(DTMF) Group—System Settings 5.23 [3-8-2] VM(DTMF) Group—Group Settings 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 1— 6.5 [4-1-4] Wired Extension—Flexible Button – Type – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Voice Mail Transfer) PC Programming Manual Programmed Mailbox No. Feature Programming References • • • 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Option 1— 6.13 [4-2-3] Portable Station—Flexible Button – Type – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Voice Mail Transfer) 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console Type – – Ext. No. / Floating Ext. No. (for Voice Mail Transfer) Programmed Mailbox No. Feature Guide References 1.24.2 Voice Mail DTMF Integration Voice over Internet Protocol (VoIP) Network • 3.4 [1-1] Slot—Card Property - IPCMPR Feature Guide References 1.30.2 Voice over Internet Protocol (VoIP) Network Walking COS • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— • • • User Remote Operation / Walking COS / Verification Code 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—Optional Device & Other Extensions— Remote Operation by Other Extension 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— Extension PIN 6.10 [4-2-1] Portable Station—Extension Settings—Main— Extension PIN Feature Guide References 1.9.5 Walking COS Walking Extension • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Walking Extension • 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Main— Extension PIN • 6.17 [4-3] DSS Console— Pair Extension Feature Guide References 1.28.3 Walking Extension Features Whisper OHCA • 4.11 [2-6-3] Numbering Plan—B/NA DND Call Feature BSS / OHCA / Whisper OHCA / DND Override – – BSS / OHCA / Whisper OHCA / DND Override-2 • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—Extension Feature— OHCA / Whisper OHCA • 4.18 [2-9] System Options—Option 5— Whisper OHCA—for SLT / APT / KX-T72xx Feature Guide References 1.8.4.4 Whisper OHCA Wireless XDP Parallel Mode • 3.24 [1-1] Slot—Port Property - Extension Port— DPT Type—Type • 3.47 [1-2] Portable Station—PS Registration and De-registration • 4.9 [2-6-1] Numbering Plan—Main—Features— Wireless XDP Parallel Mode Set / Cancel PC Programming Manual 929 Feature Programming References • • 4.12 [2-7-1] Class of Service—COS Settings—Optional Device & Other Extensions— XDP Parallel Mode Set by PS 6.1 [4-1-1] Wired Extension—Extension Settings—Option 1— Wireless XDP Feature Guide References 1.25.5 Wireless XDP Parallel Mode 930 PC Programming Manual Accept Wireless Notes PC Programming Manual 931 1-62, 4-chome, Minoshima, Hakata-ku, Fukuoka 812-8531, Japan Copyright: This material is copyrighted by Panasonic Communications Co., Ltd., and may be reproduced for internal use only. All other reproduction, in whole or in part, is prohibited without the written consent of Panasonic Communications Co., Ltd. Panasonic Communications Co., Ltd. 2008 PSQX4753XA KK0808GJ2049
* Your assessment is very important for improving the work of artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project
advertisement